]> pere.pagekite.me Git - text-free-culture-lessig.git/blob - freeculture.xml
Two more index entries.
[text-free-culture-lessig.git] / freeculture.xml
1 <?xml version='1.0' encoding='UTF-8' ?>
2 <!-- Converted to DocBook by Hans Schou 2004-03-29 -->
3 <!--
4 TODO
5 * indexterm primary
6 * replace '. . .' with something else
7 * quotes ?
8 -->
9 <!DOCTYPE book PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.3//EN"
10 "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.3/docbookx.dtd"
11 [
12 <!ENTITY copy "©">
13 <!ENTITY translationblock "">
14 ]>
15 <!--
16 -->
17
18 <book id="index" lang="en">
19 <bookinfo>
20 <title>Free Culture</title>
21
22 <abbrev>"freeculture"</abbrev>
23
24 <subtitle>HOW BIG MEDIA USES TECHNOLOGY AND THE LAW TO LOCK DOWN
25 CULTURE AND CONTROL CREATIVITY</subtitle>
26
27 <pubdate>2004-03-25</pubdate>
28
29 <releaseinfo>Version 2004-02-10</releaseinfo>
30
31 <authorgroup>
32 <author>
33 <firstname>Lawrence</firstname>
34 <surname>Lessig</surname>
35 </author>
36 </authorgroup>
37
38 <copyright>
39 <year>2004</year>
40 <holder>Lawrence Lessig</holder>
41 </copyright>
42
43 <legalnotice>
44 <para>
45 This version of <citetitle>Free Culture</citetitle> is licensed under
46 a Creative Commons license. This license permits non-commercial use of
47 this work, so long as attribution is given. For more information
48 about the license, click the icon above, or visit
49 <ulink url="http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc/1.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc/1.0/</ulink>
50 </para>
51 </legalnotice>
52
53 <abstract>
54 <title>ABOUT THE AUTHOR</title>
55 <para>
56 LAWRENCE LESSIG
57 (<ulink url="http://www.lessig.org/">http://www.lessig.org</ulink>),
58 professor of law and a John A. Wilson Distinguished Faculty Scholar
59 at Stanford Law School, is founder of the Stanford Center for Internet
60 and Society and is chairman of the Creative Commons
61 (<ulink url="http://creativecommons.org/">http://creativecommons.org</ulink>).
62 The author of The Future of Ideas (Random House, 2001) and Code: And
63 Other Laws of Cyberspace (Basic Books, 1999), Lessig is a member of
64 the boards of the Public Library of Science, the Electronic Frontier
65 Foundation, and Public Knowledge. He was the winner of the Free
66 Software Foundation's Award for the Advancement of Free Software,
67 twice listed in BusinessWeek's "e.biz 25," and named one of Scientific
68 American's "50 visionaries." A graduate of the University of
69 Pennsylvania, Cambridge University, and Yale Law School, Lessig
70 clerked for Judge Richard Posner of the U.S. Seventh Circuit Court of
71 Appeals.
72 </para>
73 </abstract>
74 </bookinfo>
75
76 <colophon>
77 <!-- PAGE BREAK 1 -->
78
79 <para>
80 You can buy a copy of this book by clicking on one of the links below:
81 </para>
82 <itemizedlist mark="number" spacing="compact">
83 <listitem><para><ulink url="http://www.amazon.com/">Amazon</ulink></para></listitem>
84 <listitem><para><ulink url="http://www.barnesandnoble.com/">B&amp;N</ulink></para></listitem>
85 <listitem><para><ulink url="http://www.penguin.com/">Penguin</ulink></para></listitem>
86 <!-- <ulink url="">Local Bookstore</ulink> -->
87 </itemizedlist>
88 <!-- PAGE BREAK 2 -->
89
90 <!-- PAGE BREAK 3 -->
91 <para>
92 ALSO BY LAWRENCE LESSIG
93 </para>
94 <para>
95 The Future of Ideas: The Fate of the Commons in a Connected World
96 </para>
97 <para>
98 Code: And Other Laws of Cyberspace
99 </para>
100
101 <!-- PAGE BREAK 4 -->
102 <para>
103 THE PENGUIN PRESS, NEW YORK
104 </para>
105
106 <!-- PAGE BREAK 5 -->
107 <para>
108 FREE CULTURE
109 </para>
110
111 <para>
112 HOW BIG MEDIA USES TECHNOLOGY AND
113 THE LAW TO LOCK DOWN CULTURE
114 AND CONTROL CREATIVITY
115 </para>
116
117 <para>
118 LAWRENCE LESSIG
119 </para>
120
121 <!-- PAGE BREAK 6 -->
122 <para>
123 THE PENGUIN PRESS, a member of Penguin Group (USA) Inc. 375 Hudson Street New
124 York, New York
125 </para>
126 <para>
127 Copyright &copy; Lawrence Lessig. All rights reserved.
128 </para>
129 <para>
130 Excerpt from an editorial titled "The Coming of Copyright Perpetuity,"
131 <citetitle>The New York Times</citetitle>, January 16, 2003. Copyright
132 &copy; 2003 by The New York Times Co. Reprinted with permission.
133 </para>
134 <para>
135 Cartoon in <xref linkend="fig-1711"/> by Paul Conrad, copyright Tribune
136 Media Services, Inc. All rights reserved. Reprinted with permission.
137 </para>
138 <para>
139 Diagram in <xref linkend="fig-1761"/> courtesy of the office of FCC
140 Commissioner, Michael J. Copps.
141 </para>
142 <para>
143 Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data
144 </para>
145 <para>
146 Lessig, Lawrence.
147 Free culture : how big media uses technology and the law to lock down
148 culture and control creativity / Lawrence Lessig.
149 </para>
150 <para>
151 p. cm.
152 </para>
153 <para>
154 Includes index.
155 </para>
156 <para>
157 ISBN 1-59420-006-8 (hardcover)
158 </para>
159 <para>
160 1. Intellectual property&mdash;United States. 2. Mass media&mdash;United States.
161 </para>
162 <para>
163 3. Technological innovations&mdash;United States. 4. Art&mdash;United States. I. Title.
164 </para>
165 <para>
166 KF2979.L47
167 </para>
168 <para>
169 343.7309'9&mdash;dc22
170 </para>
171 <para>
172 This book is printed on acid-free paper.
173 </para>
174 <para>
175 Printed in the United States of America
176 </para>
177 <para>
178 1 3 5 7 9 10 8 6 4
179 </para>
180 <para>
181 Designed by Marysarah Quinn
182 </para>
183
184 <para>
185 &translationblock;
186 </para>
187
188 <para>
189 Without limiting the rights under copyright reserved above, no part of
190 this publication may be reproduced, stored in or introduced into a
191 retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means
192 (electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise),
193 without the prior written permission of both the copyright owner and
194 the above publisher of this book. The scanning, uploading, and
195 distribution of this book via the Internet or via any other means
196 without the permission of the publisher is illegal and punishable by
197 law. Please purchase only authorized electronic editions and do not
198 participate in or encourage electronic piracy of copyrighted
199 materials. Your support of the author's rights is appreciated.
200 </para>
201 </colophon>
202
203 <!-- PAGE BREAK 7 -->
204 <dedication>
205 <para>
206 To Eric Eldred&mdash;whose work first drew me to this cause, and for whom
207 it continues still.
208 </para>
209
210 <para>
211 <figure id="CreativeCommons">
212 <title>Creative Commons, Some rights reserved</title>
213 <graphic fileref="images/cc.png"></graphic>
214 </figure>
215 </para>
216 </dedication>
217
218 <toc id="toc"></toc>
219
220 <lot>
221 <title>List of figures</title>
222 </lot>
223
224 <!--
225 c PREFACE xiii
226 c INTRODUCTION
227 c "PIRACY"
228 1 CHAPTER ONE: Creators
229 1 CHAPTER TWO: "Mere Copyists"
230 1 CHAPTER THREE: Catalogs
231 1 CHAPTER FOUR: "Pirates"
232 2 Film
233 2 Recorded Music
234 2 Radio
235 2 Cable TV
236 1 CHAPTER FIVE: "Piracy"
237 2 Piracy I
238 2 Piracy II
239 c "PROPERTY"
240 1 CHAPTER SIX: Founders
241 1 CHAPTER SEVEN: Recorders
242 1 CHAPTER EIGHT: Transformers
243 1 CHAPTER NINE: Collectors
244 1 CHAPTER TEN: "Property"
245 2 Why Hollywood Is Right
246 2 Beginnings
247 2 Law: Duration
248 2 Law: Scope
249 2 Law and Architecture: Reach
250 2 Architecture and Law: Force
251 2 Market: Concentration
252 2 Together
253 c PUZZLES
254 1 CHAPTER ELEVEN: Chimera
255 1 CHAPTER TWELVE: Harms
256 2 Constraining Creators
257 2 Constraining Innovators
258 2 Corrupting Citizens
259 c BALANCES
260 1 CHAPTER THIRTEEN: Eldred
261 1 CHAPTER FOURTEEN: Eldred II
262 c CONCLUSION
263 c AFTERWORD
264 1 Us, Now
265 2 Rebuilding Freedoms Previously Presumed: Examples
266 2 Rebuilding Free Culture: One Idea
267 1 Them, Soon
268 2 1. More Formalities
269 3 Registration and Renewal
270 3 Marking
271 2 2. Shorter Terms
272 2 3. Free Use Vs. Fair Use
273 2 4. Liberate the Music- -Again
274 2 5. Fire Lots of Lawyers 304
275 c NOTES
276 c ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
277 c INDEX
278 -->
279
280 <!-- PAGE BREAK 11 -->
281
282 <preface id="preface">
283 <title>PREFACE</title>
284 <indexterm id="idxpoguedavid" class='startofrange'>
285 <primary>Pogue, David</primary>
286 </indexterm>
287 <para>
288 At the end of his review of my first book, <citetitle>Code: And Other
289 Laws of Cyberspace</citetitle>, David Pogue, a brilliant writer and
290 author of countless technical and computer-related texts, wrote this:
291 </para>
292 <blockquote>
293 <para>
294 Unlike actual law, Internet software has no capacity to punish. It
295 doesn't affect people who aren't online (and only a tiny minority
296 of the world population is). And if you don't like the Internet's
297 system, you can always flip off the modem.<footnote id="preface01"><para>
298 David Pogue, "Don't Just Chat, Do Something," <citetitle>New York Times</citetitle>, 30 January 2000.
299 </para></footnote>
300 </para>
301 </blockquote>
302 <para>
303 Pogue was skeptical of the core argument of the book&mdash;that
304 software, or "code," functioned as a kind of law&mdash;and his review
305 suggested the happy thought that if life in cyberspace got bad, we
306 could always "drizzle, drazzle, druzzle, drome"-like simply flip a
307 switch and be back home. Turn off the modem, unplug the computer, and
308 any troubles that exist in <emphasis>that</emphasis> space wouldn't
309 "affect" us anymore.
310 </para>
311 <para>
312 Pogue might have been right in 1999&mdash;I'm skeptical, but maybe.
313 But even if he was right then, the point is not right now:
314 <citetitle>Free Culture</citetitle> is about the troubles the Internet
315 causes even after the modem is turned
316 <!-- PAGE BREAK 12 -->
317 off. It is an argument about how the battles that now rage regarding life
318 on-line have fundamentally affected "people who aren't online." There
319 is no switch that will insulate us from the Internet's effect.
320 </para>
321 <indexterm startref="idxpoguedavid" class='endofrange'/>
322 <para>
323 But unlike <citetitle>Code</citetitle>, the argument here is not much
324 about the Internet itself. It is instead about the consequence of the
325 Internet to a part of our tradition that is much more fundamental,
326 and, as hard as this is for a geek-wanna-be to admit, much more
327 important.
328 </para>
329 <para>
330 That tradition is the way our culture gets made. As I explain in the
331 pages that follow, we come from a tradition of "free culture"&mdash;not
332 "free" as in "free beer" (to borrow a phrase from the founder of the
333 free software movement<footnote>
334 <para>
335 Richard M. Stallman, <citetitle>Free Software, Free Societies</citetitle> 57 (Joshua Gay, ed. 2002).
336 </para></footnote>), but "free" as in "free speech," "free markets,"
337 "free trade," "free enterprise," "free will," and "free elections." A
338 free culture supports and protects creators and innovators. It does
339 this directly by granting intellectual property rights. But it does so
340 indirectly by limiting the reach of those rights, to guarantee that
341 follow-on creators and innovators remain <emphasis>as free as
342 possible</emphasis> from the control of the past. A free culture is
343 not a culture without property, just as a free market is not a market
344 in which everything is free. The opposite of a free culture is a
345 "permission culture"&mdash;a culture in which creators get to create
346 only with the permission of the powerful, or of creators from the
347 past.
348 </para>
349 <para>
350 If we understood this change, I believe we would resist it. Not "we"
351 on the Left or "you" on the Right, but we who have no stake in the
352 particular industries of culture that defined the twentieth century.
353 Whether you are on the Left or the Right, if you are in this sense
354 disinterested, then the story I tell here will trouble you. For the
355 changes I describe affect values that both sides of our political
356 culture deem fundamental.
357 </para>
358 <indexterm><primary>CodePink Women in Peace</primary></indexterm>
359 <para>
360 We saw a glimpse of this bipartisan outrage in the early summer of
361 2003. As the FCC considered changes in media ownership rules that
362 would relax limits on media concentration, an extraordinary coalition
363 generated more than 700,000 letters to the FCC opposing the change.
364 As William Safire described marching "uncomfortably alongside CodePink
365 Women for Peace and the National Rifle Association, between liberal
366 Olympia Snowe and conservative Ted Stevens," he formulated perhaps
367 most simply just what was at stake: the concentration of power. And as
368 he asked,
369 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William</primary></indexterm>
370 </para>
371 <blockquote>
372 <para>
373 Does that sound unconservative? Not to me. The concentration of
374 power&mdash;political, corporate, media, cultural&mdash;should be anathema to
375 conservatives. The diffusion of power through local control, thereby
376 encouraging individual participation, is the essence of federalism and
377 the greatest expression of democracy.<footnote><para> William Safire,
378 "The Great Media Gulp," <citetitle>New York Times</citetitle>, 22 May 2003.
379 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William</primary></indexterm>
380 </para></footnote>
381 </para>
382 </blockquote>
383 <para>
384 This idea is an element of the argument of <citetitle>Free Culture</citetitle>, though my
385 focus is not just on the concentration of power produced by
386 concentrations in ownership, but more importantly, if because less
387 visibly, on the concentration of power produced by a radical change in
388 the effective scope of the law. The law is changing; that change is
389 altering the way our culture gets made; that change should worry
390 you&mdash;whether or not you care about the Internet, and whether you're on
391 Safire's left or on his right. The inspiration for the title and for
392 much of the argument of this book comes from the work of Richard
393 Stallman and the Free Software Foundation. Indeed, as I reread
394 Stallman's own work, especially the essays in <citetitle>Free Software, Free
395 Society</citetitle>, I realize that all of the theoretical insights I develop here
396 are insights Stallman described decades ago. One could thus well argue
397 that this work is "merely" derivative.
398 </para>
399 <para>
400 I accept that criticism, if indeed it is a criticism. The work of a
401 lawyer is always derivative, and I mean to do nothing more in this
402 book than to remind a culture about a tradition that has always been
403 its own. Like Stallman, I defend that tradition on the basis of
404 values. Like Stallman, I believe those are the values of freedom. And
405 like Stallman, I believe those are values of our past that will need
406 to be defended in our future. A free culture has been our past, but it
407 will only be our future if we change the path we are on right now.
408
409 <!-- PAGE BREAK 14 -->
410 Like Stallman's arguments for free software, an argument for free
411 culture stumbles on a confusion that is hard to avoid, and even harder
412 to understand. A free culture is not a culture without property; it is not
413 a culture in which artists don't get paid. A culture without property, or
414 in which creators can't get paid, is anarchy, not freedom. Anarchy is not
415 what I advance here.
416 </para>
417 <para>
418 Instead, the free culture that I defend in this book is a balance
419 between anarchy and control. A free culture, like a free market, is
420 filled with property. It is filled with rules of property and contract
421 that get enforced by the state. But just as a free market is perverted
422 if its property becomes feudal, so too can a free culture be queered
423 by extremism in the property rights that define it. That is what I
424 fear about our culture today. It is against that extremism that this
425 book is written.
426 </para>
427
428 </preface>
429 <!-- PAGE BREAK 15 -->
430
431 <!-- PAGE BREAK 16 -->
432 <chapter id="c-introduction">
433 <title>INTRODUCTION</title>
434 <para>
435 On December 17, 1903, on a windy North Carolina beach for just
436 shy of one hundred seconds, the Wright brothers demonstrated that a
437 heavier-than-air, self-propelled vehicle could fly. The moment was electric
438 and its importance widely understood. Almost immediately, there
439 was an explosion of interest in this newfound technology of manned
440 flight, and a gaggle of innovators began to build upon it.
441 </para>
442 <para>
443 At the time the Wright brothers invented the airplane, American
444 law held that a property owner presumptively owned not just the surface
445 of his land, but all the land below, down to the center of the earth,
446 and all the space above, to "an indefinite extent, upwards."<footnote><para>
447 St. George Tucker, <citetitle>Blackstone's Commentaries</citetitle> 3 (South Hackensack, N.J.:
448 Rothman Reprints, 1969), 18.
449 </para></footnote>
450 For many
451 years, scholars had puzzled about how best to interpret the idea that
452 rights in land ran to the heavens. Did that mean that you owned the
453 stars? Could you prosecute geese for their willful and regular trespass?
454 </para>
455 <para>
456 Then came airplanes, and for the first time, this principle of American
457 law&mdash;deep within the foundations of our tradition, and acknowledged
458 by the most important legal thinkers of our past&mdash;mattered. If
459 my land reaches to the heavens, what happens when United flies over
460 my field? Do I have the right to banish it from my property? Am I allowed
461 to enter into an exclusive license with Delta Airlines? Could we
462 set up an auction to decide how much these rights are worth?
463 </para>
464 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee</primary></indexterm>
465 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie</primary></indexterm>
466 <para>
467 In 1945, these questions became a federal case. When North Carolina
468 farmers Thomas Lee and Tinie Causby started losing chickens
469 because of low-flying military aircraft (the terrified chickens apparently
470 flew into the barn walls and died), the Causbys filed a lawsuit saying
471 that the government was trespassing on their land. The airplanes,
472 of course, never touched the surface of the Causbys' land. But if, as
473 Blackstone, Kent, and Coke had said, their land reached to "an indefinite
474 extent, upwards," then the government was trespassing on their
475 property, and the Causbys wanted it to stop.
476 </para>
477 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee</primary></indexterm>
478 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie</primary></indexterm>
479 <para>
480 The Supreme Court agreed to hear the Causbys' case. Congress had
481 declared the airways public, but if one's property really extended to the
482 heavens, then Congress's declaration could well have been an unconstitutional
483 "taking" of property without compensation. The Court acknowledged
484 that "it is ancient doctrine that common law ownership of
485 the land extended to the periphery of the universe." But Justice Douglas
486 had no patience for ancient doctrine. In a single paragraph, hundreds of
487 years of property law were erased. As he wrote for the Court,
488 </para>
489 <blockquote>
490 <para>
491 [The] doctrine has no place in the modern world. The air is a
492 public highway, as Congress has declared. Were that not true,
493 every transcontinental flight would subject the operator to countless
494 trespass suits. Common sense revolts at the idea. To recognize
495 such private claims to the airspace would clog these highways,
496 seriously interfere with their control and development in the public
497 interest, and transfer into private ownership that to which only
498 the public has a just claim.<footnote>
499 <para>
500 United States v. Causby, U.S. 328 (1946): 256, 261. The Court did find
501 that there could be a "taking" if the government's use of its land
502 effectively destroyed the value of the Causbys' land. This example was
503 suggested to me by Keith Aoki's wonderful piece, "(Intellectual)
504 Property and Sovereignty: Notes Toward a Cultural Geography of
505 Authorship," <citetitle>Stanford Law Review</citetitle> 48 (1996): 1293, 1333. See also Paul
506 Goldstein, <citetitle>Real Property</citetitle> (Mineola, N.Y.: Foundation Press, 1984),
507 1112&ndash;13.
508 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee</primary></indexterm>
509 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie</primary></indexterm>
510 </para></footnote>
511 </para>
512 </blockquote>
513 <para>
514 "Common sense revolts at the idea."
515 </para>
516 <para>
517 This is how the law usually works. Not often this abruptly or
518 impatiently, but eventually, this is how it works. It was Douglas's style not to
519 dither. Other justices would have blathered on for pages to reach the
520 <!-- PAGE BREAK 18 -->
521 conclusion that Douglas holds in a single line: "Common sense revolts
522 at the idea." But whether it takes pages or a few words, it is the special
523 genius of a common law system, as ours is, that the law adjusts to the
524 technologies of the time. And as it adjusts, it changes. Ideas that were
525 as solid as rock in one age crumble in another.
526 </para>
527 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee</primary></indexterm>
528 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie</primary></indexterm>
529 <para>
530 Or at least, this is how things happen when there's no one powerful
531 on the other side of the change. The Causbys were just farmers. And
532 though there were no doubt many like them who were upset by the
533 growing traffic in the air (though one hopes not many chickens flew
534 themselves into walls), the Causbys of the world would find it very
535 hard to unite and stop the idea, and the technology, that the Wright
536 brothers had birthed. The Wright brothers spat airplanes into the
537 technological meme pool; the idea then spread like a virus in a chicken
538 coop; farmers like the Causbys found themselves surrounded by "what
539 seemed reasonable" given the technology that the Wrights had produced.
540 They could stand on their farms, dead chickens in hand, and
541 shake their fists at these newfangled technologies all they wanted.
542 They could call their representatives or even file a lawsuit. But in the
543 end, the force of what seems "obvious" to everyone else&mdash;the power of
544 "common sense"&mdash;would prevail. Their "private interest" would not be
545 allowed to defeat an obvious public gain.
546 </para>
547 <para>
548 Edwin Howard Armstrong is one of America's forgotten inventor
549 geniuses. He came to the great American inventor scene just after the
550 titans Thomas Edison and Alexander Graham Bell. But his work in
551 the area of radio technology was perhaps the most important of any
552 single inventor in the first fifty years of radio. He was better educated
553 than Michael Faraday, who as a bookbinder's apprentice had discovered
554 electric induction in 1831. But he had the same intuition about
555 how the world of radio worked, and on at least three occasions,
556 Armstrong invented profoundly important technologies that advanced our
557 understanding of radio.
558 <!-- PAGE BREAK 19 -->
559 <indexterm><primary>Bell, Alexander Graham</primary></indexterm>
560 <indexterm><primary>Edison, Thomas</primary></indexterm>
561 <indexterm><primary>Faraday, Michael</primary></indexterm>
562 </para>
563 <para>
564 On the day after Christmas, 1933, four patents were issued to Armstrong
565 for his most significant invention&mdash;FM radio. Until then, consumer radio
566 had been amplitude-modulated (AM) radio. The theorists
567 of the day had said that frequency-modulated (FM) radio could never
568 work. They were right about FM radio in a narrow band of spectrum.
569 But Armstrong discovered that frequency-modulated radio in a wide
570 band of spectrum would deliver an astonishing fidelity of sound, with
571 much less transmitter power and static.
572 </para>
573 <para>
574 On November 5, 1935, he demonstrated the technology at a meeting of
575 the Institute of Radio Engineers at the Empire State Building in New
576 York City. He tuned his radio dial across a range of AM stations,
577 until the radio locked on a broadcast that he had arranged from
578 seventeen miles away. The radio fell totally silent, as if dead, and
579 then with a clarity no one else in that room had ever heard from an
580 electrical device, it produced the sound of an announcer's voice:
581 "This is amateur station W2AG at Yonkers, New York, operating on
582 frequency modulation at two and a half meters."
583 </para>
584 <para>
585 The audience was hearing something no one had thought possible:
586 </para>
587 <blockquote>
588 <para>
589 A glass of water was poured before the microphone in Yonkers; it
590 sounded like a glass of water being poured. . . . A paper was crumpled
591 and torn; it sounded like paper and not like a crackling forest
592 fire. . . . Sousa marches were played from records and a piano solo
593 and guitar number were performed. . . . The music was projected with a
594 live-ness rarely if ever heard before from a radio "music
595 box."<footnote><para>
596 Lawrence Lessing, <citetitle>Man of High Fidelity: Edwin Howard Armstrong</citetitle>
597 (Philadelphia: J. B. Lipincott Company, 1956), 209.
598 </para></footnote>
599 </para>
600 </blockquote>
601 <para>
602 As our own common sense tells us, Armstrong had discovered a vastly
603 superior radio technology. But at the time of his invention, Armstrong
604 was working for RCA. RCA was the dominant player in the then dominant
605 AM radio market. By 1935, there were a thousand radio stations across
606 the United States, but the stations in large cities were all owned by
607 a handful of networks.
608 <!-- PAGE BREAK 20 -->
609 </para>
610 <para>
611 RCA's president, David Sarnoff, a friend of Armstrong's, was eager
612 that Armstrong discover a way to remove static from AM radio. So
613 Sarnoff was quite excited when Armstrong told him he had a device
614 that removed static from "radio." But when Armstrong demonstrated
615 his invention, Sarnoff was not pleased.
616 <indexterm><primary>Sarnoff, David</primary></indexterm>
617 </para>
618 <blockquote>
619 <para>
620 I thought Armstrong would invent some kind of a filter to remove
621 static from our AM radio. I didn't think he'd start a
622 revolution&mdash; start up a whole damn new industry to compete with
623 RCA.<footnote><para> See "Saints: The Heroes and Geniuses of the
624 Electronic Era," First Electronic Church of America, at
625 www.webstationone.com/fecha, available at
626
627 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #1</ulink>.
628 </para></footnote>
629 </para>
630 </blockquote>
631 <para>
632 Armstrong's invention threatened RCA's AM empire, so the company
633 launched a campaign to smother FM radio. While FM may have been a
634 superior technology, Sarnoff was a superior tactician. As one author
635 described,
636 <indexterm><primary>Sarnoff, David</primary></indexterm>
637 </para>
638 <blockquote>
639 <para>
640 The forces for FM, largely engineering, could not overcome the weight
641 of strategy devised by the sales, patent, and legal offices to subdue
642 this threat to corporate position. For FM, if allowed to develop
643 unrestrained, posed . . . a complete reordering of radio power
644 . . . and the eventual overthrow of the carefully restricted AM system
645 on which RCA had grown to power.<footnote><para>Lessing, 226.
646 </para></footnote>
647 </para>
648 </blockquote>
649 <para>
650 RCA at first kept the technology in house, insisting that further
651 tests were needed. When, after two years of testing, Armstrong grew
652 impatient, RCA began to use its power with the government to stall
653 FM radio's deployment generally. In 1936, RCA hired the former head
654 of the FCC and assigned him the task of assuring that the FCC assign
655 spectrum in a way that would castrate FM&mdash;principally by moving FM
656 radio to a different band of spectrum. At first, these efforts failed. But
657 when Armstrong and the nation were distracted by World War II,
658 RCA's work began to be more successful. Soon after the war ended, the
659 FCC announced a set of policies that would have one clear effect: FM
660 radio would be crippled. As Lawrence Lessing described it,
661 </para>
662 <!-- PAGE BREAK 21 -->
663 <blockquote>
664 <para>
665 The series of body blows that FM radio received right after the
666 war, in a series of rulings manipulated through the FCC by the
667 big radio interests, were almost incredible in their force and
668 deviousness.<footnote><para>
669 Lessing, 256.
670 </para></footnote>
671 </para>
672 </blockquote>
673 <indexterm><primary>AT&amp;T</primary></indexterm>
674 <para>
675 To make room in the spectrum for RCA's latest gamble, television,
676 FM radio users were to be moved to a totally new spectrum band. The
677 power of FM radio stations was also cut, meaning FM could no longer
678 be used to beam programs from one part of the country to another.
679 (This change was strongly supported by AT&amp;T, because the loss of
680 FM relaying stations would mean radio stations would have to buy
681 wired links from AT&amp;T.) The spread of FM radio was thus choked, at
682 least temporarily.
683 </para>
684 <para>
685 Armstrong resisted RCA's efforts. In response, RCA resisted
686 Armstrong's patents. After incorporating FM technology into the
687 emerging standard for television, RCA declared the patents
688 invalid&mdash;baselessly, and almost fifteen years after they were
689 issued. It thus refused to pay him royalties. For six years, Armstrong
690 fought an expensive war of litigation to defend the patents. Finally,
691 just as the patents expired, RCA offered a settlement so low that it
692 would not even cover Armstrong's lawyers' fees. Defeated, broken, and
693 now broke, in 1954 Armstrong wrote a short note to his wife and then
694 stepped out of a thirteenth-story window to his death.
695 </para>
696 <para>
697 This is how the law sometimes works. Not often this tragically, and
698 rarely with heroic drama, but sometimes, this is how it works. From
699 the beginning, government and government agencies have been subject to
700 capture. They are more likely captured when a powerful interest is
701 threatened by either a legal or technical change. That powerful
702 interest too often exerts its influence within the government to get
703 the government to protect it. The rhetoric of this protection is of
704 course always public spirited; the reality is something
705 different. Ideas that were as solid as rock in one age, but that, left
706 to themselves, would crumble in
707 <!-- PAGE BREAK 22 -->
708 another, are sustained through this subtle corruption of our political
709 process. RCA had what the Causbys did not: the power to stifle the
710 effect of technological change.
711 </para>
712 <para>
713 There's no single inventor of the Internet. Nor is there any good date
714 upon which to mark its birth. Yet in a very short time, the Internet
715 has become part of ordinary American life. According to the Pew
716 Internet and American Life Project, 58 percent of Americans had access
717 to the Internet in 2002, up from 49 percent two years
718 before.<footnote><para>
719 Amanda Lenhart, "The Ever-Shifting Internet Population: A New Look at
720 Internet Access and the Digital Divide," Pew Internet and American
721 Life Project, 15 April 2003: 6, available at
722 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #2</ulink>.
723 </para></footnote>
724 That number could well exceed two thirds of the nation by the end
725 of 2004.
726 </para>
727 <para>
728 As the Internet has been integrated into ordinary life, it has
729 changed things. Some of these changes are technical&mdash;the Internet has
730 made communication faster, it has lowered the cost of gathering data,
731 and so on. These technical changes are not the focus of this book. They
732 are important. They are not well understood. But they are the sort of
733 thing that would simply go away if we all just switched the Internet off.
734 They don't affect people who don't use the Internet, or at least they
735 don't affect them directly. They are the proper subject of a book about
736 the Internet. But this is not a book about the Internet.
737 </para>
738 <para>
739 Instead, this book is about an effect of the Internet beyond the
740 Internet itself: an effect upon how culture is made. My claim is that
741 the Internet has induced an important and unrecognized change in that
742 process. That change will radically transform a tradition that is as
743 old as the Republic itself. Most, if they recognized this change,
744 would reject it. Yet most don't even see the change that the Internet
745 has introduced.
746 </para>
747 <para>
748 We can glimpse a sense of this change by distinguishing between
749 commercial and noncommercial culture, and by mapping the law's
750 regulation of each. By "commercial culture" I mean that part of our
751 culture that is produced and sold or produced to be sold. By
752 "noncommercial culture" I mean all the rest. When old men sat around
753 parks or on
754 <!-- PAGE BREAK 23 -->
755 street corners telling stories that kids and others consumed, that was
756 noncommercial culture. When Noah Webster published his "Reader," or
757 Joel Barlow his poetry, that was commercial culture.
758 </para>
759 <para>
760 At the beginning of our history, and for just about the whole of our
761 tradition, noncommercial culture was essentially unregulated. Of
762 course, if your stories were lewd, or if your song disturbed the
763 peace, then the law might intervene. But the law was never directly
764 concerned with the creation or spread of this form of culture, and it
765 left this culture "free." The ordinary ways in which ordinary
766 individuals shared and transformed their culture&mdash;telling
767 stories, reenacting scenes from plays or TV, participating in fan
768 clubs, sharing music, making tapes&mdash;were left alone by the law.
769 </para>
770 <para>
771 The focus of the law was on commercial creativity. At first slightly,
772 then quite extensively, the law protected the incentives of creators by
773 granting them exclusive rights to their creative work, so that they could
774 sell those exclusive rights in a commercial
775 marketplace.<footnote>
776 <para>
777 This is not the only purpose of copyright, though it is the overwhelmingly
778 primary purpose of the copyright established in the federal constitution.
779 State copyright law historically protected not just the commercial interest in
780 publication, but also a privacy interest. By granting authors the exclusive
781 right to first publication, state copyright law gave authors the power to
782 control the spread of facts about them. See Samuel D. Warren and Louis
783 D. Brandeis, "The Right to Privacy," Harvard Law Review 4 (1890): 193,
784 198&ndash;200.
785 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.</primary></indexterm>
786 </para></footnote>
787 This is also, of course, an important part of creativity and culture,
788 and it has become an increasingly important part in America. But in no
789 sense was it dominant within our tradition. It was instead just one
790 part, a controlled part, balanced with the free.
791 </para>
792 <para>
793 This rough divide between the free and the controlled has now
794 been erased.<footnote><para>
795 See Jessica Litman, <citetitle>Digital Copyright</citetitle> (New York: Prometheus Books,
796 2001), ch. 13.
797 <indexterm><primary>Litman, Jessica</primary></indexterm>
798 </para></footnote>
799 The Internet has set the stage for this erasure and, pushed by big
800 media, the law has now affected it. For the first time in our
801 tradition, the ordinary ways in which individuals create and share
802 culture fall within the reach of the regulation of the law, which has
803 expanded to draw within its control a vast amount of culture and
804 creativity that it never reached before. The technology that preserved
805 the balance of our history&mdash;between uses of our culture that were
806 free and uses of our culture that were only upon permission&mdash;has
807 been undone. The consequence is that we are less and less a free
808 culture, more and more a permission culture.
809 </para>
810 <!-- PAGE BREAK 24 -->
811 <para>
812 This change gets justified as necessary to protect commercial
813 creativity. And indeed, protectionism is precisely its
814 motivation. But the protectionism that justifies the changes that I
815 will describe below is not the limited and balanced sort that has
816 defined the law in the past. This is not a protectionism to protect
817 artists. It is instead a protectionism to protect certain forms of
818 business. Corporations threatened by the potential of the Internet to
819 change the way both commercial and noncommercial culture are made and
820 shared have united to induce lawmakers to use the law to protect
821 them. It is the story of RCA and Armstrong; it is the dream of the
822 Causbys.
823 </para>
824 <para>
825 For the Internet has unleashed an extraordinary possibility for many
826 to participate in the process of building and cultivating a culture
827 that reaches far beyond local boundaries. That power has changed the
828 marketplace for making and cultivating culture generally, and that
829 change in turn threatens established content industries. The Internet
830 is thus to the industries that built and distributed content in the
831 twentieth century what FM radio was to AM radio, or what the truck was
832 to the railroad industry of the nineteenth century: the beginning of
833 the end, or at least a substantial transformation. Digital
834 technologies, tied to the Internet, could produce a vastly more
835 competitive and vibrant market for building and cultivating culture;
836 that market could include a much wider and more diverse range of
837 creators; those creators could produce and distribute a much more
838 vibrant range of creativity; and depending upon a few important
839 factors, those creators could earn more on average from this system
840 than creators do today&mdash;all so long as the RCAs of our day don't
841 use the law to protect themselves against this competition.
842 </para>
843 <para>
844 Yet, as I argue in the pages that follow, that is precisely what is
845 happening in our culture today. These modern-day equivalents of the
846 early twentieth-century radio or nineteenth-century railroads are
847 using their power to get the law to protect them against this new,
848 more efficient, more vibrant technology for building culture. They are
849 succeeding in their plan to remake the Internet before the Internet
850 remakes them.
851 </para>
852 <para>
853 It doesn't seem this way to many. The battles over copyright and the
854 <!-- PAGE BREAK 25 -->
855 Internet seem remote to most. To the few who follow them, they seem
856 mainly about a much simpler brace of questions&mdash;whether "piracy" will
857 be permitted, and whether "property" will be protected. The "war" that
858 has been waged against the technologies of the Internet&mdash;what
859 Motion Picture Association of America (MPAA) president Jack Valenti
860 calls his "own terrorist war"<footnote><para>
861 Amy Harmon, "Black Hawk Download: Moving Beyond Music, Pirates
862 Use New Tools to Turn the Net into an Illicit Video Club," <citetitle>New York
863 Times</citetitle>, 17 January 2002.
864 </para></footnote>&mdash;has been framed as a battle about the
865 rule of law and respect for property. To know which side to take in this
866 war, most think that we need only decide whether we're for property or
867 against it.
868 </para>
869 <para>
870 If those really were the choices, then I would be with Jack Valenti
871 and the content industry. I, too, am a believer in property, and
872 especially in the importance of what Mr. Valenti nicely calls
873 "creative property." I believe that "piracy" is wrong, and that the
874 law, properly tuned, should punish "piracy," whether on or off the
875 Internet.
876 </para>
877 <para>
878 But those simple beliefs mask a much more fundamental question
879 and a much more dramatic change. My fear is that unless we come to see
880 this change, the war to rid the world of Internet "pirates" will also rid our
881 culture of values that have been integral to our tradition from the start.
882 </para>
883 <para>
884 These values built a tradition that, for at least the first 180 years of
885 our Republic, guaranteed creators the right to build freely upon their
886 past, and protected creators and innovators from either state or private
887 control. The First Amendment protected creators against state control.
888 And as Professor Neil Netanel powerfully argues,<footnote>
889 <para>
890 Neil W. Netanel, "Copyright and a Democratic Civil Society," <citetitle>Yale Law
891 Journal</citetitle> 106 (1996): 283.
892 <indexterm><primary>Netanel, Neil Weinstock</primary></indexterm>
893 </para></footnote>
894 copyright law, properly balanced, protected creators against private
895 control. Our tradition was thus neither Soviet nor the tradition of
896 patrons. It instead carved out a wide berth within which creators
897 could cultivate and extend our culture.
898 </para>
899 <para>
900 Yet the law's response to the Internet, when tied to changes in the
901 technology of the Internet itself, has massively increased the
902 effective regulation of creativity in America. To build upon or
903 critique the culture around us one must ask, Oliver Twist&ndash;like,
904 for permission first. Permission is, of course, often
905 granted&mdash;but it is not often granted to the critical or the
906 independent. We have built a kind of cultural nobility; those within
907 the noble class live easily; those outside it don't. But it is
908 nobility of any form that is alien to our tradition.
909 </para>
910 <!-- PAGE BREAK 26. FIXME: Should "Is it" be "It is" ? -->
911 <para>
912 The story that follows is about this war. Is it not about the
913 "centrality of technology" to ordinary life. I don't believe in gods,
914 digital or otherwise. Nor is it an effort to demonize any individual
915 or group, for neither do I believe in a devil, corporate or
916 otherwise. It is not a morality tale. Nor is it a call to jihad
917 against an industry.
918 </para>
919 <para>
920 It is instead an effort to understand a hopelessly destructive war
921 inspired by the technologies of the Internet but reaching far beyond
922 its code. And by understanding this battle, it is an effort to map
923 peace. There is no good reason for the current struggle around
924 Internet technologies to continue. There will be great harm to our
925 tradition and culture if it is allowed to continue unchecked. We must
926 come to understand the source of this war. We must resolve it soon.
927 </para>
928 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee</primary></indexterm>
929 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie</primary></indexterm>
930 <para>
931 Like the Causbys' battle, this war is, in part, about "property." The
932 property of this war is not as tangible as the Causbys', and no
933 innocent chicken has yet to lose its life. Yet the ideas surrounding
934 this "property" are as obvious to most as the Causbys' claim about the
935 sacredness of their farm was to them. We are the Causbys. Most of us
936 take for granted the extraordinarily powerful claims that the owners
937 of "intellectual property" now assert. Most of us, like the Causbys,
938 treat these claims as obvious. And hence we, like the Causbys, object
939 when a new technology interferes with this property. It is as plain to
940 us as it was to them that the new technologies of the Internet are
941 "trespassing" upon legitimate claims of "property." It is as plain to
942 us as it was to them that the law should intervene to stop this
943 trespass.
944 </para>
945 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee</primary></indexterm>
946 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie</primary></indexterm>
947 <para>
948 And thus, when geeks and technologists defend their Armstrong or
949 Wright brothers technology, most of us are simply unsympathetic.
950 Common sense does not revolt. Unlike in the case of the unlucky
951 Causbys, common sense is on the side of the property owners in this
952 war. Unlike
953 <!-- PAGE BREAK 27 -->
954 the lucky Wright brothers, the Internet has not inspired a revolution
955 on its side.
956 </para>
957 <para>
958 My hope is to push this common sense along. I have become increasingly
959 amazed by the power of this idea of intellectual property and, more
960 importantly, its power to disable critical thought by policy makers
961 and citizens. There has never been a time in our history when more of
962 our "culture" was as "owned" as it is now. And yet there has never
963 been a time when the concentration of power to control the
964 <emphasis>uses</emphasis> of culture has been as unquestioningly
965 accepted as it is now.
966 </para>
967 <para>
968 The puzzle is, Why? Is it because we have come to understand a truth
969 about the value and importance of absolute property over ideas and
970 culture? Is it because we have discovered that our tradition of
971 rejecting such an absolute claim was wrong?
972 </para>
973 <para>
974 Or is it because the idea of absolute property over ideas and culture
975 benefits the RCAs of our time and fits our own unreflective intuitions?
976 </para>
977 <para>
978 Is the radical shift away from our tradition of free culture an instance
979 of America correcting a mistake from its past, as we did after a bloody
980 war with slavery, and as we are slowly doing with inequality? Or is the
981 radical shift away from our tradition of free culture yet another example
982 of a political system captured by a few powerful special interests?
983 </para>
984 <para>
985 Does common sense lead to the extremes on this question because common
986 sense actually believes in these extremes? Or does common sense stand
987 silent in the face of these extremes because, as with Armstrong versus
988 RCA, the more powerful side has ensured that it has the more powerful
989 view?
990 </para>
991 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee</primary></indexterm>
992 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie</primary></indexterm>
993 <para>
994 I don't mean to be mysterious. My own views are resolved. I believe it
995 was right for common sense to revolt against the extremism of the
996 Causbys. I believe it would be right for common sense to revolt
997 against the extreme claims made today on behalf of "intellectual
998 property." What the law demands today is increasingly as silly as a
999 sheriff arresting an airplane for trespass. But the consequences of
1000 this silliness will be much more profound.
1001 <!-- PAGE BREAK 28 -->
1002 </para>
1003 <para>
1004 The struggle that rages just now centers on two ideas: "piracy" and
1005 "property." My aim in this book's next two parts is to explore these two
1006 ideas.
1007 </para>
1008 <para>
1009 My method is not the usual method of an academic. I don't want to
1010 plunge you into a complex argument, buttressed with references to
1011 obscure French theorists&mdash;however natural that is for the weird
1012 sort we academics have become. Instead I begin in each part with a
1013 collection of stories that set a context within which these apparently
1014 simple ideas can be more fully understood.
1015 </para>
1016 <para>
1017 The two sections set up the core claim of this book: that while the
1018 Internet has indeed produced something fantastic and new, our
1019 government, pushed by big media to respond to this "something new," is
1020 destroying something very old. Rather than understanding the changes
1021 the Internet might permit, and rather than taking time to let "common
1022 sense" resolve how best to respond, we are allowing those most
1023 threatened by the changes to use their power to change the
1024 law&mdash;and more importantly, to use their power to change something
1025 fundamental about who we have always been.
1026 </para>
1027 <para>
1028 We allow this, I believe, not because it is right, and not because
1029 most of us really believe in these changes. We allow it because the
1030 interests most threatened are among the most powerful players in our
1031 depressingly compromised process of making law. This book is the story
1032 of one more consequence of this form of corruption&mdash;a consequence
1033 to which most of us remain oblivious.
1034 </para>
1035 </chapter>
1036 <!-- PAGE BREAK 29 -->
1037 <part id="c-piracy">
1038 <title>"PIRACY"</title>
1039 <partintro>
1040 <!-- PAGE BREAK 30 -->
1041 <indexterm id="idxmansfield1" class='startofrange'>
1042 <primary>Mansfield, William Murray, Lord</primary>
1043 </indexterm>
1044 <para>
1045 Since the inception of the law regulating creative property, there has
1046 been a war against "piracy." The precise contours of this concept,
1047 "piracy," are hard to sketch, but the animating injustice is easy to
1048 capture. As Lord Mansfield wrote in a case that extended the reach of
1049 English copyright law to include sheet music,
1050 </para>
1051 <blockquote>
1052 <para>
1053 A person may use the copy by playing it, but he has no right to
1054 rob the author of the profit, by multiplying copies and disposing
1055 of them for his own use.<footnote><para>
1056 <!-- f1 -->
1057 <citetitle>Bach</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Longman</citetitle>, 98 Eng. Rep. 1274 (1777) (Mansfield).
1058 </para></footnote>
1059 </para>
1060 <indexterm startref="idxmansfield1" class='endofrange'/>
1061 </blockquote>
1062 <para>
1063 Today we are in the middle of another "war" against "piracy." The
1064 Internet has provoked this war. The Internet makes possible the
1065 efficient spread of content. Peer-to-peer (p2p) file sharing is among
1066 the most efficient of the efficient technologies the Internet
1067 enables. Using distributed intelligence, p2p systems facilitate the
1068 easy spread of content in a way unimagined a generation ago.
1069 <!-- PAGE BREAK 31 -->
1070 </para>
1071 <para>
1072 This efficiency does not respect the traditional lines of copyright.
1073 The network doesn't discriminate between the sharing of copyrighted
1074 and uncopyrighted content. Thus has there been a vast amount of
1075 sharing of copyrighted content. That sharing in turn has excited the
1076 war, as copyright owners fear the sharing will "rob the author of the
1077 profit."
1078 </para>
1079 <para>
1080 The warriors have turned to the courts, to the legislatures, and
1081 increasingly to technology to defend their "property" against this
1082 "piracy." A generation of Americans, the warriors warn, is being
1083 raised to believe that "property" should be "free." Forget tattoos,
1084 never mind body piercing&mdash;our kids are becoming
1085 <emphasis>thieves</emphasis>!
1086 </para>
1087 <para>
1088 There's no doubt that "piracy" is wrong, and that pirates should be
1089 punished. But before we summon the executioners, we should put this
1090 notion of "piracy" in some context. For as the concept is increasingly
1091 used, at its core is an extraordinary idea that is almost certainly wrong.
1092 </para>
1093 <para>
1094 The idea goes something like this:
1095 </para>
1096 <blockquote>
1097 <para>
1098 Creative work has value; whenever I use, or take, or build upon
1099 the creative work of others, I am taking from them something of
1100 value. Whenever I take something of value from someone else, I
1101 should have their permission. The taking of something of value
1102 from someone else without permission is wrong. It is a form of
1103 piracy.
1104 </para>
1105 </blockquote>
1106 <indexterm><primary>Dreyfuss, Rochelle</primary></indexterm>
1107 <para>
1108 This view runs deep within the current debates. It is what NYU law
1109 professor Rochelle Dreyfuss criticizes as the "if value, then right"
1110 theory of creative property<footnote><para>
1111 <!-- f2 -->
1112 See Rochelle Dreyfuss, "Expressive Genericity: Trademarks as Language
1113 in the Pepsi Generation," <citetitle>Notre Dame Law Review</citetitle> 65 (1990): 397.
1114 </para></footnote>
1115 &mdash;if there is value, then someone must have a
1116 right to that value. It is the perspective that led a composers' rights
1117 organization, ASCAP, to sue the Girl Scouts for failing to pay for the
1118 songs that girls sang around Girl Scout campfires.<footnote><para>
1119 <!-- f3 -->
1120 Lisa Bannon, "The Birds May Sing, but Campers Can't Unless They Pay
1121 Up," <citetitle>Wall Street Journal</citetitle>, 21 August 1996, available at
1122 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #3</ulink>; Jonathan
1123 Zittrain, "Calling Off the Copyright War: In Battle of Property vs. Free
1124 Speech, No One Wins," <citetitle>Boston Globe</citetitle>, 24 November 2002.
1125 <indexterm><primary>Zittrain, Jonathan</primary></indexterm>
1126 </para></footnote>
1127 There was "value" (the songs) so there must have been a
1128 "right"&mdash;even against the Girl Scouts.
1129 </para>
1130 <indexterm><primary>ASCAP</primary></indexterm>
1131 <para>
1132 This idea is certainly a possible understanding of how creative
1133 property should work. It might well be a possible design for a system
1134 <!-- PAGE BREAK 32 -->
1135 of law protecting creative property. But the "if value, then right"
1136 theory of creative property has never been America's theory of
1137 creative property. It has never taken hold within our law.
1138 </para>
1139 <para>
1140 Instead, in our tradition, intellectual property is an instrument. It
1141 sets the groundwork for a richly creative society but remains
1142 subservient to the value of creativity. The current debate has this
1143 turned around. We have become so concerned with protecting the
1144 instrument that we are losing sight of the value.
1145 </para>
1146 <para>
1147 The source of this confusion is a distinction that the law no longer
1148 takes care to draw&mdash;the distinction between republishing someone's
1149 work on the one hand and building upon or transforming that work on
1150 the other. Copyright law at its birth had only publishing as its concern;
1151 copyright law today regulates both.
1152 </para>
1153 <para>
1154 Before the technologies of the Internet, this conflation didn't matter
1155 all that much. The technologies of publishing were expensive; that
1156 meant the vast majority of publishing was commercial. Commercial
1157 entities could bear the burden of the law&mdash;even the burden of the
1158 Byzantine complexity that copyright law has become. It was just one
1159 more expense of doing business.
1160 </para>
1161 <indexterm><primary>Florida, Richard</primary></indexterm>
1162 <para>
1163 But with the birth of the Internet, this natural limit to the reach of
1164 the law has disappeared. The law controls not just the creativity of
1165 commercial creators but effectively that of anyone. Although that
1166 expansion would not matter much if copyright law regulated only
1167 "copying," when the law regulates as broadly and obscurely as it does,
1168 the extension matters a lot. The burden of this law now vastly
1169 outweighs any original benefit&mdash;certainly as it affects
1170 noncommercial creativity, and increasingly as it affects commercial
1171 creativity as well. Thus, as we'll see more clearly in the chapters
1172 below, the law's role is less and less to support creativity, and more
1173 and more to protect certain industries against competition. Just at
1174 the time digital technology could unleash an extraordinary range of
1175 commercial and noncommercial creativity, the law burdens this
1176 creativity with insanely complex and vague rules and with the threat
1177 of obscenely severe penalties. We may
1178 <!-- PAGE BREAK 33 -->
1179 be seeing, as Richard Florida writes, the "Rise of the Creative Class."<footnote>
1180 <para>
1181 <!-- f4 -->
1182 In <citetitle>The Rise of the Creative Class</citetitle> (New York: Basic Books, 2002),
1183 Richard Florida documents a shift in the nature of labor toward a
1184 labor of creativity. His work, however, doesn't directly address the
1185 legal conditions under which that creativity is enabled or stifled. I
1186 certainly agree with him about the importance and significance of this
1187 change, but I also believe the conditions under which it will be
1188 enabled are much more tenuous.
1189 <indexterm><primary>Florida, Richard</primary></indexterm>
1190 </para></footnote>
1191 Unfortunately, we are also seeing an extraordinary rise of regulation of
1192 this creative class.
1193 </para>
1194 <para>
1195 These burdens make no sense in our tradition. We should begin by
1196 understanding that tradition a bit more and by placing in their proper
1197 context the current battles about behavior labeled "piracy."
1198 </para>
1199 </partintro>
1200
1201 <!-- PAGE BREAK 34 -->
1202 <chapter id="creators">
1203 <title>CHAPTER ONE: Creators</title>
1204 <para>
1205 In 1928, a cartoon character was born. An early Mickey Mouse
1206 made his debut in May of that year, in a silent flop called <citetitle>Plane Crazy</citetitle>.
1207 In November, in New York City's Colony Theater, in the first widely
1208 distributed cartoon synchronized with sound, <citetitle>Steamboat Willie</citetitle> brought
1209 to life the character that would become Mickey Mouse.
1210 </para>
1211 <para>
1212 Synchronized sound had been introduced to film a year earlier in the
1213 movie <citetitle>The Jazz Singer</citetitle>. That success led Walt Disney to copy the
1214 technique and mix sound with cartoons. No one knew whether it would
1215 work or, if it did work, whether it would win an audience. But when
1216 Disney ran a test in the summer of 1928, the results were unambiguous.
1217 As Disney describes that first experiment,
1218 </para>
1219 <blockquote>
1220 <para>
1221 A couple of my boys could read music, and one of them could play
1222 a mouth organ. We put them in a room where they could not see
1223 the screen and arranged to pipe their sound into the room where
1224 our wives and friends were going to see the picture.
1225 <!-- PAGE BREAK 35 -->
1226 </para>
1227 <para>
1228 The boys worked from a music and sound-effects score. After several
1229 false starts, sound and action got off with the gun. The mouth
1230 organist played the tune, the rest of us in the sound department
1231 bammed tin pans and blew slide whistles on the beat. The
1232 synchronization was pretty close.
1233 </para>
1234 <para>
1235 The effect on our little audience was nothing less than electric.
1236 They responded almost instinctively to this union of sound and
1237 motion. I thought they were kidding me. So they put me in the audience
1238 and ran the action again. It was terrible, but it was wonderful! And
1239 it was something new!<footnote><para>
1240 <!-- f1 -->
1241 Leonard Maltin, <citetitle>Of Mice and Magic: A History of American Animated
1242 Cartoons</citetitle> (New York: Penguin Books, 1987), 34&ndash;35.
1243 </para></footnote>
1244 </para>
1245 </blockquote>
1246 <para>
1247 Disney's then partner, and one of animation's most extraordinary
1248 talents, Ub Iwerks, put it more strongly: "I have never been so thrilled
1249 in my life. Nothing since has ever equaled it."
1250 <indexterm><primary>Iwerks, Ub</primary></indexterm>
1251 </para>
1252 <para>
1253 Disney had created something very new, based upon something relatively
1254 new. Synchronized sound brought life to a form of creativity that had
1255 rarely&mdash;except in Disney's hands&mdash;been anything more than
1256 filler for other films. Throughout animation's early history, it was
1257 Disney's invention that set the standard that others struggled to
1258 match. And quite often, Disney's great genius, his spark of
1259 creativity, was built upon the work of others.
1260 </para>
1261 <para>
1262 This much is familiar. What you might not know is that 1928 also marks
1263 another important transition. In that year, a comic (as opposed to
1264 cartoon) genius created his last independently produced silent film.
1265 That genius was Buster Keaton. The film was <citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr</citetitle>.
1266 </para>
1267 <para>
1268 Keaton was born into a vaudeville family in 1895. In the era of silent
1269 film, he had mastered using broad physical comedy as a way to spark
1270 uncontrollable laughter from his audience. <citetitle>Steamboat Bill,
1271 Jr</citetitle>. was a classic of this form, famous among film buffs for its
1272 incredible stunts. The film was classic Keaton&mdash;wildly popular
1273 and among the best of its genre.
1274 </para>
1275 <para>
1276 <citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr</citetitle>. appeared before Disney's cartoon Steamboat
1277 Willie.
1278 <!-- PAGE BREAK 36 -->
1279 The coincidence of titles is not coincidental. Steamboat Willie is a
1280 direct cartoon parody of Steamboat Bill,<footnote><para>
1281 <!-- f2 -->
1282 I am grateful to David Gerstein and his careful history, described at
1283 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #4</ulink>.
1284 According to Dave Smith of the Disney Archives, Disney paid royalties to
1285 use the music for five songs in <citetitle>Steamboat Willie</citetitle>: "Steamboat Bill," "The
1286 Simpleton" (Delille), "Mischief Makers" (Carbonara), "Joyful Hurry No. 1"
1287 (Baron), and "Gawky Rube" (Lakay). A sixth song, "The Turkey in the
1288 Straw," was already in the public domain. Letter from David Smith to
1289 Harry Surden, 10 July 2003, on file with author.
1290 </para></footnote>
1291 and both are built upon a common song as a source. It is not just from
1292 the invention of synchronized sound in <citetitle>The Jazz Singer</citetitle> that we
1293 get <citetitle>Steamboat Willie</citetitle>. It is also from Buster Keaton's invention of
1294 Steamboat Bill, Jr., itself inspired by the song "Steamboat Bill,"
1295 that we get Steamboat Willie, and then from Steamboat Willie, Mickey
1296 Mouse.
1297 </para>
1298 <para>
1299 This "borrowing" was nothing unique, either for Disney or for the
1300 industry. Disney was always parroting the feature-length mainstream
1301 films of his day.<footnote><para>
1302 <!-- f3 -->
1303 He was also a fan of the public domain. See Chris Sprigman, "The Mouse
1304 that Ate the Public Domain," Findlaw, 5 March 2002, at
1305 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #5</ulink>.
1306 </para></footnote>
1307 So did many others. Early cartoons are filled with
1308 knockoffs&mdash;slight variations on winning themes; retellings of
1309 ancient stories. The key to success was the brilliance of the
1310 differences. With Disney, it was sound that gave his animation its
1311 spark. Later, it was the quality of his work relative to the
1312 production-line cartoons with which he competed. Yet these additions
1313 were built upon a base that was borrowed. Disney added to the work of
1314 others before him, creating something new out of something just barely
1315 old.
1316 </para>
1317 <para>
1318 Sometimes this borrowing was slight. Sometimes it was significant.
1319 Think about the fairy tales of the Brothers Grimm. If you're as
1320 oblivious as I was, you're likely to think that these tales are happy,
1321 sweet stories, appropriate for any child at bedtime. In fact, the
1322 Grimm fairy tales are, well, for us, grim. It is a rare and perhaps
1323 overly ambitious parent who would dare to read these bloody,
1324 moralistic stories to his or her child, at bedtime or anytime.
1325 </para>
1326 <para>
1327 Disney took these stories and retold them in a way that carried them
1328 into a new age. He animated the stories, with both characters and
1329 light. Without removing the elements of fear and danger altogether, he
1330 made funny what was dark and injected a genuine emotion of compassion
1331 where before there was fear. And not just with the work of the
1332 Brothers Grimm. Indeed, the catalog of Disney work drawing upon the
1333 work of others is astonishing when set together: <citetitle>Snow White</citetitle>
1334 (1937), <citetitle>Fantasia</citetitle> (1940), <citetitle>Pinocchio</citetitle> (1940), <citetitle>Dumbo</citetitle>
1335 (1941), <citetitle>Bambi</citetitle> (1942), <citetitle>Song of the South</citetitle> (1946),
1336 <citetitle>Cinderella</citetitle> (1950), <citetitle>Alice in Wonderland</citetitle> (1951), <citetitle>Robin
1337 Hood</citetitle> (1952), <citetitle>Peter Pan</citetitle> (1953), <citetitle>Lady and the Tramp</citetitle>
1338 <!-- PAGE BREAK 37 -->
1339 (1955), <citetitle>Mulan</citetitle> (1998), <citetitle>Sleeping Beauty</citetitle> (1959), <citetitle>101
1340 Dalmatians</citetitle> (1961), <citetitle>The Sword in the Stone</citetitle> (1963), and
1341 <citetitle>The Jungle Book</citetitle> (1967)&mdash;not to mention a recent example
1342 that we should perhaps quickly forget, <citetitle>Treasure Planet</citetitle>
1343 (2003). In all of these cases, Disney (or Disney, Inc.) ripped
1344 creativity from the culture around him, mixed that creativity with his
1345 own extraordinary talent, and then burned that mix into the soul of
1346 his culture. Rip, mix, and burn.
1347 </para>
1348 <para>
1349 This is a kind of creativity. It is a creativity that we should
1350 remember and celebrate. There are some who would say that there is no
1351 creativity except this kind. We don't need to go that far to recognize
1352 its importance. We could call this "Disney creativity," though that
1353 would be a bit misleading. It is, more precisely, "Walt Disney
1354 creativity"&mdash;a form of expression and genius that builds upon the
1355 culture around us and makes it something different.
1356 </para>
1357 <para> In 1928, the culture that Disney was free to draw upon was
1358 relatively fresh. The public domain in 1928 was not very old and was
1359 therefore quite vibrant. The average term of copyright was just around
1360 thirty years&mdash;for that minority of creative work that was in fact
1361 copyrighted.<footnote><para>
1362 <!-- f4 -->
1363 Until 1976, copyright law granted an author the possibility of two terms: an
1364 initial term and a renewal term. I have calculated the "average" term by
1365 determining
1366 the weighted average of total registrations for any particular year,
1367 and the proportion renewing. Thus, if 100 copyrights are registered in year
1368 1, and only 15 are renewed, and the renewal term is 28 years, then the
1369 average
1370 term is 32.2 years. For the renewal data and other relevant data, see the
1371 Web site associated with this book, available at
1372 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #6</ulink>.
1373 </para></footnote>
1374 That means that for thirty years, on average, the authors or
1375 copyright holders of a creative work had an "exclusive right" to control
1376 certain uses of the work. To use this copyrighted work in limited ways
1377 required the permission of the copyright owner.
1378 </para>
1379 <para>
1380 At the end of a copyright term, a work passes into the public domain.
1381 No permission is then needed to draw upon or use that work. No
1382 permission and, hence, no lawyers. The public domain is a "lawyer-free
1383 zone." Thus, most of the content from the nineteenth century was free
1384 for Disney to use and build upon in 1928. It was free for
1385 anyone&mdash; whether connected or not, whether rich or not, whether
1386 approved or not&mdash;to use and build upon.
1387 </para>
1388 <para>
1389 This is the ways things always were&mdash;until quite recently. For most
1390 of our history, the public domain was just over the horizon. From
1391 until 1978, the average copyright term was never more than thirty-two
1392 years, meaning that most culture just a generation and a half old was
1393
1394 <!-- PAGE BREAK 38 -->
1395 free for anyone to build upon without the permission of anyone else.
1396 Today's equivalent would be for creative work from the 1960s and 1970s
1397 to now be free for the next Walt Disney to build upon without
1398 permission. Yet today, the public domain is presumptive only for
1399 content from before the Great Depression.
1400 </para>
1401 <para>
1402 Of course, Walt Disney had no monopoly on "Walt Disney creativity."
1403 Nor does America. The norm of free culture has, until recently, and
1404 except within totalitarian nations, been broadly exploited and quite
1405 universal.
1406 </para>
1407 <para>
1408 Consider, for example, a form of creativity that seems strange to many
1409 Americans but that is inescapable within Japanese culture: <citetitle>manga</citetitle>, or
1410 comics. The Japanese are fanatics about comics. Some 40 percent of
1411 publications are comics, and 30 percent of publication revenue derives
1412 from comics. They are everywhere in Japanese society, at every
1413 magazine stand, carried by a large proportion of commuters on Japan's
1414 extraordinary system of public transportation.
1415 </para>
1416 <para>
1417 Americans tend to look down upon this form of culture. That's an
1418 unattractive characteristic of ours. We're likely to misunderstand
1419 much about manga, because few of us have ever read anything close to
1420 the stories that these "graphic novels" tell. For the Japanese, manga
1421 cover every aspect of social life. For us, comics are "men in tights."
1422 And anyway, it's not as if the New York subways are filled with
1423 readers of Joyce or even Hemingway. People of different cultures
1424 distract themselves in different ways, the Japanese in this
1425 interestingly different way.
1426 </para>
1427 <para>
1428 But my purpose here is not to understand manga. It is to describe a
1429 variant on manga that from a lawyer's perspective is quite odd, but
1430 from a Disney perspective is quite familiar.
1431 </para>
1432 <para>
1433 This is the phenomenon of <citetitle>doujinshi</citetitle>. Doujinshi are also comics, but
1434 they are a kind of copycat comic. A rich ethic governs the creation of
1435 doujinshi. It is not doujinshi if it is <emphasis>just</emphasis> a
1436 copy; the artist must make a contribution to the art he copies, by
1437 transforming it either subtly or
1438 <!-- PAGE BREAK 39 -->
1439 significantly. A doujinshi comic can thus take a mainstream comic and
1440 develop it differently&mdash;with a different story line. Or the comic can
1441 keep the character in character but change its look slightly. There is no
1442 formula for what makes the doujinshi sufficiently "different." But they
1443 must be different if they are to be considered true doujinshi. Indeed,
1444 there are committees that review doujinshi for inclusion within shows
1445 and reject any copycat comic that is merely a copy.
1446 </para>
1447 <para>
1448 These copycat comics are not a tiny part of the manga market. They are
1449 huge. More than 33,000 "circles" of creators from across Japan produce
1450 these bits of Walt Disney creativity. More than 450,000 Japanese come
1451 together twice a year, in the largest public gathering in the country,
1452 to exchange and sell them. This market exists in parallel to the
1453 mainstream commercial manga market. In some ways, it obviously
1454 competes with that market, but there is no sustained effort by those
1455 who control the commercial manga market to shut the doujinshi market
1456 down. It flourishes, despite the competition and despite the law.
1457 </para>
1458 <para>
1459 The most puzzling feature of the doujinshi market, for those trained
1460 in the law, at least, is that it is allowed to exist at all. Under
1461 Japanese copyright law, which in this respect (on paper) mirrors
1462 American copyright law, the doujinshi market is an illegal
1463 one. Doujinshi are plainly "derivative works." There is no general
1464 practice by doujinshi artists of securing the permission of the manga
1465 creators. Instead, the practice is simply to take and modify the
1466 creations of others, as Walt Disney did with <citetitle>Steamboat Bill,
1467 Jr</citetitle>. Under both Japanese and American law, that "taking" without
1468 the permission of the original copyright owner is illegal. It is an
1469 infringement of the original copyright to make a copy or a derivative
1470 work without the original copyright owner's permission.
1471 </para>
1472 <indexterm id="idxwinickjudd" class='startofrange'>
1473 <primary>Winick, Judd</primary>
1474 </indexterm>
1475 <para>
1476 Yet this illegal market exists and indeed flourishes in Japan, and in
1477 the view of many, it is precisely because it exists that Japanese manga
1478 flourish. As American graphic novelist Judd Winick said to me, "The
1479 early days of comics in America are very much like what's going on
1480 in Japan now. . . . American comics were born out of copying each
1481 <!-- PAGE BREAK 40 -->
1482 other. . . . That's how [the artists] learn to draw&mdash;by going into comic
1483 books and not tracing them, but looking at them and copying them"
1484 and building from them.<footnote><para>
1485 <!-- f5 -->
1486 For an excellent history, see Scott McCloud, <citetitle>Reinventing Comics</citetitle> (New
1487 York: Perennial, 2000).
1488 </para></footnote>
1489 </para>
1490 <para>
1491 American comics now are quite different, Winick explains, in part
1492 because of the legal difficulty of adapting comics the way doujinshi are
1493 allowed. Speaking of Superman, Winick told me, "there are these rules
1494 and you have to stick to them." There are things Superman "cannot"
1495 do. "As a creator, it's frustrating having to stick to some parameters
1496 which are fifty years old."
1497 </para>
1498 <indexterm startref="idxwinickjudd" class='endofrange'/>
1499 <para>
1500 The norm in Japan mitigates this legal difficulty. Some say it is
1501 precisely the benefit accruing to the Japanese manga market that
1502 explains the mitigation. Temple University law professor Salil Mehra,
1503 for example, hypothesizes that the manga market accepts these
1504 technical violations because they spur the manga market to be more
1505 wealthy and productive. Everyone would be worse off if doujinshi were
1506 banned, so the law does not ban doujinshi.<footnote><para>
1507 <!-- f6 -->
1508 See Salil K. Mehra, "Copyright and Comics in Japan: Does Law Explain
1509 Why All the Comics My Kid Watches Are Japanese Imports?" <citetitle>Rutgers Law
1510 Review</citetitle> 55 (2002): 155, 182. "[T]here might be a collective economic
1511 rationality that would lead manga and anime artists to forgo bringing
1512 legal actions for infringement. One hypothesis is that all manga
1513 artists may be better off collectively if they set aside their
1514 individual self-interest and decide not to press their legal
1515 rights. This is essentially a prisoner's dilemma solved."
1516 </para></footnote>
1517 </para>
1518 <para>
1519 The problem with this story, however, as Mehra plainly acknowledges,
1520 is that the mechanism producing this laissez faire response is not
1521 clear. It may well be that the market as a whole is better off if
1522 doujinshi are permitted rather than banned, but that doesn't explain
1523 why individual copyright owners don't sue nonetheless. If the law has
1524 no general exception for doujinshi, and indeed in some cases
1525 individual manga artists have sued doujinshi artists, why is there not
1526 a more general pattern of blocking this "free taking" by the doujinshi
1527 culture?
1528 </para>
1529 <para>
1530 I spent four wonderful months in Japan, and I asked this question
1531 as often as I could. Perhaps the best account in the end was offered by
1532 a friend from a major Japanese law firm. "We don't have enough
1533 lawyers," he told me one afternoon. There "just aren't enough resources
1534 to prosecute cases like this."
1535 </para>
1536 <para>
1537 This is a theme to which we will return: that regulation by law is a
1538 function of both the words on the books and the costs of making those
1539 words have effect. For now, focus on the obvious question that is
1540 begged: Would Japan be better off with more lawyers? Would manga
1541 <!-- PAGE BREAK 41 -->
1542 be richer if doujinshi artists were regularly prosecuted? Would the
1543 Japanese gain something important if they could end this practice of
1544 uncompensated sharing? Does piracy here hurt the victims of the
1545 piracy, or does it help them? Would lawyers fighting this piracy help
1546 their clients or hurt them?
1547 Let's pause for a moment.
1548 </para>
1549 <para>
1550 If you're like I was a decade ago, or like most people are when they
1551 first start thinking about these issues, then just about now you should
1552 be puzzled about something you hadn't thought through before.
1553 </para>
1554 <para>
1555 We live in a world that celebrates "property." I am one of those
1556 celebrants. I believe in the value of property in general, and I also
1557 believe in the value of that weird form of property that lawyers call
1558 "intellectual property."<footnote><para>
1559 <!-- f7 -->
1560 The term <citetitle>intellectual property</citetitle> is of relatively recent origin. See
1561 Siva Vaidhyanathan, <citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs</citetitle>, 11 (New York: New York
1562 University Press, 2001). See also Lawrence Lessig, <citetitle>The Future of Ideas</citetitle>
1563 (New York: Random House, 2001), 293 n. 26. The term accurately
1564 describes a set of "property" rights&mdash;copyright, patents,
1565 trademark, and trade-secret&mdash;but the nature of those rights is
1566 very different.
1567 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva</primary></indexterm>
1568 </para></footnote>
1569 A large, diverse society cannot survive without property; a large,
1570 diverse, and modern society cannot flourish without intellectual
1571 property.
1572 </para>
1573 <para>
1574 But it takes just a second's reflection to realize that there is
1575 plenty of value out there that "property" doesn't capture. I don't
1576 mean "money can't buy you love," but rather, value that is plainly
1577 part of a process of production, including commercial as well as
1578 noncommercial production. If Disney animators had stolen a set of
1579 pencils to draw Steamboat Willie, we'd have no hesitation in
1580 condemning that taking as wrong&mdash; even though trivial, even if
1581 unnoticed. Yet there was nothing wrong, at least under the law of the
1582 day, with Disney's taking from Buster Keaton or from the Brothers
1583 Grimm. There was nothing wrong with the taking from Keaton because
1584 Disney's use would have been considered "fair." There was nothing
1585 wrong with the taking from the Grimms because the Grimms' work was in
1586 the public domain.
1587 </para>
1588 <para>
1589 Thus, even though the things that Disney took&mdash;or more generally,
1590 the things taken by anyone exercising Walt Disney creativity&mdash;are
1591 valuable, our tradition does not treat those takings as wrong. Some
1592
1593 <!-- PAGE BREAK 42 -->
1594 things remain free for the taking within a free culture, and that
1595 freedom is good.
1596 </para>
1597 <para>
1598 The same with the doujinshi culture. If a doujinshi artist broke into
1599 a publisher's office and ran off with a thousand copies of his latest
1600 work&mdash;or even one copy&mdash;without paying, we'd have no hesitation in
1601 saying the artist was wrong. In addition to having trespassed, he would
1602 have stolen something of value. The law bans that stealing in whatever
1603 form, whether large or small.
1604 </para>
1605 <para>
1606 Yet there is an obvious reluctance, even among Japanese lawyers, to
1607 say that the copycat comic artists are "stealing." This form of Walt
1608 Disney creativity is seen as fair and right, even if lawyers in
1609 particular find it hard to say why.
1610 </para>
1611 <para>
1612 It's the same with a thousand examples that appear everywhere once you
1613 begin to look. Scientists build upon the work of other scientists
1614 without asking or paying for the privilege. ("Excuse me, Professor
1615 Einstein, but may I have permission to use your theory of relativity
1616 to show that you were wrong about quantum physics?") Acting companies
1617 perform adaptations of the works of Shakespeare without securing
1618 permission from anyone. (Does <emphasis>anyone</emphasis> believe
1619 Shakespeare would be better spread within our culture if there were a
1620 central Shakespeare rights clearinghouse that all productions of
1621 Shakespeare must appeal to first?) And Hollywood goes through cycles
1622 with a certain kind of movie: five asteroid films in the late 1990s;
1623 two volcano disaster films in 1997.
1624 </para>
1625 <para>
1626 Creators here and everywhere are always and at all times building
1627 upon the creativity that went before and that surrounds them now.
1628 That building is always and everywhere at least partially done without
1629 permission and without compensating the original creator. No society,
1630 free or controlled, has ever demanded that every use be paid for or that
1631 permission for Walt Disney creativity must always be sought. Instead,
1632 every society has left a certain bit of its culture free for the taking&mdash;free
1633 societies more fully than unfree, perhaps, but all societies to some degree.
1634 <!-- PAGE BREAK 43 -->
1635 </para>
1636 <para>
1637 The hard question is therefore not <emphasis>whether</emphasis> a
1638 culture is free. All cultures are free to some degree. The hard
1639 question instead is "<emphasis>How</emphasis> free is this culture?"
1640 How much, and how broadly, is the culture free for others to take and
1641 build upon? Is that freedom limited to party members? To members of
1642 the royal family? To the top ten corporations on the New York Stock
1643 Exchange? Or is that freedom spread broadly? To artists generally,
1644 whether affiliated with the Met or not? To musicians generally,
1645 whether white or not? To filmmakers generally, whether affiliated with
1646 a studio or not?
1647 </para>
1648 <para>
1649 Free cultures are cultures that leave a great deal open for others to
1650 build upon; unfree, or permission, cultures leave much less. Ours was a
1651 free culture. It is becoming much less so.
1652 </para>
1653
1654 <!-- PAGE BREAK 44 -->
1655 </chapter>
1656 <chapter id="mere-copyists">
1657 <title>CHAPTER TWO: "Mere Copyists"</title>
1658 <indexterm><primary>Daguerre, Louis</primary></indexterm>
1659 <para>
1660 In 1839, Louis Daguerre invented the first practical technology for
1661 producing what we would call "photographs." Appropriately enough, they
1662 were called "daguerreotypes." The process was complicated and
1663 expensive, and the field was thus limited to professionals and a few
1664 zealous and wealthy amateurs. (There was even an American Daguerre
1665 Association that helped regulate the industry, as do all such
1666 associations, by keeping competition down so as to keep prices up.)
1667 </para>
1668 <para>
1669 Yet despite high prices, the demand for daguerreotypes was strong.
1670 This pushed inventors to find simpler and cheaper ways to make
1671 "automatic pictures." William Talbot soon discovered a process for
1672 making "negatives." But because the negatives were glass, and had to
1673 be kept wet, the process still remained expensive and cumbersome. In
1674 the 1870s, dry plates were developed, making it easier to separate the
1675 taking of a picture from its developing. These were still plates of
1676 glass, and thus it was still not a process within reach of most
1677 amateurs.
1678 </para>
1679 <indexterm id="idxeastmangeorge" class='startofrange'>
1680 <primary>Eastman, George</primary>
1681 </indexterm>
1682 <para>
1683 The technological change that made mass photography possible
1684 didn't happen until 1888, and was the creation of a single man. George
1685 <!-- PAGE BREAK 45 -->
1686 Eastman, himself an amateur photographer, was frustrated by the
1687 technology of photographs made with plates. In a flash of insight (so
1688 to speak), Eastman saw that if the film could be made to be flexible,
1689 it could be held on a single spindle. That roll could then be sent to
1690 a developer, driving the costs of photography down substantially. By
1691 lowering the costs, Eastman expected he could dramatically broaden the
1692 population of photographers.
1693 </para>
1694 <para>
1695 Eastman developed flexible, emulsion-coated paper film and placed
1696 rolls of it in small, simple cameras: the Kodak. The device was
1697 marketed on the basis of its simplicity. "You press the button and we
1698 do the rest."<footnote><para>
1699 <!-- f1 -->
1700 Reese V. Jenkins, <citetitle>Images and Enterprise</citetitle> (Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press, 1975), 112.
1701 </para></footnote> As he described in <citetitle>The Kodak Primer</citetitle>:
1702 </para>
1703 <blockquote>
1704 <para>
1705 The principle of the Kodak system is the separation of the work that
1706 any person whomsoever can do in making a photograph, from the work
1707 that only an expert can do. . . . We furnish anybody, man, woman or
1708 child, who has sufficient intelligence to point a box straight and
1709 press a button, with an instrument which altogether removes from the
1710 practice of photography the necessity for exceptional facilities or,
1711 in fact, any special knowledge of the art. It can be employed without
1712 preliminary study, without a darkroom and without
1713 chemicals.<footnote>
1714 <para>
1715 <!-- f2 -->
1716 Brian Coe, <citetitle>The Birth of Photography</citetitle> (New York: Taplinger Publishing,
1717 1977), 53.
1718 <indexterm><primary>Coe, Brian</primary></indexterm>
1719 </para></footnote>
1720 </para>
1721 </blockquote>
1722 <para>
1723 For $25, anyone could make pictures. The camera came preloaded
1724 with film, and when it had been used, the camera was returned to an
1725 Eastman factory, where the film was developed. Over time, of course,
1726 the cost of the camera and the ease with which it could be used both
1727 improved. Roll film thus became the basis for the explosive growth of
1728 popular photography. Eastman's camera first went on sale in 1888; one
1729 year later, Kodak was printing more than six thousand negatives a day.
1730 From 1888 through 1909, while industrial production was rising by 4.7
1731 percent, photographic equipment and material sales increased by
1732 percent.<footnote><para>
1733 <!-- f3 -->
1734 Jenkins, 177.
1735 </para></footnote> Eastman Kodak's sales during the same period experienced
1736 an average annual increase of over 17 percent.<footnote><para>
1737 <!-- f4 -->
1738 Based on a chart in Jenkins, p. 178.
1739 </para></footnote>
1740 </para>
1741 <indexterm><primary>Coe, Brian</primary></indexterm>
1742 <para>
1743
1744 <!-- PAGE BREAK 46 -->
1745 The real significance of Eastman's invention, however, was not
1746 economic. It was social. Professional photography gave individuals a
1747 glimpse of places they would never otherwise see. Amateur photography
1748 gave them the ability to record their own lives in a way they had
1749 never been able to do before. As author Brian Coe notes, "For the
1750 first time the snapshot album provided the man on the street with a
1751 permanent record of his family and its activities. . . . For the first
1752 time in history there exists an authentic visual record of the
1753 appearance and activities of the common man made without [literary]
1754 interpretation or bias."<footnote><para>
1755 <!-- f5 -->
1756 Coe, 58.
1757 </para></footnote>
1758 </para>
1759 <para>
1760 In this way, the Kodak camera and film were technologies of
1761 expression. The pencil or paintbrush was also a technology of
1762 expression, of course. But it took years of training before they could
1763 be deployed by amateurs in any useful or effective way. With the
1764 Kodak, expression was possible much sooner and more simply. The
1765 barrier to expression was lowered. Snobs would sneer at its "quality";
1766 professionals would discount it as irrelevant. But watch a child study
1767 how best to frame a picture and you get a sense of the experience of
1768 creativity that the Kodak enabled. Democratic tools gave ordinary
1769 people a way to express themselves more easily than any tools could
1770 have before.
1771 </para>
1772 <para>
1773 What was required for this technology to flourish? Obviously,
1774 Eastman's genius was an important part. But also important was the
1775 legal environment within which Eastman's invention grew. For early in
1776 the history of photography, there was a series of judicial decisions
1777 that could well have changed the course of photography substantially.
1778 Courts were asked whether the photographer, amateur or professional,
1779 required permission before he could capture and print whatever image
1780 he wanted. Their answer was no.<footnote><para>
1781 <!-- f6 -->
1782 For illustrative cases, see, for example, <citetitle>Pavesich</citetitle>
1783 v. <citetitle>N.E. Life Ins. Co</citetitle>., 50 S.E. 68 (Ga. 1905);
1784 <citetitle>Foster-Milburn Co</citetitle>. v. <citetitle>Chinn</citetitle>, 123090 S.W. 364, 366
1785 (Ky. 1909); <citetitle>Corliss</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Walker</citetitle>, 64 F. 280 (Mass.
1786 Dist. Ct. 1894).
1787 </para></footnote>
1788 </para>
1789 <para>
1790 The arguments in favor of requiring permission will sound surprisingly
1791 familiar. The photographer was "taking" something from the person or
1792 building whose photograph he shot&mdash;pirating something of
1793 value. Some even thought he was taking the target's soul. Just as
1794 Disney was not free to take the pencils that his animators used to
1795 draw
1796 <!-- PAGE BREAK 47 -->
1797 Mickey, so, too, should these photographers not be free to take images
1798 that they thought valuable.
1799 </para>
1800 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.</primary></indexterm>
1801 <para>
1802 On the other side was an argument that should be familiar, as well.
1803 Sure, there may be something of value being used. But citizens should
1804 have the right to capture at least those images that stand in public view.
1805 (Louis Brandeis, who would become a Supreme Court Justice, thought
1806 the rule should be different for images from private spaces.<footnote>
1807 <para>
1808 <!-- f7 -->
1809 Samuel D. Warren and Louis D. Brandeis, "The Right to Privacy,"
1810 <citetitle>Harvard Law Review</citetitle> 4 (1890): 193.
1811 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.</primary></indexterm>
1812 <indexterm><primary>Warren, Samuel D.</primary></indexterm>
1813 </para></footnote>) It may be that this means that the photographer
1814 gets something for nothing. Just as Disney could take inspiration from
1815 <citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr</citetitle>. or the Brothers Grimm, the photographer should be
1816 free to capture an image without compensating the source.
1817 </para>
1818 <para>
1819 Fortunately for Mr. Eastman, and for photography in general, these
1820 early decisions went in favor of the pirates. In general, no
1821 permission would be required before an image could be captured and
1822 shared with others. Instead, permission was presumed. Freedom was the
1823 default. (The law would eventually craft an exception for famous
1824 people: commercial photographers who snap pictures of famous people
1825 for commercial purposes have more restrictions than the rest of
1826 us. But in the ordinary case, the image can be captured without
1827 clearing the rights to do the capturing.<footnote><para>
1828 <!-- f8 -->
1829 See Melville B. Nimmer, "The Right of Publicity," <citetitle>Law and Contemporary
1830 Problems</citetitle> 19 (1954): 203; William L. Prosser, "Privacy," <citetitle>California Law
1831 Review</citetitle> 48 (1960) 398&ndash;407; <citetitle>White</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Samsung Electronics America,
1832 Inc</citetitle>., 971 F. 2d 1395 (9th Cir. 1992), cert. denied, 508 U.S. 951
1833 (1993).
1834 </para></footnote>)
1835 </para>
1836 <para>
1837 We can only speculate about how photography would have developed had
1838 the law gone the other way. If the presumption had been against the
1839 photographer, then the photographer would have had to demonstrate
1840 permission. Perhaps Eastman Kodak would have had to demonstrate
1841 permission, too, before it developed the film upon which images were
1842 captured. After all, if permission were not granted, then Eastman
1843 Kodak would be benefiting from the "theft" committed by the
1844 photographer. Just as Napster benefited from the copyright
1845 infringements committed by Napster users, Kodak would be benefiting
1846 from the "image-right" infringement of its photographers. We could
1847 imagine the law then requiring that some form of permission be
1848 demonstrated before a company developed pictures. We could imagine a
1849 system developing to demonstrate that permission.
1850 </para>
1851 <para>
1852
1853 <!-- PAGE BREAK 48 -->
1854 But though we could imagine this system of permission, it would be
1855 very hard to see how photography could have flourished as it did if
1856 the requirement for permission had been built into the rules that
1857 govern it. Photography would have existed. It would have grown in
1858 importance over time. Professionals would have continued to use the
1859 technology as they did&mdash;since professionals could have more
1860 easily borne the burdens of the permission system. But the spread of
1861 photography to ordinary people would not have occurred. Nothing like
1862 that growth would have been realized. And certainly, nothing like that
1863 growth in a democratic technology of expression would have been
1864 realized. If you drive through San Francisco's Presidio, you might
1865 see two gaudy yellow school buses painted over with colorful and
1866 striking images, and the logo "Just Think!" in place of the name of a
1867 school. But there's little that's "just" cerebral in the projects that
1868 these busses enable. These buses are filled with technologies that
1869 teach kids to tinker with film. Not the film of Eastman. Not even the
1870 film of your VCR. Rather the "film" of digital cameras. Just Think!
1871 is a project that enables kids to make films, as a way to understand
1872 and critique the filmed culture that they find all around them. Each
1873 year, these busses travel to more than thirty schools and enable three
1874 hundred to five hundred children to learn something about media by
1875 doing something with media. By doing, they think. By tinkering, they
1876 learn.
1877 </para>
1878 <indexterm startref="idxeastmangeorge" class='endofrange'/>
1879 <para>
1880 These buses are not cheap, but the technology they carry is
1881 increasingly so. The cost of a high-quality digital video system has
1882 fallen dramatically. As one analyst puts it, "Five years ago, a good
1883 real-time digital video editing system cost $25,000. Today you can get
1884 professional quality for $595."<footnote><para>
1885 <!-- f9 -->
1886 H. Edward Goldberg, "Essential Presentation Tools: Hardware and
1887 Software You Need to Create Digital Multimedia Presentations,"
1888 cadalyst, February 2002, available at
1889 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #7</ulink>.
1890 </para></footnote>
1891 These buses are filled with technology that would have cost hundreds
1892 of thousands just ten years ago. And it is now feasible to imagine not
1893 just buses like this, but classrooms across the country where kids are
1894 learning more and more of something teachers call "media literacy."
1895 </para>
1896 <para>
1897 <!-- PAGE BREAK 49 -->
1898 "Media literacy," as Dave Yanofsky, the executive director of Just
1899 Think!, puts it, "is the ability . . . to understand, analyze, and
1900 deconstruct media images. Its aim is to make [kids] literate about the
1901 way media works, the way it's constructed, the way it's delivered, and
1902 the way people access it."
1903 <indexterm><primary>Yanofsky, Dave</primary></indexterm>
1904 </para>
1905 <para>
1906 This may seem like an odd way to think about "literacy." For most
1907 people, literacy is about reading and writing. Faulkner and Hemingway
1908 and noticing split infinitives are the things that "literate" people know
1909 about.
1910 </para>
1911 <para>
1912 Maybe. But in a world where children see on average 390 hours of
1913 television commercials per year, or between 20,000 and 45,000
1914 commercials generally,<footnote><para>
1915 <!-- f10 -->
1916 Judith Van Evra, <citetitle>Television and Child Development</citetitle> (Hillsdale, N.J.:
1917 Lawrence Erlbaum Associates, 1990); "Findings on Family and TV
1918 Study," <citetitle>Denver Post</citetitle>, 25 May 1997, B6.
1919 </para></footnote>
1920 it is increasingly important to understand the "grammar" of media. For
1921 just as there is a grammar for the written word, so, too, is there one
1922 for media. And just as kids learn how to write by writing lots of
1923 terrible prose, kids learn how to write media by constructing lots of
1924 (at least at first) terrible media.
1925 </para>
1926 <para>
1927 A growing field of academics and activists sees this form of literacy
1928 as crucial to the next generation of culture. For though anyone who
1929 has written understands how difficult writing is&mdash;how difficult
1930 it is to sequence the story, to keep a reader's attention, to craft
1931 language to be understandable&mdash;few of us have any real sense of
1932 how difficult media is. Or more fundamentally, few of us have a sense
1933 of how media works, how it holds an audience or leads it through a
1934 story, how it triggers emotion or builds suspense.
1935 </para>
1936 <para>
1937 It took filmmaking a generation before it could do these things well.
1938 But even then, the knowledge was in the filming, not in writing about
1939 the film. The skill came from experiencing the making of a film, not
1940 from reading a book about it. One learns to write by writing and then
1941 reflecting upon what one has written. One learns to write with images
1942 by making them and then reflecting upon what one has created.
1943 </para>
1944 <indexterm><primary>Crichton, Michael</primary></indexterm>
1945 <para>
1946 This grammar has changed as media has changed. When it was just film,
1947 as Elizabeth Daley, executive director of the University of Southern
1948 California's Annenberg Center for Communication and dean of the
1949
1950 <!-- PAGE BREAK 50 -->
1951 USC School of Cinema-Television, explained to me, the grammar was
1952 about "the placement of objects, color, . . . rhythm, pacing, and
1953 texture."<footnote>
1954 <para>
1955 <!-- f11 -->
1956 Interview with Elizabeth Daley and Stephanie Barish, 13 December
1957 2002.
1958 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie</primary></indexterm>
1959 <indexterm><primary>Daley, Elizabeth</primary></indexterm>
1960 </para></footnote>
1961 But as computers open up an interactive space where a story is
1962 "played" as well as experienced, that grammar changes. The simple
1963 control of narrative is lost, and so other techniques are necessary. Author
1964 Michael Crichton had mastered the narrative of science fiction.
1965 But when he tried to design a computer game based on one of his
1966 works, it was a new craft he had to learn. How to lead people through
1967 a game without their feeling they have been led was not obvious, even
1968 to a wildly successful author.<footnote><para>
1969 <!-- f12 -->
1970 See Scott Steinberg, "Crichton Gets Medieval on PCs," E!online, 4
1971 November 2000, available at
1972 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #8</ulink>; "Timeline," 22 November 2000,
1973 available at
1974 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #9</ulink>.
1975 </para></footnote>
1976 </para>
1977 <indexterm><primary>computer games</primary></indexterm>
1978 <para>
1979 This skill is precisely the craft a filmmaker learns. As Daley
1980 describes, "people are very surprised about how they are led through a
1981 film. [I]t is perfectly constructed to keep you from seeing it, so you
1982 have no idea. If a filmmaker succeeds you do not know how you were
1983 led." If you know you were led through a film, the film has failed.
1984 </para>
1985 <para>
1986 Yet the push for an expanded literacy&mdash;one that goes beyond text
1987 to include audio and visual elements&mdash;is not about making better
1988 film directors. The aim is not to improve the profession of
1989 filmmaking at all. Instead, as Daley explained,
1990 </para>
1991 <blockquote>
1992 <para>
1993 From my perspective, probably the most important digital divide
1994 is not access to a box. It's the ability to be empowered with the
1995 language that that box works in. Otherwise only a very few people
1996 can write with this language, and all the rest of us are reduced to
1997 being read-only.
1998 </para>
1999 </blockquote>
2000 <para>
2001 "Read-only." Passive recipients of culture produced elsewhere.
2002 Couch potatoes. Consumers. This is the world of media from the
2003 twentieth century.
2004 </para>
2005 <para>
2006 The twenty-first century could be different. This is the crucial
2007 point: It could be both read and write. Or at least reading and better
2008 understanding the craft of writing. Or best, reading and understanding
2009 the tools that enable the writing to lead or mislead. The aim of any
2010 literacy,
2011 <!-- PAGE BREAK 51 -->
2012 and this literacy in particular, is to "empower people to choose the
2013 appropriate language for what they need to create or
2014 express."<footnote>
2015 <para>
2016 <!-- f13 -->
2017 Interview with Daley and Barish.
2018 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie</primary></indexterm>
2019 </para></footnote> It is to enable students "to communicate in the
2020 language of the twenty-first century."<footnote><para>
2021 <!-- f14 -->
2022 Ibid.
2023 </para></footnote>
2024 </para>
2025 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie</primary></indexterm>
2026 <para>
2027 As with any language, this language comes more easily to some than to
2028 others. It doesn't necessarily come more easily to those who excel in
2029 written language. Daley and Stephanie Barish, director of the
2030 Institute for Multimedia Literacy at the Annenberg Center, describe
2031 one particularly poignant example of a project they ran in a high
2032 school. The high school was a very poor inner-city Los Angeles
2033 school. In all the traditional measures of success, this school was a
2034 failure. But Daley and Barish ran a program that gave kids an
2035 opportunity to use film to express meaning about something the
2036 students know something about&mdash;gun violence.
2037 </para>
2038 <para>
2039 The class was held on Friday afternoons, and it created a relatively
2040 new problem for the school. While the challenge in most classes was
2041 getting the kids to come, the challenge in this class was keeping them
2042 away. The "kids were showing up at 6 A.M. and leaving at 5 at night,"
2043 said Barish. They were working harder than in any other class to do
2044 what education should be about&mdash;learning how to express themselves.
2045 </para>
2046 <para>
2047 Using whatever "free web stuff they could find," and relatively simple
2048 tools to enable the kids to mix "image, sound, and text," Barish said
2049 this class produced a series of projects that showed something about
2050 gun violence that few would otherwise understand. This was an issue
2051 close to the lives of these students. The project "gave them a tool
2052 and empowered them to be able to both understand it and talk about
2053 it," Barish explained. That tool succeeded in creating
2054 expression&mdash;far more successfully and powerfully than could have
2055 been created using only text. "If you had said to these students, `you
2056 have to do it in text,' they would've just thrown their hands up and
2057 gone and done something else," Barish described, in part, no doubt,
2058 because expressing themselves in text is not something these students
2059 can do well. Yet neither is text a form in which
2060 <emphasis>these</emphasis> ideas can be expressed well. The power of
2061 this message depended upon its connection to this form of expression.
2062 </para>
2063 <para>
2064
2065 <!-- PAGE BREAK 52 -->
2066 "But isn't education about teaching kids to write?" I asked. In part,
2067 of course, it is. But why are we teaching kids to write? Education,
2068 Daley explained, is about giving students a way of "constructing
2069 meaning." To say that that means just writing is like saying teaching
2070 writing is only about teaching kids how to spell. Text is one
2071 part&mdash;and increasingly, not the most powerful part&mdash;of
2072 constructing meaning. As Daley explained in the most moving part of
2073 our interview,
2074 </para>
2075 <blockquote>
2076 <para>
2077 What you want is to give these students ways of constructing
2078 meaning. If all you give them is text, they're not going to do it.
2079 Because they can't. You know, you've got Johnny who can look at a
2080 video, he can play a video game, he can do graffiti all over your
2081 walls, he can take your car apart, and he can do all sorts of other
2082 things. He just can't read your text. So Johnny comes to school and
2083 you say, "Johnny, you're illiterate. Nothing you can do matters."
2084 Well, Johnny then has two choices: He can dismiss you or he [can]
2085 dismiss himself. If his ego is healthy at all, he's going to dismiss
2086 you. [But i]nstead, if you say, "Well, with all these things that you
2087 can do, let's talk about this issue. Play for me music that you think
2088 reflects that, or show me images that you think reflect that, or draw
2089 for me something that reflects that." Not by giving a kid a video
2090 camera and . . . saying, "Let's go have fun with the video camera and
2091 make a little movie." But instead, really help you take these elements
2092 that you understand, that are your language, and construct meaning
2093 about the topic. . . .
2094 </para>
2095 <para>
2096 That empowers enormously. And then what happens, of
2097 course, is eventually, as it has happened in all these classes, they
2098 bump up against the fact, "I need to explain this and I really need
2099 to write something." And as one of the teachers told Stephanie,
2100 they would rewrite a paragraph 5, 6, 7, 8 times, till they got it right.
2101 </para>
2102 <para>
2103 Because they needed to. There was a reason for doing it. They
2104 needed to say something, as opposed to just jumping through
2105 your hoops. They actually needed to use a language that they
2106 <!-- PAGE BREAK 53 -->
2107 didn't speak very well. But they had come to understand that they
2108 had a lot of power with this language."
2109 </para>
2110 </blockquote>
2111 <para>
2112 When two planes crashed into the World Trade Center, another into the
2113 Pentagon, and a fourth into a Pennsylvania field, all media around the
2114 world shifted to this news. Every moment of just about every day for
2115 that week, and for weeks after, television in particular, and media
2116 generally, retold the story of the events we had just witnessed. The
2117 telling was a retelling, because we had seen the events that were
2118 described. The genius of this awful act of terrorism was that the
2119 delayed second attack was perfectly timed to assure that the whole
2120 world would be watching.
2121 </para>
2122 <para>
2123 These retellings had an increasingly familiar feel. There was music
2124 scored for the intermissions, and fancy graphics that flashed across
2125 the screen. There was a formula to interviews. There was "balance,"
2126 and seriousness. This was news choreographed in the way we have
2127 increasingly come to expect it, "news as entertainment," even if the
2128 entertainment is tragedy.
2129 </para>
2130 <indexterm><primary>ABC</primary></indexterm>
2131 <indexterm><primary>CBS</primary></indexterm>
2132 <para>
2133 But in addition to this produced news about the "tragedy of September
2134 11," those of us tied to the Internet came to see a very different
2135 production as well. The Internet was filled with accounts of the same
2136 events. Yet these Internet accounts had a very different flavor. Some
2137 people constructed photo pages that captured images from around the
2138 world and presented them as slide shows with text. Some offered open
2139 letters. There were sound recordings. There was anger and frustration.
2140 There were attempts to provide context. There was, in short, an
2141 extraordinary worldwide barn raising, in the sense Mike Godwin uses
2142 the term in his book <citetitle>Cyber Rights</citetitle>, around a news event that had
2143 captured the attention of the world. There was ABC and CBS, but there
2144 was also the Internet.
2145 </para>
2146 <para>
2147 I don't mean simply to praise the Internet&mdash;though I do think the
2148 people who supported this form of speech should be praised. I mean
2149 instead to point to a significance in this form of speech. For like a
2150 Kodak, the Internet enables people to capture images. And like in a
2151 movie
2152 <!-- PAGE BREAK 54 -->
2153 by a student on the "Just Think!" bus, the visual images could be mixed
2154 with sound or text.
2155 </para>
2156 <para>
2157 But unlike any technology for simply capturing images, the Internet
2158 allows these creations to be shared with an extraordinary number of
2159 people, practically instantaneously. This is something new in our
2160 tradition&mdash;not just that culture can be captured mechanically,
2161 and obviously not just that events are commented upon critically, but
2162 that this mix of captured images, sound, and commentary can be widely
2163 spread practically instantaneously.
2164 </para>
2165 <para>
2166 September 11 was not an aberration. It was a beginning. Around the
2167 same time, a form of communication that has grown dramatically was
2168 just beginning to come into public consciousness: the Web-log, or
2169 blog. The blog is a kind of public diary, and within some cultures,
2170 such as in Japan, it functions very much like a diary. In those
2171 cultures, it records private facts in a public way&mdash;it's a kind
2172 of electronic <citetitle>Jerry Springer</citetitle>, available anywhere in the world.
2173 </para>
2174 <para>
2175 But in the United States, blogs have taken on a very different
2176 character. There are some who use the space simply to talk about
2177 their private life. But there are many who use the space to engage in
2178 public discourse. Discussing matters of public import, criticizing
2179 others who are mistaken in their views, criticizing politicians about
2180 the decisions they make, offering solutions to problems we all see:
2181 blogs create the sense of a virtual public meeting, but one in which
2182 we don't all hope to be there at the same time and in which
2183 conversations are not necessarily linked. The best of the blog entries
2184 are relatively short; they point directly to words used by others,
2185 criticizing with or adding to them. They are arguably the most
2186 important form of unchoreographed public discourse that we have.
2187 </para>
2188 <para>
2189 That's a strong statement. Yet it says as much about our democracy as
2190 it does about blogs. This is the part of America that is most
2191 difficult for those of us who love America to accept: Our democracy
2192 has atrophied. Of course we have elections, and most of the time the
2193 courts allow those elections to count. A relatively small number of
2194 people vote
2195 <!-- PAGE BREAK 55 -->
2196 in those elections. The cycle of these elections has become totally
2197 professionalized and routinized. Most of us think this is democracy.
2198 </para>
2199 <para>
2200 But democracy has never just been about elections. Democracy
2201 means rule by the people, but rule means something more than mere
2202 elections. In our tradition, it also means control through reasoned
2203 discourse. This was the idea that captured the imagination of Alexis
2204 de Tocqueville, the nineteenth-century French lawyer who wrote the
2205 most important account of early "Democracy in America." It wasn't
2206 popular elections that fascinated him&mdash;it was the jury, an
2207 institution that gave ordinary people the right to choose life or
2208 death for other citizens. And most fascinating for him was that the
2209 jury didn't just vote about the outcome they would impose. They
2210 deliberated. Members argued about the "right" result; they tried to
2211 persuade each other of the "right" result, and in criminal cases at
2212 least, they had to agree upon a unanimous result for the process to
2213 come to an end.<footnote><para>
2214 <!-- f15 -->
2215 See, for example, Alexis de Tocqueville, <citetitle>Democracy in America</citetitle>,
2216 bk. 1, trans. Henry Reeve (New York: Bantam Books, 2000), ch. 16.
2217 </para></footnote>
2218 </para>
2219 <para>
2220 Yet even this institution flags in American life today. And in its
2221 place, there is no systematic effort to enable citizen deliberation. Some
2222 are pushing to create just such an institution.<footnote><para>
2223 <!-- f16 -->
2224 Bruce Ackerman and James Fishkin, "Deliberation Day," <citetitle>Journal of
2225 Political Philosophy</citetitle> 10 (2) (2002): 129.
2226 </para></footnote>
2227 And in some towns in New England, something close to deliberation
2228 remains. But for most of us for most of the time, there is no time or
2229 place for "democratic deliberation" to occur.
2230 </para>
2231 <para>
2232 More bizarrely, there is generally not even permission for it to
2233 occur. We, the most powerful democracy in the world, have developed a
2234 strong norm against talking about politics. It's fine to talk about
2235 politics with people you agree with. But it is rude to argue about
2236 politics with people you disagree with. Political discourse becomes
2237 isolated, and isolated discourse becomes more extreme.<footnote><para>
2238 <!-- f17 -->
2239 Cass Sunstein, <citetitle>Republic.com</citetitle> (Princeton: Princeton University Press, 2001),
2240 65&ndash;80, 175, 182, 183, 192.
2241 </para></footnote> We say what our friends want to hear, and hear very
2242 little beyond what our friends say.
2243 </para>
2244 <para>
2245 Enter the blog. The blog's very architecture solves one part of this
2246 problem. People post when they want to post, and people read when they
2247 want to read. The most difficult time is synchronous time.
2248 Technologies that enable asynchronous communication, such as e-mail,
2249 increase the opportunity for communication. Blogs allow for public
2250
2251 <!-- PAGE BREAK 56 -->
2252 discourse without the public ever needing to gather in a single public
2253 place.
2254 </para>
2255 <para>
2256 But beyond architecture, blogs also have solved the problem of
2257 norms. There's no norm (yet) in blog space not to talk about politics.
2258 Indeed, the space is filled with political speech, on both the right and
2259 the left. Some of the most popular sites are conservative or libertarian,
2260 but there are many of all political stripes. And even blogs that are not
2261 political cover political issues when the occasion merits.
2262 </para>
2263 <para>
2264 The significance of these blogs is tiny now, though not so tiny. The
2265 name Howard Dean may well have faded from the 2004 presidential race
2266 but for blogs. Yet even if the number of readers is small, the reading
2267 is having an effect.
2268 <indexterm><primary>Dean, Howard</primary></indexterm>
2269 </para>
2270 <para>
2271 One direct effect is on stories that had a different life cycle in the
2272 mainstream media. The Trent Lott affair is an example. When Lott
2273 "misspoke" at a party for Senator Strom Thurmond, essentially praising
2274 Thurmond's segregationist policies, he calculated correctly that this
2275 story would disappear from the mainstream press within forty-eight
2276 hours. It did. But he didn't calculate its life cycle in blog
2277 space. The bloggers kept researching the story. Over time, more and
2278 more instances of the same "misspeaking" emerged. Finally, the story
2279 broke back into the mainstream press. In the end, Lott was forced to
2280 resign as senate majority leader.<footnote><para>
2281 <!-- f18 -->
2282 Noah Shachtman, "With Incessant Postings, a Pundit Stirs the Pot," New
2283 York Times, 16 January 2003, G5.
2284 </para></footnote>
2285 <indexterm><primary>Lott, Trent</primary></indexterm>
2286 </para>
2287 <para>
2288 This different cycle is possible because the same commercial pressures
2289 don't exist with blogs as with other ventures. Television and
2290 newspapers are commercial entities. They must work to keep attention.
2291 If they lose readers, they lose revenue. Like sharks, they must move
2292 on.
2293 </para>
2294 <para>
2295 But bloggers don't have a similar constraint. They can obsess, they
2296 can focus, they can get serious. If a particular blogger writes a
2297 particularly interesting story, more and more people link to that
2298 story. And as the number of links to a particular story increases, it
2299 rises in the ranks of stories. People read what is popular; what is
2300 popular has been selected by a very democratic process of
2301 peer-generated rankings.
2302 </para>
2303 <indexterm id="idxwinerdave" class='startofrange'>
2304 <primary>Winer, Dave</primary>
2305 </indexterm>
2306 <para>
2307 There's a second way, as well, in which blogs have a different cycle
2308 <!-- PAGE BREAK 57 -->
2309 from the mainstream press. As Dave Winer, one of the fathers of this
2310 movement and a software author for many decades, told me, another
2311 difference is the absence of a financial "conflict of interest." "I think you
2312 have to take the conflict of interest" out of journalism, Winer told me.
2313 "An amateur journalist simply doesn't have a conflict of interest, or the
2314 conflict of interest is so easily disclosed that you know you can sort of
2315 get it out of the way."
2316 </para>
2317 <indexterm><primary>CNN</primary></indexterm>
2318 <para>
2319 These conflicts become more important as media becomes more
2320 concentrated (more on this below). A concentrated media can hide more
2321 from the public than an unconcentrated media can&mdash;as CNN admitted
2322 it did after the Iraq war because it was afraid of the consequences to
2323 its own employees.<footnote><para>
2324 <!-- f19 -->
2325 Telephone interview with David Winer, 16 April 2003.
2326 </para></footnote>
2327 It also needs to sustain a more coherent account. (In the middle of
2328 the Iraq war, I read a post on the Internet from someone who was at
2329 that time listening to a satellite uplink with a reporter in Iraq. The
2330 New York headquarters was telling the reporter over and over that her
2331 account of the war was too bleak: She needed to offer a more
2332 optimistic story. When she told New York that wasn't warranted, they
2333 told her <emphasis>that</emphasis> they were writing "the story.")
2334 </para>
2335 <para> Blog space gives amateurs a way to enter the
2336 debate&mdash;"amateur" not in the sense of inexperienced, but in the
2337 sense of an Olympic athlete, meaning not paid by anyone to give their
2338 reports. It allows for a much broader range of input into a story, as
2339 reporting on the Columbia disaster revealed, when hundreds from across
2340 the southwest United States turned to the Internet to retell what they
2341 had seen.<footnote><para>
2342 <!-- f20 -->
2343 John Schwartz, "Loss of the Shuttle: The Internet; A Wealth of
2344 Information Online," <citetitle>New York Times</citetitle>, 2 February 2003, A28; Staci
2345 D. Kramer, "Shuttle Disaster Coverage Mixed, but Strong Overall,"
2346 Online Journalism Review, 2 February 2003, available at
2347 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #10</ulink>.
2348 </para></footnote>
2349 And it drives readers to read across the range of accounts and
2350 "triangulate," as Winer puts it, the truth. Blogs, Winer says, are
2351 "communicating directly with our constituency, and the middle man is
2352 out of it"&mdash;with all the benefits, and costs, that might entail.
2353 </para>
2354 <para>
2355 Winer is optimistic about the future of journalism infected
2356 with blogs. "It's going to become an essential skill," Winer predicts,
2357 for public figures and increasingly for private figures as well. It's
2358 not clear that "journalism" is happy about this&mdash;some journalists
2359 have been told to curtail their blogging.<footnote>
2360 <para>
2361 <!-- f21 -->
2362 See Michael Falcone, "Does an Editor's Pencil Ruin a Web Log?" <citetitle>New
2363 York Times</citetitle>, 29 September 2003, C4. ("Not all news organizations have
2364 been as accepting of employees who blog. Kevin Sites, a CNN
2365 correspondent in Iraq who started a blog about his reporting of the
2366 war on March 9, stopped posting 12 days later at his bosses'
2367 request. Last year Steve Olafson, a <citetitle>Houston Chronicle</citetitle> reporter, was
2368 fired for keeping a personal Web log, published under a pseudonym,
2369 that dealt with some of the issues and people he was covering.")
2370 <indexterm><primary>CNN</primary></indexterm>
2371 </para></footnote>
2372 But it is clear that we are still in transition. "A
2373
2374 <!-- PAGE BREAK 58 -->
2375 lot of what we are doing now is warm-up exercises," Winer told me.
2376 There is a lot that must mature before this space has its mature effect.
2377 And as the inclusion of content in this space is the least infringing use
2378 of the Internet (meaning infringing on copyright), Winer said, "we will
2379 be the last thing that gets shut down."
2380 </para>
2381 <para>
2382 This speech affects democracy. Winer thinks that happens because "you
2383 don't have to work for somebody who controls, [for] a gatekeeper."
2384 That is true. But it affects democracy in another way as well. As
2385 more and more citizens express what they think, and defend it in
2386 writing, that will change the way people understand public issues. It
2387 is easy to be wrong and misguided in your head. It is harder when the
2388 product of your mind can be criticized by others. Of course, it is a
2389 rare human who admits that he has been persuaded that he is wrong. But
2390 it is even rarer for a human to ignore when he has been proven wrong.
2391 The writing of ideas, arguments, and criticism improves democracy.
2392 Today there are probably a couple of million blogs where such writing
2393 happens. When there are ten million, there will be something
2394 extraordinary to report.
2395 </para>
2396 <indexterm startref="idxwinerdave" class='endofrange'/>
2397 <indexterm id="idxbrownjohnseely" class='startofrange'>
2398 <primary>Brown, John Seely</primary>
2399 </indexterm>
2400 <para>
2401 John Seely Brown is the chief scientist of the Xerox Corporation.
2402 His work, as his Web site describes it, is "human learning and . . . the
2403 creation of knowledge ecologies for creating . . . innovation."
2404 </para>
2405 <para>
2406 Brown thus looks at these technologies of digital creativity a bit
2407 differently from the perspectives I've sketched so far. I'm sure he
2408 would be excited about any technology that might improve
2409 democracy. But his real excitement comes from how these technologies
2410 affect learning.
2411 </para>
2412 <para>
2413 As Brown believes, we learn by tinkering. When "a lot of us grew up,"
2414 he explains, that tinkering was done "on motorcycle engines, lawnmower
2415 engines, automobiles, radios, and so on." But digital technologies
2416 enable a different kind of tinkering&mdash;with abstract ideas though
2417 in concrete form. The kids at Just Think! not only think about how a
2418 commercial portrays a politician; using digital technology, they can
2419 <!-- PAGE BREAK 59 -->
2420 take the commercial apart and manipulate it, tinker with it to see how
2421 it does what it does. Digital technologies launch a kind of bricolage,
2422 or "free collage," as Brown calls it. Many get to add to or transform
2423 the tinkering of many others.
2424 </para>
2425 <para>
2426 The best large-scale example of this kind of tinkering so far is free
2427 software or open-source software (FS/OSS). FS/OSS is software whose
2428 source code is shared. Anyone can download the technology that makes a
2429 FS/OSS program run. And anyone eager to learn how a particular bit of
2430 FS/OSS technology works can tinker with the code.
2431 </para>
2432 <para>
2433 This opportunity creates a "completely new kind of learning platform,"
2434 as Brown describes. "As soon as you start doing that, you . . .
2435 unleash a free collage on the community, so that other people can
2436 start looking at your code, tinkering with it, trying it out, seeing
2437 if they can improve it." Each effort is a kind of
2438 apprenticeship. "Open source becomes a major apprenticeship platform."
2439 </para>
2440 <para>
2441 In this process, "the concrete things you tinker with are abstract.
2442 They are code." Kids are "shifting to the ability to tinker in the
2443 abstract, and this tinkering is no longer an isolated activity that
2444 you're doing in your garage. You are tinkering with a community
2445 platform. . . . You are tinkering with other people's stuff. The more
2446 you tinker the more you improve." The more you improve, the more you
2447 learn.
2448 </para>
2449 <para>
2450 This same thing happens with content, too. And it happens in the same
2451 collaborative way when that content is part of the Web. As Brown puts
2452 it, "the Web [is] the first medium that truly honors multiple forms of
2453 intelligence." Earlier technologies, such as the typewriter or word
2454 processors, helped amplify text. But the Web amplifies much more than
2455 text. "The Web . . . says if you are musical, if you are artistic, if
2456 you are visual, if you are interested in film . . . [then] there is a
2457 lot you can start to do on this medium. [It] can now amplify and honor
2458 these multiple forms of intelligence."
2459 </para>
2460 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie</primary></indexterm>
2461 <para>
2462 Brown is talking about what Elizabeth Daley, Stephanie Barish, and
2463 Just Think! teach: that this tinkering with culture teaches as well
2464
2465 <!-- PAGE BREAK 60 -->
2466 as creates. It develops talents differently, and it builds a different
2467 kind of recognition.
2468 </para>
2469 <para>
2470 Yet the freedom to tinker with these objects is not guaranteed.
2471 Indeed, as we'll see through the course of this book, that freedom is
2472 increasingly highly contested. While there's no doubt that your father
2473 had the right to tinker with the car engine, there's great doubt that
2474 your child will have the right to tinker with the images she finds all
2475 around. The law and, increasingly, technology interfere with a
2476 freedom that technology, and curiosity, would otherwise ensure.
2477 </para>
2478 <para>
2479 These restrictions have become the focus of researchers and scholars.
2480 Professor Ed Felten of Princeton (whom we'll see more of in chapter
2481 10) has developed a powerful argument in favor of the "right to
2482 tinker" as it applies to computer science and to knowledge in
2483 general.<footnote><para>
2484 <!-- f22 -->
2485 See, for example, Edward Felten and Andrew Appel, "Technological Access
2486 Control Interferes with Noninfringing Scholarship," <citetitle>Communications
2487 of the Association for Computer Machinery</citetitle> 43 (2000): 9.
2488 </para></footnote>
2489 But Brown's concern is earlier, or younger, or more fundamental. It is
2490 about the learning that kids can do, or can't do, because of the law.
2491 </para>
2492 <para>
2493 "This is where education in the twenty-first century is going," Brown
2494 explains. We need to "understand how kids who grow up digital think
2495 and want to learn."
2496 </para>
2497 <para>
2498 "Yet," as Brown continued, and as the balance of this book will
2499 evince, "we are building a legal system that completely suppresses the
2500 natural tendencies of today's digital kids. . . . We're building an
2501 architecture that unleashes 60 percent of the brain [and] a legal
2502 system that closes down that part of the brain."
2503 </para>
2504 <indexterm startref="idxbrownjohnseely" class='endofrange'/>
2505 <para>
2506 We're building a technology that takes the magic of Kodak, mixes
2507 moving images and sound, and adds a space for commentary and an
2508 opportunity to spread that creativity everywhere. But we're building
2509 the law to close down that technology.
2510 </para>
2511 <para>
2512 "No way to run a culture," as Brewster Kahle, whom we'll meet in
2513 chapter 9, quipped to me in a rare moment of despondence.
2514 </para>
2515 <!-- PAGE BREAK 61 -->
2516 </chapter>
2517 <chapter id="catalogs">
2518 <title>CHAPTER THREE: Catalogs</title>
2519 <para>
2520 In the fall of 2002, Jesse Jordan of Oceanside, New York, enrolled as
2521 a freshman at Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute, in Troy, New York.
2522 His major at RPI was information technology. Though he is not a
2523 programmer, in October Jesse decided to begin to tinker with search
2524 engine technology that was available on the RPI network.
2525 </para>
2526 <para>
2527 RPI is one of America's foremost technological research institutions.
2528 It offers degrees in fields ranging from architecture and engineering
2529 to information sciences. More than 65 percent of its five thousand
2530 undergraduates finished in the top 10 percent of their high school
2531 class. The school is thus a perfect mix of talent and experience to
2532 imagine and then build, a generation for the network age.
2533 </para>
2534 <para>
2535 RPI's computer network links students, faculty, and administration to
2536 one another. It also links RPI to the Internet. Not everything
2537 available on the RPI network is available on the Internet. But the
2538 network is designed to enable students to get access to the Internet,
2539 as well as more intimate access to other members of the RPI community.
2540 </para>
2541 <para>
2542 Search engines are a measure of a network's intimacy. Google
2543 <!-- PAGE BREAK 62 -->
2544 brought the Internet much closer to all of us by fantastically
2545 improving the quality of search on the network. Specialty search
2546 engines can do this even better. The idea of "intranet" search
2547 engines, search engines that search within the network of a particular
2548 institution, is to provide users of that institution with better
2549 access to material from that institution. Businesses do this all the
2550 time, enabling employees to have access to material that people
2551 outside the business can't get. Universities do it as well.
2552 </para>
2553 <para>
2554 These engines are enabled by the network technology itself.
2555 Microsoft, for example, has a network file system that makes it very
2556 easy for search engines tuned to that network to query the system for
2557 information about the publicly (within that network) available
2558 content. Jesse's search engine was built to take advantage of this
2559 technology. It used Microsoft's network file system to build an index
2560 of all the files available within the RPI network.
2561 </para>
2562 <para>
2563 Jesse's wasn't the first search engine built for the RPI network.
2564 Indeed, his engine was a simple modification of engines that others
2565 had built. His single most important improvement over those engines
2566 was to fix a bug within the Microsoft file-sharing system that could
2567 cause a user's computer to crash. With the engines that existed
2568 before, if you tried to access a file through a Windows browser that
2569 was on a computer that was off-line, your computer could crash. Jesse
2570 modified the system a bit to fix that problem, by adding a button that
2571 a user could click to see if the machine holding the file was still
2572 on-line.
2573 </para>
2574 <para>
2575 Jesse's engine went on-line in late October. Over the following six
2576 months, he continued to tweak it to improve its functionality. By
2577 March, the system was functioning quite well. Jesse had more than one
2578 million files in his directory, including every type of content that might
2579 be on users' computers.
2580 </para>
2581 <para>
2582 Thus the index his search engine produced included pictures, which
2583 students could use to put on their own Web sites; copies of notes or
2584 research; copies of information pamphlets; movie clips that students
2585 might have created; university brochures&mdash;basically anything that
2586 <!-- PAGE BREAK 63 -->
2587 users of the RPI network made available in a public folder of their
2588 computer.
2589 </para>
2590 <para>
2591 But the index also included music files. In fact, one quarter of the
2592 files that Jesse's search engine listed were music files. But that
2593 means, of course, that three quarters were not, and&mdash;so that this
2594 point is absolutely clear&mdash;Jesse did nothing to induce people to
2595 put music files in their public folders. He did nothing to target the
2596 search engine to these files. He was a kid tinkering with a
2597 Google-like technology at a university where he was studying
2598 information science, and hence, tinkering was the aim. Unlike Google,
2599 or Microsoft, for that matter, he made no money from this tinkering;
2600 he was not connected to any business that would make any money from
2601 this experiment. He was a kid tinkering with technology in an
2602 environment where tinkering with technology was precisely what he was
2603 supposed to do.
2604 </para>
2605 <para>
2606 On April 3, 2003, Jesse was contacted by the dean of students at
2607 RPI. The dean informed Jesse that the Recording Industry Association
2608 of America, the RIAA, would be filing a lawsuit against him and three
2609 other students whom he didn't even know, two of them at other
2610 universities. A few hours later, Jesse was served with papers from
2611 the suit. As he read these papers and watched the news reports about
2612 them, he was increasingly astonished.
2613 </para>
2614 <para>
2615 "It was absurd," he told me. "I don't think I did anything
2616 wrong. . . . I don't think there's anything wrong with the search
2617 engine that I ran or . . . what I had done to it. I mean, I hadn't
2618 modified it in any way that promoted or enhanced the work of
2619 pirates. I just modified the search engine in a way that would make it
2620 easier to use"&mdash;again, a <emphasis>search engine</emphasis>,
2621 which Jesse had not himself built, using the Windows filesharing
2622 system, which Jesse had not himself built, to enable members of the
2623 RPI community to get access to content, which Jesse had not himself
2624 created or posted, and the vast majority of which had nothing to do
2625 with music.
2626 </para>
2627 <para>
2628 But the RIAA branded Jesse a pirate. They claimed he operated a
2629 network and had therefore "willfully" violated copyright laws. They
2630 <!-- PAGE BREAK 64 -->
2631 demanded that he pay them the damages for his wrong. For cases of
2632 "willful infringement," the Copyright Act specifies something lawyers
2633 call "statutory damages." These damages permit a copyright owner to
2634 claim $150,000 per infringement. As the RIAA alleged more than one
2635 hundred specific copyright infringements, they therefore demanded that
2636 Jesse pay them at least $15,000,000.
2637 </para>
2638 <para>
2639 Similar lawsuits were brought against three other students: one other
2640 student at RPI, one at Michigan Technical University, and one at
2641 Princeton. Their situations were similar to Jesse's. Though each case
2642 was different in detail, the bottom line in each was exactly the same:
2643 huge demands for "damages" that the RIAA claimed it was entitled to.
2644 If you added up the claims, these four lawsuits were asking courts in
2645 the United States to award the plaintiffs close to $100
2646 <emphasis>billion</emphasis>&mdash;six times the
2647 <emphasis>total</emphasis> profit of the film industry in
2648 2001.<footnote><para>
2649
2650 <!-- f1 -->
2651 Tim Goral, "Recording Industry Goes After Campus P-2-P Networks:
2652 Suit Alleges $97.8 Billion in Damages," <citetitle>Professional Media Group LCC</citetitle> 6
2653 (2003): 5, available at 2003 WL 55179443.
2654 </para></footnote>
2655 </para>
2656 <para>
2657 Jesse called his parents. They were supportive but a bit frightened.
2658 An uncle was a lawyer. He began negotiations with the RIAA. They
2659 demanded to know how much money Jesse had. Jesse had saved
2660 $12,000 from summer jobs and other employment. They demanded
2661 $12,000 to dismiss the case.
2662 </para>
2663 <para>
2664 The RIAA wanted Jesse to admit to doing something wrong. He
2665 refused. They wanted him to agree to an injunction that would
2666 essentially make it impossible for him to work in many fields of
2667 technology for the rest of his life. He refused. They made him
2668 understand that this process of being sued was not going to be
2669 pleasant. (As Jesse's father recounted to me, the chief lawyer on the
2670 case, Matt Oppenheimer, told Jesse, "You don't want to pay another
2671 visit to a dentist like me.") And throughout, the RIAA insisted it
2672 would not settle the case until it took every penny Jesse had saved.
2673 </para>
2674 <para>
2675 Jesse's family was outraged at these claims. They wanted to fight.
2676 But Jesse's uncle worked to educate the family about the nature of the
2677 American legal system. Jesse could fight the RIAA. He might even
2678 win. But the cost of fighting a lawsuit like this, Jesse was told, would be
2679 at least $250,000. If he won, he would not recover that money. If he
2680 <!-- PAGE BREAK 65 -->
2681 won, he would have a piece of paper saying he had won, and a piece of
2682 paper saying he and his family were bankrupt.
2683 </para>
2684 <para>
2685 So Jesse faced a mafia-like choice: $250,000 and a chance at winning,
2686 or $12,000 and a settlement.
2687 </para>
2688 <para>
2689 The recording industry insists this is a matter of law and morality.
2690 Let's put the law aside for a moment and think about the morality.
2691 Where is the morality in a lawsuit like this? What is the virtue in
2692 scapegoatism? The RIAA is an extraordinarily powerful lobby. The
2693 president of the RIAA is reported to make more than $1 million a year.
2694 Artists, on the other hand, are not well paid. The average recording
2695 artist makes $45,900.<footnote><para>
2696 <!-- f2 -->
2697 Occupational Employment Survey, U.S. Dept. of Labor (2001)
2698 (27&ndash;2042&mdash;Musicians and Singers). See also National Endowment for
2699 the Arts, <citetitle>More Than One in a Blue Moon</citetitle> (2000).
2700 </para></footnote>
2701 There are plenty of ways for the RIAA to affect
2702 and direct policy. So where is the morality in taking money from a
2703 student for running a search engine?<footnote><para>
2704 <!-- f3 -->
2705 Douglas Lichtman makes a related point in "KaZaA and Punishment,"
2706 <citetitle>Wall Street Journal</citetitle>, 10 September 2003, A24.
2707 </para></footnote>
2708 </para>
2709 <para>
2710 On June 23, Jesse wired his savings to the lawyer working for the
2711 RIAA. The case against him was then dismissed. And with this, this
2712 kid who had tinkered a computer into a $15 million lawsuit became an
2713 activist:
2714 </para>
2715 <blockquote>
2716 <para>
2717 I was definitely not an activist [before]. I never really meant to be
2718 an activist. . . . [But] I've been pushed into this. In no way did I
2719 ever foresee anything like this, but I think it's just completely
2720 absurd what the RIAA has done.
2721 </para>
2722 </blockquote>
2723 <para>
2724 Jesse's parents betray a certain pride in their reluctant activist. As
2725 his father told me, Jesse "considers himself very conservative, and so do
2726 I. . . . He's not a tree hugger. . . . I think it's bizarre that they would
2727 pick on him. But he wants to let people know that they're sending the
2728 wrong message. And he wants to correct the record."
2729 </para>
2730 <!-- PAGE BREAK 66 -->
2731 </chapter>
2732 <chapter id="pirates">
2733 <title>CHAPTER FOUR: "Pirates"</title>
2734 <para>
2735 If "piracy" means using the creative property of others without
2736 their permission&mdash;if "if value, then right" is true&mdash;then the history of
2737 the content industry is a history of piracy. Every important sector of
2738 "big media" today&mdash;film, records, radio, and cable TV&mdash;was born of a
2739 kind of piracy so defined. The consistent story is how last generation's
2740 pirates join this generation's country club&mdash;until now.
2741 </para>
2742 <section id="film">
2743 <title>Film</title>
2744 <para>
2745 The film industry of Hollywood was built by fleeing pirates.<footnote><para>
2746 <!-- f1 -->
2747 I am grateful to Peter DiMauro for pointing me to this extraordinary
2748 history. See also Siva Vaidhyanathan, <citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs</citetitle>, 87&ndash;93,
2749 which details Edison's "adventures" with copyright and patent.
2750 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva</primary></indexterm>
2751 </para></footnote>
2752 Creators and directors migrated from the East Coast to California in
2753 the early twentieth century in part to escape controls that patents
2754 granted the inventor of filmmaking, Thomas Edison. These controls were
2755 exercised through a monopoly "trust," the Motion Pictures Patents
2756 Company, and were based on Thomas Edison's creative
2757 property&mdash;patents. Edison formed the MPPC to exercise the rights
2758 this creative property
2759 <!-- PAGE BREAK 67 -->
2760 gave him, and the MPPC was serious about the control it demanded.
2761 </para>
2762 <para>
2763 As one commentator tells one part of the story,
2764 </para>
2765 <blockquote>
2766 <para>
2767 A January 1909 deadline was set for all companies to comply with
2768 the license. By February, unlicensed outlaws, who referred to
2769 themselves as independents protested the trust and carried on
2770 business without submitting to the Edison monopoly. In the
2771 summer of 1909 the independent movement was in full-swing,
2772 with producers and theater owners using illegal equipment and
2773 imported film stock to create their own underground market.
2774 </para>
2775 <para>
2776 With the country experiencing a tremendous expansion in the number of
2777 nickelodeons, the Patents Company reacted to the independent movement
2778 by forming a strong-arm subsidiary known as the General Film Company
2779 to block the entry of non-licensed independents. With coercive tactics
2780 that have become legendary, General Film confiscated unlicensed
2781 equipment, discontinued product supply to theaters which showed
2782 unlicensed films, and effectively monopolized distribution with the
2783 acquisition of all U.S. film exchanges, except for the one owned by
2784 the independent William Fox who defied the Trust even after his
2785 license was revoked.<footnote><para>
2786 <!-- f2 -->
2787 J. A. Aberdeen, <citetitle>Hollywood Renegades: The Society of Independent Motion
2788 Picture Producers</citetitle> (Cobblestone Entertainment, 2000) and expanded texts
2789 posted at "The Edison Movie Monopoly: The Motion Picture Patents
2790 Company vs. the Independent Outlaws," available at
2791 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #11</ulink>. For a
2792 discussion of the economic motive behind both these limits and the
2793 limits imposed by Victor on phonographs, see Randal C. Picker, "From
2794 Edison to the Broadcast Flag: Mechanisms of Consent and Refusal and
2795 the Propertization of Copyright" (September 2002), University of
2796 Chicago Law School, James M. Olin Program in Law and Economics,
2797 Working Paper No. 159. </para></footnote>
2798 <indexterm><primary>General Film Company</primary></indexterm>
2799 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.</primary></indexterm>
2800 </para>
2801 </blockquote>
2802 <para>
2803 The Napsters of those days, the "independents," were companies like
2804 Fox. And no less than today, these independents were vigorously
2805 resisted. "Shooting was disrupted by machinery stolen, and
2806 `accidents' resulting in loss of negatives, equipment, buildings and
2807 sometimes life and limb frequently occurred."<footnote><para>
2808 <!-- f3 -->
2809 Marc Wanamaker, "The First Studios," <citetitle>The Silents Majority</citetitle>, archived at
2810 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #12</ulink>.
2811 </para></footnote>
2812 That led the independents to flee the East
2813 Coast. California was remote enough from Edison's reach that
2814 filmmakers there could pirate his inventions without fear of the
2815 law. And the leaders of Hollywood filmmaking, Fox most prominently,
2816 did just that.
2817 </para>
2818 <para>
2819 Of course, California grew quickly, and the effective enforcement
2820 of federal law eventually spread west. But because patents grant the
2821 patent holder a truly "limited" monopoly (just seventeen years at that
2822
2823 <!-- PAGE BREAK 68 -->
2824 time), by the time enough federal marshals appeared, the patents had
2825 expired. A new industry had been born, in part from the piracy of
2826 Edison's creative property.
2827 </para>
2828 </section>
2829 <section id="recordedmusic">
2830 <title>Recorded Music</title>
2831 <para>
2832 The record industry was born of another kind of piracy, though to see
2833 how requires a bit of detail about the way the law regulates music.
2834 </para>
2835 <para>
2836 At the time that Edison and Henri Fourneaux invented machines
2837 for reproducing music (Edison the phonograph, Fourneaux the player
2838 piano), the law gave composers the exclusive right to control copies of
2839 their music and the exclusive right to control public performances of
2840 their music. In other words, in 1900, if I wanted a copy of Phil Russel's
2841 1899 hit "Happy Mose," the law said I would have to pay for the right
2842 to get a copy of the musical score, and I would also have to pay for the
2843 right to perform it publicly.
2844 </para>
2845 <indexterm><primary>Beatles</primary></indexterm>
2846 <para>
2847 But what if I wanted to record "Happy Mose," using Edison's phonograph
2848 or Fourneaux's player piano? Here the law stumbled. It was clear
2849 enough that I would have to buy any copy of the musical score that I
2850 performed in making this recording. And it was clear enough that I
2851 would have to pay for any public performance of the work I was
2852 recording. But it wasn't totally clear that I would have to pay for a
2853 "public performance" if I recorded the song in my own house (even
2854 today, you don't owe the Beatles anything if you sing their songs in
2855 the shower), or if I recorded the song from memory (copies in your
2856 brain are not&mdash;yet&mdash; regulated by copyright law). So if I
2857 simply sang the song into a recording device in the privacy of my own
2858 home, it wasn't clear that I owed the composer anything. And more
2859 importantly, it wasn't clear whether I owed the composer anything if I
2860 then made copies of those recordings. Because of this gap in the law,
2861 then, I could effectively pirate someone else's song without paying
2862 its composer anything.
2863 </para>
2864 <para>
2865 The composers (and publishers) were none too happy about
2866 <!-- PAGE BREAK 69 -->
2867 this capacity to pirate. As South Dakota senator Alfred Kittredge
2868 put it,
2869 </para>
2870 <blockquote>
2871 <para>
2872 Imagine the injustice of the thing. A composer writes a song or an
2873 opera. A publisher buys at great expense the rights to the same and
2874 copyrights it. Along come the phonographic companies and companies who
2875 cut music rolls and deliberately steal the work of the brain of the
2876 composer and publisher without any regard for [their]
2877 rights.<footnote><para>
2878 <!-- f4 -->
2879 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright: Hearings on
2880 S. 6330 and H.R. 19853 Before the ( Joint) Committees on Patents, 59th
2881 Cong. 59, 1st sess. (1906) (statement of Senator Alfred B. Kittredge,
2882 of South Dakota, chairman), reprinted in <citetitle>Legislative History of the
2883 Copyright Act</citetitle>, E. Fulton Brylawski and Abe Goldman, eds. (South
2884 Hackensack, N.J.: Rothman Reprints, 1976).
2885 </para></footnote>
2886 </para>
2887 </blockquote>
2888 <para>
2889 The innovators who developed the technology to record other
2890 people's works were "sponging upon the toil, the work, the talent, and
2891 genius of American composers,"<footnote><para>
2892 <!-- f5 -->
2893 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright, 223
2894 (statement of Nathan Burkan, attorney for the Music Publishers Association).
2895 </para></footnote>
2896 and the "music publishing industry"
2897 was thereby "at the complete mercy of this one pirate."<footnote><para>
2898 <!-- f6 -->
2899 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright, 226
2900 (statement of Nathan Burkan, attorney for the Music Publishers Association).
2901 </para></footnote>
2902 As John Philip
2903 Sousa put it, in as direct a way as possible, "When they make money
2904 out of my pieces, I want a share of it."<footnote><para>
2905 <!-- f7 -->
2906 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright, 23
2907 (statement of John Philip Sousa, composer).
2908 </para></footnote>
2909 </para>
2910 <para>
2911 These arguments have familiar echoes in the wars of our day. So, too,
2912 do the arguments on the other side. The innovators who developed the
2913 player piano argued that "it is perfectly demonstrable that the
2914 introduction of automatic music players has not deprived any composer
2915 of anything he had before their introduction." Rather, the machines
2916 increased the sales of sheet music.<footnote><para>
2917 <!-- f8 -->
2918
2919 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright, 283&ndash;84
2920 (statement of Albert Walker, representative of the Auto-Music
2921 Perforating Company of New York).
2922 </para></footnote> In any case, the innovators argued, the job of
2923 Congress was "to consider first the interest of [the public], whom
2924 they represent, and whose servants they are." "All talk about
2925 `theft,'" the general counsel of the American Graphophone Company
2926 wrote, "is the merest claptrap, for there exists no property in ideas
2927 musical, literary or artistic, except as defined by
2928 statute."<footnote><para>
2929 <!-- f9 -->
2930 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright, 376 (prepared
2931 memorandum of Philip Mauro, general patent counsel of the American
2932 Graphophone Company Association).
2933 </para></footnote>
2934 </para>
2935 <para>
2936 The law soon resolved this battle in favor of the composer
2937 <emphasis>and</emphasis> the recording artist. Congress amended the
2938 law to make sure that composers would be paid for the "mechanical
2939 reproductions" of their music. But rather than simply granting the
2940 composer complete control over the right to make mechanical
2941 reproductions, Congress gave recording artists a right to record the
2942 music, at a price set by Congress, once the composer allowed it to be
2943 recorded once. This is the part of
2944
2945 <!-- PAGE BREAK 70 -->
2946 copyright law that makes cover songs possible. Once a composer
2947 authorizes a recording of his song, others are free to record the same
2948 song, so long as they pay the original composer a fee set by the law.
2949 </para>
2950 <para>
2951 American law ordinarily calls this a "compulsory license," but I will
2952 refer to it as a "statutory license." A statutory license is a license
2953 whose key terms are set by law. After Congress's amendment of the
2954 Copyright Act in 1909, record companies were free to distribute copies
2955 of recordings so long as they paid the composer (or copyright holder)
2956 the fee set by the statute.
2957 </para>
2958 <para>
2959 This is an exception within the law of copyright. When John Grisham
2960 writes a novel, a publisher is free to publish that novel only if
2961 Grisham gives the publisher permission. Grisham, in turn, is free to
2962 charge whatever he wants for that permission. The price to publish
2963 Grisham is thus set by Grisham, and copyright law ordinarily says you
2964 have no permission to use Grisham's work except with permission of
2965 Grisham.
2966 <indexterm><primary>Grisham, John</primary></indexterm>
2967 </para>
2968 <para>
2969 But the law governing recordings gives recording artists less. And
2970 thus, in effect, the law <emphasis>subsidizes</emphasis> the recording
2971 industry through a kind of piracy&mdash;by giving recording artists a
2972 weaker right than it otherwise gives creative authors. The Beatles
2973 have less control over their creative work than Grisham does. And the
2974 beneficiaries of this less control are the recording industry and the
2975 public. The recording industry gets something of value for less than
2976 it otherwise would pay; the public gets access to a much wider range
2977 of musical creativity. Indeed, Congress was quite explicit about its
2978 reasons for granting this right. Its fear was the monopoly power of
2979 rights holders, and that that power would stifle follow-on
2980 creativity.<footnote><para>
2981
2982 <!-- f10 -->
2983 Copyright Law Revision: Hearings on S. 2499, S. 2900, H.R. 243, and
2984 H.R. 11794 Before the ( Joint) Committee on Patents, 60th Cong., 1st
2985 sess., 217 (1908) (statement of Senator Reed Smoot, chairman), reprinted
2986 in <citetitle>Legislative History of the 1909 Copyright Act</citetitle>, E. Fulton Brylawski and
2987 Abe Goldman, eds. (South Hackensack, N.J.: Rothman Reprints, 1976).
2988 </para></footnote>
2989 <indexterm><primary>Beatles</primary></indexterm>
2990 </para>
2991 <para>
2992 While the recording industry has been quite coy about this recently,
2993 historically it has been quite a supporter of the statutory license for
2994 records. As a 1967 report from the House Committee on the Judiciary
2995 relates,
2996 </para>
2997 <blockquote>
2998 <para>
2999 the record producers argued vigorously that the compulsory
3000 <!-- PAGE BREAK 71 -->
3001 license system must be retained. They asserted that the record
3002 industry is a half-billion-dollar business of great economic
3003 importance in the United States and throughout the world; records
3004 today are the principal means of disseminating music, and this creates
3005 special problems, since performers need unhampered access to musical
3006 material on nondiscriminatory terms. Historically, the record
3007 producers pointed out, there were no recording rights before 1909 and
3008 the 1909 statute adopted the compulsory license as a deliberate
3009 anti-monopoly condition on the grant of these rights. They argue that
3010 the result has been an outpouring of recorded music, with the public
3011 being given lower prices, improved quality, and a greater
3012 choice.<footnote><para>
3013 <!-- f11 -->
3014 Copyright Law Revision: Report to Accompany H.R. 2512, House Committee
3015 on the Judiciary, 90th Cong., 1st sess., House Document no. 83, (8
3016 March 1967). I am grateful to Glenn Brown for drawing my attention to
3017 this report.</para></footnote>
3018 </para>
3019 </blockquote>
3020 <para>
3021 By limiting the rights musicians have, by partially pirating their
3022 creative work, the record producers, and the public, benefit.
3023 </para>
3024 </section>
3025 <section id="radio">
3026 <title>Radio</title>
3027 <para>
3028 Radio was also born of piracy.
3029 </para>
3030 <para>
3031 When a radio station plays a record on the air, that constitutes a
3032 "public performance" of the composer's work.<footnote><para>
3033 <!-- f12 -->
3034 See 17 <citetitle>United States Code</citetitle>, sections 106 and 110. At the beginning,
3035 record companies printed "Not Licensed for Radio Broadcast" and other
3036 messages purporting to restrict the ability to play a record on a
3037 radio station. Judge Learned Hand rejected the argument that a
3038 warning attached to a record might restrict the rights of the radio
3039 station. See <citetitle>RCA Manufacturing Co</citetitle>. v. <citetitle>Whiteman</citetitle>, 114 F. 2d 86 (2nd
3040 Cir. 1940). See also Randal C. Picker, "From Edison to the Broadcast
3041 Flag: Mechanisms of Consent and Refusal and the Propertization of
3042 Copyright," <citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review</citetitle> 70 (2003): 281.
3043 <indexterm><primary>Hand, Learned</primary></indexterm>
3044 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.</primary></indexterm>
3045 </para></footnote>
3046 As I described above, the law gives the composer (or copyright holder)
3047 an exclusive right to public performances of his work. The radio
3048 station thus owes the composer money for that performance.
3049 </para>
3050 <para>
3051 But when the radio station plays a record, it is not only performing a
3052 copy of the <emphasis>composer's</emphasis> work. The radio station is
3053 also performing a copy of the <emphasis>recording artist's</emphasis>
3054 work. It's one thing to have "Happy Birthday" sung on the radio by the
3055 local children's choir; it's quite another to have it sung by the
3056 Rolling Stones or Lyle Lovett. The recording artist is adding to the
3057 value of the composition performed on the radio station. And if the
3058 law were perfectly consistent, the radio station would have to pay the
3059 recording artist for his work, just as it pays the composer of the
3060 music for his work.
3061 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle</primary></indexterm>
3062
3063 <!-- PAGE BREAK 72 -->
3064 </para>
3065 <para>
3066 But it doesn't. Under the law governing radio performances, the radio
3067 station does not have to pay the recording artist. The radio station
3068 need only pay the composer. The radio station thus gets a bit of
3069 something for nothing. It gets to perform the recording artist's work
3070 for free, even if it must pay the composer something for the privilege
3071 of playing the song.
3072 </para>
3073 <indexterm id="idxmadonna" class='startofrange'>
3074 <primary>Madonna</primary>
3075 </indexterm>
3076 <para>
3077 This difference can be huge. Imagine you compose a piece of music.
3078 Imagine it is your first. You own the exclusive right to authorize
3079 public performances of that music. So if Madonna wants to sing your
3080 song in public, she has to get your permission.
3081 </para>
3082 <para>
3083 Imagine she does sing your song, and imagine she likes it a lot. She
3084 then decides to make a recording of your song, and it becomes a top
3085 hit. Under our law, every time a radio station plays your song, you
3086 get some money. But Madonna gets nothing, save the indirect effect on
3087 the sale of her CDs. The public performance of her recording is not a
3088 "protected" right. The radio station thus gets to
3089 <emphasis>pirate</emphasis> the value of Madonna's work without paying
3090 her anything.
3091 </para>
3092 <indexterm startref="idxmadonna" class='endofrange'/>
3093 <para>
3094 No doubt, one might argue that, on balance, the recording artists
3095 benefit. On average, the promotion they get is worth more than the
3096 performance rights they give up. Maybe. But even if so, the law
3097 ordinarily gives the creator the right to make this choice. By making
3098 the choice for him or her, the law gives the radio station the right
3099 to take something for nothing.
3100 </para>
3101 </section>
3102 <section id="cabletv">
3103 <title>Cable TV</title>
3104 <para>
3105
3106 Cable TV was also born of a kind of piracy.
3107 </para>
3108 <para>
3109 When cable entrepreneurs first started wiring communities with cable
3110 television in 1948, most refused to pay broadcasters for the content
3111 that they echoed to their customers. Even when the cable companies
3112 started selling access to television broadcasts, they refused to pay
3113 <!-- PAGE BREAK 73 -->
3114 for what they sold. Cable companies were thus Napsterizing
3115 broadcasters' content, but more egregiously than anything Napster ever
3116 did&mdash; Napster never charged for the content it enabled others to
3117 give away.
3118 </para>
3119 <indexterm><primary>Anello, Douglas</primary></indexterm>
3120 <indexterm><primary>Burdick, Quentin</primary></indexterm>
3121 <para>
3122 Broadcasters and copyright owners were quick to attack this theft.
3123 Rosel Hyde, chairman of the FCC, viewed the practice as a kind of
3124 "unfair and potentially destructive competition."<footnote><para>
3125 <!-- f13 -->
3126 Copyright Law Revision&mdash;CATV: Hearing on S. 1006 Before the
3127 Subcommittee on Patents, Trademarks, and Copyrights of the Senate
3128 Committee on the Judiciary, 89th Cong., 2nd sess., 78 (1966)
3129 (statement of Rosel H. Hyde, chairman of the Federal Communications
3130 Commission).
3131 </para></footnote>
3132 There may have been a "public interest" in spreading the reach of cable
3133 TV, but as Douglas Anello, general counsel to the National Association
3134 of Broadcasters, asked Senator Quentin Burdick during testimony, "Does public
3135 interest dictate that you use somebody else's property?"<footnote><para>
3136 <!-- f14 -->
3137 Copyright Law Revision&mdash;CATV, 116 (statement of Douglas A. Anello,
3138 general counsel of the National Association of Broadcasters).
3139 </para></footnote>
3140 As another broadcaster put it,
3141 </para>
3142 <blockquote>
3143 <para>
3144 The extraordinary thing about the CATV business is that it is the
3145 only business I know of where the product that is being sold is not
3146 paid for.<footnote><para>
3147 <!-- f15 -->
3148 Copyright Law Revision&mdash;CATV, 126 (statement of Ernest W. Jennes,
3149 general counsel of the Association of Maximum Service Telecasters, Inc.).
3150 </para></footnote>
3151 </para>
3152 </blockquote>
3153 <para>
3154 Again, the demand of the copyright holders seemed reasonable enough:
3155 </para>
3156 <blockquote>
3157 <para>
3158 All we are asking for is a very simple thing, that people who now
3159 take our property for nothing pay for it. We are trying to stop
3160 piracy and I don't think there is any lesser word to describe it. I
3161 think there are harsher words which would fit it.<footnote><para>
3162 <!-- f16 -->
3163 Copyright Law Revision&mdash;CATV, 169 (joint statement of Arthur B.
3164 Krim, president of United Artists Corp., and John Sinn, president of
3165 United Artists Television, Inc.).
3166 </para></footnote>
3167 </para>
3168 </blockquote>
3169 <para>
3170 These were "free-ride[rs]," Screen Actor's Guild president Charlton
3171 Heston said, who were "depriving actors of
3172 compensation."<footnote><para>
3173 <!-- f17 -->
3174 Copyright Law Revision&mdash;CATV, 209 (statement of Charlton Heston,
3175 president of the Screen Actors Guild).
3176 </para></footnote>
3177 </para>
3178 <para>
3179 But again, there was another side to the debate. As Assistant Attorney
3180 General Edwin Zimmerman put it,
3181 </para>
3182 <blockquote>
3183 <para>
3184 Our point here is that unlike the problem of whether you have any
3185 copyright protection at all, the problem here is whether copyright
3186 holders who are already compensated, who already have a monopoly,
3187 should be permitted to extend that monopoly. . . . The
3188
3189 <!-- PAGE BREAK 74 -->
3190 question here is how much compensation they should have and
3191 how far back they should carry their right to compensation.<footnote><para>
3192 <!-- f18 -->
3193 Copyright Law Revision&mdash;CATV, 216 (statement of Edwin M.
3194 Zimmerman, acting assistant attorney general).
3195 <indexterm><primary>Zimmerman, Edwin</primary></indexterm>
3196 </para></footnote>
3197 <indexterm><primary>Zimmerman, Edwin</primary></indexterm>
3198 </para>
3199 </blockquote>
3200 <para>
3201 Copyright owners took the cable companies to court. Twice the Supreme
3202 Court held that the cable companies owed the copyright owners nothing.
3203 </para>
3204 <para>
3205 It took Congress almost thirty years before it resolved the question
3206 of whether cable companies had to pay for the content they "pirated."
3207 In the end, Congress resolved this question in the same way that it
3208 resolved the question about record players and player pianos. Yes,
3209 cable companies would have to pay for the content that they broadcast;
3210 but the price they would have to pay was not set by the copyright
3211 owner. The price was set by law, so that the broadcasters couldn't
3212 exercise veto power over the emerging technologies of cable. Cable
3213 companies thus built their empire in part upon a "piracy" of the value
3214 created by broadcasters' content.
3215 </para>
3216 <para>
3217 These separate stories sing a common theme. If "piracy" means
3218 using value from someone else's creative property without permission
3219 from that creator&mdash;as it is increasingly described
3220 today<footnote><para>
3221 <!-- f19 -->
3222 See, for example, National Music Publisher's Association, <citetitle>The Engine
3223 of Free Expression: Copyright on the Internet&mdash;The Myth of Free
3224 Information</citetitle>, available at
3225 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #13</ulink>. "The
3226 threat of piracy&mdash;the use of someone else's creative work without
3227 permission or compensation&mdash;has grown with the Internet."
3228 </para></footnote>
3229 &mdash; then <emphasis>every</emphasis> industry affected by copyright
3230 today is the product and beneficiary of a certain kind of
3231 piracy. Film, records, radio, cable TV. . . . The list is long and
3232 could well be expanded. Every generation welcomes the pirates from the
3233 last. Every generation&mdash;until now.
3234 </para>
3235 <!-- PAGE BREAK 75 -->
3236 </section>
3237 </chapter>
3238 <chapter id="piracy">
3239 <title>CHAPTER FIVE: "Piracy"</title>
3240 <para>
3241 There is piracy of copyrighted material. Lots of it. This piracy comes
3242 in many forms. The most significant is commercial piracy, the
3243 unauthorized taking of other people's content within a commercial
3244 context. Despite the many justifications that are offered in its
3245 defense, this taking is wrong. No one should condone it, and the law
3246 should stop it.
3247 </para>
3248 <para>
3249 But as well as copy-shop piracy, there is another kind of "taking"
3250 that is more directly related to the Internet. That taking, too, seems
3251 wrong to many, and it is wrong much of the time. Before we paint this
3252 taking "piracy," however, we should understand its nature a bit more.
3253 For the harm of this taking is significantly more ambiguous than
3254 outright copying, and the law should account for that ambiguity, as it
3255 has so often done in the past.
3256 <!-- PAGE BREAK 76 -->
3257 </para>
3258 <section id="piracy-i">
3259 <title>Piracy I</title>
3260 <para>
3261 All across the world, but especially in Asia and Eastern Europe, there
3262 are businesses that do nothing but take others people's copyrighted
3263 content, copy it, and sell it&mdash;all without the permission of a copyright
3264 owner. The recording industry estimates that it loses about $4.6 billion
3265 every year to physical piracy<footnote><para>
3266 <!-- f1 -->
3267 See IFPI (International Federation of the Phonographic Industry), <citetitle>The
3268 Recording Industry Commercial Piracy Report 2003</citetitle>, July 2003, available
3269 at <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #14</ulink>. See
3270 also Ben Hunt, "Companies Warned on Music Piracy Risk," <citetitle>Financial
3271 Times</citetitle>, 14 February 2003, 11.
3272 </para></footnote>
3273 (that works out to one in three CDs sold worldwide). The MPAA
3274 estimates that it loses $3 billion annually worldwide to piracy.
3275 </para>
3276 <para>
3277 This is piracy plain and simple. Nothing in the argument of this
3278 book, nor in the argument that most people make when talking about
3279 the subject of this book, should draw into doubt this simple point:
3280 This piracy is wrong.
3281 </para>
3282 <para>
3283 Which is not to say that excuses and justifications couldn't be made
3284 for it. We could, for example, remind ourselves that for the first one
3285 hundred years of the American Republic, America did not honor foreign
3286 copyrights. We were born, in this sense, a pirate nation. It might
3287 therefore seem hypocritical for us to insist so strongly that other
3288 developing nations treat as wrong what we, for the first hundred years
3289 of our existence, treated as right.
3290 </para>
3291 <para>
3292 That excuse isn't terribly strong. Technically, our law did not ban
3293 the taking of foreign works. It explicitly limited itself to American
3294 works. Thus the American publishers who published foreign works
3295 without the permission of foreign authors were not violating any rule.
3296 The copy shops in Asia, by contrast, are violating Asian law. Asian
3297 law does protect foreign copyrights, and the actions of the copy shops
3298 violate that law. So the wrong of piracy that they engage in is not
3299 just a moral wrong, but a legal wrong, and not just an internationally
3300 legal wrong, but a locally legal wrong as well.
3301 </para>
3302 <para>
3303 True, these local rules have, in effect, been imposed upon these
3304 countries. No country can be part of the world economy and choose
3305 <!-- PAGE BREAK 77 -->
3306 not to protect copyright internationally. We may have been born a
3307 pirate nation, but we will not allow any other nation to have a
3308 similar childhood.
3309 </para>
3310 <para>
3311 If a country is to be treated as a sovereign, however, then its laws are
3312 its laws regardless of their source. The international law under which
3313 these nations live gives them some opportunities to escape the burden
3314 of intellectual property law.<footnote><para>
3315 <!-- f2 -->
3316 See Peter Drahos with John Braithwaite, Information Feudalism: <citetitle>Who
3317 Owns the Knowledge Economy?</citetitle> (New York: The New Press, 2003), 10&ndash;13,
3318 209. The Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights
3319 (TRIPS) agreement obligates member nations to create administrative
3320 and enforcement mechanisms for intellectual property rights, a costly
3321 proposition for developing countries. Additionally, patent rights may
3322 lead to higher prices for staple industries such as
3323 agriculture. Critics of TRIPS question the disparity between burdens
3324 imposed upon developing countries and benefits conferred to
3325 industrialized nations. TRIPS does permit governments to use patents
3326 for public, noncommercial uses without first obtaining the patent
3327 holder's permission. Developing nations may be able to use this to
3328 gain the benefits of foreign patents at lower prices. This is a
3329 promising strategy for developing nations within the TRIPS framework.
3330 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter</primary></indexterm>
3331 </para></footnote> In my view, more developing nations should take
3332 advantage of that opportunity, but when they don't, then their laws
3333 should be respected. And under the laws of these nations, this piracy
3334 is wrong.
3335 </para>
3336 <para>
3337 Alternatively, we could try to excuse this piracy by noting that in
3338 any case, it does no harm to the industry. The Chinese who get access
3339 to American CDs at 50 cents a copy are not people who would have
3340 bought those American CDs at $15 a copy. So no one really has any
3341 less money than they otherwise would have had.<footnote><para>
3342 <!-- f3 -->
3343 For an analysis of the economic impact of copying technology, see Stan
3344 Liebowitz, <citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy</citetitle> (New York: Amacom, 2002),
3345 144&ndash;90. "In some instances . . . the impact of piracy on the
3346 copyright holder's ability to appropriate the value of the work will
3347 be negligible. One obvious instance is the case where the individual
3348 engaging in pirating would not have purchased an original even if
3349 pirating were not an option." Ibid., 149.
3350 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan</primary></indexterm>
3351 </para></footnote>
3352 </para>
3353 <para>
3354 This is often true (though I have friends who have purchased many
3355 thousands of pirated DVDs who certainly have enough money to pay
3356 for the content they have taken), and it does mitigate to some degree
3357 the harm caused by such taking. Extremists in this debate love to say,
3358 "You wouldn't go into Barnes &amp; Noble and take a book off of the shelf
3359 without paying; why should it be any different with on-line music?"
3360 The difference is, of course, that when you take a book from Barnes &amp;
3361 Noble, it has one less book to sell. By contrast, when you take an MP3
3362 from a computer network, there is not one less CD that can be sold.
3363 The physics of piracy of the intangible are different from the physics of
3364 piracy of the tangible.
3365 </para>
3366 <para>
3367 This argument is still very weak. However, although copyright is a
3368 property right of a very special sort, it <emphasis>is</emphasis> a
3369 property right. Like all property rights, the copyright gives the
3370 owner the right to decide the terms under which content is shared. If
3371 the copyright owner doesn't want to sell, she doesn't have to. There
3372 are exceptions: important statutory licenses that apply to copyrighted
3373 content regardless of the wish of the copyright owner. Those licenses
3374 give people the right to "take" copyrighted content whether or not the
3375 copyright owner wants to sell. But
3376
3377 <!-- PAGE BREAK 78 -->
3378 where the law does not give people the right to take content, it is
3379 wrong to take that content even if the wrong does no harm. If we have
3380 a property system, and that system is properly balanced to the
3381 technology of a time, then it is wrong to take property without the
3382 permission of a property owner. That is exactly what "property" means.
3383 </para>
3384 <para>
3385 Finally, we could try to excuse this piracy with the argument that the
3386 piracy actually helps the copyright owner. When the Chinese "steal"
3387 Windows, that makes the Chinese dependent on Microsoft. Microsoft
3388 loses the value of the software that was taken. But it gains users who
3389 are used to life in the Microsoft world. Over time, as the nation
3390 grows more wealthy, more and more people will buy software rather than
3391 steal it. And hence over time, because that buying will benefit
3392 Microsoft, Microsoft benefits from the piracy. If instead of pirating
3393 Microsoft Windows, the Chinese used the free GNU/Linux operating
3394 system, then these Chinese users would not eventually be buying
3395 Microsoft. Without piracy, then, Microsoft would lose.
3396 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system</primary></indexterm>
3397 <indexterm>
3398 <primary>Microsoft</primary>
3399 <secondary>Windows operating system of</secondary>
3400 </indexterm>
3401 <indexterm><primary>Windows</primary></indexterm>
3402 </para>
3403 <para>
3404 This argument, too, is somewhat true. The addiction strategy is a good
3405 one. Many businesses practice it. Some thrive because of it. Law
3406 students, for example, are given free access to the two largest legal
3407 databases. The companies marketing both hope the students will become
3408 so used to their service that they will want to use it and not the
3409 other when they become lawyers (and must pay high subscription fees).
3410 </para>
3411 <para>
3412 Still, the argument is not terribly persuasive. We don't give the
3413 alcoholic a defense when he steals his first beer, merely because that
3414 will make it more likely that he will buy the next three. Instead, we
3415 ordinarily allow businesses to decide for themselves when it is best
3416 to give their product away. If Microsoft fears the competition of
3417 GNU/Linux, then Microsoft can give its product away, as it did, for
3418 example, with Internet Explorer to fight Netscape. A property right
3419 means giving the property owner the right to say who gets access to
3420 what&mdash;at least ordinarily. And if the law properly balances the
3421 rights of the copyright owner with the rights of access, then
3422 violating the law is still wrong.
3423 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system</primary></indexterm>
3424 </para>
3425 <para>
3426 <!-- PAGE BREAK 79 -->
3427 Thus, while I understand the pull of these justifications for piracy,
3428 and I certainly see the motivation, in my view, in the end, these efforts
3429 at justifying commercial piracy simply don't cut it. This kind of piracy
3430 is rampant and just plain wrong. It doesn't transform the content it
3431 steals; it doesn't transform the market it competes in. It merely gives
3432 someone access to something that the law says he should not have.
3433 Nothing has changed to draw that law into doubt. This form of piracy
3434 is flat out wrong.
3435 </para>
3436 <para>
3437 But as the examples from the four chapters that introduced this part
3438 suggest, even if some piracy is plainly wrong, not all "piracy" is. Or
3439 at least, not all "piracy" is wrong if that term is understood in the
3440 way it is increasingly used today. Many kinds of "piracy" are useful
3441 and productive, to produce either new content or new ways of doing
3442 business. Neither our tradition nor any tradition has ever banned all
3443 "piracy" in that sense of the term.
3444 </para>
3445 <para>
3446 This doesn't mean that there are no questions raised by the latest
3447 piracy concern, peer-to-peer file sharing. But it does mean that we
3448 need to understand the harm in peer-to-peer sharing a bit more before
3449 we condemn it to the gallows with the charge of piracy.
3450 </para>
3451 <para>
3452 For (1) like the original Hollywood, p2p sharing escapes an overly
3453 controlling industry; and (2) like the original recording industry, it
3454 simply exploits a new way to distribute content; but (3) unlike cable
3455 TV, no one is selling the content that is shared on p2p services.
3456 </para>
3457 <para>
3458 These differences distinguish p2p sharing from true piracy. They
3459 should push us to find a way to protect artists while enabling this
3460 sharing to survive.
3461 </para>
3462 </section>
3463 <section id="piracy-ii">
3464 <title>Piracy II</title>
3465 <para>
3466 The key to the "piracy" that the law aims to quash is a use that "rob[s]
3467 the author of [his] profit."<footnote><para>
3468 <!-- f4 -->
3469 <citetitle>Bach</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Longman</citetitle>, 98 Eng. Rep. 1274 (1777).
3470 </para></footnote>
3471 This means we must determine whether
3472 and how much p2p sharing harms before we know how strongly the
3473 <!-- PAGE BREAK 80 -->
3474 law should seek to either prevent it or find an alternative to assure the
3475 author of his profit.
3476 </para>
3477 <para>
3478 Peer-to-peer sharing was made famous by Napster. But the inventors of
3479 the Napster technology had not made any major technological
3480 innovations. Like every great advance in innovation on the Internet
3481 (and, arguably, off the Internet as well<footnote><para>
3482 <!-- f5 -->
3483 See Clayton M. Christensen, <citetitle>The Innovator's Dilemma: The Revolutionary
3484 National Bestseller That Changed the Way We Do Business</citetitle> (New York:
3485 HarperBusiness, 2000). Professor Christensen examines why companies
3486 that give rise to and dominate a product area are frequently unable to
3487 come up with the most creative, paradigm-shifting uses for their own
3488 products. This job usually falls to outside innovators, who
3489 reassemble existing technology in inventive ways. For a discussion of
3490 Christensen's ideas, see Lawrence Lessig, <citetitle>Future</citetitle>, 89&ndash;92, 139.
3491
3492 <indexterm><primary>Christensen, Clayton M.</primary></indexterm>
3493 </para></footnote>), Shawn Fanning and crew had simply
3494 put together components that had been developed independently.
3495 <indexterm><primary>Fanning, Shawn</primary></indexterm>
3496 </para>
3497 <para>
3498 The result was spontaneous combustion. Launched in July 1999,
3499 Napster amassed over 10 million users within nine months. After
3500 eighteen months, there were close to 80 million registered users of the
3501 system.<footnote><para>
3502 <!-- f6 -->
3503 See Carolyn Lochhead, "Silicon Valley Dream, Hollywood Nightmare," <citetitle>San
3504 Francisco Chronicle</citetitle>, 24 September 2002, A1; "Rock 'n' Roll Suicide,"
3505 <citetitle>New Scientist</citetitle>, 6 July 2002, 42; Benny Evangelista, "Napster Names CEO,
3506 Secures New Financing," <citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle</citetitle>, 23 May 2003, C1;
3507 "Napster's Wake-Up Call," <citetitle>Economist</citetitle>, 24 June 2000, 23; John Naughton,
3508 "Hollywood at War with the Internet" (London) <citetitle>Times</citetitle>, 26 July 2002, 18.
3509 </para></footnote>
3510 Courts quickly shut Napster down, but other services emerged
3511 to take its place. (Kazaa is currently the most popular p2p service. It
3512 boasts over 100 million members.) These services' systems are different
3513 architecturally, though not very different in function: Each enables
3514 users to make content available to any number of other users. With a
3515 p2p system, you can share your favorite songs with your best friend&mdash;
3516 or your 20,000 best friends.
3517 </para>
3518 <para>
3519 According to a number of estimates, a huge proportion of Americans
3520 have tasted file-sharing technology. A study by Ipsos-Insight in
3521 September 2002 estimated that 60 million Americans had downloaded
3522 music&mdash;28 percent of Americans older than 12.<footnote><para>
3523
3524 <!-- f7 -->
3525 See Ipsos-Insight, <citetitle>TEMPO: Keeping Pace with Online Music Distribution</citetitle>
3526 (September 2002), reporting that 28 percent of Americans aged twelve
3527 and older have downloaded music off of the Internet and 30 percent have
3528 listened to digital music files stored on their computers.
3529 </para></footnote>
3530 A survey by the NPD group quoted in <citetitle>The New York Times</citetitle>
3531 estimated that 43 million citizens used file-sharing networks to
3532 exchange content in May 2003.<footnote><para>
3533 <!-- f8 -->
3534 Amy Harmon, "Industry Offers a Carrot in Online Music Fight," <citetitle>New
3535 York Times</citetitle>, 6 June 2003, A1.
3536 </para></footnote>
3537 The vast majority of these are not kids. Whatever the actual figure, a
3538 massive quantity of content is being "taken" on these networks. The
3539 ease and inexpensiveness of file-sharing networks have inspired
3540 millions to enjoy music in a way that they hadn't before.
3541 </para>
3542 <para>
3543 Some of this enjoying involves copyright infringement. Some of it does
3544 not. And even among the part that is technically copyright
3545 infringement, calculating the actual harm to copyright owners is more
3546 complicated than one might think. So consider&mdash;a bit more
3547 carefully than the polarized voices around this debate usually
3548 do&mdash;the kinds of sharing that file sharing enables, and the kinds
3549 of harm it entails.
3550 </para>
3551 <para>
3552 <!-- PAGE BREAK 81 -->
3553 File sharers share different kinds of content. We can divide these
3554 different kinds into four types.
3555 </para>
3556 <orderedlist numeration="upperalpha">
3557 <listitem><para>
3558 <!-- A. -->
3559 There are some who use sharing networks as substitutes for purchasing
3560 content. Thus, when a new Madonna CD is released, rather than buying
3561 the CD, these users simply take it. We might quibble about whether
3562 everyone who takes it would actually have bought it if sharing didn't
3563 make it available for free. Most probably wouldn't have, but clearly
3564 there are some who would. The latter are the target of category A:
3565 users who download instead of purchasing.
3566 <indexterm><primary>Madonna</primary></indexterm>
3567 </para></listitem>
3568 <listitem><para>
3569 <!-- B. -->
3570 There are some who use sharing networks to sample music before
3571 purchasing it. Thus, a friend sends another friend an MP3 of an artist
3572 he's not heard of. The other friend then buys CDs by that artist. This
3573 is a kind of targeted advertising, quite likely to succeed. If the
3574 friend recommending the album gains nothing from a bad recommendation,
3575 then one could expect that the recommendations will actually be quite
3576 good. The net effect of this sharing could increase the quantity of
3577 music purchased.
3578 </para></listitem>
3579 <listitem><para>
3580 <!-- C. -->
3581 There are many who use sharing networks to get access to copyrighted
3582 content that is no longer sold or that they would not have purchased
3583 because the transaction costs off the Net are too high. This use of
3584 sharing networks is among the most rewarding for many. Songs that were
3585 part of your childhood but have long vanished from the marketplace
3586 magically appear again on the network. (One friend told me that when
3587 she discovered Napster, she spent a solid weekend "recalling" old
3588 songs. She was astonished at the range and mix of content that was
3589 available.) For content not sold, this is still technically a
3590 violation of copyright, though because the copyright owner is not
3591 selling the content anymore, the economic harm is zero&mdash;the same
3592 harm that occurs when I sell my collection of 1960s 45-rpm records to
3593 a local collector.
3594 </para></listitem>
3595 <listitem><para>
3596 <!-- PAGE BREAK 82 -->
3597 <!-- D. -->
3598 Finally, there are many who use sharing networks to get access
3599 to content that is not copyrighted or that the copyright owner
3600 wants to give away.
3601 </para></listitem>
3602 </orderedlist>
3603 <para>
3604 How do these different types of sharing balance out?
3605 </para>
3606 <para>
3607 Let's start with some simple but important points. From the
3608 perspective of the law, only type D sharing is clearly legal. From the
3609 perspective of economics, only type A sharing is clearly
3610 harmful.<footnote><para>
3611 <!-- f9 -->
3612 See Liebowitz, <citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy</citetitle>, 148&ndash;49.
3613 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan</primary></indexterm>
3614 </para></footnote>
3615 Type B sharing is illegal but plainly beneficial. Type C sharing is
3616 illegal, yet good for society (since more exposure to music is good)
3617 and harmless to the artist (since the work is not otherwise
3618 available). So how sharing matters on balance is a hard question to
3619 answer&mdash;and certainly much more difficult than the current
3620 rhetoric around the issue suggests.
3621 </para>
3622 <para>
3623 Whether on balance sharing is harmful depends importantly on how
3624 harmful type A sharing is. Just as Edison complained about Hollywood,
3625 composers complained about piano rolls, recording artists complained
3626 about radio, and broadcasters complained about cable TV, the music
3627 industry complains that type A sharing is a kind of "theft" that is
3628 "devastating" the industry.
3629 </para>
3630 <para>
3631 While the numbers do suggest that sharing is harmful, how
3632 harmful is harder to reckon. It has long been the recording industry's
3633 practice to blame technology for any drop in sales. The history of
3634 cassette recording is a good example. As a study by Cap Gemini Ernst
3635 &amp; Young put it, "Rather than exploiting this new, popular
3636 technology, the labels fought it."<footnote><para>
3637 <!-- f10 -->
3638 See Cap Gemini Ernst &amp; Young, <citetitle>Technology Evolution and the
3639 Music Industry's Business Model Crisis</citetitle> (2003), 3. This report
3640 describes the music industry's effort to stigmatize the budding
3641 practice of cassette taping in the 1970s, including an advertising
3642 campaign featuring a cassette-shape skull and the caption "Home taping
3643 is killing music." At the time digital audio tape became a threat,
3644 the Office of Technical Assessment conducted a survey of consumer
3645 behavior. In 1988, 40 percent of consumers older than ten had taped
3646 music to a cassette format. U.S. Congress, Office of Technology
3647 Assessment, <citetitle>Copyright and Home Copying: Technology Challenges the Law</citetitle>,
3648 OTA-CIT-422 (Washington, D.C.: U.S. Government Printing Office,
3649 October 1989), 145&ndash;56. </para></footnote>
3650 The labels claimed that every album taped was an album unsold, and
3651 when record sales fell by 11.4 percent in 1981, the industry claimed
3652 that its point was proved. Technology was the problem, and banning or
3653 regulating technology was the answer.
3654 </para>
3655 <para>
3656 Yet soon thereafter, and before Congress was given an opportunity
3657 to enact regulation, MTV was launched, and the industry had a record
3658 turnaround. "In the end," Cap Gemini concludes, "the `crisis' . . . was
3659 not the fault of the tapers&mdash;who did not [stop after MTV came into
3660 <!-- PAGE BREAK 83 -->
3661 being]&mdash;but had to a large extent resulted from stagnation in musical
3662 innovation at the major labels."<footnote><para>
3663 <!-- f11 -->
3664 U.S. Congress, <citetitle>Copyright and Home Copying</citetitle>, 4.
3665 </para></footnote>
3666 </para>
3667 <para>
3668 But just because the industry was wrong before does not mean it is
3669 wrong today. To evaluate the real threat that p2p sharing presents to
3670 the industry in particular, and society in general&mdash;or at least
3671 the society that inherits the tradition that gave us the film
3672 industry, the record industry, the radio industry, cable TV, and the
3673 VCR&mdash;the question is not simply whether type A sharing is
3674 harmful. The question is also <emphasis>how</emphasis> harmful type A
3675 sharing is, and how beneficial the other types of sharing are.
3676 </para>
3677 <para>
3678 We start to answer this question by focusing on the net harm, from the
3679 standpoint of the industry as a whole, that sharing networks cause.
3680 The "net harm" to the industry as a whole is the amount by which type
3681 A sharing exceeds type B. If the record companies sold more records
3682 through sampling than they lost through substitution, then sharing
3683 networks would actually benefit music companies on balance. They would
3684 therefore have little <emphasis>static</emphasis> reason to resist
3685 them.
3686
3687 </para>
3688 <para>
3689 Could that be true? Could the industry as a whole be gaining because
3690 of file sharing? Odd as that might sound, the data about CD sales
3691 actually suggest it might be close.
3692 </para>
3693 <para>
3694 In 2002, the RIAA reported that CD sales had fallen by 8.9 percent,
3695 from 882 million to 803 million units; revenues fell 6.7
3696 percent.<footnote><para>
3697 <!-- f12 -->
3698 See Recording Industry Association of America, <citetitle>2002 Yearend Statistics</citetitle>,
3699 available at
3700 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #15</ulink>. A later
3701 report indicates even greater losses. See Recording Industry
3702 Association of America, <citetitle>Some Facts About Music Piracy</citetitle>, 25 June 2003,
3703 available at <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
3704 #16</ulink>: "In the past four years, unit shipments of recorded music
3705 have fallen by 26 percent from 1.16 billion units in to 860 million
3706 units in 2002 in the United States (based on units shipped). In terms
3707 of sales, revenues are down 14 percent, from $14.6 billion in to $12.6
3708 billion last year (based on U.S. dollar value of shipments). The music
3709 industry worldwide has gone from a $39 billion industry in 2000 down
3710 to a $32 billion industry in 2002 (based on U.S. dollar value of
3711 shipments)."
3712 </para></footnote>
3713 This confirms a trend over the past few years. The RIAA blames
3714 Internet piracy for the trend, though there are many other causes that
3715 could account for this drop. SoundScan, for example, reports a more
3716 than 20 percent drop in the number of CDs released since 1999. That no
3717 doubt accounts for some of the decrease in sales. Rising prices could
3718 account for at least some of the loss. "From 1999 to 2001, the average
3719 price of a CD rose 7.2 percent, from $13.04 to $14.19."<footnote>
3720 <!-- f13 -->
3721 <para>
3722 Jane Black, "Big Music's Broken Record," BusinessWeek online, 13
3723 February 2003, available at
3724 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #17</ulink>.
3725 <indexterm><primary>Black, Jane</primary></indexterm>
3726 </para>
3727 </footnote>
3728 Competition from other forms of media could also account for some of
3729 the decline. As Jane Black of <citetitle>BusinessWeek</citetitle> notes, "The
3730 soundtrack to the film <citetitle>High Fidelity</citetitle> has a list price of
3731 $18.98. You could get the whole movie [on DVD] for
3732 $19.99."<footnote><para>
3733 <!-- f14 -->
3734 Ibid.
3735 </para></footnote>
3736 </para>
3737 <para>
3738
3739 <!-- PAGE BREAK 84 -->
3740 But let's assume the RIAA is right, and all of the decline in CD sales
3741 is because of Internet sharing. Here's the rub: In the same period
3742 that the RIAA estimates that 803 million CDs were sold, the RIAA
3743 estimates that 2.1 billion CDs were downloaded for free. Thus,
3744 although 2.6 times the total number of CDs sold were downloaded for
3745 free, sales revenue fell by just 6.7 percent.
3746 </para>
3747 <para>
3748 There are too many different things happening at the same time to
3749 explain these numbers definitively, but one conclusion is unavoidable:
3750 The recording industry constantly asks, "What's the difference between
3751 downloading a song and stealing a CD?"&mdash;but their own numbers
3752 reveal the difference. If I steal a CD, then there is one less CD to
3753 sell. Every taking is a lost sale. But on the basis of the numbers the
3754 RIAA provides, it is absolutely clear that the same is not true of
3755 downloads. If every download were a lost sale&mdash;if every use of
3756 Kazaa "rob[bed] the author of [his] profit"&mdash;then the industry
3757 would have suffered a 100 percent drop in sales last year, not a 7
3758 percent drop. If 2.6 times the number of CDs sold were downloaded for
3759 free, and yet sales revenue dropped by just 6.7 percent, then there is
3760 a huge difference between "downloading a song and stealing a CD."
3761 </para>
3762 <para>
3763 These are the harms&mdash;alleged and perhaps exaggerated but, let's
3764 assume, real. What of the benefits? File sharing may impose costs on
3765 the recording industry. What value does it produce in addition to
3766 these costs?
3767 </para>
3768 <para>
3769 One benefit is type C sharing&mdash;making available content that
3770 is technically still under copyright but is no longer commercially
3771 available. This is not a small category of content. There are
3772 millions of tracks that are no longer commercially
3773 available.<footnote><para>
3774 <!-- f15 -->
3775 By one estimate, 75 percent of the music released by the major labels
3776 is no longer in print. See Online Entertainment and Copyright
3777 Law&mdash;Coming Soon to a Digital Device Near You: Hearing Before the
3778 Senate Committee on the Judiciary, 107th Cong., 1st sess. (3 April
3779 2001) (prepared statement of the Future of Music Coalition), available
3780 at <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #18</ulink>.
3781 </para></footnote>
3782 And while it's conceivable that some of this content is not available
3783 because the artist producing the content doesn't want it to be made
3784 available, the vast majority of it is unavailable solely because the
3785 publisher or the distributor has decided it no longer makes economic
3786 sense <emphasis>to the company</emphasis> to make it available.
3787 </para>
3788 <para>
3789 In real space&mdash;long before the Internet&mdash;the market had a simple
3790 <!-- PAGE BREAK 85 -->
3791 response to this problem: used book and record stores. There are
3792 thousands of used book and used record stores in America
3793 today.<footnote><para>
3794 <!-- f16 -->
3795 While there are not good estimates of the number of used record stores in
3796 existence, in 2002, there were 7,198 used book dealers in the United States,
3797 an increase of 20 percent since 1993. See Book Hunter Press, <citetitle>The Quiet
3798 Revolution: The Expansion of the Used Book Market</citetitle> (2002), available at
3799 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #19</ulink>. Used records accounted for $260 million in sales in 2002. See
3800 National
3801 Association of Recording Merchandisers, "2002 Annual Survey
3802 Results,"
3803 available at
3804 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #20</ulink>.
3805 </para></footnote>
3806 These stores buy content from owners, then sell the content they
3807 buy. And under American copyright law, when they buy and sell this
3808 content, <emphasis>even if the content is still under
3809 copyright</emphasis>, the copyright owner doesn't get a dime. Used
3810 book and record stores are commercial entities; their owners make
3811 money from the content they sell; but as with cable companies before
3812 statutory licensing, they don't have to pay the copyright owner for
3813 the content they sell.
3814 </para>
3815 <indexterm><primary>Bernstein, Leonard</primary></indexterm>
3816 <para>
3817 Type C sharing, then, is very much like used book stores or used
3818 record stores. It is different, of course, because the person making
3819 the content available isn't making money from making the content
3820 available. It is also different, of course, because in real space,
3821 when I sell a record, I don't have it anymore, while in cyberspace,
3822 when someone shares my 1949 recording of Bernstein's "Two Love Songs,"
3823 I still have it. That difference would matter economically if the
3824 owner of the copyright were selling the record in competition to my
3825 sharing. But we're talking about the class of content that is not
3826 currently commercially available. The Internet is making it available,
3827 through cooperative sharing, without competing with the market.
3828 </para>
3829 <para>
3830 It may well be, all things considered, that it would be better if the
3831 copyright owner got something from this trade. But just because it may
3832 well be better, it doesn't follow that it would be good to ban used book
3833 stores. Or put differently, if you think that type C sharing should be
3834 stopped, do you think that libraries and used book stores should be
3835 shut as well?
3836 </para>
3837 <para>
3838 Finally, and perhaps most importantly, file-sharing networks enable
3839 type D sharing to occur&mdash;the sharing of content that copyright owners
3840 want to have shared or for which there is no continuing copyright. This
3841 sharing clearly benefits authors and society. Science fiction author
3842 Cory Doctorow, for example, released his first novel, <citetitle>Down and Out in
3843 the Magic Kingdom</citetitle>, both free on-line and in bookstores on the same
3844
3845 <!-- PAGE BREAK 86 -->
3846 day. His (and his publisher's) thinking was that the on-line distribution
3847 would be a great advertisement for the "real" book. People would read
3848 part on-line, and then decide whether they liked the book or not. If
3849 they liked it, they would be more likely to buy it. Doctorow's content is
3850 type D content. If sharing networks enable his work to be spread, then
3851 both he and society are better off. (Actually, much better off: It is a
3852 great book!)
3853 </para>
3854 <para>
3855 Likewise for work in the public domain: This sharing benefits society
3856 with no legal harm to authors at all. If efforts to solve the problem
3857 of type A sharing destroy the opportunity for type D sharing, then we
3858 lose something important in order to protect type A content.
3859 </para>
3860 <para>
3861 The point throughout is this: While the recording industry
3862 understandably says, "This is how much we've lost," we must also ask,
3863 "How much has society gained from p2p sharing? What are the
3864 efficiencies? What is the content that otherwise would be
3865 unavailable?"
3866 </para>
3867 <para>
3868 For unlike the piracy I described in the first section of this
3869 chapter, much of the "piracy" that file sharing enables is plainly
3870 legal and good. And like the piracy I described in chapter 4, much of
3871 this piracy is motivated by a new way of spreading content caused by
3872 changes in the technology of distribution. Thus, consistent with the
3873 tradition that gave us Hollywood, radio, the recording industry, and
3874 cable TV, the question we should be asking about file sharing is how
3875 best to preserve its benefits while minimizing (to the extent
3876 possible) the wrongful harm it causes artists. The question is one of
3877 balance. The law should seek that balance, and that balance will be
3878 found only with time.
3879 </para>
3880 <para>
3881 "But isn't the war just a war against illegal sharing? Isn't the target
3882 just what you call type A sharing?"
3883 </para>
3884 <para>
3885 You would think. And we should hope. But so far, it is not. The
3886 effect
3887 of the war purportedly on type A sharing alone has been felt far
3888 beyond that one class of sharing. That much is obvious from the
3889 Napster
3890 case itself. When Napster told the district court that it had
3891 developed
3892 a technology to block the transfer of 99.4 percent of identified
3893 <!-- PAGE BREAK 87 -->
3894 infringing material, the district court told counsel for Napster 99.4
3895 percent was not good enough. Napster had to push the infringements
3896 "down to zero."<footnote><para>
3897 <!-- f17 -->
3898 See Transcript of Proceedings, In Re: Napster Copyright Litigation at 34-
3899 35 (N.D. Cal., 11 July 2001), nos. MDL-00-1369 MHP, C 99-5183
3900 MHP, available at
3901
3902 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #21</ulink>. For an
3903 account of the litigation and its toll on Napster, see Joseph Menn,
3904 <citetitle>All the Rave: The Rise and Fall of Shawn Fanning's Napster</citetitle> (New
3905 York: Crown Business, 2003), 269&ndash;82.
3906 </para></footnote>
3907 </para>
3908 <para>
3909 If 99.4 percent is not good enough, then this is a war on file-sharing
3910 technologies, not a war on copyright infringement. There is no way to
3911 assure that a p2p system is used 100 percent of the time in compliance
3912 with the law, any more than there is a way to assure that 100 percent of
3913 VCRs or 100 percent of Xerox machines or 100 percent of handguns
3914 are used in compliance with the law. Zero tolerance means zero p2p.
3915 The court's ruling means that we as a society must lose the benefits of
3916 p2p, even for the totally legal and beneficial uses they serve, simply to
3917 assure that there are zero copyright infringements caused by p2p.
3918 </para>
3919 <para>
3920 Zero tolerance has not been our history. It has not produced the
3921 content industry that we know today. The history of American law has
3922 been a process of balance. As new technologies changed the way content
3923 was distributed, the law adjusted, after some time, to the new
3924 technology. In this adjustment, the law sought to ensure the
3925 legitimate rights of creators while protecting innovation. Sometimes
3926 this has meant more rights for creators. Sometimes less.
3927 </para>
3928 <para>
3929 So, as we've seen, when "mechanical reproduction" threatened the
3930 interests of composers, Congress balanced the rights of composers
3931 against the interests of the recording industry. It granted rights to
3932 composers, but also to the recording artists: Composers were to be
3933 paid, but at a price set by Congress. But when radio started
3934 broadcasting the recordings made by these recording artists, and they
3935 complained to Congress that their "creative property" was not being
3936 respected (since the radio station did not have to pay them for the
3937 creativity it broadcast), Congress rejected their claim. An indirect
3938 benefit was enough.
3939 </para>
3940 <para>
3941 Cable TV followed the pattern of record albums. When the courts
3942 rejected the claim that cable broadcasters had to pay for the content
3943 they rebroadcast, Congress responded by giving broadcasters a right to
3944 compensation, but at a level set by the law. It likewise gave cable
3945 companies the right to the content, so long as they paid the statutory
3946 price.
3947 </para>
3948 <para>
3949
3950 <!-- PAGE BREAK 88 -->
3951 This compromise, like the compromise affecting records and player
3952 pianos, served two important goals&mdash;indeed, the two central goals
3953 of any copyright legislation. First, the law assured that new
3954 innovators would have the freedom to develop new ways to deliver
3955 content. Second, the law assured that copyright holders would be paid
3956 for the content that was distributed. One fear was that if Congress
3957 simply required cable TV to pay copyright holders whatever they
3958 demanded for their content, then copyright holders associated with
3959 broadcasters would use their power to stifle this new technology,
3960 cable. But if Congress had permitted cable to use broadcasters'
3961 content for free, then it would have unfairly subsidized cable. Thus
3962 Congress chose a path that would assure
3963 <emphasis>compensation</emphasis> without giving the past
3964 (broadcasters) control over the future (cable).
3965 </para>
3966 <indexterm><primary>Betamax</primary></indexterm>
3967 <para>
3968 In the same year that Congress struck this balance, two major
3969 producers and distributors of film content filed a lawsuit against
3970 another technology, the video tape recorder (VTR, or as we refer to
3971 them today, VCRs) that Sony had produced, the Betamax. Disney's and
3972 Universal's claim against Sony was relatively simple: Sony produced a
3973 device, Disney and Universal claimed, that enabled consumers to engage
3974 in copyright infringement. Because the device that Sony built had a
3975 "record" button, the device could be used to record copyrighted movies
3976 and shows. Sony was therefore benefiting from the copyright
3977 infringement of its customers. It should therefore, Disney and
3978 Universal claimed, be partially liable for that infringement.
3979 </para>
3980 <para>
3981 There was something to Disney's and Universal's claim. Sony did
3982 decide to design its machine to make it very simple to record television
3983 shows. It could have built the machine to block or inhibit any direct
3984 copying from a television broadcast. Or possibly, it could have built the
3985 machine to copy only if there were a special "copy me" signal on the
3986 line. It was clear that there were many television shows that did not
3987 grant anyone permission to copy. Indeed, if anyone had asked, no
3988 doubt the majority of shows would not have authorized copying. And
3989 <!-- PAGE BREAK 89 -->
3990 in the face of this obvious preference, Sony could have designed its
3991 system to minimize the opportunity for copyright infringement. It did
3992 not, and for that, Disney and Universal wanted to hold it responsible
3993 for the architecture it chose.
3994 </para>
3995 <para>
3996 MPAA president Jack Valenti became the studios' most vocal
3997 champion. Valenti called VCRs "tapeworms." He warned, "When there are
3998 20, 30, 40 million of these VCRs in the land, we will be invaded by
3999 millions of `tapeworms,' eating away at the very heart and essence of
4000 the most precious asset the copyright owner has, his
4001 copyright."<footnote><para>
4002 <!-- f18 -->
4003 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders): Hearing on
4004 S. 1758 Before the Senate Committee on the Judiciary, 97th Cong., 1st
4005 and 2nd sess., 459 (1982) (testimony of Jack Valenti, president, Motion
4006 Picture Association of America, Inc.).
4007 </para></footnote>
4008 "One does not have to be trained in sophisticated marketing and
4009 creative judgment," he told Congress, "to understand the devastation
4010 on the after-theater marketplace caused by the hundreds of millions of
4011 tapings that will adversely impact on the future of the creative
4012 community in this country. It is simply a question of basic economics
4013 and plain common sense."<footnote><para>
4014 <!-- f19 -->
4015 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders), 475.
4016 </para></footnote>
4017 Indeed, as surveys would later show,
4018 percent of VCR owners had movie libraries of ten videos or more<footnote><para>
4019 <!-- f20 -->
4020 <citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc</citetitle>. v. <citetitle>Sony Corp. of America</citetitle>, 480 F. Supp. 429,
4021 (C.D. Cal., 1979).
4022 </para></footnote>
4023 &mdash; a use the Court would later hold was not "fair." By
4024 "allowing VCR owners to copy freely by the means of an exemption from
4025 copyright infringementwithout creating a mechanism to compensate
4026 copyrightowners," Valenti testified, Congress would "take from the
4027 owners the very essence of their property: the exclusive right to
4028 control who may use their work, that is, who may copy it and thereby
4029 profit from its reproduction."<footnote><para>
4030 <!-- f21 -->
4031 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders), 485 (testimony
4032 of Jack Valenti).
4033 </para></footnote>
4034 </para>
4035 <para>
4036 It took eight years for this case to be resolved by the Supreme
4037 Court. In the interim, the Ninth Circuit Court of Appeals, which
4038 includes Hollywood in its jurisdiction&mdash;leading Judge Alex
4039 Kozinski, who sits on that court, refers to it as the "Hollywood
4040 Circuit"&mdash;held that Sony would be liable for the copyright
4041 infringement made possible by its machines. Under the Ninth Circuit's
4042 rule, this totally familiar technology&mdash;which Jack Valenti had
4043 called "the Boston Strangler of the American film industry" (worse
4044 yet, it was a <emphasis>Japanese</emphasis> Boston Strangler of the
4045 American film industry)&mdash;was an illegal
4046 technology.<footnote><para>
4047 <!-- f22 -->
4048 <citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc</citetitle>. v. <citetitle>Sony Corp. of America</citetitle>, 659 F. 2d 963 (9th Cir.
4049 1981).
4050 </para></footnote>
4051 </para>
4052 <para>
4053 But the Supreme Court reversed the decision of the Ninth Circuit.
4054
4055 <!-- PAGE BREAK 90 -->
4056 And in its reversal, the Court clearly articulated its understanding of
4057 when and whether courts should intervene in such disputes. As the
4058 Court wrote,
4059 </para>
4060 <blockquote>
4061 <para>
4062 Sound policy, as well as history, supports our consistent deference
4063 to Congress when major technological innovations alter the
4064 market
4065 for copyrighted materials. Congress has the constitutional
4066 authority
4067 and the institutional ability to accommodate fully the
4068 varied permutations of competing interests that are inevitably
4069 implicated
4070 by such new technology.<footnote><para>
4071 <!-- f23 -->
4072 <citetitle>Sony Corp. of America</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc</citetitle>., 464 U.S. 417, 431 (1984).
4073 </para></footnote>
4074 </para>
4075 </blockquote>
4076 <para>
4077 Congress was asked to respond to the Supreme Court's decision. But as
4078 with the plea of recording artists about radio broadcasts, Congress
4079 ignored the request. Congress was convinced that American film got
4080 enough, this "taking" notwithstanding. If we put these cases
4081 together, a pattern is clear:
4082 </para>
4083
4084 <table id="t1">
4085 <title>Table</title>
4086 <tgroup cols="4" align="char">
4087 <thead>
4088 <row>
4089 <entry>CASE</entry>
4090 <entry>WHOSE VALUE WAS "PIRATED"</entry>
4091 <entry>RESPONSE OF THE COURTS</entry>
4092 <entry>RESPONSE OF CONGRESS</entry>
4093 </row>
4094 </thead>
4095 <tbody>
4096 <row>
4097 <entry>Recordings</entry>
4098 <entry>Composers</entry>
4099 <entry>No protection</entry>
4100 <entry>Statutory license</entry>
4101 </row>
4102 <row>
4103 <entry>Radio</entry>
4104 <entry>Recording artists</entry>
4105 <entry>N/A</entry>
4106 <entry>Nothing</entry>
4107 </row>
4108 <row>
4109 <entry>Cable TV</entry>
4110 <entry>Broadcasters</entry>
4111 <entry>No protection</entry>
4112 <entry>Statutory license</entry>
4113 </row>
4114 <row>
4115 <entry>VCR</entry>
4116 <entry>Film creators</entry>
4117 <entry>No protection</entry>
4118 <entry>Nothing</entry>
4119 </row>
4120 </tbody>
4121 </tgroup>
4122 </table>
4123
4124 <para>
4125 In each case throughout our history, a new technology changed the
4126 way content was distributed.<footnote><para>
4127 <!-- f24 -->
4128 These are the most important instances in our history, but there are other
4129 cases as well. The technology of digital audio tape (DAT), for example,
4130 was regulated by Congress to minimize the risk of piracy. The remedy
4131 Congress imposed did burden DAT producers, by taxing tape sales and
4132 controlling the technology of DAT. See Audio Home Recording Act of
4133 1992 (Title 17 of the <citetitle>United States Code</citetitle>), Pub. L. No. 102-563, 106 Stat.
4134 4237, codified at 17 U.S.C. §1001. Again, however, this regulation did not
4135 eliminate the opportunity for free riding in the sense I've described. See
4136 Lessig, <citetitle>Future</citetitle>, 71. See also Picker, "From Edison to the Broadcast Flag,"
4137 <citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review</citetitle> 70 (2003): 293&ndash;96.
4138 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.</primary></indexterm>
4139 </para></footnote>
4140 In each case, throughout our history,
4141 that change meant that someone got a "free ride" on someone else's
4142 work.
4143 </para>
4144 <para>
4145 In <emphasis>none</emphasis> of these cases did either the courts or
4146 Congress eliminate all free riding. In <emphasis>none</emphasis> of
4147 these cases did the courts or Congress insist that the law should
4148 assure that the copyright holder get all the value that his copyright
4149 created. In every case, the copyright owners complained of "piracy."
4150 In every case, Congress acted to recognize some of the legitimacy in
4151 the behavior of the "pirates." In each case, Congress allowed some new
4152 technology to benefit from content made before. It balanced the
4153 interests at stake.
4154 <!-- PAGE BREAK 91 -->
4155 </para>
4156 <para>
4157 When you think across these examples, and the other examples that
4158 make up the first four chapters of this section, this balance makes
4159 sense. Was Walt Disney a pirate? Would doujinshi be better if creators
4160 had to ask permission? Should tools that enable others to capture and
4161 spread images as a way to cultivate or criticize our culture be better
4162 regulated?
4163 Is it really right that building a search engine should expose you
4164 to $15 million in damages? Would it have been better if Edison had
4165 controlled film? Should every cover band have to hire a lawyer to get
4166 permission to record a song?
4167 </para>
4168 <para>
4169 We could answer yes to each of these questions, but our tradition
4170 has answered no. In our tradition, as the Supreme Court has stated,
4171 copyright "has never accorded the copyright owner complete control
4172 over all possible uses of his work."<footnote><para>
4173 <!-- f25 -->
4174 <citetitle>Sony Corp. of America</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc</citetitle>., 464 U.S. 417,
4175 (1984).
4176 </para></footnote>
4177 Instead, the particular uses that the law regulates have been defined
4178 by balancing the good that comes from granting an exclusive right
4179 against the burdens such an exclusive right creates. And this
4180 balancing has historically been done <emphasis>after</emphasis> a
4181 technology has matured, or settled into the mix of technologies that
4182 facilitate the distribution of content.
4183 </para>
4184 <para>
4185 We should be doing the same thing today. The technology of the
4186 Internet is changing quickly. The way people connect to the Internet
4187 (wires vs. wireless) is changing very quickly. No doubt the network
4188 should not become a tool for "stealing" from artists. But neither
4189 should the law become a tool to entrench one particular way in which
4190 artists (or more accurately, distributors) get paid. As I describe in
4191 some detail in the last chapter of this book, we should be securing
4192 income to artists while we allow the market to secure the most
4193 efficient way to promote and distribute content. This will require
4194 changes in the law, at least in the interim. These changes should be
4195 designed to balance the protection of the law against the strong
4196 public interest that innovation continue.
4197 </para>
4198 <para>
4199
4200 <!-- PAGE BREAK 92 -->
4201 This is especially true when a new technology enables a vastly
4202 superior mode of distribution. And this p2p has done. P2p technologies
4203 can be ideally efficient in moving content across a widely diverse
4204 network. Left to develop, they could make the network vastly more
4205 efficient. Yet these "potential public benefits," as John Schwartz
4206 writes in <citetitle>The New York Times</citetitle>, "could be delayed in the P2P
4207 fight."<footnote><para>
4208 <!-- f26 -->
4209 John Schwartz, "New Economy: The Attack on Peer-to-Peer Software
4210 Echoes Past Efforts," <citetitle>New York Times</citetitle>, 22 September 2003, C3.
4211 </para></footnote>
4212 Yet when anyone begins to talk about "balance," the copyright warriors
4213 raise a different argument. "All this hand waving about balance and
4214 incentives," they say, "misses a fundamental point. Our content," the
4215 warriors insist, "is our <emphasis>property</emphasis>. Why should we
4216 wait for Congress to `rebalance' our property rights? Do you have to
4217 wait before calling the police when your car has been stolen? And why
4218 should Congress deliberate at all about the merits of this theft? Do
4219 we ask whether the car thief had a good use for the car before we
4220 arrest him?"
4221 </para>
4222 <para>
4223 "It is <emphasis>our property</emphasis>," the warriors insist. "And
4224 it should be protected just as any other property is protected."
4225 </para>
4226 <!-- PAGE BREAK 93 -->
4227 </section>
4228 </chapter>
4229 </part>
4230 <part id="c-property">
4231 <title>"PROPERTY"</title>
4232 <partintro>
4233 <para>
4234
4235 <!-- PAGE BREAK 94 -->
4236 The copyright warriors are right: A copyright is a kind of
4237 property. It can be owned and sold, and the law protects against its
4238 theft. Ordinarily, the copyright owner gets to hold out for any price he
4239 wants. Markets reckon the supply and demand that partially determine
4240 the price she can get.
4241 </para>
4242 <para>
4243 But in ordinary language, to call a copyright a "property" right is a
4244 bit misleading, for the property of copyright is an odd kind of
4245 property. Indeed, the very idea of property in any idea or any
4246 expression is very odd. I understand what I am taking when I take the
4247 picnic table you put in your backyard. I am taking a thing, the picnic
4248 table, and after I take it, you don't have it. But what am I taking
4249 when I take the good <emphasis>idea</emphasis> you had to put a picnic
4250 table in the backyard&mdash;by, for example, going to Sears, buying a
4251 table, and putting it in my backyard? What is the thing I am taking
4252 then?
4253 </para>
4254 <para>
4255 The point is not just about the thingness of picnic tables versus
4256 ideas, though that's an important difference. The point instead is that
4257 <!-- PAGE BREAK 95 -->
4258 in the ordinary case&mdash;indeed, in practically every case except for a
4259 narrow
4260 range of exceptions&mdash;ideas released to the world are free. I don't
4261 take anything from you when I copy the way you dress&mdash;though I
4262 might seem weird if I did it every day, and especially weird if you are a
4263 woman. Instead, as Thomas Jefferson said (and as is especially true
4264 when I copy the way someone else dresses), "He who receives an idea
4265 from me, receives instruction himself without lessening mine; as he who
4266 lights his taper at mine, receives light without darkening me."<footnote><para>
4267 <!-- f1 -->
4268 Letter from Thomas Jefferson to Isaac McPherson (13 August 1813) in
4269 <citetitle>The Writings of Thomas Jefferson</citetitle>, vol. 6 (Andrew A. Lipscomb and Albert
4270 Ellery Bergh, eds., 1903), 330, 333&ndash;34.
4271 </para></footnote>
4272 </para>
4273 <para>
4274 The exceptions to free use are ideas and expressions within the
4275 reach of the law of patent and copyright, and a few other domains that
4276 I won't discuss here. Here the law says you can't take my idea or
4277 expression
4278 without my permission: The law turns the intangible into
4279 property.
4280 </para>
4281 <para>
4282 But how, and to what extent, and in what form&mdash;the details,
4283 in other words&mdash;matter. To get a good sense of how this practice
4284 of turning the intangible into property emerged, we need to place this
4285 "property" in its proper context.<footnote><para>
4286 <!-- f2 -->
4287 As the legal realists taught American law, all property rights are
4288 intangible. A property right is simply a right that an individual has
4289 against the world to do or not do certain things that may or may not
4290 attach to a physical object. The right itself is intangible, even if
4291 the object to which it is (metaphorically) attached is tangible. See
4292 Adam Mossoff, "What Is Property? Putting the Pieces Back Together,"
4293 <citetitle>Arizona Law Review</citetitle> 45 (2003): 373, 429 n. 241.
4294 </para></footnote>
4295 </para>
4296 <para>
4297 My strategy in doing this will be the same as my strategy in the
4298 preceding part. I offer four stories to help put the idea of
4299 "copyright material is property" in context. Where did the idea come
4300 from? What are its limits? How does it function in practice? After
4301 these stories, the significance of this true
4302 statement&mdash;"copyright material is property"&mdash; will be a bit
4303 more clear, and its implications will be revealed as quite different
4304 from the implications that the copyright warriors would have us draw.
4305 </para>
4306 </partintro>
4307
4308 <!-- PAGE BREAK 96 -->
4309 <chapter id="founders">
4310 <title>CHAPTER SIX: Founders</title>
4311 <para>
4312 William Shakespeare wrote <citetitle>Romeo and Juliet</citetitle> in 1595. The play
4313 was first published in 1597. It was the eleventh major play that
4314 Shakespeare had written. He would continue to write plays through
4315 1613, and the plays that he wrote have continued to define
4316 Anglo-American culture ever since. So deeply have the works of a
4317 sixteenth-century writer seeped into our culture that we often don't
4318 even recognize their source. I once overheard someone commenting on
4319 Kenneth Branagh's adaptation of Henry V: "I liked it, but Shakespeare
4320 is so full of clichés."
4321 </para>
4322 <para>
4323 In 1774, almost 180 years after <citetitle>Romeo and Juliet</citetitle> was written, the
4324 "copy-right" for the work was still thought by many to be the exclusive
4325 right of a single London publisher, Jacob Tonson.<footnote><para>
4326 <!-- f1 -->
4327 Jacob Tonson is typically remembered for his associations with prominent
4328 eighteenth-century literary figures, especially John Dryden, and for his
4329 handsome "definitive editions" of classic works. In addition to <citetitle>Romeo and
4330 Juliet</citetitle>, he published an astonishing array of works that still remain at the
4331 heart of the English canon, including collected works of Shakespeare, Ben
4332 Jonson, John Milton, and John Dryden. See Keith Walker, "Jacob Tonson,
4333 Bookseller," <citetitle>American Scholar</citetitle> 61:3 (1992): 424&ndash;31.
4334 </para></footnote>
4335 Tonson was the most prominent of a small group of publishers called
4336 the Conger<footnote><para>
4337 <!-- f2 -->
4338 Lyman Ray Patterson, <citetitle>Copyright in Historical Perspective</citetitle> (Nashville:
4339 Vanderbilt University Press, 1968), 151&ndash;52.
4340 </para></footnote>
4341 who controlled bookselling in England during the eighteenth
4342 century. The Conger claimed a perpetual right to control the "copy" of
4343 books that they had acquired from authors. That perpetual right meant
4344 that no
4345 <!-- PAGE BREAK 97 -->
4346 one else could publish copies of a book to which they held the
4347 copyright. Prices of the classics were thus kept high; competition to
4348 produce better or cheaper editions was eliminated.
4349 </para>
4350 <para>
4351 Now, there's something puzzling about the year 1774 to anyone who
4352 knows a little about copyright law. The better-known year in the
4353 history of copyright is 1710, the year that the British Parliament
4354 adopted the first "copyright" act. Known as the Statute of Anne, the
4355 act stated that all published works would get a copyright term of
4356 fourteen years, renewable once if the author was alive, and that all
4357 works already published by 1710 would get a single term of twenty-one
4358 additional years.<footnote><para>
4359 <!-- f3 -->
4360 As Siva Vaidhyanathan nicely argues, it is erroneous to call this a
4361 "copyright law." See Vaidhyanathan, <citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs</citetitle>, 40.
4362 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva</primary></indexterm>
4363 </para></footnote> Under this law, <citetitle>Romeo and Juliet</citetitle> should have been
4364 free in 1731. So why was there any issue about it still being under
4365 Tonson's control in 1774?
4366 </para>
4367 <para>
4368 The reason is that the English hadn't yet agreed on what a "copyright"
4369 was&mdash;indeed, no one had. At the time the English passed the
4370 Statute of Anne, there was no other legislation governing copyrights.
4371 The last law regulating publishers, the Licensing Act of 1662, had
4372 expired in 1695. That law gave publishers a monopoly over publishing,
4373 as a way to make it easier for the Crown to control what was
4374 published. But after it expired, there was no positive law that said
4375 that the publishers, or "Stationers," had an exclusive right to print
4376 books.
4377 <indexterm><primary>Licensing Act (1662)</primary></indexterm>
4378 </para>
4379 <para>
4380 There was no <emphasis>positive</emphasis> law, but that didn't mean
4381 that there was no law. The Anglo-American legal tradition looks to
4382 both the words of legislatures and the words of judges to know the
4383 rules that are to govern how people are to behave. We call the words
4384 from legislatures "positive law." We call the words from judges
4385 "common law." The common law sets the background against which
4386 legislatures legislate; the legislature, ordinarily, can trump that
4387 background only if it passes a law to displace it. And so the real
4388 question after the licensing statutes had expired was whether the
4389 common law protected a copyright, independent of any positive law.
4390 </para>
4391 <para>
4392 This question was important to the publishers, or "booksellers," as
4393 they were called, because there was growing competition from foreign
4394 publishers. The Scottish, in particular, were increasingly publishing
4395 and exporting books to England. That competition reduced the profits
4396
4397 <!-- PAGE BREAK 98 -->
4398 of the Conger, which reacted by demanding that Parliament pass a law
4399 to again give them exclusive control over publishing. That demand
4400 ultimately
4401 resulted in the Statute of Anne.
4402 </para>
4403 <para>
4404 The Statute of Anne granted the author or "proprietor" of a book an
4405 exclusive right to print that book. In an important limitation,
4406 however, and to the horror of the booksellers, the law gave the
4407 bookseller that right for a limited term. At the end of that term, the
4408 copyright "expired," and the work would then be free and could be
4409 published by anyone. Or so the legislature is thought to have
4410 believed.
4411 </para>
4412 <para>
4413 Now, the thing to puzzle about for a moment is this: Why would
4414 Parliament limit the exclusive right? Not why would they limit it to
4415 the particular limit they set, but why would they limit the right
4416 <emphasis>at all?</emphasis>
4417 </para>
4418 <para>
4419 For the booksellers, and the authors whom they represented, had a very
4420 strong claim. Take <citetitle>Romeo and Juliet</citetitle> as an example: That play
4421 was written by Shakespeare. It was his genius that brought it into the
4422 world. He didn't take anybody's property when he created this play
4423 (that's a controversial claim, but never mind), and by his creating
4424 this play, he didn't make it any harder for others to craft a play. So
4425 why is it that the law would ever allow someone else to come along and
4426 take Shakespeare's play without his, or his estate's, permission? What
4427 reason is there to allow someone else to "steal" Shakespeare's work?
4428 </para>
4429 <para>
4430 The answer comes in two parts. We first need to see something special
4431 about the notion of "copyright" that existed at the time of the
4432 Statute of Anne. Second, we have to see something important about
4433 "booksellers."
4434 </para>
4435 <para>
4436 First, about copyright. In the last three hundred years, we have come
4437 to apply the concept of "copyright" ever more broadly. But in 1710, it
4438 wasn't so much a concept as it was a very particular right. The
4439 copyright was born as a very specific set of restrictions: It forbade
4440 others from reprinting a book. In 1710, the "copy-right" was a right
4441 to use a particular machine to replicate a particular work. It did not
4442 go beyond that very narrow right. It did not control any more
4443 generally how
4444 <!-- PAGE BREAK 99 -->
4445 a work could be <emphasis>used</emphasis>. Today the right includes a
4446 large collection of restrictions on the freedom of others: It grants
4447 the author the exclusive right to copy, the exclusive right to
4448 distribute, the exclusive right to perform, and so on.
4449 </para>
4450 <para>
4451 So, for example, even if the copyright to Shakespeare's works were
4452 perpetual, all that would have meant under the original meaning of the
4453 term was that no one could reprint Shakespeare's work without the
4454 permission
4455 of the Shakespeare estate. It would not have controlled
4456 anything,
4457 for example, about how the work could be performed, whether
4458 the work could be translated, or whether Kenneth Branagh would be
4459 allowed to make his films. The "copy-right" was only an exclusive right
4460 to print&mdash;no less, of course, but also no more.
4461 </para>
4462 <para>
4463 Even that limited right was viewed with skepticism by the British.
4464 They had had a long and ugly experience with "exclusive rights,"
4465 especially
4466 "exclusive rights" granted by the Crown. The English had fought
4467 a civil war in part about the Crown's practice of handing out
4468 monopolies&mdash;especially
4469 monopolies for works that already existed. King Henry
4470 VIII granted a patent to print the Bible and a monopoly to Darcy to
4471 print playing cards. The English Parliament began to fight back
4472 against this power of the Crown. In 1656, it passed the Statute of
4473 Monopolies,
4474 limiting monopolies to patents for new inventions. And by
4475 1710, Parliament was eager to deal with the growing monopoly in
4476 publishing.
4477 </para>
4478 <para>
4479 Thus the "copy-right," when viewed as a monopoly right, was
4480 naturally
4481 viewed as a right that should be limited. (However convincing
4482 the claim that "it's my property, and I should have it forever," try
4483 sounding convincing when uttering, "It's my monopoly, and I should
4484 have it forever.") The state would protect the exclusive right, but only
4485 so long as it benefited society. The British saw the harms from
4486 specialinterest
4487 favors; they passed a law to stop them.
4488 </para>
4489 <para>
4490 Second, about booksellers. It wasn't just that the copyright was a
4491 monopoly. It was also that it was a monopoly held by the booksellers.
4492 Booksellers sound quaint and harmless to us. They were not viewed
4493 as harmless in seventeenth-century England. Members of the Conger
4494 <!-- PAGE BREAK 100 -->
4495
4496 were increasingly seen as monopolists of the worst
4497 kind&mdash;tools of the Crown's repression, selling the liberty of
4498 England to guarantee themselves a monopoly profit. The attacks against
4499 these monopolists were harsh: Milton described them as "old patentees
4500 and monopolizers in the trade of book-selling"; they were "men who do
4501 not therefore labour in an honest profession to which learning is
4502 indetted."<footnote><para>
4503
4504 <!-- f4 -->
4505 Philip Wittenberg, <citetitle>The Protection and Marketing of Literary
4506 Property</citetitle> (New York: J. Messner, Inc., 1937), 31.
4507 </para></footnote>
4508 </para>
4509 <para>
4510 Many believed the power the booksellers exercised over the spread of
4511 knowledge was harming that spread, just at the time the Enlightenment
4512 was teaching the importance of education and knowledge spread
4513 generally. The idea that knowledge should be free was a hallmark of
4514 the time, and these powerful commercial interests were interfering
4515 with that idea.
4516 </para>
4517 <para>
4518 To balance this power, Parliament decided to increase competition
4519 among booksellers, and the simplest way to do that was to spread the
4520 wealth of valuable books. Parliament therefore limited the term of
4521 copyrights, and thereby guaranteed that valuable books would become
4522 open to any publisher to publish after a limited time. Thus the setting
4523 of the term for existing works to just twenty-one years was a
4524 compromise
4525 to fight the power of the booksellers. The limitation on terms was
4526 an indirect way to assure competition among publishers, and thus the
4527 construction and spread of culture.
4528 </para>
4529 <para>
4530 When 1731 (1710 + 21) came along, however, the booksellers were
4531 getting anxious. They saw the consequences of more competition, and
4532 like every competitor, they didn't like them. At first booksellers simply
4533 ignored the Statute of Anne, continuing to insist on the perpetual right
4534 to control publication. But in 1735 and 1737, they tried to persuade
4535 Parliament to extend their terms. Twenty-one years was not enough,
4536 they said; they needed more time.
4537 </para>
4538 <para>
4539 Parliament rejected their requests. As one pamphleteer put it, in
4540 words that echo today,
4541 </para>
4542 <blockquote>
4543 <para>
4544 I see no Reason for granting a further Term now, which will not
4545 hold as well for granting it again and again, as often as the Old
4546 <!-- PAGE BREAK 101 -->
4547 ones Expire; so that should this Bill pass, it will in Effect be
4548 establishing a perpetual Monopoly, a Thing deservedly odious in the
4549 Eye of the Law; it will be a great Cramp to Trade, a Discouragement to
4550 Learning, no Benefit to the Authors, but a general Tax on the Publick;
4551 and all this only to increase the private Gain of the
4552 Booksellers.<footnote><para>
4553 <!-- f5 -->
4554 A Letter to a Member of Parliament concerning the Bill now depending
4555 in the House of Commons, for making more effectual an Act in the
4556 Eighth Year of the Reign of Queen Anne, entitled, An Act for the
4557 Encouragement of Learning, by Vesting the Copies of Printed Books in
4558 the Authors or Purchasers of such Copies, during the Times therein
4559 mentioned (London, 1735), in Brief Amici Curiae of Tyler T. Ochoa et
4560 al., 8, <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Ashcroft</citetitle>, 537 U.S. 186 (2003) (No. 01-618).
4561 </para></footnote>
4562 </para>
4563 </blockquote>
4564 <para>
4565 Having failed in Parliament, the publishers turned to the courts in a
4566 series of cases. Their argument was simple and direct: The Statute of
4567 Anne gave authors certain protections through positive law, but those
4568 protections were not intended as replacements for the common law.
4569 Instead, they were intended simply to supplement the common law.
4570 Under common law, it was already wrong to take another person's
4571 creative "property" and use it without his permission. The Statute of
4572 Anne, the booksellers argued, didn't change that. Therefore, just
4573 because the protections of the Statute of Anne expired, that didn't
4574 mean the protections of the common law expired: Under the common law
4575 they had the right to ban the publication of a book, even if its
4576 Statute of Anne copyright had expired. This, they argued, was the only
4577 way to protect authors.
4578 </para>
4579 <para>
4580 This was a clever argument, and one that had the support of some of
4581 the leading jurists of the day. It also displayed extraordinary
4582 chutzpah. Until then, as law professor Raymond Patterson has put it,
4583 "The publishers . . . had as much concern for authors as a cattle
4584 rancher has for cattle."<footnote><para>
4585 <!-- f6 -->
4586 Lyman Ray Patterson, "Free Speech, Copyright, and Fair Use," <citetitle>Vanderbilt
4587 Law Review</citetitle> 40 (1987): 28. For a wonderfully compelling account, see
4588 Vaidhyanathan, 37&ndash;48.
4589 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva</primary></indexterm>
4590 </para></footnote>
4591 The bookseller didn't care squat for the rights of the author. His
4592 concern was the monopoly profit that the author's work gave.
4593 </para>
4594 <para>
4595 The booksellers' argument was not accepted without a fight.
4596 The hero of this fight was a Scottish bookseller named Alexander
4597 Donaldson.<footnote><para>
4598 <!-- f7 -->
4599 For a compelling account, see David Saunders, <citetitle>Authorship and Copyright</citetitle>
4600 (London: Routledge, 1992), 62&ndash;69.
4601 </para></footnote>
4602 </para>
4603 <para>
4604 Donaldson was an outsider to the London Conger. He began his
4605 career in Edinburgh in 1750. The focus of his business was inexpensive
4606 reprints "of standard works whose copyright term had expired," at least
4607 under the Statute of Anne.<footnote><para>
4608 <!-- f8 -->
4609 Mark Rose, <citetitle>Authors and Owners</citetitle> (Cambridge: Harvard University Press,
4610 1993), 92.
4611 </para></footnote>
4612 Donaldson's publishing house prospered
4613 <!-- PAGE BREAK 102 -->
4614 and became "something of a center for literary Scotsmen." "[A]mong
4615 them," Professor Mark Rose writes, was "the young James Boswell
4616 who, together with his friend Andrew Erskine, published an anthology
4617 of contemporary Scottish poems with Donaldson."<footnote><para>
4618 <!-- f9 -->
4619 Ibid., 93.
4620 </para></footnote>
4621 <indexterm><primary>Erskine, Andrew</primary></indexterm>
4622 </para>
4623 <para>
4624 When the London booksellers tried to shut down Donaldson's shop in
4625 Scotland, he responded by moving his shop to London, where he sold
4626 inexpensive editions "of the most popular English books, in defiance
4627 of the supposed common law right of Literary
4628 Property."<footnote><para>
4629 <!-- f10 -->
4630 Lyman Ray Patterson, <citetitle>Copyright in Historical Perspective</citetitle>, 167 (quoting
4631 Borwell).
4632 </para></footnote>
4633 His books undercut the Conger prices by 30 to 50 percent, and he
4634 rested his right to compete upon the ground that, under the Statute of
4635 Anne, the works he was selling had passed out of protection.
4636 </para>
4637 <para>
4638 The London booksellers quickly brought suit to block "piracy" like
4639 Donaldson's. A number of actions were successful against the "pirates,"
4640 the most important early victory being <citetitle>Millar</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Taylor</citetitle>.
4641 </para>
4642 <para>
4643 Millar was a bookseller who in 1729 had purchased the rights to James
4644 Thomson's poem "The Seasons." Millar complied with the requirements of
4645 the Statute of Anne, and therefore received the full protection of the
4646 statute. After the term of copyright ended, Robert Taylor began
4647 printing a competing volume. Millar sued, claiming a perpetual common
4648 law right, the Statute of Anne notwithstanding.<footnote><para>
4649 <!-- f11 -->
4650 Howard B. Abrams, "The Historic Foundation of American Copyright Law:
4651 Exploding the Myth of Common Law Copyright," <citetitle>Wayne Law Review</citetitle> 29
4652 (1983): 1152.
4653 </para></footnote>
4654 </para>
4655 <indexterm id="idxmansfield2" class='startofrange'>
4656 <primary>Mansfield, William Murray, Lord</primary>
4657 </indexterm>
4658 <para>
4659 Astonishingly to modern lawyers, one of the greatest judges in English
4660 history, Lord Mansfield, agreed with the booksellers. Whatever
4661 protection the Statute of Anne gave booksellers, it did not, he held,
4662 extinguish any common law right. The question was whether the common
4663 law would protect the author against subsequent "pirates."
4664 Mansfield's answer was yes: The common law would bar Taylor from
4665 reprinting Thomson's poem without Millar's permission. That common law
4666 rule thus effectively gave the booksellers a perpetual right to
4667 control the publication of any book assigned to them.
4668 </para>
4669 <para>
4670 Considered as a matter of abstract justice&mdash;reasoning as if
4671 justice were just a matter of logical deduction from first
4672 principles&mdash;Mansfield's conclusion might make some sense. But
4673 what it ignored was the larger issue that Parliament had struggled
4674 with in 1710: How best to limit
4675 <!-- PAGE BREAK 103 -->
4676 the monopoly power of publishers? Parliament's strategy was to offer a
4677 term for existing works that was long enough to buy peace in 1710, but
4678 short enough to assure that culture would pass into competition within
4679 a reasonable period of time. Within twenty-one years, Parliament
4680 believed, Britain would mature from the controlled culture that the
4681 Crown coveted to the free culture that we inherited.
4682 </para>
4683 <indexterm startref="idxmansfield2" class='endofrange'/>
4684 <para>
4685 The fight to defend the limits of the Statute of Anne was not to end
4686 there, however, and it is here that Donaldson enters the mix.
4687 </para>
4688 <indexterm><primary>Beckett, Thomas</primary></indexterm>
4689 <para>
4690 Millar died soon after his victory, so his case was not appealed. His
4691 estate sold Thomson's poems to a syndicate of printers that included
4692 Thomas Beckett.<footnote><para>
4693 <!-- f12 -->
4694 Ibid., 1156.
4695 </para></footnote>
4696 Donaldson then released an unauthorized edition
4697 of Thomson's works. Beckett, on the strength of the decision in <citetitle>Millar</citetitle>,
4698 got an injunction against Donaldson. Donaldson appealed the case to
4699 the House of Lords, which functioned much like our own Supreme
4700 Court. In February of 1774, that body had the chance to interpret the
4701 meaning of Parliament's limits from sixty years before.
4702 </para>
4703 <para>
4704 As few legal cases ever do, <citetitle>Donaldson</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Beckett</citetitle> drew an
4705 enormous amount of attention throughout Britain. Donaldson's lawyers
4706 argued that whatever rights may have existed under the common law, the
4707 Statute of Anne terminated those rights. After passage of the Statute
4708 of Anne, the only legal protection for an exclusive right to control
4709 publication came from that statute. Thus, they argued, after the term
4710 specified in the Statute of Anne expired, works that had been
4711 protected by the statute were no longer protected.
4712 </para>
4713 <para>
4714 The House of Lords was an odd institution. Legal questions were
4715 presented to the House and voted upon first by the "law lords,"
4716 members of special legal distinction who functioned much like the
4717 Justices in our Supreme Court. Then, after the law lords voted, the
4718 House of Lords generally voted.
4719 </para>
4720 <para>
4721 The reports about the law lords' votes are mixed. On some counts,
4722 it looks as if perpetual copyright prevailed. But there is no ambiguity
4723 <!-- PAGE BREAK 104 -->
4724 about how the House of Lords voted as whole. By a two-to-one majority
4725 (22 to 11) they voted to reject the idea of perpetual copyrights.
4726 Whatever one's understanding of the common law, now a copyright was
4727 fixed for a limited time, after which the work protected by copyright
4728 passed into the public domain.
4729 </para>
4730 <para>
4731 "The public domain." Before the case of <citetitle>Donaldson</citetitle>
4732 v. <citetitle>Beckett</citetitle>, there was no clear idea of a public domain in
4733 England. Before 1774, there was a strong argument that common law
4734 copyrights were perpetual. After 1774, the public domain was
4735 born. For the first time in Anglo-American history, the legal control
4736 over creative works expired, and the greatest works in English
4737 history&mdash;including those of Shakespeare, Bacon, Milton, Johnson,
4738 and Bunyan&mdash;were free of legal restraint.
4739 <indexterm><primary>Bacon, Francis</primary></indexterm>
4740 <indexterm><primary>Bunyan, John</primary></indexterm>
4741 <indexterm><primary>Johnson, Samuel</primary></indexterm>
4742 <indexterm><primary>Milton, John</primary></indexterm>
4743 <indexterm><primary>Shakespeare, William</primary></indexterm>
4744 </para>
4745 <para>
4746 It is hard for us to imagine, but this decision by the House of Lords
4747 fueled an extraordinarily popular and political reaction. In Scotland,
4748 where most of the "pirate publishers" did their work, people
4749 celebrated the decision in the streets. As the <citetitle>Edinburgh Advertiser</citetitle>
4750 reported, "No private cause has so much engrossed the attention of the
4751 public, and none has been tried before the House of Lords in the
4752 decision of which so many individuals were interested." "Great
4753 rejoicing in Edinburgh upon victory over literary property: bonfires
4754 and illuminations."<footnote><para>
4755 <!-- f13 -->
4756 Rose, 97.
4757 </para></footnote>
4758 </para>
4759 <para>
4760 In London, however, at least among publishers, the reaction was
4761 equally strong in the opposite direction. The <citetitle>Morning Chronicle</citetitle>
4762 reported:
4763 </para>
4764 <blockquote>
4765 <para>
4766 By the above decision . . . near 200,000 pounds worth of what was
4767 honestly purchased at public sale, and which was yesterday thought
4768 property is now reduced to nothing. The Booksellers of London and
4769 Westminster, many of whom sold estates and houses to purchase
4770 Copy-right, are in a manner ruined, and those who after many years
4771 industry thought they had acquired a competency to provide for their
4772 families now find themselves without a shilling to devise to their
4773 successors.<footnote><para>
4774 <!-- f14 -->
4775 Ibid.
4776 </para></footnote>
4777 </para>
4778 </blockquote>
4779 <para>
4780 <!-- PAGE BREAK 105 -->
4781 "Ruined" is a bit of an exaggeration. But it is not an exaggeration to
4782 say that the change was profound. The decision of the House of Lords
4783 meant that the booksellers could no longer control how culture in
4784 England would grow and develop. Culture in England was thereafter
4785 <emphasis>free</emphasis>. Not in the sense that copyrights would not
4786 be respected, for of course, for a limited time after a work was
4787 published, the bookseller had an exclusive right to control the
4788 publication of that book. And not in the sense that books could be
4789 stolen, for even after a copyright expired, you still had to buy the
4790 book from someone. But <emphasis>free</emphasis> in the sense that the
4791 culture and its growth would no longer be controlled by a small group
4792 of publishers. As every free market does, this free market of free
4793 culture would grow as the consumers and producers chose. English
4794 culture would develop as the many English readers chose to let it
4795 develop&mdash; chose in the books they bought and wrote; chose in the
4796 memes they repeated and endorsed. Chose in a <emphasis>competitive
4797 context</emphasis>, not a context in which the choices about what
4798 culture is available to people and how they get access to it are made
4799 by the few despite the wishes of the many.
4800 </para>
4801 <para>
4802 At least, this was the rule in a world where the Parliament is
4803 antimonopoly, resistant to the protectionist pleas of publishers. In a
4804 world where the Parliament is more pliant, free culture would be less
4805 protected.
4806 </para>
4807 <!-- PAGE BREAK 106 -->
4808 </chapter>
4809 <chapter id="recorders">
4810 <title>CHAPTER SEVEN: Recorders</title>
4811 <para>
4812 Jon Else is a filmmaker. He is best known for his documentaries and
4813 has been very successful in spreading his art. He is also a teacher, and
4814 as a teacher myself, I envy the loyalty and admiration that his students
4815 feel for him. (I met, by accident, two of his students at a dinner party.
4816 He was their god.)
4817 </para>
4818 <para>
4819 Else worked on a documentary that I was involved in. At a break,
4820 he told me a story about the freedom to create with film in America
4821 today.
4822 </para>
4823 <para>
4824 In 1990, Else was working on a documentary about Wagner's Ring
4825 Cycle. The focus was stagehands at the San Francisco Opera.
4826 Stagehands are a particularly funny and colorful element of an opera.
4827 During a show, they hang out below the stage in the grips' lounge and
4828 in the lighting loft. They make a perfect contrast to the art on the
4829 stage.
4830 <indexterm><primary>San Francisco Opera</primary></indexterm>
4831 </para>
4832 <para>
4833 During one of the performances, Else was shooting some stagehands
4834 playing checkers. In one corner of the room was a television set.
4835 Playing on the television set, while the stagehands played checkers
4836 and the opera company played Wagner, was <citetitle>The Simpsons</citetitle>. As Else judged
4837 <!-- PAGE BREAK 107 -->
4838 it, this touch of cartoon helped capture the flavor of what was special
4839 about the scene.
4840 </para>
4841 <para>
4842 Years later, when he finally got funding to complete the film, Else
4843 attempted to clear the rights for those few seconds of <citetitle>The Simpsons</citetitle>.
4844 For of course, those few seconds are copyrighted; and of course, to use
4845 copyrighted material you need the permission of the copyright owner,
4846 unless "fair use" or some other privilege applies.
4847 </para>
4848 <para>
4849 Else called <citetitle>Simpsons</citetitle> creator Matt Groening's office to get permission.
4850 Groening approved the shot. The shot was a four-and-a-halfsecond image
4851 on a tiny television set in the corner of the room. How could it hurt?
4852 Groening was happy to have it in the film, but he told Else to contact
4853 Gracie Films, the company that produces the program.
4854 <indexterm><primary>Gracie Films</primary></indexterm>
4855 </para>
4856 <para>
4857 Gracie Films was okay with it, too, but they, like Groening, wanted
4858 to be careful. So they told Else to contact Fox, Gracie's parent company.
4859 Else called Fox and told them about the clip in the corner of the one
4860 room shot of the film. Matt Groening had already given permission,
4861 Else said. He was just confirming the permission with Fox.
4862 <indexterm><primary>Gracie Films</primary></indexterm>
4863 </para>
4864 <para>
4865 Then, as Else told me, "two things happened. First we discovered
4866 . . . that Matt Groening doesn't own his own creation&mdash;or at
4867 least that someone [at Fox] believes he doesn't own his own creation."
4868 And second, Fox "wanted ten thousand dollars as a licensing fee for us
4869 to use this four-point-five seconds of . . . entirely unsolicited
4870 <citetitle>Simpsons</citetitle> which was in the corner of the shot."
4871 </para>
4872 <para>
4873 Else was certain there was a mistake. He worked his way up to someone
4874 he thought was a vice president for licensing, Rebecca Herrera. He
4875 explained to her, "There must be some mistake here. . . . We're
4876 asking for your educational rate on this." That was the educational
4877 rate, Herrera told Else. A day or so later, Else called again to
4878 confirm what he had been told.
4879 </para>
4880 <para>
4881 "I wanted to make sure I had my facts straight," he told me. "Yes, you
4882 have your facts straight," she said. It would cost $10,000 to use the
4883 clip of <citetitle>The Simpsons</citetitle> in the corner of a shot in a documentary film
4884 about
4885
4886 <!-- PAGE BREAK 108 -->
4887 Wagner's Ring Cycle. And then, astonishingly, Herrera told Else, "And
4888 if you quote me, I'll turn you over to our attorneys." As an assistant
4889 to Herrera told Else later on, "They don't give a shit. They just want
4890 the money."
4891 </para>
4892 <para>
4893 Else didn't have the money to buy the right to replay what was playing
4894 on the television backstage at the San Francisco Opera. To reproduce
4895 this reality was beyond the documentary filmmaker's budget. At the
4896 very last minute before the film was to be released, Else digitally
4897 replaced the shot with a clip from another film that he had worked on,
4898 <citetitle>The Day After Trinity</citetitle>, from ten years before.
4899 <indexterm><primary>San Francisco Opera</primary></indexterm>
4900 <indexterm><primary>Day After Trinity, The</primary></indexterm>
4901 </para>
4902 <para>
4903 There's no doubt that someone, whether Matt Groening or Fox, owns the
4904 copyright to <citetitle>The Simpsons</citetitle>. That copyright is their property. To use
4905 that copyrighted material thus sometimes requires the permission of
4906 the copyright owner. If the use that Else wanted to make of the
4907 <citetitle>Simpsons</citetitle> copyright were one of the uses restricted by the law, then he
4908 would need to get the permission of the copyright owner before he
4909 could use the work in that way. And in a free market, it is the owner
4910 of the copyright who gets to set the price for any use that the law
4911 says the owner gets to control.
4912 </para>
4913 <para>
4914 For example, "public performance" is a use of <citetitle>The Simpsons</citetitle> that the
4915 copyright owner gets to control. If you take a selection of favorite
4916 episodes, rent a movie theater, and charge for tickets to come see "My
4917 Favorite <citetitle>Simpsons</citetitle>," then you need to get permission from the copyright
4918 owner. And the copyright owner (rightly, in my view) can charge
4919 whatever she wants&mdash;$10 or $1,000,000. That's her right, as set
4920 by the law.
4921 </para>
4922 <para>
4923 But when lawyers hear this story about Jon Else and Fox, their first
4924 thought is "fair use."<footnote><para>
4925 <!-- f1 -->
4926 For an excellent argument that such use is "fair use," but that
4927 lawyers don't permit recognition that it is "fair use," see Richard
4928 A. Posner with William F. Patry, "Fair Use and Statutory Reform in the
4929 Wake of <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle>" (draft on file with author), University of Chicago
4930 Law School, 5 August 2003.
4931 </para></footnote>
4932 Else's use of just 4.5 seconds of an indirect shot of a <citetitle>Simpsons</citetitle>
4933 episode is clearly a fair use of <citetitle>The Simpsons</citetitle>&mdash;and fair use does
4934 not require the permission of anyone.
4935 </para>
4936 <para>
4937 <!-- PAGE BREAK 109 -->
4938 So I asked Else why he didn't just rely upon "fair use." Here's his reply:
4939 </para>
4940 <blockquote>
4941 <para>
4942 The <citetitle>Simpsons</citetitle> fiasco was for me a great lesson in the gulf between what
4943 lawyers find irrelevant in some abstract sense, and what is crushingly
4944 relevant in practice to those of us actually trying to make and
4945 broadcast documentaries. I never had any doubt that it was "clearly
4946 fair use" in an absolute legal sense. But I couldn't rely on the
4947 concept in any concrete way. Here's why:
4948 </para>
4949 <orderedlist numeration="arabic">
4950 <listitem><para>
4951 <!-- 1. -->
4952 Before our films can be broadcast, the network requires that we buy
4953 Errors and Omissions insurance. The carriers require a detailed
4954 "visual cue sheet" listing the source and licensing status of each
4955 shot in the film. They take a dim view of "fair use," and a claim of
4956 "fair use" can grind the application process to a halt.
4957 </para></listitem>
4958 <listitem><para>
4959 <!-- 2. -->
4960 I probably never should have asked Matt Groening in the first
4961 place. But I knew (at least from folklore) that Fox had a history of
4962 tracking down and stopping unlicensed <citetitle>Simpsons</citetitle> usage, just as George
4963 Lucas had a very high profile litigating <citetitle>Star Wars</citetitle> usage. So I decided
4964 to play by the book, thinking that we would be granted free or cheap
4965 license to four seconds of <citetitle>Simpsons</citetitle>. As a documentary producer working
4966 to exhaustion on a shoestring, the last thing I wanted was to risk
4967 legal trouble, even nuisance legal trouble, and even to defend a
4968 principle.
4969 <indexterm><primary>Lucas, George</primary></indexterm>
4970 </para></listitem>
4971 <listitem><para>
4972 <!-- 3. -->
4973 I did, in fact, speak with one of your colleagues at Stanford Law
4974 School . . . who confirmed that it was fair use. He also confirmed
4975 that Fox would "depose and litigate you to within an inch of your
4976 life," regardless of the merits of my claim. He made clear that it
4977 would boil down to who had the bigger legal department and the deeper
4978 pockets, me or them.
4979 <!-- PAGE BREAK 110 -->
4980 </para></listitem>
4981 <listitem><para>
4982 <!-- 4. -->
4983 The question of fair use usually comes up at the end of the
4984 project, when we are up against a release deadline and out of
4985 money.
4986 </para></listitem>
4987 </orderedlist>
4988 </blockquote>
4989 <para>
4990 In theory, fair use means you need no permission. The theory therefore
4991 supports free culture and insulates against a permission culture. But
4992 in practice, fair use functions very differently. The fuzzy lines of
4993 the law, tied to the extraordinary liability if lines are crossed,
4994 means that the effective fair use for many types of creators is
4995 slight. The law has the right aim; practice has defeated the aim.
4996 </para>
4997 <para>
4998 This practice shows just how far the law has come from its
4999 eighteenth-century roots. The law was born as a shield to protect
5000 publishers' profits against the unfair competition of a pirate. It has
5001 matured into a sword that interferes with any use, transformative or
5002 not.
5003 </para>
5004 <!-- PAGE BREAK 111 -->
5005 </chapter>
5006 <chapter id="transformers">
5007 <title>CHAPTER EIGHT: Transformers</title>
5008 <indexterm><primary>Allen, Paul</primary></indexterm>
5009 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex</primary></indexterm>
5010 <para>
5011 In 1993, Alex Alben was a lawyer working at Starwave, Inc. Starwave
5012 was an innovative company founded by Microsoft cofounder Paul Allen to
5013 develop digital entertainment. Long before the Internet became
5014 popular, Starwave began investing in new technology for delivering
5015 entertainment in anticipation of the power of networks.
5016 </para>
5017 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex</primary></indexterm>
5018 <para>
5019 Alben had a special interest in new technology. He was intrigued by
5020 the emerging market for CD-ROM technology&mdash;not to distribute
5021 film, but to do things with film that otherwise would be very
5022 difficult. In 1993, he launched an initiative to develop a product to
5023 build retrospectives on the work of particular actors. The first actor
5024 chosen was Clint Eastwood. The idea was to showcase all of the work of
5025 Eastwood, with clips from his films and interviews with figures
5026 important to his career.
5027 </para>
5028 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex</primary></indexterm>
5029 <para>
5030 At that time, Eastwood had made more than fifty films, as an actor and
5031 as a director. Alben began with a series of interviews with Eastwood,
5032 asking him about his career. Because Starwave produced those
5033 interviews, it was free to include them on the CD.
5034 </para>
5035 <para>
5036 <!-- PAGE BREAK 112 -->
5037 That alone would not have made a very interesting product, so
5038 Starwave wanted to add content from the movies in Eastwood's career:
5039 posters, scripts, and other material relating to the films Eastwood
5040 made. Most of his career was spent at Warner Brothers, and so it was
5041 relatively easy to get permission for that content.
5042 </para>
5043 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex</primary></indexterm>
5044 <para>
5045 Then Alben and his team decided to include actual film clips. "Our
5046 goal was that we were going to have a clip from every one of
5047 Eastwood's films," Alben told me. It was here that the problem
5048 arose. "No one had ever really done this before," Alben explained. "No
5049 one had ever tried to do this in the context of an artistic look at an
5050 actor's career."
5051 </para>
5052 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex</primary></indexterm>
5053 <para>
5054 Alben brought the idea to Michael Slade, the CEO of Starwave.
5055 Slade asked, "Well, what will it take?"
5056 </para>
5057 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex</primary></indexterm>
5058 <para>
5059 Alben replied, "Well, we're going to have to clear rights from
5060 everyone who appears in these films, and the music and everything
5061 else that we want to use in these film clips." Slade said, "Great! Go
5062 for it."<footnote>
5063 <para>
5064 <!-- f1 -->
5065 Technically, the rights that Alben had to clear were mainly those of
5066 publicity&mdash;rights an artist has to control the commercial
5067 exploitation of his image. But these rights, too, burden "Rip, Mix,
5068 Burn" creativity, as this chapter evinces.
5069 <indexterm>
5070 <primary>artists</primary>
5071 <secondary>publicity rights on images of</secondary>
5072 </indexterm>
5073 </para></footnote>
5074 </para>
5075 <para>
5076 The problem was that neither Alben nor Slade had any idea what
5077 clearing those rights would mean. Every actor in each of the films
5078 could have a claim to royalties for the reuse of that film. But CD-
5079 ROMs had not been specified in the contracts for the actors, so there
5080 was no clear way to know just what Starwave was to do.
5081 </para>
5082 <para>
5083 I asked Alben how he dealt with the problem. With an obvious
5084 pride in his resourcefulness that obscured the obvious bizarreness of his
5085 tale, Alben recounted just what they did:
5086 </para>
5087 <blockquote>
5088 <para>
5089 So we very mechanically went about looking up the film clips. We made
5090 some artistic decisions about what film clips to include&mdash;of
5091 course we were going to use the "Make my day" clip from <citetitle>Dirty
5092 Harry</citetitle>. But you then need to get the guy on the ground who's wiggling
5093 under the gun and you need to get his permission. And then you have
5094 to decide what you are going to pay him.
5095 </para>
5096 <para>
5097 <!-- PAGE BREAK 113 -->
5098 We decided that it would be fair if we offered them the dayplayer rate
5099 for the right to reuse that performance. We're talking about a clip of
5100 less than a minute, but to reuse that performance in the CD-ROM the
5101 rate at the time was about $600. So we had to identify the
5102 people&mdash;some of them were hard to identify because in Eastwood
5103 movies you can't tell who's the guy crashing through the
5104 glass&mdash;is it the actor or is it the stuntman? And then we just,
5105 we put together a team, my assistant and some others, and we just
5106 started calling people.
5107 </para>
5108 </blockquote>
5109 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex</primary></indexterm>
5110 <para>
5111 Some actors were glad to help&mdash;Donald Sutherland, for example,
5112 followed up himself to be sure that the rights had been cleared.
5113 Others were dumbfounded at their good fortune. Alben would ask,
5114 "Hey, can I pay you $600 or maybe if you were in two films, you
5115 know, $1,200?" And they would say, "Are you for real? Hey, I'd love
5116 to get $1,200." And some of course were a bit difficult (estranged
5117 ex-wives, in particular). But eventually, Alben and his team had
5118 cleared the rights to this retrospective CD-ROM on Clint Eastwood's
5119 career.
5120 </para>
5121 <para>
5122 It was one <emphasis>year</emphasis> later&mdash;"and even then we
5123 weren't sure whether we were totally in the clear."
5124 </para>
5125 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex</primary></indexterm>
5126 <para>
5127 Alben is proud of his work. The project was the first of its kind and
5128 the only time he knew of that a team had undertaken such a massive
5129 project for the purpose of releasing a retrospective.
5130 </para>
5131 <blockquote>
5132 <para>
5133 Everyone thought it would be too hard. Everyone just threw up their
5134 hands and said, "Oh, my gosh, a film, it's so many copyrights, there's
5135 the music, there's the screenplay, there's the director, there's the
5136 actors." But we just broke it down. We just put it into its
5137 constituent parts and said, "Okay, there's this many actors, this many
5138 directors, . . . this many musicians," and we just went at it very
5139 systematically and cleared the rights.
5140 </para>
5141 </blockquote>
5142 <para>
5143
5144 <!-- PAGE BREAK 114 -->
5145 And no doubt, the product itself was exceptionally good. Eastwood
5146 loved it, and it sold very well.
5147 </para>
5148 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex</primary></indexterm>
5149 <indexterm><primary>Drucker, Peter</primary></indexterm>
5150 <para>
5151 But I pressed Alben about how weird it seems that it would have to
5152 take a year's work simply to clear rights. No doubt Alben had done
5153 this efficiently, but as Peter Drucker has famously quipped, "There is
5154 nothing so useless as doing efficiently that which should not be done
5155 at all."<footnote><para>
5156 <!-- f2 -->
5157 U.S. Department of Commerce Office of Acquisition Management, <citetitle>Seven
5158 Steps to Performance-Based Services Acquisition</citetitle>, available at
5159 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #22</ulink>.
5160 </para></footnote>
5161 Did it make sense, I asked Alben, that this is the way a new work
5162 has to be made?
5163 </para>
5164 <para>
5165 For, as he acknowledged, "very few . . . have the time and resources,
5166 and the will to do this," and thus, very few such works would ever be
5167 made. Does it make sense, I asked him, from the standpoint of what
5168 anybody really thought they were ever giving rights for originally, that
5169 you would have to go clear rights for these kinds of clips?
5170 </para>
5171 <blockquote>
5172 <para>
5173 I don't think so. When an actor renders a performance in a movie,
5174 he or she gets paid very well. . . . And then when 30 seconds of
5175 that performance is used in a new product that is a retrospective
5176 of somebody's career, I don't think that that person . . . should be
5177 compensated for that.
5178 </para>
5179 </blockquote>
5180 <para>
5181 Or at least, is this <emphasis>how</emphasis> the artist should be
5182 compensated? Would it make sense, I asked, for there to be some kind
5183 of statutory license that someone could pay and be free to make
5184 derivative use of clips like this? Did it really make sense that a
5185 follow-on creator would have to track down every artist, actor,
5186 director, musician, and get explicit permission from each? Wouldn't a
5187 lot more be created if the legal part of the creative process could be
5188 made to be more clean?
5189 </para>
5190 <blockquote>
5191 <para>
5192 Absolutely. I think that if there were some fair-licensing
5193 mechanism&mdash;where you weren't subject to hold-ups and you weren't
5194 subject to estranged former spouses&mdash;you'd see a lot more of this
5195 work, because it wouldn't be so daunting to try to put together a
5196 <!-- PAGE BREAK 115 -->
5197 retrospective of someone's career and meaningfully illustrate it with
5198 lots of media from that person's career. You'd build in a cost as the
5199 producer of one of these things. You'd build in a cost of paying X
5200 dollars to the talent that performed. But it would be a known
5201 cost. That's the thing that trips everybody up and makes this kind of
5202 product hard to get off the ground. If you knew I have a hundred
5203 minutes of film in this product and it's going to cost me X, then you
5204 build your budget around it, and you can get investments and
5205 everything else that you need to produce it. But if you say, "Oh, I
5206 want a hundred minutes of something and I have no idea what it's going
5207 to cost me, and a certain number of people are going to hold me up for
5208 money," then it becomes difficult to put one of these things together.
5209 </para>
5210 </blockquote>
5211 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex</primary></indexterm>
5212 <para>
5213 Alben worked for a big company. His company was backed by some of the
5214 richest investors in the world. He therefore had authority and access
5215 that the average Web designer would not have. So if it took him a
5216 year, how long would it take someone else? And how much creativity is
5217 never made just because the costs of clearing the rights are so high?
5218 These costs are the burdens of a kind of regulation. Put on a
5219 Republican hat for a moment, and get angry for a bit. The government
5220 defines the scope of these rights, and the scope defined determines
5221 how much it's going to cost to negotiate them. (Remember the idea that
5222 land runs to the heavens, and imagine the pilot purchasing flythrough
5223 rights as he negotiates to fly from Los Angeles to San Francisco.)
5224 These rights might well have once made sense; but as circumstances
5225 change, they make no sense at all. Or at least, a well-trained,
5226 regulationminimizing Republican should look at the rights and ask,
5227 "Does this still make sense?"
5228 </para>
5229 <para>
5230 I've seen the flash of recognition when people get this point, but only
5231 a few times. The first was at a conference of federal judges in California.
5232 The judges were gathered to discuss the emerging topic of cyber-law. I
5233 was asked to be on the panel. Harvey Saferstein, a well-respected lawyer
5234
5235 <!-- PAGE BREAK 116 -->
5236 from an L.A. firm, introduced the panel with a video that he and a
5237 friend, Robert Fairbank, had produced.
5238 </para>
5239 <para>
5240 The video was a brilliant collage of film from every period in the
5241 twentieth century, all framed around the idea of a <citetitle>60 Minutes</citetitle> episode.
5242 The execution was perfect, down to the sixty-minute stopwatch. The
5243 judges loved every minute of it.
5244 </para>
5245 <indexterm><primary>Nimmer, David</primary></indexterm>
5246 <para>
5247 When the lights came up, I looked over to my copanelist, David
5248 Nimmer, perhaps the leading copyright scholar and practitioner in the
5249 nation. He had an astonished look on his face, as he peered across the
5250 room of over 250 well-entertained judges. Taking an ominous tone, he
5251 began his talk with a question: "Do you know how many federal laws
5252 were just violated in this room?"
5253 </para>
5254 <indexterm><primary>Boies, David</primary></indexterm>
5255 <para>
5256 For of course, the two brilliantly talented creators who made this
5257 film hadn't done what Alben did. They hadn't spent a year clearing the
5258 rights to these clips; technically, what they had done violated the
5259 law. Of course, it wasn't as if they or anyone were going to be
5260 prosecuted for this violation (the presence of 250 judges and a gaggle
5261 of federal marshals notwithstanding). But Nimmer was making an
5262 important point: A year before anyone would have heard of the word
5263 Napster, and two years before another member of our panel, David
5264 Boies, would defend Napster before the Ninth Circuit Court of Appeals,
5265 Nimmer was trying to get the judges to see that the law would not be
5266 friendly to the capacities that this technology would
5267 enable. Technology means you can now do amazing things easily; but you
5268 couldn't easily do them legally.
5269 </para>
5270 <para>
5271 We live in a "cut and paste" culture enabled by technology. Anyone
5272 building a presentation knows the extraordinary freedom that the cut
5273 and paste architecture of the Internet created&mdash;in a second you can
5274 find just about any image you want; in another second, you can have it
5275 planted in your presentation.
5276 </para>
5277 <para>
5278 But presentations are just a tiny beginning. Using the Internet and
5279 <!-- PAGE BREAK 117 -->
5280 its archives, musicians are able to string together mixes of sound
5281 never before imagined; filmmakers are able to build movies out of
5282 clips on computers around the world. An extraordinary site in Sweden
5283 takes images of politicians and blends them with music to create
5284 biting political commentary. A site called Camp Chaos has produced
5285 some of the most biting criticism of the record industry that there is
5286 through the mixing of Flash! and music.
5287 <indexterm><primary>Camp Chaos</primary></indexterm>
5288 </para>
5289 <para>
5290 All of these creations are technically illegal. Even if the creators
5291 wanted to be "legal," the cost of complying with the law is impossibly
5292 high. Therefore, for the law-abiding sorts, a wealth of creativity is
5293 never made. And for that part that is made, if it doesn't follow the
5294 clearance rules, it doesn't get released.
5295 </para>
5296 <para>
5297 To some, these stories suggest a solution: Let's alter the mix of
5298 rights so that people are free to build upon our culture. Free to add
5299 or mix as they see fit. We could even make this change without
5300 necessarily requiring that the "free" use be free as in "free beer."
5301 Instead, the system could simply make it easy for follow-on creators
5302 to compensate artists without requiring an army of lawyers to come
5303 along: a rule, for example, that says "the royalty owed the copyright
5304 owner of an unregistered work for the derivative reuse of his work
5305 will be a flat 1 percent of net revenues, to be held in escrow for the
5306 copyright owner." Under this rule, the copyright owner could benefit
5307 from some royalty, but he would not have the benefit of a full
5308 property right (meaning the right to name his own price) unless he
5309 registers the work.
5310 </para>
5311 <para>
5312 Who could possibly object to this? And what reason would there be
5313 for objecting? We're talking about work that is not now being made;
5314 which if made, under this plan, would produce new income for artists.
5315 What reason would anyone have to oppose it?
5316 </para>
5317 <para>
5318 In February 2003, DreamWorks studios announced an agreement with Mike
5319 Myers, the comic genius of <citetitle>Saturday Night Live</citetitle> and
5320 <!-- PAGE BREAK 118 -->
5321 Austin Powers. According to the announcement, Myers and Dream-Works
5322 would work together to form a "unique filmmaking pact." Under the
5323 agreement, DreamWorks "will acquire the rights to existing motion
5324 picture hits and classics, write new storylines and&mdash;with the use
5325 of stateof-the-art digital technology&mdash;insert Myers and other
5326 actors into the film, thereby creating an entirely new piece of
5327 entertainment."
5328 </para>
5329 <para>
5330 The announcement called this "film sampling." As Myers explained,
5331 "Film Sampling is an exciting way to put an original spin on existing
5332 films and allow audiences to see old movies in a new light. Rap
5333 artists have been doing this for years with music and now we are able
5334 to take that same concept and apply it to film." Steven Spielberg is
5335 quoted as saying, "If anyone can create a way to bring old films to
5336 new audiences, it is Mike."
5337 </para>
5338 <para>
5339 Spielberg is right. Film sampling by Myers will be brilliant. But if
5340 you don't think about it, you might miss the truly astonishing point
5341 about this announcement. As the vast majority of our film heritage
5342 remains under copyright, the real meaning of the DreamWorks
5343 announcement is just this: It is Mike Myers and only Mike Myers who is
5344 free to sample. Any general freedom to build upon the film archive of
5345 our culture, a freedom in other contexts presumed for us all, is now a
5346 privilege reserved for the funny and famous&mdash;and presumably rich.
5347 </para>
5348 <para>
5349 This privilege becomes reserved for two sorts of reasons. The first
5350 continues the story of the last chapter: the vagueness of "fair use."
5351 Much of "sampling" should be considered "fair use." But few would
5352 rely upon so weak a doctrine to create. That leads to the second reason
5353 that the privilege is reserved for the few: The costs of negotiating the
5354 legal rights for the creative reuse of content are astronomically high.
5355 These costs mirror the costs with fair use: You either pay a lawyer to
5356 defend your fair use rights or pay a lawyer to track down permissions
5357 so you don't have to rely upon fair use rights. Either way, the creative
5358 process is a process of paying lawyers&mdash;again a privilege, or perhaps a
5359 curse, reserved for the few.
5360 </para>
5361 <!-- PAGE BREAK 119 -->
5362 </chapter>
5363 <chapter id="collectors">
5364 <title>CHAPTER NINE: Collectors</title>
5365 <para>
5366 In April 1996, millions of "bots"&mdash;computer codes designed to
5367 "spider," or automatically search the Internet and copy content&mdash;began
5368 running across the Net. Page by page, these bots copied Internet-based
5369 information onto a small set of computers located in a basement in San
5370 Francisco's Presidio. Once the bots finished the whole of the Internet,
5371 they started again. Over and over again, once every two months, these
5372 bits of code took copies of the Internet and stored them.
5373 </para>
5374 <para>
5375 By October 2001, the bots had collected more than five years of
5376 copies. And at a small announcement in Berkeley, California, the
5377 archive that these copies created, the Internet Archive, was opened to
5378 the world. Using a technology called "the Way Back Machine," you could
5379 enter a Web page, and see all of its copies going back to 1996, as
5380 well as when those pages changed.
5381 </para>
5382 <para>
5383 This is the thing about the Internet that Orwell would have
5384 appreciated. In the dystopia described in <citetitle>1984</citetitle>, old newspapers were
5385 constantly updated to assure that the current view of the world,
5386 approved of by the government, was not contradicted by previous news
5387 reports.
5388 </para>
5389 <para>
5390 <!-- PAGE BREAK 120 -->
5391 Thousands of workers constantly reedited the past, meaning there was
5392 no way ever to know whether the story you were reading today was the
5393 story that was printed on the date published on the paper.
5394 </para>
5395 <para>
5396 It's the same with the Internet. If you go to a Web page today,
5397 there's no way for you to know whether the content you are reading is
5398 the same as the content you read before. The page may seem the same,
5399 but the content could easily be different. The Internet is Orwell's
5400 library&mdash;constantly updated, without any reliable memory.
5401 </para>
5402 <para>
5403 Until the Way Back Machine, at least. With the Way Back Machine, and
5404 the Internet Archive underlying it, you can see what the Internet
5405 was. You have the power to see what you remember. More importantly,
5406 perhaps, you also have the power to find what you don't remember and
5407 what others might prefer you forget.<footnote><para>
5408 <!-- f1 -->
5409 The temptations remain, however. Brewster Kahle reports that the White
5410 House changes its own press releases without notice. A May 13, 2003,
5411 press release stated, "Combat Operations in Iraq Have Ended." That was
5412 later changed, without notice, to "Major Combat Operations in Iraq
5413 Have Ended." E-mail from Brewster Kahle, 1 December 2003.
5414 </para></footnote>
5415 </para>
5416 <para>
5417 We take it for granted that we can go back to see what we remember
5418 reading. Think about newspapers. If you wanted to study the reaction
5419 of your hometown newspaper to the race riots in Watts in 1965, or to
5420 Bull Connor's water cannon in 1963, you could go to your public
5421 library and look at the newspapers. Those papers probably exist on
5422 microfiche. If you're lucky, they exist in paper, too. Either way, you
5423 are free, using a library, to go back and remember&mdash;not just what
5424 it is convenient to remember, but remember something close to the
5425 truth.
5426 </para>
5427 <para>
5428 It is said that those who fail to remember history are doomed to
5429 repeat it. That's not quite correct. We <emphasis>all</emphasis>
5430 forget history. The key is whether we have a way to go back to
5431 rediscover what we forget. More directly, the key is whether an
5432 objective past can keep us honest. Libraries help do that, by
5433 collecting content and keeping it, for schoolchildren, for
5434 researchers, for grandma. A free society presumes this knowedge.
5435 </para>
5436 <para>
5437 The Internet was an exception to this presumption. Until the Internet
5438 Archive, there was no way to go back. The Internet was the
5439 quintessentially transitory medium. And yet, as it becomes more
5440 important in forming and reforming society, it becomes more and more
5441 <!-- PAGE BREAK 121 -->
5442 important to maintain in some historical form. It's just bizarre to
5443 think that we have scads of archives of newspapers from tiny towns
5444 around the world, yet there is but one copy of the Internet&mdash;the
5445 one kept by the Internet Archive.
5446 </para>
5447 <para>
5448 Brewster Kahle is the founder of the Internet Archive. He was a very
5449 successful Internet entrepreneur after he was a successful computer
5450 researcher. In the 1990s, Kahle decided he had had enough business
5451 success. It was time to become a different kind of success. So he
5452 launched a series of projects designed to archive human knowledge. The
5453 Internet Archive was just the first of the projects of this Andrew
5454 Carnegie of the Internet. By December of 2002, the archive had over 10
5455 billion pages, and it was growing at about a billion pages a month.
5456 </para>
5457 <para>
5458 The Way Back Machine is the largest archive of human knowledge in
5459 human history. At the end of 2002, it held "two hundred and thirty
5460 terabytes of material"&mdash;and was "ten times larger than the
5461 Library of Congress." And this was just the first of the archives that
5462 Kahle set out to build. In addition to the Internet Archive, Kahle has
5463 been constructing the Television Archive. Television, it turns out, is
5464 even more ephemeral than the Internet. While much of twentieth-century
5465 culture was constructed through television, only a tiny proportion of
5466 that culture is available for anyone to see today. Three hours of news
5467 are recorded each evening by Vanderbilt University&mdash;thanks to a
5468 specific exemption in the copyright law. That content is indexed, and
5469 is available to scholars for a very low fee. "But other than that,
5470 [television] is almost unavailable," Kahle told me. "If you were
5471 Barbara Walters you could get access to [the archives], but if you are
5472 just a graduate student?" As Kahle put it,
5473 </para>
5474 <blockquote>
5475 <para>
5476 Do you remember when Dan Quayle was interacting with Murphy Brown?
5477 Remember that back and forth surreal experience of a politician
5478 interacting with a fictional television character? If you were a
5479 graduate student wanting to study that, and you wanted to get those
5480 original back and forth exchanges between the two, the
5481
5482 <!-- PAGE BREAK 122 -->
5483 <citetitle>60 Minutes</citetitle> episode that came out after it . . . it would be almost
5484 impossible. . . . Those materials are almost unfindable. . . .
5485 </para>
5486 </blockquote>
5487 <para>
5488 Why is that? Why is it that the part of our culture that is recorded
5489 in newspapers remains perpetually accessible, while the part that is
5490 recorded on videotape is not? How is it that we've created a world
5491 where researchers trying to understand the effect of media on
5492 nineteenthcentury America will have an easier time than researchers
5493 trying to understand the effect of media on twentieth-century America?
5494 </para>
5495 <para>
5496 In part, this is because of the law. Early in American copyright law,
5497 copyright owners were required to deposit copies of their work in
5498 libraries. These copies were intended both to facilitate the spread
5499 of knowledge and to assure that a copy of the work would be around
5500 once the copyright expired, so that others might access and copy the
5501 work.
5502 </para>
5503 <para>
5504 These rules applied to film as well. But in 1915, the Library
5505 of Congress made an exception for film. Film could be copyrighted so
5506 long as such deposits were made. But the filmmaker was then allowed to
5507 borrow back the deposits&mdash;for an unlimited time at no cost. In
5508 1915 alone, there were more than 5,475 films deposited and "borrowed
5509 back." Thus, when the copyrights to films expire, there is no copy
5510 held by any library. The copy exists&mdash;if it exists at
5511 all&mdash;in the library archive of the film company.<footnote><para>
5512 <!-- f2 -->
5513 Doug Herrick, "Toward a National Film Collection: Motion Pictures at
5514 the Library of Congress," <citetitle>Film Library Quarterly</citetitle> 13 nos. 2&ndash;3
5515 (1980): 5; Anthony Slide, <citetitle>Nitrate Won't Wait: A History of Film
5516 Preservation in the United States</citetitle> ( Jefferson, N.C.: McFarland &amp;
5517 Co., 1992), 36.
5518 </para></footnote>
5519 </para>
5520 <para>
5521 The same is generally true about television. Television broadcasts
5522 were originally not copyrighted&mdash;there was no way to capture the
5523 broadcasts, so there was no fear of "theft." But as technology enabled
5524 capturing, broadcasters relied increasingly upon the law. The law
5525 required they make a copy of each broadcast for the work to be
5526 "copyrighted." But those copies were simply kept by the
5527 broadcasters. No library had any right to them; the government didn't
5528 demand them. The content of this part of American culture is
5529 practically invisible to anyone who would look.
5530 </para>
5531 <para>
5532 Kahle was eager to correct this. Before September 11, 2001, he and
5533 <!-- PAGE BREAK 123 -->
5534 his allies had started capturing television. They selected twenty
5535 stations from around the world and hit the Record button. After
5536 September 11, Kahle, working with dozens of others, selected twenty
5537 stations from around the world and, beginning October 11, 2001, made
5538 their coverage during the week of September 11 available free on-line.
5539 Anyone could see how news reports from around the world covered the
5540 events of that day.
5541 </para>
5542 <para>
5543 Kahle had the same idea with film. Working with Rick Prelinger, whose
5544 archive of film includes close to 45,000 "ephemeral films" (meaning
5545 films other than Hollywood movies, films that were never copyrighted),
5546 Kahle established the Movie Archive. Prelinger let Kahle digitize
5547 1,300 films in this archive and post those films on the Internet to be
5548 downloaded for free. Prelinger's is a for-profit company. It sells
5549 copies of these films as stock footage. What he has discovered is that
5550 after he made a significant chunk available for free, his stock
5551 footage sales went up dramatically. People could easily find the
5552 material they wanted to use. Some downloaded that material and made
5553 films on their own. Others purchased copies to enable other films to
5554 be made. Either way, the archive enabled access to this important
5555 part of our culture. Want to see a copy of the "Duck and Cover" film
5556 that instructed children how to save themselves in the middle of
5557 nuclear attack? Go to archive.org, and you can download the film in a
5558 few minutes&mdash;for free.
5559 <indexterm><primary>Movie Archive</primary></indexterm>
5560 </para>
5561 <para>
5562 Here again, Kahle is providing access to a part of our culture that we
5563 otherwise could not get easily, if at all. It is yet another part of
5564 what defines the twentieth century that we have lost to history. The
5565 law doesn't require these copies to be kept by anyone, or to be
5566 deposited in an archive by anyone. Therefore, there is no simple way
5567 to find them.
5568 </para>
5569 <para>
5570 The key here is access, not price. Kahle wants to enable free access
5571 to this content, but he also wants to enable others to sell access to
5572 it. His aim is to ensure competition in access to this important part
5573 of our culture. Not during the commercial life of a bit of creative
5574 property, but during a second life that all creative property
5575 has&mdash;a noncommercial life.
5576 </para>
5577 <para>
5578 For here is an idea that we should more clearly recognize. Every bit
5579 of creative property goes through different "lives." In its first
5580 life, if the
5581
5582 <!-- PAGE BREAK 124 -->
5583 creator is lucky, the content is sold. In such cases the commercial
5584 market is successful for the creator. The vast majority of creative
5585 property doesn't enjoy such success, but some clearly does. For that
5586 content, commercial life is extremely important. Without this
5587 commercial market, there would be, many argue, much less creativity.
5588 </para>
5589 <para>
5590 After the commercial life of creative property has ended, our
5591 tradition has always supported a second life as well. A newspaper
5592 delivers the news every day to the doorsteps of America. The very next
5593 day, it is used to wrap fish or to fill boxes with fragile gifts or to
5594 build an archive of knowledge about our history. In this second life,
5595 the content can continue to inform even if that information is no
5596 longer sold.
5597 </para>
5598 <para>
5599 The same has always been true about books. A book goes out of print
5600 very quickly (the average today is after about a year<footnote><para>
5601 <!-- f3 -->
5602 Dave Barns, "Fledgling Career in Antique Books: Woodstock Landlord,
5603 Bar Owner Starts a New Chapter by Adopting Business," <citetitle>Chicago Tribune</citetitle>,
5604 5 September 1997, at Metro Lake 1L. Of books published between 1927
5605 and 1946, only 2.2 percent were in print in 2002. R. Anthony Reese,
5606 "The First Sale Doctrine in the Era of Digital Networks," <citetitle>Boston
5607 College Law Review</citetitle> 44 (2003): 593 n. 51.
5608 </para></footnote>). After
5609 it is out of print, it can be sold in used book stores without the
5610 copyright owner getting anything and stored in libraries, where many
5611 get to read the book, also for free. Used book stores and libraries
5612 are thus the second life of a book. That second life is extremely
5613 important to the spread and stability of culture.
5614 </para>
5615 <para>
5616 Yet increasingly, any assumption about a stable second life for
5617 creative property does not hold true with the most important
5618 components of popular culture in the twentieth and twenty-first
5619 centuries. For these&mdash;television, movies, music, radio, the
5620 Internet&mdash;there is no guarantee of a second life. For these sorts
5621 of culture, it is as if we've replaced libraries with Barnes &amp;
5622 Noble superstores. With this culture, what's accessible is nothing but
5623 what a certain limited market demands. Beyond that, culture
5624 disappears.
5625 </para>
5626 <para>
5627 For most of the twentieth century, it was economics that made this
5628 so. It would have been insanely expensive to collect and make
5629 accessible all television and film and music: The cost of analog
5630 copies is extraordinarily high. So even though the law in principle
5631 would have restricted the ability of a Brewster Kahle to copy culture
5632 generally, the
5633 <!-- PAGE BREAK 125 -->
5634 real restriction was economics. The market made it impossibly
5635 difficult to do anything about this ephemeral culture; the law had
5636 little practical effect.
5637 </para>
5638 <para>
5639 Perhaps the single most important feature of the digital revolution is
5640 that for the first time since the Library of Alexandria, it is
5641 feasible to imagine constructing archives that hold all culture
5642 produced or distributed publicly. Technology makes it possible to
5643 imagine an archive of all books published, and increasingly makes it
5644 possible to imagine an archive of all moving images and sound.
5645 </para>
5646 <para>
5647 The scale of this potential archive is something we've never imagined
5648 before. The Brewster Kahles of our history have dreamed about it; but
5649 we are for the first time at a point where that dream is possible. As
5650 Kahle describes,
5651 </para>
5652 <blockquote>
5653 <para>
5654 It looks like there's about two to three million recordings of music.
5655 Ever. There are about a hundred thousand theatrical releases of
5656 movies, . . . and about one to two million movies [distributed] during
5657 the twentieth century. There are about twenty-six million different
5658 titles of books. All of these would fit on computers that would fit in
5659 this room and be able to be afforded by a small company. So we're at
5660 a turning point in our history. Universal access is the goal. And the
5661 opportunity of leading a different life, based on this, is
5662 . . . thrilling. It could be one of the things humankind would be most
5663 proud of. Up there with the Library of Alexandria, putting a man on
5664 the moon, and the invention of the printing press.
5665 </para>
5666 </blockquote>
5667 <para>
5668 Kahle is not the only librarian. The Internet Archive is not the only
5669 archive. But Kahle and the Internet Archive suggest what the future of
5670 libraries or archives could be. <emphasis>When</emphasis> the
5671 commercial life of creative property ends, I don't know. But it
5672 does. And whenever it does, Kahle and his archive hint at a world
5673 where this knowledge, and culture, remains perpetually available. Some
5674 will draw upon it to understand it;
5675 <!-- PAGE BREAK 126 -->
5676 some to criticize it. Some will use it, as Walt Disney did, to
5677 re-create the past for the future. These technologies promise
5678 something that had become unimaginable for much of our past&mdash;a
5679 future <emphasis>for</emphasis> our past. The technology of digital
5680 arts could make the dream of the Library of Alexandria real again.
5681 </para>
5682 <para>
5683 Technologists have thus removed the economic costs of building such an
5684 archive. But lawyers' costs remain. For as much as we might like to
5685 call these "archives," as warm as the idea of a "library" might seem,
5686 the "content" that is collected in these digital spaces is also
5687 someone's "property." And the law of property restricts the freedoms
5688 that Kahle and others would exercise.
5689 </para>
5690 <!-- PAGE BREAK 127 -->
5691 </chapter>
5692 <chapter id="property-i">
5693 <title>CHAPTER TEN: "Property"</title>
5694 <para>
5695 Jack Valenti has been the president of the Motion Picture Association
5696 of America since 1966. He first came to Washington, D.C., with Lyndon
5697 Johnson's administration&mdash;literally. The famous picture of
5698 Johnson's swearing-in on Air Force One after the assassination of
5699 President Kennedy has Valenti in the background. In his almost forty
5700 years of running the MPAA, Valenti has established himself as perhaps
5701 the most prominent and effective lobbyist in Washington.
5702 <indexterm><primary>Johnson, Lyndon</primary></indexterm>
5703 </para>
5704 <para>
5705 The MPAA is the American branch of the international Motion Picture
5706 Association. It was formed in 1922 as a trade association whose goal
5707 was to defend American movies against increasing domestic criticism.
5708 The organization now represents not only filmmakers but producers and
5709 distributors of entertainment for television, video, and cable. Its
5710 board is made up of the chairmen and presidents of the seven major
5711 producers and distributors of motion picture and television programs
5712 in the United States: Walt Disney, Sony Pictures Entertainment, MGM,
5713 Paramount Pictures, Twentieth Century Fox, Universal Studios, and
5714 Warner Brothers.
5715 <indexterm><primary>Disney, Inc.</primary></indexterm>
5716 <indexterm><primary>Sony Pictures Entertainment</primary></indexterm>
5717 <indexterm><primary>MGM</primary></indexterm>
5718 <indexterm><primary>Paramount Pictures</primary></indexterm>
5719 <indexterm><primary>Twentieth Century Fox</primary></indexterm>
5720 <indexterm><primary>Universal Pictures</primary></indexterm>
5721 <indexterm><primary>Warner Brothers</primary></indexterm>
5722 </para>
5723 <para>
5724 <!-- PAGE BREAK 128 -->
5725 Valenti is only the third president of the MPAA. No president before
5726 him has had as much influence over that organization, or over
5727 Washington. As a Texan, Valenti has mastered the single most important
5728 political skill of a Southerner&mdash;the ability to appear simple and
5729 slow while hiding a lightning-fast intellect. To this day, Valenti
5730 plays the simple, humble man. But this Harvard MBA, and author of four
5731 books, who finished high school at the age of fifteen and flew more
5732 than fifty combat missions in World War II, is no Mr. Smith. When
5733 Valenti went to Washington, he mastered the city in a quintessentially
5734 Washingtonian way.
5735 </para>
5736 <para>
5737 In defending artistic liberty and the freedom of speech that our
5738 culture depends upon, the MPAA has done important good. In crafting
5739 the MPAA rating system, it has probably avoided a great deal of
5740 speech-regulating harm. But there is an aspect to the organization's
5741 mission that is both the most radical and the most important. This is
5742 the organization's effort, epitomized in Valenti's every act, to
5743 redefine the meaning of "creative property."
5744 </para>
5745 <para>
5746 In 1982, Valenti's testimony to Congress captured the strategy
5747 perfectly:
5748 </para>
5749 <blockquote>
5750 <para>
5751 No matter the lengthy arguments made, no matter the charges and the
5752 counter-charges, no matter the tumult and the shouting, reasonable men
5753 and women will keep returning to the fundamental issue, the central
5754 theme which animates this entire debate: <emphasis>Creative property
5755 owners must be accorded the same rights and protection resident in all
5756 other property owners in the nation</emphasis>. That is the issue.
5757 That is the question. And that is the rostrum on which this entire
5758 hearing and the debates to follow must rest.<footnote><para>
5759 <!-- f1 -->
5760 Home Recording of Copyrighted Works: Hearings on H.R. 4783, H.R.
5761 4794, H.R. 4808, H.R. 5250, H.R. 5488, and H.R. 5705 Before the
5762 Subcommittee on Courts, Civil Liberties, and the Administration of
5763 Justice of the Committee on the Judiciary of the House of
5764 Representatives, 97th Cong., 2nd sess. (1982): 65 (testimony of Jack
5765 Valenti).
5766 </para></footnote>
5767 </para>
5768 </blockquote>
5769 <para>
5770 The strategy of this rhetoric, like the strategy of most of Valenti's
5771 rhetoric, is brilliant and simple and brilliant because simple. The
5772 "central theme" to which "reasonable men and women" will return is
5773 this:
5774 <!-- PAGE BREAK 129 -->
5775 "Creative property owners must be accorded the same rights and
5776 protections resident in all other property owners in the nation."
5777 There are no second-class citizens, Valenti might have
5778 continued. There should be no second-class property owners.
5779 </para>
5780 <para>
5781 This claim has an obvious and powerful intuitive pull. It is stated
5782 with such clarity as to make the idea as obvious as the notion that we
5783 use elections to pick presidents. But in fact, there is no more
5784 extreme a claim made by <emphasis>anyone</emphasis> who is serious in
5785 this debate than this claim of Valenti's. Jack Valenti, however sweet
5786 and however brilliant, is perhaps the nation's foremost extremist when
5787 it comes to the nature and scope of "creative property." His views
5788 have <emphasis>no</emphasis> reasonable connection to our actual legal
5789 tradition, even if the subtle pull of his Texan charm has slowly
5790 redefined that tradition, at least in Washington.
5791 </para>
5792 <para>
5793 While "creative property" is certainly "property" in a nerdy and
5794 precise sense that lawyers are trained to understand,<footnote><para>
5795 <!-- f2 -->
5796 Lawyers speak of "property" not as an absolute thing, but as a bundle
5797 of rights that are sometimes associated with a particular
5798 object. Thus, my "property right" to my car gives me the right to
5799 exclusive use, but not the right to drive at 150 miles an hour. For
5800 the best effort to connect the ordinary meaning of "property" to
5801 "lawyer talk," see Bruce Ackerman, <citetitle>Private Property and the
5802 Constitution</citetitle> (New Haven: Yale University Press, 1977), 26&ndash;27.
5803 </para></footnote> it has never been the case, nor should it be, that
5804 "creative property owners" have been "accorded the same rights and
5805 protection resident in all other property owners." Indeed, if creative
5806 property owners were given the same rights as all other property
5807 owners, that would effect a radical, and radically undesirable, change
5808 in our tradition.
5809 </para>
5810 <para>
5811 Valenti knows this. But he speaks for an industry that cares squat for
5812 our tradition and the values it represents. He speaks for an industry
5813 that is instead fighting to restore the tradition that the British
5814 overturned in 1710. In the world that Valenti's changes would create,
5815 a powerful few would exercise powerful control over how our creative
5816 culture would develop.
5817 </para>
5818 <para>
5819 I have two purposes in this chapter. The first is to convince you
5820 that, historically, Valenti's claim is absolutely wrong. The second is
5821 to convince you that it would be terribly wrong for us to reject our
5822 history. We have always treated rights in creative property
5823 differently from the rights resident in all other property
5824 owners. They have never been the same. And they should never be the
5825 same, because, however counterintuitive this may seem, to make them
5826 the same would be to
5827
5828 <!-- PAGE BREAK 130 -->
5829 fundamentally weaken the opportunity for new creators to create.
5830 Creativity depends upon the owners of creativity having less than
5831 perfect control.
5832 </para>
5833 <para>
5834 Organizations such as the MPAA, whose board includes the most powerful
5835 of the old guard, have little interest, their rhetoric
5836 notwithstanding, in assuring that the new can displace them. No
5837 organization does. No person does. (Ask me about tenure, for example.)
5838 But what's good for the MPAA is not necessarily good for America. A
5839 society that defends the ideals of free culture must preserve
5840 precisely the opportunity for new creativity to threaten the old. To
5841 get just a hint that there is something fundamentally wrong in
5842 Valenti's argument, we need look no further than the United States
5843 Constitution itself.
5844 </para>
5845 <para>
5846 The framers of our Constitution loved "property." Indeed, so strongly
5847 did they love property that they built into the Constitution an
5848 important requirement. If the government takes your property&mdash;if
5849 it condemns your house, or acquires a slice of land from your
5850 farm&mdash;it is required, under the Fifth Amendment's "Takings
5851 Clause," to pay you "just compensation" for that taking. The
5852 Constitution thus guarantees that property is, in a certain sense,
5853 sacred. It cannot <emphasis>ever</emphasis> be taken from the property
5854 owner unless the government pays for the privilege.
5855 </para>
5856 <para>
5857 Yet the very same Constitution speaks very differently about what
5858 Valenti calls "creative property." In the clause granting Congress the
5859 power to create "creative property," the Constitution
5860 <emphasis>requires</emphasis> that after a "limited time," Congress
5861 take back the rights that it has granted and set the "creative
5862 property" free to the public domain. Yet when Congress does this, when
5863 the expiration of a copyright term "takes" your copyright and turns it
5864 over to the public domain, Congress does not have any obligation to
5865 pay "just compensation" for this "taking." Instead, the same
5866 Constitution that requires compensation for your land
5867 <!-- PAGE BREAK 131 -->
5868 requires that you lose your "creative property" right without any
5869 compensation at all.
5870 </para>
5871 <para>
5872 The Constitution thus on its face states that these two forms of
5873 property are not to be accorded the same rights. They are plainly to
5874 be treated differently. Valenti is therefore not just asking for a
5875 change in our tradition when he argues that creative-property owners
5876 should be accorded the same rights as every other property-right
5877 owner. He is effectively arguing for a change in our Constitution
5878 itself.
5879 </para>
5880 <para>
5881 Arguing for a change in our Constitution is not necessarily wrong.
5882 There was much in our original Constitution that was plainly wrong.
5883 The Constitution of 1789 entrenched slavery; it left senators to be
5884 appointed rather than elected; it made it possible for the electoral
5885 college to produce a tie between the president and his own vice
5886 president (as it did in 1800). The framers were no doubt
5887 extraordinary, but I would be the first to admit that they made big
5888 mistakes. We have since rejected some of those mistakes; no doubt
5889 there could be others that we should reject as well. So my argument is
5890 not simply that because Jefferson did it, we should, too.
5891 </para>
5892 <para>
5893 Instead, my argument is that because Jefferson did it, we should at
5894 least try to understand <emphasis>why</emphasis>. Why did the framers,
5895 fanatical property types that they were, reject the claim that
5896 creative property be given the same rights as all other property? Why
5897 did they require that for creative property there must be a public
5898 domain?
5899 </para>
5900 <para>
5901 To answer this question, we need to get some perspective on the
5902 history of these "creative property" rights, and the control that they
5903 enabled. Once we see clearly how differently these rights have been
5904 defined, we will be in a better position to ask the question that
5905 should be at the core of this war: Not <emphasis>whether</emphasis>
5906 creative property should be protected, but how. Not
5907 <emphasis>whether</emphasis> we will enforce the rights the law gives
5908 to creative-property owners, but what the particular mix of rights
5909 ought to be. Not <emphasis>whether</emphasis> artists should be paid,
5910 but whether institutions designed to assure that artists get paid need
5911 also control how culture develops.
5912 </para>
5913 <para>
5914
5915 <!-- PAGE BREAK 132 -->
5916 To answer these questions, we need a more general way to talk about
5917 how property is protected. More precisely, we need a more general way
5918 than the narrow language of the law allows. In <citetitle>Code and Other Laws of
5919 Cyberspace</citetitle>, I used a simple model to capture this more general
5920 perspective. For any particular right or regulation, this model asks
5921 how four different modalities of regulation interact to support or
5922 weaken the right or regulation. I represented it with this diagram:
5923 </para>
5924 <figure id="fig-1331">
5925 <title>How four different modalities of regulation interact to support or weaken the right or regulation.</title>
5926 <graphic fileref="images/1331.png"></graphic>
5927 </figure>
5928 <para>
5929 At the center of this picture is a regulated dot: the individual or
5930 group that is the target of regulation, or the holder of a right. (In
5931 each case throughout, we can describe this either as regulation or as
5932 a right. For simplicity's sake, I will speak only of regulations.)
5933 The ovals represent four ways in which the individual or group might
5934 be regulated&mdash; either constrained or, alternatively, enabled. Law
5935 is the most obvious constraint (to lawyers, at least). It constrains
5936 by threatening punishments after the fact if the rules set in advance
5937 are violated. So if, for example, you willfully infringe Madonna's
5938 copyright by copying a song from her latest CD and posting it on the
5939 Web, you can be punished
5940 <!-- PAGE BREAK 133 -->
5941 with a $150,000 fine. The fine is an ex post punishment for violating
5942 an ex ante rule. It is imposed by the state.
5943 <indexterm><primary>Madonna</primary></indexterm>
5944 </para>
5945 <para>
5946 Norms are a different kind of constraint. They, too, punish an
5947 individual for violating a rule. But the punishment of a norm is
5948 imposed by a community, not (or not only) by the state. There may be
5949 no law against spitting, but that doesn't mean you won't be punished
5950 if you spit on the ground while standing in line at a movie. The
5951 punishment might not be harsh, though depending upon the community, it
5952 could easily be more harsh than many of the punishments imposed by the
5953 state. The mark of the difference is not the severity of the rule, but
5954 the source of the enforcement.
5955 </para>
5956 <para>
5957 The market is a third type of constraint. Its constraint is effected
5958 through conditions: You can do X if you pay Y; you'll be paid M if you
5959 do N. These constraints are obviously not independent of law or
5960 norms&mdash;it is property law that defines what must be bought if it
5961 is to be taken legally; it is norms that say what is appropriately
5962 sold. But given a set of norms, and a background of property and
5963 contract law, the market imposes a simultaneous constraint upon how an
5964 individual or group might behave.
5965 </para>
5966 <para>
5967 Finally, and for the moment, perhaps, most mysteriously,
5968 "architecture"&mdash;the physical world as one finds it&mdash;is a
5969 constraint on behavior. A fallen bridge might constrain your ability
5970 to get across a river. Railroad tracks might constrain the ability of
5971 a community to integrate its social life. As with the market,
5972 architecture does not effect its constraint through ex post
5973 punishments. Instead, also as with the market, architecture effects
5974 its constraint through simultaneous conditions. These conditions are
5975 imposed not by courts enforcing contracts, or by police punishing
5976 theft, but by nature, by "architecture." If a 500-pound boulder
5977 blocks your way, it is the law of gravity that enforces this
5978 constraint. If a $500 airplane ticket stands between you and a flight
5979 to New York, it is the market that enforces this constraint.
5980 </para>
5981 <para>
5982
5983 <!-- PAGE BREAK 134 -->
5984 So the first point about these four modalities of regulation is
5985 obvious: They interact. Restrictions imposed by one might be
5986 reinforced by another. Or restrictions imposed by one might be
5987 undermined by another.
5988 </para>
5989 <para>
5990 The second point follows directly: If we want to understand the
5991 effective freedom that anyone has at a given moment to do any
5992 particular thing, we have to consider how these four modalities
5993 interact. Whether or not there are other constraints (there may well
5994 be; my claim is not about comprehensiveness), these four are among the
5995 most significant, and any regulator (whether controlling or freeing)
5996 must consider how these four in particular interact.
5997 </para>
5998 <indexterm id="idxdrivespeed" class='startofrange'>
5999 <primary>driving speed, constraints on</primary>
6000 </indexterm>
6001 <para>
6002 So, for example, consider the "freedom" to drive a car at a high
6003 speed. That freedom is in part restricted by laws: speed limits that
6004 say how fast you can drive in particular places at particular
6005 times. It is in part restricted by architecture: speed bumps, for
6006 example, slow most rational drivers; governors in buses, as another
6007 example, set the maximum rate at which the driver can drive. The
6008 freedom is in part restricted by the market: Fuel efficiency drops as
6009 speed increases, thus the price of gasoline indirectly constrains
6010 speed. And finally, the norms of a community may or may not constrain
6011 the freedom to speed. Drive at 50 mph by a school in your own
6012 neighborhood and you're likely to be punished by the neighbors. The
6013 same norm wouldn't be as effective in a different town, or at night.
6014 </para>
6015 <para>
6016 The final point about this simple model should also be fairly clear:
6017 While these four modalities are analytically independent, law has a
6018 special role in affecting the three.<footnote><para>
6019 <!-- f3 -->
6020 By describing the way law affects the other three modalities, I don't
6021 mean to suggest that the other three don't affect law. Obviously, they
6022 do. Law's only distinction is that it alone speaks as if it has a
6023 right self-consciously to change the other three. The right of the
6024 other three is more timidly expressed. See Lawrence Lessig, <citetitle>Code: And
6025 Other Laws of Cyberspace</citetitle> (New York: Basic Books, 1999): 90&ndash;95;
6026 Lawrence Lessig, "The New Chicago School," <citetitle>Journal of Legal Studies</citetitle>,
6027 June 1998.
6028 </para></footnote>
6029 The law, in other words, sometimes operates to increase or decrease
6030 the constraint of a particular modality. Thus, the law might be used
6031 to increase taxes on gasoline, so as to increase the incentives to
6032 drive more slowly. The law might be used to mandate more speed bumps,
6033 so as to increase the difficulty of driving rapidly. The law might be
6034 used to fund ads that stigmatize reckless driving. Or the law might be
6035 used to require that other laws be more
6036 <!-- PAGE BREAK 135 -->
6037 strict&mdash;a federal requirement that states decrease the speed
6038 limit, for example&mdash;so as to decrease the attractiveness of fast
6039 driving.
6040 </para>
6041 <indexterm startref="idxdrivespeed" class='endofrange'/>
6042
6043 <figure id="fig-1361">
6044 <title>Law has a special role in affecting the three.</title>
6045 <graphic fileref="images/1361.png"></graphic>
6046 </figure>
6047 <para>
6048 These constraints can thus change, and they can be changed. To
6049 understand the effective protection of liberty or protection of
6050 property at any particular moment, we must track these changes over
6051 time. A restriction imposed by one modality might be erased by
6052 another. A freedom enabled by one modality might be displaced by
6053 another.<footnote>
6054 <para>
6055 <!-- f4 -->
6056 Some people object to this way of talking about "liberty." They object
6057 because their focus when considering the constraints that exist at any
6058 particular moment are constraints imposed exclusively by the
6059 government. For instance, if a storm destroys a bridge, these people
6060 think it is meaningless to say that one's liberty has been
6061 restrained. A bridge has washed out, and it's harder to get from one
6062 place to another. To talk about this as a loss of freedom, they say,
6063 is to confuse the stuff of politics with the vagaries of ordinary
6064 life. I don't mean to deny the value in this narrower view, which
6065 depends upon the context of the inquiry. I do, however, mean to argue
6066 against any insistence that this narrower view is the only proper view
6067 of liberty. As I argued in <citetitle>Code</citetitle>, we come from a long tradition of
6068 political thought with a broader focus than the narrow question of
6069 what the government did when. John Stuart Mill defended freedom of
6070 speech, for example, from the tyranny of narrow minds, not from the
6071 fear of government prosecution; John Stuart Mill, <citetitle>On Liberty</citetitle> (Indiana:
6072 Hackett Publishing Co., 1978), 19. John R. Commons famously defended
6073 the economic freedom of labor from constraints imposed by the market;
6074 John R. Commons, "The Right to Work," in Malcom Rutherford and Warren
6075 J. Samuels, eds., <citetitle>John R. Commons: Selected Essays</citetitle> (London:
6076 Routledge: 1997), 62. The Americans with Disabilities Act increases
6077 the liberty of people with physical disabilities by changing the
6078 architecture of certain public places, thereby making access to those
6079 places easier; 42 <citetitle>United States Code</citetitle>, section 12101 (2000). Each of
6080 these interventions to change existing conditions changes the liberty
6081 of a particular group. The effect of those interventions should be
6082 accounted for in order to understand the effective liberty that each
6083 of these groups might face.
6084 <indexterm><primary>Commons, John R.</primary></indexterm>
6085 </para></footnote>
6086 </para>
6087 <section id="hollywood">
6088 <title>Why Hollywood Is Right</title>
6089 <para>
6090 The most obvious point that this model reveals is just why, or just
6091 how, Hollywood is right. The copyright warriors have rallied Congress
6092 and the courts to defend copyright. This model helps us see why that
6093 rallying makes sense.
6094 </para>
6095 <para>
6096 Let's say this is the picture of copyright's regulation before the
6097 Internet:
6098 </para>
6099 <figure id="fig-1371">
6100 <title>Copyright's regulation before the Internet.</title>
6101 <graphic fileref="images/1331.png"></graphic>
6102 </figure>
6103 <para>
6104 <!-- PAGE BREAK 136 -->
6105 There is balance between law, norms, market, and architecture. The law
6106 limits the ability to copy and share content, by imposing penalties on
6107 those who copy and share content. Those penalties are reinforced by
6108 technologies that make it hard to copy and share content
6109 (architecture) and expensive to copy and share content
6110 (market). Finally, those penalties are mitigated by norms we all
6111 recognize&mdash;kids, for example, taping other kids' records. These
6112 uses of copyrighted material may well be infringement, but the norms
6113 of our society (before the Internet, at least) had no problem with
6114 this form of infringement.
6115 </para>
6116 <para>
6117 Enter the Internet, or, more precisely, technologies such as MP3s and
6118 p2p sharing. Now the constraint of architecture changes dramatically,
6119 as does the constraint of the market. And as both the market and
6120 architecture relax the regulation of copyright, norms pile on. The
6121 happy balance (for the warriors, at least) of life before the Internet
6122 becomes an effective state of anarchy after the Internet.
6123 </para>
6124 <para>
6125 Thus the sense of, and justification for, the warriors' response.
6126 Technology has changed, the warriors say, and the effect of this
6127 change, when ramified through the market and norms, is that a balance
6128 of protection for the copyright owners' rights has been lost. This is
6129 Iraq
6130 <!-- PAGE BREAK 137 -->
6131 after the fall of Saddam, but this time no government is justifying the
6132 looting that results.
6133 </para>
6134 <figure id="fig-1381">
6135 <title>effective state of anarchy after the Internet.</title>
6136 <graphic fileref="images/1381.png"></graphic>
6137 </figure>
6138 <para>
6139 Neither this analysis nor the conclusions that follow are new to the
6140 warriors. Indeed, in a "White Paper" prepared by the Commerce
6141 Department (one heavily influenced by the copyright warriors) in 1995,
6142 this mix of regulatory modalities had already been identified and the
6143 strategy to respond already mapped. In response to the changes the
6144 Internet had effected, the White Paper argued (1) Congress should
6145 strengthen intellectual property law, (2) businesses should adopt
6146 innovative marketing techniques, (3) technologists should push to
6147 develop code to protect copyrighted material, and (4) educators should
6148 educate kids to better protect copyright.
6149 </para>
6150 <para>
6151 This mixed strategy is just what copyright needed&mdash;if it was to
6152 preserve the particular balance that existed before the change induced
6153 by the Internet. And it's just what we should expect the content
6154 industry to push for. It is as American as apple pie to consider the
6155 happy life you have as an entitlement, and to look to the law to
6156 protect it if something comes along to change that happy
6157 life. Homeowners living in a
6158
6159 <!-- PAGE BREAK 138 -->
6160 flood plain have no hesitation appealing to the government to rebuild
6161 (and rebuild again) when a flood (architecture) wipes away their
6162 property (law). Farmers have no hesitation appealing to the government
6163 to bail them out when a virus (architecture) devastates their
6164 crop. Unions have no hesitation appealing to the government to bail
6165 them out when imports (market) wipe out the U.S. steel industry.
6166 </para>
6167 <para>
6168 Thus, there's nothing wrong or surprising in the content industry's
6169 campaign to protect itself from the harmful consequences of a
6170 technological innovation. And I would be the last person to argue that
6171 the changing technology of the Internet has not had a profound effect
6172 on the content industry's way of doing business, or as John Seely
6173 Brown describes it, its "architecture of revenue."
6174 </para>
6175 <para>
6176 But just because a particular interest asks for government support, it
6177 doesn't follow that support should be granted. And just because
6178 technology has weakened a particular way of doing business, it doesn't
6179 follow that the government should intervene to support that old way of
6180 doing business. Kodak, for example, has lost perhaps as much as 20
6181 percent of their traditional film market to the emerging technologies
6182 of digital cameras.<footnote><para>
6183 <!-- f5 -->
6184 See Geoffrey Smith, "Film vs. Digital: Can Kodak Build a Bridge?"
6185 BusinessWeek online, 2 August 1999, available at
6186 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #23</ulink>. For a more
6187 recent analysis of Kodak's place in the market, see Chana
6188 R. Schoenberger, "Can Kodak Make Up for Lost Moments?" Forbes.com, 6
6189 October 2003, available at
6190 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #24</ulink>.
6191 </para></footnote>
6192
6193 Does anyone believe the government should ban digital cameras just to
6194 support Kodak? Highways have weakened the freight business for
6195 railroads. Does anyone think we should ban trucks from roads
6196 <emphasis>for the purpose of</emphasis> protecting the railroads?
6197 Closer to the subject of this book, remote channel changers have
6198 weakened the "stickiness" of television advertising (if a boring
6199 commercial comes on the TV, the remote makes it easy to surf ), and it
6200 may well be that this change has weakened the television advertising
6201 market. But does anyone believe we should regulate remotes to
6202 reinforce commercial television? (Maybe by limiting them to function
6203 only once a second, or to switch to only ten channels within an hour?)
6204 </para>
6205 <para>
6206 The obvious answer to these obviously rhetorical questions is no.
6207 In a free society, with a free market, supported by free enterprise and
6208 free trade, the government's role is not to support one way of doing
6209 <!-- PAGE BREAK 139 -->
6210 business against others. Its role is not to pick winners and protect
6211 them against loss. If the government did this generally, then we would
6212 never have any progress. As Microsoft chairman Bill Gates wrote in
6213 1991, in a memo criticizing software patents, "established companies
6214 have an interest in excluding future competitors."<footnote><para>
6215 <!-- f6 -->
6216 Fred Warshofsky, <citetitle>The Patent Wars</citetitle> (New York: Wiley, 1994), 170&ndash;71.
6217 </para></footnote>
6218 And relative to a
6219 startup, established companies also have the means. (Think RCA and
6220 FM radio.) A world in which competitors with new ideas must fight
6221 not only the market but also the government is a world in which
6222 competitors with new ideas will not succeed. It is a world of stasis and
6223 increasingly concentrated stagnation. It is the Soviet Union under
6224 Brezhnev.
6225 <indexterm><primary>Gates, Bill</primary></indexterm>
6226 </para>
6227 <para>
6228 Thus, while it is understandable for industries threatened with new
6229 technologies that change the way they do business to look to the
6230 government for protection, it is the special duty of policy makers to
6231 guarantee that that protection not become a deterrent to progress. It
6232 is the duty of policy makers, in other words, to assure that the
6233 changes they create, in response to the request of those hurt by
6234 changing technology, are changes that preserve the incentives and
6235 opportunities for innovation and change.
6236 </para>
6237 <para>
6238 In the context of laws regulating speech&mdash;which include,
6239 obviously, copyright law&mdash;that duty is even stronger. When the
6240 industry complaining about changing technologies is asking Congress to
6241 respond in a way that burdens speech and creativity, policy makers
6242 should be especially wary of the request. It is always a bad deal for
6243 the government to get into the business of regulating speech
6244 markets. The risks and dangers of that game are precisely why our
6245 framers created the First Amendment to our Constitution: "Congress
6246 shall make no law . . . abridging the freedom of speech." So when
6247 Congress is being asked to pass laws that would "abridge" the freedom
6248 of speech, it should ask&mdash; carefully&mdash;whether such
6249 regulation is justified.
6250 </para>
6251 <para>
6252 My argument just now, however, has nothing to do with whether
6253 <!-- PAGE BREAK 140 -->
6254 the changes that are being pushed by the copyright warriors are
6255 "justified." My argument is about their effect. For before we get to
6256 the question of justification, a hard question that depends a great
6257 deal upon your values, we should first ask whether we understand the
6258 effect of the changes the content industry wants.
6259 </para>
6260 <para>
6261 Here's the metaphor that will capture the argument to follow.
6262 </para>
6263 <indexterm id="idxddt" class='startofrange'>
6264 <primary>DDT</primary>
6265 </indexterm>
6266 <para>
6267 In 1873, the chemical DDT was first synthesized. In 1948, Swiss
6268 chemist Paul Hermann Müller won the Nobel Prize for his work
6269 demonstrating the insecticidal properties of DDT. By the 1950s, the
6270 insecticide was widely used around the world to kill disease-carrying
6271 pests. It was also used to increase farm production.
6272 <indexterm><primary>Müller, Paul Hermann</primary></indexterm>
6273 </para>
6274 <para>
6275 No one doubts that killing disease-carrying pests or increasing crop
6276 production is a good thing. No one doubts that the work of Müller was
6277 important and valuable and probably saved lives, possibly millions.
6278 </para>
6279 <indexterm><primary>Carson, Rachel</primary></indexterm>
6280 <para>
6281 But in 1962, Rachel Carson published <citetitle>Silent Spring</citetitle>, which argued that
6282 DDT, whatever its primary benefits, was also having unintended
6283 environmental consequences. Birds were losing the ability to
6284 reproduce. Whole chains of the ecology were being destroyed.
6285 <indexterm><primary>Carson, Rachel</primary></indexterm>
6286 <indexterm><primary>Silent Sprint (Carson)</primary></indexterm>
6287 </para>
6288 <para>
6289 No one set out to destroy the environment. Paul Müller certainly did
6290 not aim to harm any birds. But the effort to solve one set of problems
6291 produced another set which, in the view of some, was far worse than
6292 the problems that were originally attacked. Or more accurately, the
6293 problems DDT caused were worse than the problems it solved, at least
6294 when considering the other, more environmentally friendly ways to
6295 solve the problems that DDT was meant to solve.
6296 </para>
6297 <para>
6298 It is to this image precisely that Duke University law professor James
6299 Boyle appeals when he argues that we need an "environmentalism" for
6300 culture.<footnote><para>
6301 <!-- f7 -->
6302 See, for example, James Boyle, "A Politics of Intellectual Property:
6303 Environmentalism for the Net?" <citetitle>Duke Law Journal</citetitle> 47 (1997): 87.
6304 </para></footnote>
6305 His point, and the point I want to develop in the balance of this
6306 chapter, is not that the aims of copyright are flawed. Or that authors
6307 should not be paid for their work. Or that music should be given away
6308 "for free." The point is that some of the ways in which we might
6309 protect authors will have unintended consequences for the cultural
6310 environment, much like DDT had for the natural environment. And just
6311 <!-- PAGE BREAK 141 -->
6312 as criticism of DDT is not an endorsement of malaria or an attack on
6313 farmers, so, too, is criticism of one particular set of regulations
6314 protecting copyright not an endorsement of anarchy or an attack on
6315 authors. It is an environment of creativity that we seek, and we
6316 should be aware of our actions' effects on the environment.
6317 </para>
6318 <para>
6319 My argument, in the balance of this chapter, tries to map exactly
6320 this effect. No doubt the technology of the Internet has had a dramatic
6321 effect on the ability of copyright owners to protect their content. But
6322 there should also be little doubt that when you add together the
6323 changes in copyright law over time, plus the change in technology that
6324 the Internet is undergoing just now, the net effect of these changes will
6325 not be only that copyrighted work is effectively protected. Also, and
6326 generally missed, the net effect of this massive increase in protection
6327 will be devastating to the environment for creativity.
6328 </para>
6329 <para>
6330 In a line: To kill a gnat, we are spraying DDT with consequences
6331 for free culture that will be far more devastating than that this gnat will
6332 be lost.
6333 </para>
6334 <indexterm startref="idxddt" class='endofrange'/>
6335 </section>
6336 <section id="beginnings">
6337 <title>Beginnings</title>
6338 <para>
6339 America copied English copyright law. Actually, we copied and improved
6340 English copyright law. Our Constitution makes the purpose of "creative
6341 property" rights clear; its express limitations reinforce the English
6342 aim to avoid overly powerful publishers.
6343 </para>
6344 <para>
6345 The power to establish "creative property" rights is granted to
6346 Congress in a way that, for our Constitution, at least, is very
6347 odd. Article I, section 8, clause 8 of our Constitution states that:
6348 </para>
6349 <para>
6350 Congress has the power to promote the Progress of Science and
6351 useful Arts, by securing for limited Times to Authors and Inventors
6352 the exclusive Right to their respective Writings and Discoveries.
6353
6354 <!-- PAGE BREAK 142 -->
6355 We can call this the "Progress Clause," for notice what this clause
6356 does not say. It does not say Congress has the power to grant
6357 "creative property rights." It says that Congress has the power
6358 <emphasis>to promote progress</emphasis>. The grant of power is its
6359 purpose, and its purpose is a public one, not the purpose of enriching
6360 publishers, nor even primarily the purpose of rewarding authors.
6361 </para>
6362 <para>
6363 The Progress Clause expressly limits the term of copyrights. As we saw
6364 in chapter 6, the English limited the term of copyright so as to
6365 assure that a few would not exercise disproportionate control over
6366 culture by exercising disproportionate control over publishing. We can
6367 assume the framers followed the English for a similar purpose. Indeed,
6368 unlike the English, the framers reinforced that objective, by
6369 requiring that copyrights extend "to Authors" only.
6370 </para>
6371 <para>
6372 The design of the Progress Clause reflects something about the
6373 Constitution's design in general. To avoid a problem, the framers
6374 built structure. To prevent the concentrated power of publishers, they
6375 built a structure that kept copyrights away from publishers and kept
6376 them short. To prevent the concentrated power of a church, they banned
6377 the federal government from establishing a church. To prevent
6378 concentrating power in the federal government, they built structures
6379 to reinforce the power of the states&mdash;including the Senate, whose
6380 members were at the time selected by the states, and an electoral
6381 college, also selected by the states, to select the president. In each
6382 case, a <emphasis>structure</emphasis> built checks and balances into
6383 the constitutional frame, structured to prevent otherwise inevitable
6384 concentrations of power.
6385 </para>
6386 <para>
6387 I doubt the framers would recognize the regulation we call "copyright"
6388 today. The scope of that regulation is far beyond anything they ever
6389 considered. To begin to understand what they did, we need to put our
6390 "copyright" in context: We need to see how it has changed in the 210
6391 years since they first struck its design.
6392 </para>
6393 <para>
6394 Some of these changes come from the law: some in light of changes
6395 in technology, and some in light of changes in technology given a
6396 <!-- PAGE BREAK 143 -->
6397 particular concentration of market power. In terms of our model, we
6398 started here:
6399 </para>
6400 <figure id="fig-1441">
6401 <title>Copyright's regulation before the Internet.</title>
6402 <graphic fileref="images/1331.png"></graphic>
6403 </figure>
6404 <para>
6405 We will end here:
6406 </para>
6407 <figure id="fig-1442">
6408 <title>&quot;Copyright&quot; today.</title>
6409 <graphic fileref="images/1442.png"></graphic>
6410 </figure>
6411 <para>
6412 Let me explain how.
6413 <!-- PAGE BREAK 144 -->
6414 </para>
6415 </section>
6416 <section id="lawduration">
6417 <title>Law: Duration</title>
6418 <para>
6419 When the first Congress enacted laws to protect creative property, it
6420 faced the same uncertainty about the status of creative property that
6421 the English had confronted in 1774. Many states had passed laws
6422 protecting creative property, and some believed that these laws simply
6423 supplemented common law rights that already protected creative
6424 authorship.<footnote>
6425 <para>
6426 <!-- f8 -->
6427 William W. Crosskey, <citetitle>Politics and the Constitution in the History of
6428 the United States</citetitle> (London: Cambridge University Press, 1953), vol. 1,
6429 485&ndash;86: "extinguish[ing], by plain implication of `the supreme
6430 Law of the Land,' <emphasis>the perpetual rights which authors had, or
6431 were supposed by some to have, under the Common Law</emphasis>"
6432 (emphasis added).
6433 <indexterm><primary>Crosskey, William W.</primary></indexterm>
6434 </para></footnote>
6435 This meant that there was no guaranteed public domain in the United
6436 States in 1790. If copyrights were protected by the common law, then
6437 there was no simple way to know whether a work published in the United
6438 States was controlled or free. Just as in England, this lingering
6439 uncertainty would make it hard for publishers to rely upon a public
6440 domain to reprint and distribute works.
6441 </para>
6442 <para>
6443 That uncertainty ended after Congress passed legislation granting
6444 copyrights. Because federal law overrides any contrary state law,
6445 federal protections for copyrighted works displaced any state law
6446 protections. Just as in England the Statute of Anne eventually meant
6447 that the copyrights for all English works expired, a federal statute
6448 meant that any state copyrights expired as well.
6449 </para>
6450 <para>
6451 In 1790, Congress enacted the first copyright law. It created a
6452 federal copyright and secured that copyright for fourteen years. If
6453 the author was alive at the end of that fourteen years, then he could
6454 opt to renew the copyright for another fourteen years. If he did not
6455 renew the copyright, his work passed into the public domain.
6456 </para>
6457 <para>
6458 While there were many works created in the United States in the first
6459 ten years of the Republic, only 5 percent of the works were actually
6460 registered under the federal copyright regime. Of all the work created
6461 in the United States both before 1790 and from 1790 through 1800, 95
6462 percent immediately passed into the public domain; the balance would
6463 pass into the pubic domain within twenty-eight years at most, and more
6464 likely within fourteen years.<footnote><para>
6465 <!-- f9 -->
6466 Although 13,000 titles were published in the United States from 1790
6467 to 1799, only 556 copyright registrations were filed; John Tebbel, <citetitle>A
6468 History of Book Publishing in the United States</citetitle>, vol. 1, <citetitle>The Creation
6469 of an Industry, 1630&ndash;1865</citetitle> (New York: Bowker, 1972), 141. Of the 21,000
6470 imprints recorded before 1790, only twelve were copyrighted under the
6471 1790 act; William J. Maher, <citetitle>Copyright Term, Retrospective Extension
6472 and the Copyright Law of 1790 in Historical Context</citetitle>, 7&ndash;10 (2002),
6473 available at <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
6474 #25</ulink>. Thus, the overwhelming majority of works fell
6475 immediately into the public domain. Even those works that were
6476 copyrighted fell into the public domain quickly, because the term of
6477 copyright was short. The initial term of copyright was fourteen years,
6478 with the option of renewal for an additional fourteen years. Copyright
6479 Act of May 31, 1790, §1, 1 stat. 124. </para></footnote>
6480 </para>
6481 <para>
6482 This system of renewal was a crucial part of the American system
6483 of copyright. It assured that the maximum terms of copyright would be
6484 <!-- PAGE BREAK 145 -->
6485 granted only for works where they were wanted. After the initial term
6486 of fourteen years, if it wasn't worth it to an author to renew his
6487 copyright, then it wasn't worth it to society to insist on the
6488 copyright, either.
6489 </para>
6490 <para>
6491 Fourteen years may not seem long to us, but for the vast majority of
6492 copyright owners at that time, it was long enough: Only a small
6493 minority of them renewed their copyright after fourteen years; the
6494 balance allowed their work to pass into the public
6495 domain.<footnote><para>
6496 <!-- f10 -->
6497 Few copyright holders ever chose to renew their copyrights. For
6498 instance, of the 25,006 copyrights registered in 1883, only 894 were
6499 renewed in 1910. For a year-by-year analysis of copyright renewal
6500 rates, see Barbara A. Ringer, "Study No. 31: Renewal of Copyright,"
6501 <citetitle>Studies on Copyright</citetitle>, vol. 1 (New York: Practicing Law Institute,
6502 1963), 618. For a more recent and comprehensive analysis, see William
6503 M. Landes and Richard A. Posner, "Indefinitely Renewable Copyright,"
6504 <citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review</citetitle> 70 (2003): 471, 498&ndash;501, and
6505 accompanying figures. </para></footnote>
6506 </para>
6507 <para>
6508 Even today, this structure would make sense. Most creative work
6509 has an actual commercial life of just a couple of years. Most books fall
6510 out of print after one year.<footnote><para>
6511 <!-- f11 -->
6512 See Ringer, ch. 9, n. 2. </para></footnote> When that happens, the
6513 used books are traded free of copyright regulation. Thus the books are
6514 no longer <emphasis>effectively</emphasis> controlled by
6515 copyright. The only practical commercial use of the books at that time
6516 is to sell the books as used books; that use&mdash;because it does not
6517 involve publication&mdash;is effectively free.
6518 </para>
6519 <para>
6520 In the first hundred years of the Republic, the term of copyright was
6521 changed once. In 1831, the term was increased from a maximum of 28
6522 years to a maximum of 42 by increasing the initial term of copyright
6523 from 14 years to 28 years. In the next fifty years of the Republic,
6524 the term increased once again. In 1909, Congress extended the renewal
6525 term of 14 years to 28 years, setting a maximum term of 56 years.
6526 </para>
6527 <para>
6528 Then, beginning in 1962, Congress started a practice that has defined
6529 copyright law since. Eleven times in the last forty years, Congress
6530 has extended the terms of existing copyrights; twice in those forty
6531 years, Congress extended the term of future copyrights. Initially, the
6532 extensions of existing copyrights were short, a mere one to two years.
6533 In 1976, Congress extended all existing copyrights by nineteen years.
6534 And in 1998, in the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act, Congress
6535 extended the term of existing and future copyrights by twenty years.
6536 </para>
6537 <para>
6538 The effect of these extensions is simply to toll, or delay, the passing
6539 of works into the public domain. This latest extension means that the
6540 public domain will have been tolled for thirty-nine out of fifty-five
6541 years, or 70 percent of the time since 1962. Thus, in the twenty years
6542
6543 <!-- PAGE BREAK 146 -->
6544 after the Sonny Bono Act, while one million patents will pass into the
6545 public domain, zero copyrights will pass into the public domain by virtue
6546 of the expiration of a copyright term.
6547 </para>
6548 <para>
6549 The effect of these extensions has been exacerbated by another,
6550 little-noticed change in the copyright law. Remember I said that the
6551 framers established a two-part copyright regime, requiring a copyright
6552 owner to renew his copyright after an initial term. The requirement of
6553 renewal meant that works that no longer needed copyright protection
6554 would pass more quickly into the public domain. The works remaining
6555 under protection would be those that had some continuing commercial
6556 value.
6557 </para>
6558 <para>
6559 The United States abandoned this sensible system in 1976. For
6560 all works created after 1978, there was only one copyright term&mdash;the
6561 maximum term. For "natural" authors, that term was life plus fifty
6562 years. For corporations, the term was seventy-five years. Then, in 1992,
6563 Congress abandoned the renewal requirement for all works created
6564 before 1978. All works still under copyright would be accorded the
6565 maximum term then available. After the Sonny Bono Act, that term
6566 was ninety-five years.
6567 </para>
6568 <para>
6569 This change meant that American law no longer had an automatic way to
6570 assure that works that were no longer exploited passed into the public
6571 domain. And indeed, after these changes, it is unclear whether it is
6572 even possible to put works into the public domain. The public domain
6573 is orphaned by these changes in copyright law. Despite the requirement
6574 that terms be "limited," we have no evidence that anything will limit
6575 them.
6576 </para>
6577 <para>
6578 The effect of these changes on the average duration of copyright is
6579 dramatic. In 1973, more than 85 percent of copyright owners failed to
6580 renew their copyright. That meant that the average term of copyright
6581 in 1973 was just 32.2 years. Because of the elimination of the renewal
6582 requirement, the average term of copyright is now the maximum term.
6583 In thirty years, then, the average term has tripled, from 32.2 years to 95
6584 years.<footnote><para>
6585 <!-- f12 -->
6586 These statistics are understated. Between the years 1910 and 1962 (the
6587 first year the renewal term was extended), the average term was never
6588 more than thirty-two years, and averaged thirty years. See Landes and
6589 Posner, "Indefinitely Renewable Copyright," loc. cit.
6590 </para></footnote>
6591 </para>
6592 <!-- PAGE BREAK 147 -->
6593 </section>
6594 <section id="lawscope">
6595 <title>Law: Scope</title>
6596 <para>
6597 The "scope" of a copyright is the range of rights granted by the law.
6598 The scope of American copyright has changed dramatically. Those
6599 changes are not necessarily bad. But we should understand the extent
6600 of the changes if we're to keep this debate in context.
6601 </para>
6602 <para>
6603 In 1790, that scope was very narrow. Copyright covered only "maps,
6604 charts, and books." That means it didn't cover, for example, music or
6605 architecture. More significantly, the right granted by a copyright gave
6606 the author the exclusive right to "publish" copyrighted works. That
6607 means someone else violated the copyright only if he republished the
6608 work without the copyright owner's permission. Finally, the right granted
6609 by a copyright was an exclusive right to that particular book. The right
6610 did not extend to what lawyers call "derivative works." It would not,
6611 therefore, interfere with the right of someone other than the author to
6612 translate a copyrighted book, or to adapt the story to a different form
6613 (such as a drama based on a published book).
6614 </para>
6615 <para>
6616 This, too, has changed dramatically. While the contours of copyright
6617 today are extremely hard to describe simply, in general terms, the
6618 right covers practically any creative work that is reduced to a
6619 tangible form. It covers music as well as architecture, drama as well
6620 as computer programs. It gives the copyright owner of that creative
6621 work not only the exclusive right to "publish" the work, but also the
6622 exclusive right of control over any "copies" of that work. And most
6623 significant for our purposes here, the right gives the copyright owner
6624 control over not only his or her particular work, but also any
6625 "derivative work" that might grow out of the original work. In this
6626 way, the right covers more creative work, protects the creative work
6627 more broadly, and protects works that are based in a significant way
6628 on the initial creative work.
6629 </para>
6630 <para>
6631 At the same time that the scope of copyright has expanded, procedural
6632 limitations on the right have been relaxed. I've already described the
6633 complete removal of the renewal requirement in 1992. In addition
6634 <!-- PAGE BREAK 148 -->
6635 to the renewal requirement, for most of the history of American
6636 copyright law, there was a requirement that a work be registered
6637 before it could receive the protection of a copyright. There was also
6638 a requirement that any copyrighted work be marked either with that
6639 famous &copy; or the word <emphasis>copyright</emphasis>. And for most
6640 of the history of American copyright law, there was a requirement that
6641 works be deposited with the government before a copyright could be
6642 secured.
6643 </para>
6644 <para>
6645 The reason for the registration requirement was the sensible
6646 understanding that for most works, no copyright was required. Again,
6647 in the first ten years of the Republic, 95 percent of works eligible
6648 for copyright were never copyrighted. Thus, the rule reflected the
6649 norm: Most works apparently didn't need copyright, so registration
6650 narrowed the regulation of the law to the few that did. The same
6651 reasoning justified the requirement that a work be marked as
6652 copyrighted&mdash;that way it was easy to know whether a copyright was
6653 being claimed. The requirement that works be deposited was to assure
6654 that after the copyright expired, there would be a copy of the work
6655 somewhere so that it could be copied by others without locating the
6656 original author.
6657 </para>
6658 <para>
6659 All of these "formalities" were abolished in the American system when
6660 we decided to follow European copyright law. There is no requirement
6661 that you register a work to get a copyright; the copyright now is
6662 automatic; the copyright exists whether or not you mark your work with
6663 a &copy;; and the copyright exists whether or not you actually make a
6664 copy available for others to copy.
6665 </para>
6666 <para>
6667 Consider a practical example to understand the scope of these
6668 differences.
6669 </para>
6670 <para>
6671 If, in 1790, you wrote a book and you were one of the 5 percent who
6672 actually copyrighted that book, then the copyright law protected you
6673 against another publisher's taking your book and republishing it
6674 without your permission. The aim of the act was to regulate publishers
6675 so as to prevent that kind of unfair competition. In 1790, there were
6676 174 publishers in the United States.<footnote><para>
6677 <!-- f13 -->
6678 See Thomas Bender and David Sampliner, "Poets, Pirates, and the
6679 Creation of American Literature," 29 <citetitle>New York University Journal of
6680 International Law and Politics</citetitle> 255 (1997), and James Gilraeth, ed.,
6681 Federal Copyright Records, 1790&ndash;1800 (U.S. G.P.O., 1987).
6682
6683 </para></footnote>
6684 The Copyright Act was thus a tiny
6685 regulation of a tiny proportion of a tiny part of the creative market in
6686 the United States&mdash;publishers.
6687 </para>
6688 <para>
6689 <!-- PAGE BREAK 149 -->
6690 The act left other creators totally unregulated. If I copied your poem
6691 by hand, over and over again, as a way to learn it by heart, my act
6692 was totally unregulated by the 1790 act. If I took your novel and made
6693 a play based upon it, or if I translated it or abridged it, none of
6694 those activities were regulated by the original copyright act. These
6695 creative activities remained free, while the activities of publishers
6696 were restrained.
6697 </para>
6698 <para>
6699 Today the story is very different: If you write a book, your book is
6700 automatically protected. Indeed, not just your book. Every e-mail,
6701 every note to your spouse, every doodle, <emphasis>every</emphasis>
6702 creative act that's reduced to a tangible form&mdash;all of this is
6703 automatically copyrighted. There is no need to register or mark your
6704 work. The protection follows the creation, not the steps you take to
6705 protect it.
6706 </para>
6707 <para>
6708 That protection gives you the right (subject to a narrow range of
6709 fair use exceptions) to control how others copy the work, whether they
6710 copy it to republish it or to share an excerpt.
6711 </para>
6712 <para>
6713 That much is the obvious part. Any system of copyright would
6714 control
6715 competing publishing. But there's a second part to the copyright of
6716 today that is not at all obvious. This is the protection of "derivative
6717 rights." If you write a book, no one can make a movie out of your
6718 book without permission. No one can translate it without permission.
6719 CliffsNotes can't make an abridgment unless permission is granted. All
6720 of these derivative uses of your original work are controlled by the
6721 copyright holder. The copyright, in other words, is now not just an
6722 exclusive
6723 right to your writings, but an exclusive right to your writings
6724 and a large proportion of the writings inspired by them.
6725 </para>
6726 <para>
6727 It is this derivative right that would seem most bizarre to our
6728 framers, though it has become second nature to us. Initially, this
6729 expansion
6730 was created to deal with obvious evasions of a narrower
6731 copyright.
6732 If I write a book, can you change one word and then claim a
6733 copyright in a new and different book? Obviously that would make a
6734 joke of the copyright, so the law was properly expanded to include
6735 those slight modifications as well as the verbatim original work.
6736 </para>
6737 <para>
6738 <!-- PAGE BREAK 150 -->
6739 In preventing that joke, the law created an astonishing power
6740 within a free culture&mdash;at least, it's astonishing when you
6741 understand that the law applies not just to the commercial publisher
6742 but to anyone with a computer. I understand the wrong in duplicating
6743 and selling someone else's work. But whatever
6744 <emphasis>that</emphasis> wrong is, transforming someone else's work
6745 is a different wrong. Some view transformation as no wrong at
6746 all&mdash;they believe that our law, as the framers penned it, should
6747 not protect derivative rights at all.<footnote><para>
6748 <!-- f14 -->
6749 Jonathan Zittrain, "The Copyright Cage," <citetitle>Legal Affairs</citetitle>, July/August
6750 2003, available at
6751 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #26</ulink>.
6752 <indexterm><primary>Zittrain, Jonathan</primary></indexterm>
6753 </para></footnote>
6754 Whether or not you go that far, it seems
6755 plain that whatever wrong is involved is fundamentally different from
6756 the wrong of direct piracy.
6757 </para>
6758 <para>
6759 Yet copyright law treats these two different wrongs in the same way. I
6760 can go to court and get an injunction against your pirating my book. I
6761 can go to court and get an injunction against your transformative use
6762 of my book.<footnote><para>
6763 <!-- f15 -->
6764 Professor Rubenfeld has presented a powerful constitutional argument
6765 about the difference that copyright law should draw (from the
6766 perspective of the First Amendment) between mere "copies" and
6767 derivative works. See Jed Rubenfeld, "The Freedom of Imagination:
6768 Copyright's Constitutionality," <citetitle>Yale Law Journal</citetitle> 112 (2002):
6769 1&ndash;60 (see especially pp. 53&ndash;59).
6770 </para></footnote>
6771 These two different uses of my creative work are
6772 treated the same.
6773 </para>
6774 <para>
6775 This again may seem right to you. If I wrote a book, then why
6776 should you be able to write a movie that takes my story and makes
6777 money from it without paying me or crediting me? Or if Disney
6778 creates
6779 a creature called "Mickey Mouse," why should you be able to make
6780 Mickey Mouse toys and be the one to trade on the value that Disney
6781 originally created?
6782 </para>
6783 <para>
6784 These are good arguments, and, in general, my point is not that the
6785 derivative right is unjustified. My aim just now is much narrower:
6786 simply
6787 to make clear that this expansion is a significant change from the
6788 rights originally granted.
6789 </para>
6790 </section>
6791 <section id="lawreach">
6792 <title>Law and Architecture: Reach</title>
6793 <para>
6794 Whereas originally the law regulated only publishers, the change in
6795 copyright's scope means that the law today regulates publishers, users,
6796 and authors. It regulates them because all three are capable of making
6797 copies, and the core of the regulation of copyright law is copies.<footnote><para>
6798 <!-- f16 -->
6799 This is a simplification of the law, but not much of one. The law
6800 certainly regulates more than "copies"&mdash;a public performance of a
6801 copyrighted song, for example, is regulated even though performance
6802 per se doesn't make a copy; 17 <citetitle>United States Code</citetitle>, section
6803 106(4). And it certainly sometimes doesn't regulate a "copy"; 17
6804 <citetitle>United States Code</citetitle>, section 112(a). But the presumption under the
6805 existing law (which regulates "copies;" 17 <citetitle>United States Code</citetitle>, section
6806 102) is that if there is a copy, there is a right.
6807 </para></footnote>
6808 </para>
6809 <para>
6810 <!-- PAGE BREAK 151 -->
6811 "Copies." That certainly sounds like the obvious thing for
6812 <emphasis>copy</emphasis>right law to regulate. But as with Jack
6813 Valenti's argument at the start of this chapter, that "creative
6814 property" deserves the "same rights" as all other property, it is the
6815 <emphasis>obvious</emphasis> that we need to be most careful
6816 about. For while it may be obvious that in the world before the
6817 Internet, copies were the obvious trigger for copyright law, upon
6818 reflection, it should be obvious that in the world with the Internet,
6819 copies should <emphasis>not</emphasis> be the trigger for copyright
6820 law. More precisely, they should not <emphasis>always</emphasis> be
6821 the trigger for copyright law.
6822 </para>
6823 <para>
6824 This is perhaps the central claim of this book, so let me take this
6825 very slowly so that the point is not easily missed. My claim is that the
6826 Internet should at least force us to rethink the conditions under which
6827 the law of copyright automatically applies,<footnote><para>
6828 <!-- f17 -->
6829 Thus, my argument is not that in each place that copyright law extends,
6830 we should repeal it. It is instead that we should have a good argument for
6831 its extending where it does, and should not determine its reach on the
6832 basis
6833 of arbitrary and automatic changes caused by technology.
6834 </para></footnote>
6835 because it is clear that the
6836 current reach of copyright was never contemplated, much less chosen,
6837 by the legislators who enacted copyright law.
6838 </para>
6839 <para>
6840 We can see this point abstractly by beginning with this largely
6841 empty circle.
6842 </para>
6843 <figure id="fig-1521">
6844 <title>All potential uses of a book.</title>
6845 <graphic fileref="images/1521.png"></graphic>
6846 </figure>
6847 <para>
6848 <!-- PAGE BREAK 152 -->
6849 Think about a book in real space, and imagine this circle to represent
6850 all its potential <emphasis>uses</emphasis>. Most of these uses are
6851 unregulated by copyright law, because the uses don't create a copy. If
6852 you read a book, that act is not regulated by copyright law. If you
6853 give someone the book, that act is not regulated by copyright law. If
6854 you resell a book, that act is not regulated (copyright law expressly
6855 states that after the first sale of a book, the copyright owner can
6856 impose no further conditions on the disposition of the book). If you
6857 sleep on the book or use it to hold up a lamp or let your puppy chew
6858 it up, those acts are not regulated by copyright law, because those
6859 acts do not make a copy.
6860 </para>
6861 <figure id="fig-1531">
6862 <title>Examples of unregulated uses of a book.</title>
6863 <graphic fileref="images/1531.png"></graphic>
6864 </figure>
6865 <para>
6866 Obviously, however, some uses of a copyrighted book are regulated
6867 by copyright law. Republishing the book, for example, makes a copy. It
6868 is therefore regulated by copyright law. Indeed, this particular use stands
6869 at the core of this circle of possible uses of a copyrighted work. It is the
6870 paradigmatic use properly regulated by copyright regulation (see first
6871 diagram on next page).
6872 </para>
6873 <para>
6874 Finally, there is a tiny sliver of otherwise regulated copying uses
6875 that remain unregulated because the law considers these "fair uses."
6876 </para>
6877 <!-- PAGE BREAK 153 -->
6878 <figure id="fig-1541">
6879 <title>Republishing stands at the core of this circle of possible uses of a copyrighted work.</title>
6880 <graphic fileref="images/1541.png"></graphic>
6881 </figure>
6882 <para>
6883 These are uses that themselves involve copying, but which the law treats
6884 as unregulated because public policy demands that they remain
6885 unregulated.
6886 You are free to quote from this book, even in a review that
6887 is quite negative, without my permission, even though that quoting
6888 makes a copy. That copy would ordinarily give the copyright owner the
6889 exclusive right to say whether the copy is allowed or not, but the law
6890 denies the owner any exclusive right over such "fair uses" for public
6891 policy (and possibly First Amendment) reasons.
6892 </para>
6893 <figure id="fig-1542">
6894 <title>Unregulated copying considered &quot;fair uses.&quot;</title>
6895 <graphic fileref="images/1542.png"></graphic>
6896 </figure>
6897 <para> </para>
6898 <figure id="fig-1551">
6899 <title>Uses that before were presumptively unregulated are now presumptively regulated.</title>
6900 <graphic fileref="images/1551.png"></graphic>
6901 </figure>
6902 <para>
6903 <!-- PAGE BREAK 154 -->
6904 In real space, then, the possible uses of a book are divided into three
6905 sorts: (1) unregulated uses, (2) regulated uses, and (3) regulated uses that
6906 are nonetheless deemed "fair" regardless of the copyright owner's views.
6907 </para>
6908 <para>
6909 Enter the Internet&mdash;a distributed, digital network where every use
6910 of a copyrighted work produces a copy.<footnote><para>
6911 <!-- f18 -->
6912 I don't mean "nature" in the sense that it couldn't be different, but rather that
6913 its present instantiation entails a copy. Optical networks need not make
6914 copies of content they transmit, and a digital network could be designed to
6915 delete anything it copies so that the same number of copies remain.
6916 </para></footnote>
6917 And because of this single,
6918 arbitrary feature of the design of a digital network, the scope of
6919 category
6920 1 changes dramatically. Uses that before were presumptively
6921 unregulated
6922 are now presumptively regulated. No longer is there a set of
6923 presumptively unregulated uses that define a freedom associated with a
6924 copyrighted work. Instead, each use is now subject to the copyright,
6925 because each use also makes a copy&mdash;category 1 gets sucked into
6926 category
6927 2. And those who would defend the unregulated uses of
6928 copyrighted
6929 work must look exclusively to category 3, fair uses, to bear the
6930 burden of this shift.
6931 </para>
6932 <para>
6933 So let's be very specific to make this general point clear. Before the
6934 Internet, if you purchased a book and read it ten times, there would
6935 be no plausible <emphasis>copyright</emphasis>-related argument that
6936 the copyright owner could make to control that use of her
6937 book. Copyright law would have nothing to say about whether you read
6938 the book once, ten times, or every
6939 <!-- PAGE BREAK 155 -->
6940 night before you went to bed. None of those instances of use&mdash;reading&mdash;
6941 could be regulated by copyright law because none of those uses
6942 produced
6943 a copy.
6944 </para>
6945 <para>
6946 But the same book as an e-book is effectively governed by a different
6947 set of rules. Now if the copyright owner says you may read the book
6948 only once or only once a month, then <emphasis>copyright
6949 law</emphasis> would aid the copyright owner in exercising this degree
6950 of control, because of the accidental feature of copyright law that
6951 triggers its application upon there being a copy. Now if you read the
6952 book ten times and the license says you may read it only five times,
6953 then whenever you read the book (or any portion of it) beyond the
6954 fifth time, you are making a copy of the book contrary to the
6955 copyright owner's wish.
6956 </para>
6957 <para>
6958 There are some people who think this makes perfect sense. My aim
6959 just now is not to argue about whether it makes sense or not. My aim
6960 is only to make clear the change. Once you see this point, a few other
6961 points also become clear:
6962 </para>
6963 <para>
6964 First, making category 1 disappear is not anything any policy maker
6965 ever intended. Congress did not think through the collapse of the
6966 presumptively unregulated uses of copyrighted works. There is no
6967 evidence at all that policy makers had this idea in mind when they
6968 allowed our policy here to shift. Unregulated uses were an important
6969 part of free culture before the Internet.
6970 </para>
6971 <para>
6972 Second, this shift is especially troubling in the context of
6973 transformative uses of creative content. Again, we can all understand
6974 the wrong in commercial piracy. But the law now purports to regulate
6975 <emphasis>any</emphasis> transformation you make of creative work
6976 using a machine. "Copy and paste" and "cut and paste" become
6977 crimes. Tinkering with a story and releasing it to others exposes the
6978 tinkerer to at least a requirement of justification. However
6979 troubling the expansion with respect to copying a particular work, it
6980 is extraordinarily troubling with respect to transformative uses of
6981 creative work.
6982 </para>
6983 <para>
6984 Third, this shift from category 1 to category 2 puts an extraordinary
6985
6986 <!-- PAGE BREAK 156 -->
6987 burden on category 3 ("fair use") that fair use never before had to bear.
6988 If a copyright owner now tried to control how many times I could read
6989 a book on-line, the natural response would be to argue that this is a
6990 violation of my fair use rights. But there has never been any litigation
6991 about whether I have a fair use right to read, because before the
6992 Internet,
6993 reading did not trigger the application of copyright law and hence
6994 the need for a fair use defense. The right to read was effectively
6995 protected
6996 before because reading was not regulated.
6997 </para>
6998 <para>
6999 This point about fair use is totally ignored, even by advocates for
7000 free culture. We have been cornered into arguing that our rights
7001 depend upon fair use&mdash;never even addressing the earlier question
7002 about the expansion in effective regulation. A thin protection
7003 grounded in fair use makes sense when the vast majority of uses are
7004 <emphasis>unregulated</emphasis>. But when everything becomes
7005 presumptively regulated, then the protections of fair use are not
7006 enough.
7007 </para>
7008 <para>
7009 The case of Video Pipeline is a good example. Video Pipeline was
7010 in the business of making "trailer" advertisements for movies available
7011 to video stores. The video stores displayed the trailers as a way to sell
7012 videos. Video Pipeline got the trailers from the film distributors, put
7013 the trailers on tape, and sold the tapes to the retail stores.
7014 </para>
7015 <para>
7016 The company did this for about fifteen years. Then, in 1997, it
7017 began
7018 to think about the Internet as another way to distribute these
7019 previews.
7020 The idea was to expand their "selling by sampling" technique by
7021 giving on-line stores the same ability to enable "browsing." Just as in a
7022 bookstore you can read a few pages of a book before you buy the book,
7023 so, too, you would be able to sample a bit from the movie on-line
7024 before
7025 you bought it.
7026 </para>
7027 <para>
7028 In 1998, Video Pipeline informed Disney and other film
7029 distributors
7030 that it intended to distribute the trailers through the Internet
7031 (rather than sending the tapes) to distributors of their videos. Two
7032 years later, Disney told Video Pipeline to stop. The owner of Video
7033 <!-- PAGE BREAK 157 -->
7034 Pipeline asked Disney to talk about the matter&mdash;he had built a
7035 business
7036 on distributing this content as a way to help sell Disney films; he
7037 had customers who depended upon his delivering this content. Disney
7038 would agree to talk only if Video Pipeline stopped the distribution
7039 immediately.
7040 Video Pipeline thought it was within their "fair use" rights
7041 to distribute the clips as they had. So they filed a lawsuit to ask the
7042 court to declare that these rights were in fact their rights.
7043 </para>
7044 <para>
7045 Disney countersued&mdash;for $100 million in damages. Those damages
7046 were predicated upon a claim that Video Pipeline had "willfully
7047 infringed"
7048 on Disney's copyright. When a court makes a finding of
7049 willful
7050 infringement, it can award damages not on the basis of the actual
7051 harm to the copyright owner, but on the basis of an amount set in the
7052 statute. Because Video Pipeline had distributed seven hundred clips of
7053 Disney movies to enable video stores to sell copies of those movies,
7054 Disney was now suing Video Pipeline for $100 million.
7055 </para>
7056 <para>
7057 Disney has the right to control its property, of course. But the video
7058 stores that were selling Disney's films also had some sort of right to be
7059 able to sell the films that they had bought from Disney. Disney's claim
7060 in court was that the stores were allowed to sell the films and they were
7061 permitted to list the titles of the films they were selling, but they were
7062 not allowed to show clips of the films as a way of selling them without
7063 Disney's permission.
7064 </para>
7065 <para>
7066 Now, you might think this is a close case, and I think the courts
7067 would consider it a close case. My point here is to map the change
7068 that gives Disney this power. Before the Internet, Disney couldn't
7069 really control how people got access to their content. Once a video
7070 was in the marketplace, the "first-sale doctrine" would free the
7071 seller to use the video as he wished, including showing portions of it
7072 in order to engender sales of the entire movie video. But with the
7073 Internet, it becomes possible for Disney to centralize control over
7074 access to this content. Because each use of the Internet produces a
7075 copy, use on the Internet becomes subject to the copyright owner's
7076 control. The technology expands the scope of effective control,
7077 because the technology builds a copy into every transaction.
7078 </para>
7079 <para>
7080 <!-- PAGE BREAK 158 -->
7081 No doubt, a potential is not yet an abuse, and so the potential for
7082 control is not yet the abuse of control. Barnes &amp; Noble has the
7083 right to say you can't touch a book in their store; property law gives
7084 them that right. But the market effectively protects against that
7085 abuse. If Barnes &amp; Noble banned browsing, then consumers would
7086 choose other bookstores. Competition protects against the
7087 extremes. And it may well be (my argument so far does not even
7088 question this) that competition would prevent any similar danger when
7089 it comes to copyright. Sure, publishers exercising the rights that
7090 authors have assigned to them might try to regulate how many times you
7091 read a book, or try to stop you from sharing the book with anyone. But
7092 in a competitive market such as the book market, the dangers of this
7093 happening are quite slight.
7094 </para>
7095 <para>
7096 Again, my aim so far is simply to map the changes that this changed
7097 architecture enables. Enabling technology to enforce the control of
7098 copyright means that the control of copyright is no longer defined by
7099 balanced policy. The control of copyright is simply what private
7100 owners choose. In some contexts, at least, that fact is harmless. But
7101 in some contexts it is a recipe for disaster.
7102 </para>
7103 </section>
7104 <section id="lawforce">
7105 <title>Architecture and Law: Force</title>
7106 <para>
7107 The disappearance of unregulated uses would be change enough, but a
7108 second important change brought about by the Internet magnifies its
7109 significance. This second change does not affect the reach of copyright
7110 regulation; it affects how such regulation is enforced.
7111 </para>
7112 <para>
7113 In the world before digital technology, it was generally the law that
7114 controlled whether and how someone was regulated by copyright law.
7115 The law, meaning a court, meaning a judge: In the end, it was a human,
7116 trained in the tradition of the law and cognizant of the balances that
7117 tradition embraced, who said whether and how the law would restrict
7118 your freedom.
7119 </para>
7120 <indexterm><primary>Casablanca</primary></indexterm>
7121 <indexterm id="idxmarxbrothers" class='startofrange'>
7122 <primary>Marx Brothers</primary>
7123 </indexterm>
7124 <para>
7125 There's a famous story about a battle between the Marx Brothers
7126 and Warner Brothers. The Marxes intended to make a parody of
7127 <!-- PAGE BREAK 159 -->
7128 <citetitle>Casablanca</citetitle>. Warner Brothers objected. They wrote a nasty letter to the
7129 Marxes, warning them that there would be serious legal consequences
7130 if they went forward with their plan.<footnote><para>
7131 <!-- f19 -->
7132 See David Lange, "Recognizing the Public Domain," <citetitle>Law and
7133 Contemporary Problems</citetitle> 44 (1981): 172&ndash;73.
7134 </para></footnote>
7135 </para>
7136 <para>
7137 This led the Marx Brothers to respond in kind. They warned
7138 Warner Brothers that the Marx Brothers "were brothers long before
7139 you were."<footnote><para>
7140 <!-- f20 -->
7141 Ibid. See also Vaidhyanathan, <citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs</citetitle>, 1&ndash;3.
7142 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva</primary></indexterm>
7143 </para></footnote>
7144 The Marx Brothers therefore owned the word <citetitle>brothers</citetitle>,
7145 and if Warner Brothers insisted on trying to control <citetitle>Casablanca</citetitle>, then
7146 the Marx Brothers would insist on control over <citetitle>brothers</citetitle>.
7147 </para>
7148 <para>
7149 An absurd and hollow threat, of course, because Warner Brothers,
7150 like the Marx Brothers, knew that no court would ever enforce such a
7151 silly claim. This extremism was irrelevant to the real freedoms anyone
7152 (including Warner Brothers) enjoyed.
7153 </para>
7154 <para>
7155 On the Internet, however, there is no check on silly rules, because on
7156 the Internet, increasingly, rules are enforced not by a human but by a
7157 machine: Increasingly, the rules of copyright law, as interpreted by
7158 the copyright owner, get built into the technology that delivers
7159 copyrighted content. It is code, rather than law, that rules. And the
7160 problem with code regulations is that, unlike law, code has no
7161 shame. Code would not get the humor of the Marx Brothers. The
7162 consequence of that is not at all funny.
7163 </para>
7164 <indexterm startref="idxmarxbrothers" class='endofrange'/>
7165 <para>
7166 Consider the life of my Adobe eBook Reader.
7167 </para>
7168 <para>
7169 An e-book is a book delivered in electronic form. An Adobe eBook
7170 is not a book that Adobe has published; Adobe simply produces the
7171 software that publishers use to deliver e-books. It provides the
7172 technology,
7173 and the publisher delivers the content by using the technology.
7174 </para>
7175 <para>
7176 On the next page is a picture of an old version of my Adobe eBook
7177 Reader.
7178 </para>
7179 <para>
7180 As you can see, I have a small collection of e-books within this
7181 e-book library. Some of these books reproduce content that is in the
7182 public domain: <citetitle>Middlemarch</citetitle>, for example, is in the public domain.
7183 Some of them reproduce content that is not in the public domain: My
7184 own book <citetitle>The Future of Ideas</citetitle> is not yet within the public domain.
7185 Consider <citetitle>Middlemarch</citetitle> first. If you click on my e-book copy of
7186 <!-- PAGE BREAK 160 -->
7187 <citetitle>Middlemarch</citetitle>, you'll see a fancy cover, and then a button at the bottom
7188 called Permissions.
7189 </para>
7190 <figure id="fig-1611">
7191 <title>Picture of an old version of Adobe eBook Reader</title>
7192 <graphic fileref="images/1611.png"></graphic>
7193 </figure>
7194 <para>
7195 If you click on the Permissions button, you'll see a list of the
7196 permissions that the publisher purports to grant with this book.
7197 </para>
7198 <figure id="fig-1612">
7199 <title>List of the permissions that the publisher purports to grant.</title>
7200 <graphic fileref="images/1612.png"></graphic>
7201 </figure>
7202 <para>
7203 <!-- PAGE BREAK 161 -->
7204 According to my eBook Reader, I have the permission to copy to the
7205 clipboard of the computer ten text selections every ten days. (So far,
7206 I've copied no text to the clipboard.) I also have the permission to
7207 print ten pages from the book every ten days. Lastly, I have the
7208 permission to use the Read Aloud button to hear <citetitle>Middlemarch</citetitle>
7209 read aloud through the computer.
7210 </para>
7211 <para>
7212 Here's the e-book for another work in the public domain (including the
7213 translation): Aristotle's <citetitle>Politics</citetitle>.
7214 <indexterm><primary>Aristotle</primary></indexterm>
7215 <indexterm><primary><citetitle>Politics</citetitle>, (Aristotle)</primary></indexterm>
7216 </para>
7217 <figure id="fig-1621">
7218 <title>E-book of Aristotle;s &quot;Politics&quot;</title>
7219 <graphic fileref="images/1621.png"></graphic>
7220 </figure>
7221 <para>
7222 According to its permissions, no printing or copying is permitted
7223 at all. But fortunately, you can use the Read Aloud button to hear
7224 the book.
7225 </para>
7226 <figure id="fig-1622">
7227 <title>List of the permissions for Aristotle;s &quot;Politics&quot;.</title>
7228 <graphic fileref="images/1622.png"></graphic>
7229 </figure>
7230 <para>
7231 Finally (and most embarrassingly), here are the permissions for the
7232 original e-book version of my last book, <citetitle>The Future of
7233 Ideas</citetitle>:
7234 </para>
7235 <!-- PAGE BREAK 162 -->
7236 <figure id="fig-1631">
7237 <title>List of the permissions for &quot;The Future of Ideas&quot;.</title>
7238 <graphic fileref="images/1631.png"></graphic>
7239 </figure>
7240 <para>
7241 No copying, no printing, and don't you dare try to listen to this book!
7242 </para>
7243 <para>
7244 Now, the Adobe eBook Reader calls these controls
7245 "permissions"&mdash; as if the publisher has the power to control how
7246 you use these works. For works under copyright, the copyright owner
7247 certainly does have the power&mdash;up to the limits of the copyright
7248 law. But for work not under copyright, there is no such copyright
7249 power.<footnote><para>
7250 <!-- f21 -->
7251 In principle, a contract might impose a requirement on me. I might,
7252 for example, buy a book from you that includes a contract that says I
7253 will read it only three times, or that I promise to read it three
7254 times. But that obligation (and the limits for creating that
7255 obligation) would come from the contract, not from copyright law, and
7256 the obligations of contract would not necessarily pass to anyone who
7257 subsequently acquired the book.
7258 </para></footnote>
7259 When my e-book of <citetitle>Middlemarch</citetitle> says I have the
7260 permission to copy only ten text selections into the memory every ten
7261 days, what that really means is that the eBook Reader has enabled the
7262 publisher to control how I use the book on my computer, far beyond the
7263 control that the law would enable.
7264 </para>
7265 <para>
7266 The control comes instead from the code&mdash;from the technology
7267 within which the e-book "lives." Though the e-book says that these are
7268 permissions, they are not the sort of "permissions" that most of us
7269 deal with. When a teenager gets "permission" to stay out till
7270 midnight, she knows (unless she's Cinderella) that she can stay out
7271 till 2 A.M., but will suffer a punishment if she's caught. But when
7272 the Adobe eBook Reader says I have the permission to make ten copies
7273 of the text into the computer's memory, that means that after I've
7274 made ten copies, the computer will not make any more. The same with
7275 the printing restrictions: After ten pages, the eBook Reader will not
7276 print any more pages. It's the same with the silly restriction that
7277 says that you can't use the Read Aloud button to read my book
7278 aloud&mdash;it's not that the company will sue you if you do; instead,
7279 if you push the Read Aloud button with my book, the machine simply
7280 won't read aloud.
7281 </para>
7282 <para>
7283 <!-- PAGE BREAK 163 -->
7284 These are <emphasis>controls</emphasis>, not permissions. Imagine a
7285 world where the Marx Brothers sold word processing software that, when
7286 you tried to type "Warner Brothers," erased "Brothers" from the
7287 sentence.
7288 <indexterm><primary>Marx Brothers</primary></indexterm>
7289 </para>
7290 <para>
7291 This is the future of copyright law: not so much copyright
7292 <emphasis>law</emphasis> as copyright <emphasis>code</emphasis>. The
7293 controls over access to content will not be controls that are ratified
7294 by courts; the controls over access to content will be controls that
7295 are coded by programmers. And whereas the controls that are built into
7296 the law are always to be checked by a judge, the controls that are
7297 built into the technology have no similar built-in check.
7298 </para>
7299 <para>
7300 How significant is this? Isn't it always possible to get around the
7301 controls built into the technology? Software used to be sold with
7302 technologies that limited the ability of users to copy the software,
7303 but those were trivial protections to defeat. Why won't it be trivial
7304 to defeat these protections as well?
7305 </para>
7306 <para>
7307 We've only scratched the surface of this story. Return to the Adobe
7308 eBook Reader.
7309 </para>
7310 <para>
7311 Early in the life of the Adobe eBook Reader, Adobe suffered a public
7312 relations nightmare. Among the books that you could download for free
7313 on the Adobe site was a copy of <citetitle>Alice's Adventures in
7314 Wonderland</citetitle>. This wonderful book is in the public
7315 domain. Yet when you clicked on Permissions for that book, you got the
7316 following report:
7317 </para>
7318 <figure id="fig-1641">
7319 <title>List of the permissions for &quot;Alice's Adventures in
7320 Wonderland&quot;.</title>
7321 <graphic fileref="images/1641.png"></graphic>
7322 </figure>
7323 <para>
7324 <!-- PAGE BREAK 164 -->
7325 Here was a public domain children's book that you were not
7326 allowed
7327 to copy, not allowed to lend, not allowed to give, and, as the
7328 "permissions"
7329 indicated, not allowed to "read aloud"!
7330 </para>
7331 <para>
7332 The public relations nightmare attached to that final permission.
7333 For the text did not say that you were not permitted to use the Read
7334 Aloud button; it said you did not have the permission to read the book
7335 aloud. That led some people to think that Adobe was restricting the
7336 right of parents, for example, to read the book to their children, which
7337 seemed, to say the least, absurd.
7338 </para>
7339 <para>
7340 Adobe responded quickly that it was absurd to think that it was trying
7341 to restrict the right to read a book aloud. Obviously it was only
7342 restricting the ability to use the Read Aloud button to have the book
7343 read aloud. But the question Adobe never did answer is this: Would
7344 Adobe thus agree that a consumer was free to use software to hack
7345 around the restrictions built into the eBook Reader? If some company
7346 (call it Elcomsoft) developed a program to disable the technological
7347 protection built into an Adobe eBook so that a blind person, say,
7348 could use a computer to read the book aloud, would Adobe agree that
7349 such a use of an eBook Reader was fair? Adobe didn't answer because
7350 the answer, however absurd it might seem, is no.
7351 </para>
7352 <para>
7353 The point is not to blame Adobe. Indeed, Adobe is among the most
7354 innovative companies developing strategies to balance open access to
7355 content with incentives for companies to innovate. But Adobe's
7356 technology enables control, and Adobe has an incentive to defend this
7357 control. That incentive is understandable, yet what it creates is
7358 often crazy.
7359 </para>
7360 <para>
7361 To see the point in a particularly absurd context, consider a favorite
7362 story of mine that makes the same point.
7363 </para>
7364 <indexterm id="idxaibo" class='startofrange'>
7365 <primary>Aibo robotic dog</primary>
7366 </indexterm>
7367 <para>
7368 Consider the robotic dog made by Sony named "Aibo." The Aibo
7369 learns tricks, cuddles, and follows you around. It eats only electricity
7370 and that doesn't leave that much of a mess (at least in your house).
7371 </para>
7372 <para>
7373 The Aibo is expensive and popular. Fans from around the world
7374 have set up clubs to trade stories. One fan in particular set up a Web
7375 site to enable information about the Aibo dog to be shared. This fan set
7376 <!-- PAGE BREAK 165 -->
7377 up aibopet.com (and aibohack.com, but that resolves to the same site),
7378 and on that site he provided information about how to teach an Aibo
7379 to do tricks in addition to the ones Sony had taught it.
7380 </para>
7381 <para>
7382 "Teach" here has a special meaning. Aibos are just cute computers.
7383 You teach a computer how to do something by programming it
7384 differently. So to say that aibopet.com was giving information about
7385 how to teach the dog to do new tricks is just to say that aibopet.com
7386 was giving information to users of the Aibo pet about how to hack
7387 their computer "dog" to make it do new tricks (thus, aibohack.com).
7388 </para>
7389 <para>
7390 If you're not a programmer or don't know many programmers, the
7391 word <citetitle>hack</citetitle> has a particularly unfriendly connotation. Nonprogrammers
7392 hack bushes or weeds. Nonprogrammers in horror movies do even
7393 worse. But to programmers, or coders, as I call them, <citetitle>hack</citetitle> is a much
7394 more positive term. <citetitle>Hack</citetitle> just means code that enables the program to
7395 do something it wasn't originally intended or enabled to do. If you buy
7396 a new printer for an old computer, you might find the old computer
7397 doesn't run, or "drive," the printer. If you discovered that, you'd later be
7398 happy to discover a hack on the Net by someone who has written a
7399 driver to enable the computer to drive the printer you just bought.
7400 </para>
7401 <para>
7402 Some hacks are easy. Some are unbelievably hard. Hackers as a
7403 community like to challenge themselves and others with increasingly
7404 difficult tasks. There's a certain respect that goes with the talent to hack
7405 well. There's a well-deserved respect that goes with the talent to hack
7406 ethically.
7407 </para>
7408 <para>
7409 The Aibo fan was displaying a bit of both when he hacked the program
7410 and offered to the world a bit of code that would enable the Aibo to
7411 dance jazz. The dog wasn't programmed to dance jazz. It was a clever
7412 bit of tinkering that turned the dog into a more talented creature
7413 than Sony had built.
7414 </para>
7415 <indexterm startref="idxaibo" class='endofrange'/>
7416 <para>
7417 I've told this story in many contexts, both inside and outside the
7418 United States. Once I was asked by a puzzled member of the audience,
7419 is it permissible for a dog to dance jazz in the United States? We
7420 forget that stories about the backcountry still flow across much of
7421 the
7422
7423 <!-- PAGE BREAK 166 -->
7424 world. So let's just be clear before we continue: It's not a crime
7425 anywhere (anymore) to dance jazz. Nor is it a crime to teach your dog
7426 to dance jazz. Nor should it be a crime (though we don't have a lot to
7427 go on here) to teach your robot dog to dance jazz. Dancing jazz is a
7428 completely legal activity. One imagines that the owner of aibopet.com
7429 thought, <emphasis>What possible problem could there be with teaching
7430 a robot dog to dance?</emphasis>
7431 </para>
7432 <para>
7433 Let's put the dog to sleep for a minute, and turn to a pony show&mdash;
7434 not literally a pony show, but rather a paper that a Princeton academic
7435 named Ed Felten prepared for a conference. This Princeton academic
7436 is well known and respected. He was hired by the government in the
7437 Microsoft case to test Microsoft's claims about what could and could
7438 not be done with its own code. In that trial, he demonstrated both his
7439 brilliance and his coolness. Under heavy badgering by Microsoft
7440 lawyers, Ed Felten stood his ground. He was not about to be bullied
7441 into being silent about something he knew very well.
7442 </para>
7443 <para>
7444 But Felten's bravery was really tested in April 2001.<footnote><para>
7445 <!-- f22 -->
7446 See Pamela Samuelson, "Anticircumvention Rules: Threat to Science,"
7447 <citetitle>Science</citetitle> 293 (2001): 2028; Brendan I. Koerner, "Play Dead: Sony Muzzles
7448 the Techies Who Teach a Robot Dog New Tricks," <citetitle>American Prospect</citetitle>,
7449 January 2002; "Court Dismisses Computer Scientists' Challenge to
7450 DMCA," <citetitle>Intellectual Property Litigation Reporter</citetitle>, 11 December 2001; Bill
7451 Holland, "Copyright Act Raising Free-Speech Concerns," <citetitle>Billboard</citetitle>,
7452 May 2001; Janelle Brown, "Is the RIAA Running Scared?" Salon.com,
7453 April 2001; Electronic Frontier Foundation, "Frequently Asked
7454 Questions about <citetitle>Felten and USENIX</citetitle> v. <citetitle>RIAA</citetitle> Legal Case," available at
7455 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #27</ulink>.
7456 <indexterm><primary>Electronic Frontier Foundation</primary></indexterm>
7457 </para></footnote>
7458 He and a group of colleagues were working on a paper to be submitted
7459 at conference. The paper was intended to describe the weakness in an
7460 encryption system being developed by the Secure Digital Music
7461 Initiative as a technique to control the distribution of music.
7462 </para>
7463 <para>
7464 The SDMI coalition had as its goal a technology to enable content
7465 owners to exercise much better control over their content than the
7466 Internet, as it originally stood, granted them. Using encryption, SDMI
7467 hoped to develop a standard that would allow the content owner to say
7468 "this music cannot be copied," and have a computer respect that
7469 command. The technology was to be part of a "trusted system" of
7470 control that would get content owners to trust the system of the
7471 Internet much more.
7472 </para>
7473 <para>
7474 When SDMI thought it was close to a standard, it set up a competition.
7475 In exchange for providing contestants with the code to an
7476 SDMI-encrypted bit of content, contestants were to try to crack it
7477 and, if they did, report the problems to the consortium.
7478 </para>
7479 <para>
7480 <!-- PAGE BREAK 167 -->
7481 Felten and his team figured out the encryption system quickly. He and
7482 the team saw the weakness of this system as a type: Many encryption
7483 systems would suffer the same weakness, and Felten and his team
7484 thought it worthwhile to point this out to those who study encryption.
7485 </para>
7486 <para>
7487 Let's review just what Felten was doing. Again, this is the United
7488 States. We have a principle of free speech. We have this principle not
7489 just because it is the law, but also because it is a really great
7490 idea. A strongly protected tradition of free speech is likely to
7491 encourage a wide range of criticism. That criticism is likely, in
7492 turn, to improve the systems or people or ideas criticized.
7493 </para>
7494 <para>
7495 What Felten and his colleagues were doing was publishing a paper
7496 describing the weakness in a technology. They were not spreading free
7497 music, or building and deploying this technology. The paper was an
7498 academic essay, unintelligible to most people. But it clearly showed the
7499 weakness in the SDMI system, and why SDMI would not, as presently
7500 constituted, succeed.
7501 </para>
7502 <para>
7503 What links these two, aibopet.com and Felten, is the letters they
7504 then received. Aibopet.com received a letter from Sony about the
7505 aibopet.com hack. Though a jazz-dancing dog is perfectly legal, Sony
7506 wrote:
7507 </para>
7508 <blockquote>
7509 <para>
7510 Your site contains information providing the means to circumvent
7511 AIBO-ware's copy protection protocol constituting a violation of the
7512 anti-circumvention provisions of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act.
7513 </para>
7514 </blockquote>
7515 <para>
7516 And though an academic paper describing the weakness in a system
7517 of encryption should also be perfectly legal, Felten received a letter
7518 from an RIAA lawyer that read:
7519 </para>
7520 <blockquote>
7521 <para>
7522 Any disclosure of information gained from participating in the
7523 <!-- PAGE BREAK 168 -->
7524 Public Challenge would be outside the scope of activities permitted by
7525 the Agreement and could subject you and your research team to actions
7526 under the Digital Millennium Copyright Act ("DMCA").
7527 </para>
7528 </blockquote>
7529 <para>
7530 In both cases, this weirdly Orwellian law was invoked to control the
7531 spread of information. The Digital Millennium Copyright Act made
7532 spreading such information an offense.
7533 </para>
7534 <para>
7535 The DMCA was enacted as a response to copyright owners' first fear
7536 about cyberspace. The fear was that copyright control was effectively
7537 dead; the response was to find technologies that might compensate.
7538 These new technologies would be copyright protection
7539 technologies&mdash; technologies to control the replication and
7540 distribution of copyrighted material. They were designed as
7541 <emphasis>code</emphasis> to modify the original
7542 <emphasis>code</emphasis> of the Internet, to reestablish some
7543 protection for copyright owners.
7544 </para>
7545 <para>
7546 The DMCA was a bit of law intended to back up the protection of this
7547 code designed to protect copyrighted material. It was, we could say,
7548 <emphasis>legal code</emphasis> intended to buttress
7549 <emphasis>software code</emphasis> which itself was intended to
7550 support the <emphasis>legal code of copyright</emphasis>.
7551 </para>
7552 <para>
7553 But the DMCA was not designed merely to protect copyrighted works to
7554 the extent copyright law protected them. Its protection, that is, did
7555 not end at the line that copyright law drew. The DMCA regulated
7556 devices that were designed to circumvent copyright protection
7557 measures. It was designed to ban those devices, whether or not the use
7558 of the copyrighted material made possible by that circumvention would
7559 have been a copyright violation.
7560 </para>
7561 <para>
7562 Aibopet.com and Felten make the point. The Aibo hack circumvented a
7563 copyright protection system for the purpose of enabling the dog to
7564 dance jazz. That enablement no doubt involved the use of copyrighted
7565 material. But as aibopet.com's site was noncommercial, and the use did
7566 not enable subsequent copyright infringements, there's no doubt that
7567 aibopet.com's hack was fair use of Sony's copyrighted material. Yet
7568 fair use is not a defense to the DMCA. The question is not whether the
7569 <!-- PAGE BREAK 169 -->
7570 use of the copyrighted material was a copyright violation. The question
7571 is whether a copyright protection system was circumvented.
7572 </para>
7573 <para>
7574 The threat against Felten was more attenuated, but it followed the
7575 same line of reasoning. By publishing a paper describing how a
7576 copyright protection system could be circumvented, the RIAA lawyer
7577 suggested, Felten himself was distributing a circumvention technology.
7578 Thus, even though he was not himself infringing anyone's copyright,
7579 his academic paper was enabling others to infringe others' copyright.
7580 </para>
7581 <para>
7582 The bizarreness of these arguments is captured in a cartoon drawn in
7583 1981 by Paul Conrad. At that time, a court in California had held that
7584 the VCR could be banned because it was a copyright-infringing
7585 technology: It enabled consumers to copy films without the permission
7586 of the copyright owner. No doubt there were uses of the technology
7587 that were legal: Fred Rogers, aka "<citetitle>Mr. Rogers</citetitle>," for example, had
7588 testified in that case that he wanted people to feel free to tape
7589 Mr. Rogers' Neighborhood.
7590 </para>
7591 <blockquote>
7592 <para>
7593 Some public stations, as well as commercial stations, program the
7594 "Neighborhood" at hours when some children cannot use it. I think that
7595 it's a real service to families to be able to record such programs and
7596 show them at appropriate times. I have always felt that with the
7597 advent of all of this new technology that allows people to tape the
7598 "Neighborhood" off-the-air, and I'm speaking for the "Neighborhood"
7599 because that's what I produce, that they then become much more active
7600 in the programming of their family's television life. Very frankly, I
7601 am opposed to people being programmed by others. My whole approach in
7602 broadcasting has always been "You are an important person just the way
7603 you are. You can make healthy decisions." Maybe I'm going on too long,
7604 but I just feel that anything that allows a person to be more active
7605 in the control of his or her life, in a healthy way, is
7606 important.<footnote><para>
7607 <!-- f23 -->
7608 <citetitle>Sony Corporation of America</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc</citetitle>., 464 U.S. 417,
7609 455 fn. 27 (1984). Rogers never changed his view about the VCR. See
7610 James Lardner, <citetitle>Fast Forward: Hollywood, the Japanese, and the Onslaught of
7611 the VCR</citetitle> (New York: W. W. Norton, 1987), 270&ndash;71.
7612 </para></footnote>
7613 </para>
7614 </blockquote>
7615 <para>
7616 <!-- PAGE BREAK 170 -->
7617 Even though there were uses that were legal, because there were
7618 some uses that were illegal, the court held the companies producing
7619 the VCR responsible.
7620 </para>
7621 <para>
7622 This led Conrad to draw the cartoon below, which we can adopt to
7623 the DMCA.
7624 </para>
7625 <para>
7626 No argument I have can top this picture, but let me try to get close.
7627 </para>
7628 <para>
7629 The anticircumvention provisions of the DMCA target copyright
7630 circumvention technologies. Circumvention technologies can be used for
7631 different ends. They can be used, for example, to enable massive
7632 pirating of copyrighted material&mdash;a bad end. Or they can be used
7633 to enable the use of particular copyrighted materials in ways that
7634 would be considered fair use&mdash;a good end.
7635 </para>
7636 <para>
7637 A handgun can be used to shoot a police officer or a child. Most
7638 <!-- PAGE BREAK 171 -->
7639 would agree such a use is bad. Or a handgun can be used for target
7640 practice or to protect against an intruder. At least some would say that
7641 such a use would be good. It, too, is a technology that has both good
7642 and bad uses.
7643 </para>
7644 <figure id="fig-1711">
7645 <title>VCR/handgun cartoon.</title>
7646 <graphic fileref="images/1711.png"></graphic>
7647 </figure>
7648 <para>
7649 The obvious point of Conrad's cartoon is the weirdness of a world
7650 where guns are legal, despite the harm they can do, while VCRs (and
7651 circumvention technologies) are illegal. Flash: <emphasis>No one ever
7652 died from copyright circumvention</emphasis>. Yet the law bans circumvention
7653 technologies absolutely, despite the potential that they might do some
7654 good, but permits guns, despite the obvious and tragic harm they do.
7655 </para>
7656 <para>
7657 The Aibo and RIAA examples demonstrate how copyright owners are
7658 changing the balance that copyright law grants. Using code, copyright
7659 owners restrict fair use; using the DMCA, they punish those who would
7660 attempt to evade the restrictions on fair use that they impose through
7661 code. Technology becomes a means by which fair use can be erased; the
7662 law of the DMCA backs up that erasing.
7663 </para>
7664 <para>
7665 This is how <emphasis>code</emphasis> becomes
7666 <emphasis>law</emphasis>. The controls built into the technology of
7667 copy and access protection become rules the violation of which is also
7668 a violation of the law. In this way, the code extends the
7669 law&mdash;increasing its regulation, even if the subject it regulates
7670 (activities that would otherwise plainly constitute fair use) is
7671 beyond the reach of the law. Code becomes law; code extends the law;
7672 code thus extends the control that copyright owners effect&mdash;at
7673 least for those copyright holders with the lawyers who can write the
7674 nasty letters that Felten and aibopet.com received.
7675 </para>
7676 <para>
7677 There is one final aspect of the interaction between architecture and
7678 law that contributes to the force of copyright's regulation. This is
7679 the ease with which infringements of the law can be detected. For
7680 contrary to the rhetoric common at the birth of cyberspace that on the
7681 Internet, no one knows you're a dog, increasingly, given changing
7682 technologies deployed on the Internet, it is easy to find the dog who
7683 committed a legal wrong. The technologies of the Internet are open to
7684 snoops as well as sharers, and the snoops are increasingly good at
7685 tracking down the identity of those who violate the rules.
7686 </para>
7687 <para>
7688
7689 <!-- PAGE BREAK 172 -->
7690 For example, imagine you were part of a <citetitle>Star Trek</citetitle> fan club. You
7691 gathered every month to share trivia, and maybe to enact a kind of fan
7692 fiction about the show. One person would play Spock, another, Captain
7693 Kirk. The characters would begin with a plot from a real story, then
7694 simply continue it.<footnote><para>
7695 <!-- f24 -->
7696 For an early and prescient analysis, see Rebecca Tushnet, "Legal Fictions,
7697 Copyright, Fan Fiction, and a New Common Law," <citetitle>Loyola of Los Angeles
7698 Entertainment Law Journal</citetitle> 17 (1997): 651.
7699 </para></footnote>
7700 </para>
7701 <para>
7702 Before the Internet, this was, in effect, a totally unregulated
7703 activity. No matter what happened inside your club room, you would
7704 never be interfered with by the copyright police. You were free in
7705 that space to do as you wished with this part of our culture. You were
7706 allowed to build on it as you wished without fear of legal control.
7707 </para>
7708 <para>
7709 But if you moved your club onto the Internet, and made it generally
7710 available for others to join, the story would be very different. Bots
7711 scouring the Net for trademark and copyright infringement would
7712 quickly find your site. Your posting of fan fiction, depending upon
7713 the ownership of the series that you're depicting, could well inspire
7714 a lawyer's threat. And ignoring the lawyer's threat would be extremely
7715 costly indeed. The law of copyright is extremely efficient. The
7716 penalties are severe, and the process is quick.
7717 </para>
7718 <para>
7719 This change in the effective force of the law is caused by a change
7720 in the ease with which the law can be enforced. That change too shifts
7721 the law's balance radically. It is as if your car transmitted the speed at
7722 which you traveled at every moment that you drove; that would be just
7723 one step before the state started issuing tickets based upon the data you
7724 transmitted. That is, in effect, what is happening here.
7725 </para>
7726 </section>
7727 <section id="marketconcentration">
7728 <title>Market: Concentration</title>
7729 <para>
7730 So copyright's duration has increased dramatically&mdash;tripled in
7731 the past thirty years. And copyright's scope has increased as
7732 well&mdash;from regulating only publishers to now regulating just
7733 about everyone. And copyright's reach has changed, as every action
7734 becomes a copy and hence presumptively regulated. And as technologists
7735 find better ways
7736 <!-- PAGE BREAK 173 -->
7737 to control the use of content, and as copyright is increasingly
7738 enforced through technology, copyright's force changes, too. Misuse is
7739 easier to find and easier to control. This regulation of the creative
7740 process, which began as a tiny regulation governing a tiny part of the
7741 market for creative work, has become the single most important
7742 regulator of creativity there is. It is a massive expansion in the
7743 scope of the government's control over innovation and creativity; it
7744 would be totally unrecognizable to those who gave birth to copyright's
7745 control.
7746 </para>
7747 <para>
7748 Still, in my view, all of these changes would not matter much if it
7749 weren't for one more change that we must also consider. This is a
7750 change that is in some sense the most familiar, though its significance
7751 and scope are not well understood. It is the one that creates precisely the
7752 reason to be concerned about all the other changes I have described.
7753 </para>
7754 <para>
7755 This is the change in the concentration and integration of the media.
7756 In the past twenty years, the nature of media ownership has undergone
7757 a radical alteration, caused by changes in legal rules governing the
7758 media. Before this change happened, the different forms of media were
7759 owned by separate media companies. Now, the media is increasingly
7760 owned by only a few companies. Indeed, after the changes that the FCC
7761 announced in June 2003, most expect that within a few years, we will
7762 live in a world where just three companies control more than percent
7763 of the media.
7764 </para>
7765 <para>
7766 These changes are of two sorts: the scope of concentration, and its
7767 nature.
7768 </para>
7769 <indexterm><primary>BMG</primary></indexterm>
7770 <para>
7771 Changes in scope are the easier ones to describe. As Senator John
7772 McCain summarized the data produced in the FCC's review of media
7773 ownership, "five companies control 85 percent of our media sources."<footnote><para>
7774 <!-- f25 -->
7775 FCC Oversight: Hearing Before the Senate Commerce, Science and
7776 Transportation Committee, 108th Cong., 1st sess. (22 May 2003)
7777 (statement of Senator John McCain). </para></footnote>
7778 The five recording labels of Universal Music Group, BMG, Sony Music
7779 Entertainment, Warner Music Group, and EMI control 84.8 percent of the
7780 U.S. music market.<footnote><para>
7781 <!-- f26 -->
7782 Lynette Holloway, "Despite a Marketing Blitz, CD Sales Continue to
7783 Slide," <citetitle>New York Times</citetitle>, 23 December 2002.
7784 </para></footnote>
7785 The "five largest cable companies pipe
7786 programming to 74 percent of the cable subscribers nationwide."<footnote><para>
7787 <!-- f27 -->
7788 Molly Ivins, "Media Consolidation Must Be Stopped," <citetitle>Charleston Gazette</citetitle>,
7789 31 May 2003.
7790 </para></footnote>
7791 <indexterm><primary>McCain, John</primary></indexterm>
7792 </para>
7793 <para>
7794 The story with radio is even more dramatic. Before deregulation,
7795 the nation's largest radio broadcasting conglomerate owned fewer than
7796 <!-- PAGE BREAK 174 -->
7797 seventy-five stations. Today <emphasis>one</emphasis> company owns
7798 more than 1,200 stations. During that period of consolidation, the
7799 total number of radio owners dropped by 34 percent. Today, in most
7800 markets, the two largest broadcasters control 74 percent of that
7801 market's revenues. Overall, just four companies control 90 percent of
7802 the nation's radio advertising revenues.
7803 </para>
7804 <para>
7805 Newspaper ownership is becoming more concentrated as well. Today,
7806 there are six hundred fewer daily newspapers in the United States than
7807 there were eighty years ago, and ten companies control half of the
7808 nation's circulation. There are twenty major newspaper publishers in
7809 the United States. The top ten film studios receive 99 percent of all
7810 film revenue. The ten largest cable companies account for 85 percent
7811 of all cable revenue. This is a market far from the free press the
7812 framers sought to protect. Indeed, it is a market that is quite well
7813 protected&mdash; by the market.
7814 </para>
7815 <para>
7816 Concentration in size alone is one thing. The more invidious
7817 change is in the nature of that concentration. As author James Fallows
7818 put it in a recent article about Rupert Murdoch,
7819 <indexterm><primary>Fallows, James</primary></indexterm>
7820 </para>
7821 <blockquote>
7822 <para>
7823 Murdoch's companies now constitute a production system
7824 unmatched in its integration. They supply content&mdash;Fox movies
7825 . . . Fox TV shows . . . Fox-controlled sports broadcasts, plus
7826 newspapers and books. They sell the content to the public and to
7827 advertisers&mdash;in newspapers, on the broadcast network, on the
7828 cable channels. And they operate the physical distribution system
7829 through which the content reaches the customers. Murdoch's satellite
7830 systems now distribute News Corp. content in Europe and Asia; if
7831 Murdoch becomes DirecTV's largest single owner, that system will serve
7832 the same function in the United States.<footnote><para>
7833 <!-- f28 -->
7834 James Fallows, "The Age of Murdoch," <citetitle>Atlantic Monthly</citetitle> (September
7835 2003): 89.
7836 <indexterm><primary>Fallows, James</primary></indexterm>
7837 </para></footnote>
7838 </para>
7839 </blockquote>
7840 <para>
7841 The pattern with Murdoch is the pattern of modern media. Not
7842 just large companies owning many radio stations, but a few companies
7843 owning as many outlets of media as possible. A picture describes this
7844 pattern better than a thousand words could do:
7845 </para>
7846 <figure id="fig-1761">
7847 <title>Pattern of modern media ownership.</title>
7848 <graphic fileref="images/1761.png"></graphic>
7849 </figure>
7850 <para>
7851 <!-- PAGE BREAK 175 -->
7852 Does this concentration matter? Will it affect what is made, or
7853 what is distributed? Or is it merely a more efficient way to produce and
7854 distribute content?
7855 </para>
7856 <para>
7857 My view was that concentration wouldn't matter. I thought it was
7858 nothing more than a more efficient financial structure. But now, after
7859 reading and listening to a barrage of creators try to convince me to the
7860 contrary, I am beginning to change my mind.
7861 </para>
7862 <para>
7863 Here's a representative story that begins to suggest how this
7864 integration may matter.
7865 </para>
7866 <indexterm><primary>Lear, Norman</primary></indexterm>
7867 <indexterm><primary>ABC</primary></indexterm>
7868 <indexterm><primary>All in the Family</primary></indexterm>
7869 <para>
7870 In 1969, Norman Lear created a pilot for <citetitle>All in the Family</citetitle>. He took
7871 the pilot to ABC. The network didn't like it. It was too edgy, they told
7872 Lear. Make it again. Lear made a second pilot, more edgy than the
7873 first. ABC was exasperated. You're missing the point, they told Lear.
7874 We wanted less edgy, not more.
7875 </para>
7876 <para>
7877 Rather than comply, Lear simply took the show elsewhere. CBS
7878 was happy to have the series; ABC could not stop Lear from walking.
7879 The copyrights that Lear held assured an independence from network
7880 control.<footnote><para>
7881 <!-- f29 -->
7882 Leonard Hill, "The Axis of Access," remarks before Weidenbaum Center
7883 Forum, "Entertainment Economics: The Movie Industry," St. Louis,
7884 Missouri,
7885 3 April 2003 (transcript of prepared remarks available at
7886 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #28</ulink>;
7887 for the Lear story, not included in the prepared remarks, see
7888 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #29</ulink>).
7889 </para></footnote>
7890 </para>
7891 <para>
7892
7893 <!-- PAGE BREAK 176 -->
7894 The network did not control those copyrights because the law forbade
7895 the networks from controlling the content they syndicated. The law
7896 required a separation between the networks and the content producers;
7897 that separation would guarantee Lear freedom. And as late as 1992,
7898 because of these rules, the vast majority of prime time
7899 television&mdash;75 percent of it&mdash;was "independent" of the
7900 networks.
7901 </para>
7902 <para>
7903 In 1994, the FCC abandoned the rules that required this independence.
7904 After that change, the networks quickly changed the balance. In 1985,
7905 there were twenty-five independent television production studios; in
7906 2002, only five independent television studios remained. "In 1992,
7907 only 15 percent of new series were produced for a network by a company
7908 it controlled. Last year, the percentage of shows produced by
7909 controlled companies more than quintupled to 77 percent." "In 1992, 16
7910 new series were produced independently of conglomerate control, last
7911 year there was one."<footnote><para>
7912 <!-- f30 -->
7913 NewsCorp./DirecTV Merger and Media Consolidation: Hearings on Media
7914 Ownership Before the Senate Commerce Committee, 108th Cong., 1st
7915 sess. (2003) (testimony of Gene Kimmelman on behalf of Consumers Union
7916 and the Consumer Federation of America), available at
7917 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #30</ulink>. Kimmelman
7918 quotes Victoria Riskin, president of Writers Guild of America, West,
7919 in her Remarks at FCC En Banc Hearing, Richmond, Virginia, 27 February
7920 2003.
7921 </para></footnote>
7922 In 2002, 75 percent of prime time television was owned by the networks
7923 that ran it. "In the ten-year period between 1992 and 2002, the number
7924 of prime time television hours per week produced by network studios
7925 increased over 200%, whereas the number of prime time television hours
7926 per week produced by independent studios decreased
7927 63%."<footnote><para>
7928 <!-- f31 -->
7929 Ibid.
7930 </para></footnote>
7931 </para>
7932 <indexterm><primary>All in the Family</primary></indexterm>
7933 <para>
7934 Today, another Norman Lear with another <citetitle>All in the Family</citetitle> would
7935 find that he had the choice either to make the show less edgy or to be
7936 fired: The content of any show developed for a network is increasingly
7937 owned by the network.
7938 </para>
7939 <para>
7940 While the number of channels has increased dramatically, the ownership
7941 of those channels has narrowed to an ever smaller and smaller few. As
7942 Barry Diller said to Bill Moyers,
7943 <indexterm><primary>Diller, Barry</primary></indexterm>
7944 <indexterm><primary>Moyers, Bill</primary></indexterm>
7945 </para>
7946 <blockquote>
7947 <para>
7948 Well, if you have companies that produce, that finance, that air on
7949 their channel and then distribute worldwide everything that goes
7950 through their controlled distribution system, then what you get is
7951 fewer and fewer actual voices participating in the process. [We
7952 <!-- PAGE BREAK 177 -->
7953 u]sed to have dozens and dozens of thriving independent production
7954 companies producing television programs. Now you have less than a
7955 handful.<footnote><para>
7956 <!-- f32 -->
7957 "Barry Diller Takes on Media Deregulation," <citetitle>Now with Bill Moyers</citetitle>, Bill
7958 Moyers, 25 April 2003, edited transcript available at
7959 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #31</ulink>.
7960 </para></footnote>
7961 </para>
7962 </blockquote>
7963 <para>
7964 This narrowing has an effect on what is produced. The product of such
7965 large and concentrated networks is increasingly homogenous.
7966 Increasingly safe. Increasingly sterile. The product of news shows
7967 from networks like this is increasingly tailored to the message the
7968 network wants to convey. This is not the communist party, though from
7969 the inside, it must feel a bit like the communist party. No one can
7970 question without risk of consequence&mdash;not necessarily banishment
7971 to Siberia, but punishment nonetheless. Independent, critical,
7972 different views are quashed. This is not the environment for a
7973 democracy.
7974 </para>
7975 <indexterm><primary>Clark, Kim B.</primary></indexterm>
7976 <para>
7977 Economics itself offers a parallel that explains why this integration
7978 affects creativity. Clay Christensen has written about the "Innovator's
7979 Dilemma": the fact that large traditional firms find it rational to ignore
7980 new, breakthrough technologies that compete with their core business.
7981 The same analysis could help explain why large, traditional media
7982 companies would find it rational to ignore new cultural trends.<footnote><para>
7983 <!-- f33 -->
7984 Clayton M. Christensen, <citetitle>The Innovator's Dilemma: The
7985 Revolutionary National Bestseller that Changed the Way We Do Business</citetitle>
7986 (Cambridge: Harvard Business School Press, 1997). Christensen
7987 acknowledges that the idea was first suggested by Dean Kim Clark. See
7988 Kim B. Clark, "The Interaction of Design Hierarchies and Market
7989 Concepts in Technological Evolution," <citetitle>Research Policy</citetitle> 14 (1985):
7990 235&ndash;51. For a more recent study, see Richard Foster and Sarah
7991 Kaplan, <citetitle>Creative Destruction: Why Companies That Are Built to Last
7992 Underperform the Market&mdash;and How to Successfully Transform Them</citetitle>
7993 (New York: Currency/Doubleday, 2001). </para></footnote>
7994
7995 Lumbering giants not only don't, but should not, sprint. Yet if the
7996 field is only open to the giants, there will be far too little
7997 sprinting.
7998 <indexterm><primary>Christensen, Clayton M.</primary></indexterm>
7999 </para>
8000 <para>
8001 I don't think we know enough about the economics of the media
8002 market to say with certainty what concentration and integration will
8003 do. The efficiencies are important, and the effect on culture is hard to
8004 measure.
8005 </para>
8006 <para>
8007 But there is a quintessentially obvious example that does strongly
8008 suggest the concern.
8009 </para>
8010 <para>
8011 In addition to the copyright wars, we're in the middle of the drug
8012 wars. Government policy is strongly directed against the drug cartels;
8013 criminal and civil courts are filled with the consequences of this battle.
8014 </para>
8015 <para>
8016 Let me hereby disqualify myself from any possible appointment to
8017 any position in government by saying I believe this war is a profound
8018 mistake. I am not pro drugs. Indeed, I come from a family once
8019
8020 <!-- PAGE BREAK 178 -->
8021 wrecked by drugs&mdash;though the drugs that wrecked my family were
8022 all quite legal. I believe this war is a profound mistake because the
8023 collateral damage from it is so great as to make waging the war
8024 insane. When you add together the burdens on the criminal justice
8025 system, the desperation of generations of kids whose only real
8026 economic opportunities are as drug warriors, the queering of
8027 constitutional protections because of the constant surveillance this
8028 war requires, and, most profoundly, the total destruction of the legal
8029 systems of many South American nations because of the power of the
8030 local drug cartels, I find it impossible to believe that the marginal
8031 benefit in reduced drug consumption by Americans could possibly
8032 outweigh these costs.
8033 </para>
8034 <para>
8035 You may not be convinced. That's fine. We live in a democracy, and it
8036 is through votes that we are to choose policy. But to do that, we
8037 depend fundamentally upon the press to help inform Americans about
8038 these issues.
8039 </para>
8040 <para>
8041 Beginning in 1998, the Office of National Drug Control Policy launched
8042 a media campaign as part of the "war on drugs." The campaign produced
8043 scores of short film clips about issues related to illegal drugs. In
8044 one series (the Nick and Norm series) two men are in a bar, discussing
8045 the idea of legalizing drugs as a way to avoid some of the collateral
8046 damage from the war. One advances an argument in favor of drug
8047 legalization. The other responds in a powerful and effective way
8048 against the argument of the first. In the end, the first guy changes
8049 his mind (hey, it's television). The plug at the end is a damning
8050 attack on the pro-legalization campaign.
8051 </para>
8052 <para>
8053 Fair enough. It's a good ad. Not terribly misleading. It delivers its
8054 message well. It's a fair and reasonable message.
8055 </para>
8056 <para>
8057 But let's say you think it is a wrong message, and you'd like to run a
8058 countercommercial. Say you want to run a series of ads that try to
8059 demonstrate the extraordinary collateral harm that comes from the drug
8060 war. Can you do it?
8061 </para>
8062 <para>
8063 Well, obviously, these ads cost lots of money. Assume you raise the
8064 <!-- PAGE BREAK 179 -->
8065 money. Assume a group of concerned citizens donates all the money in
8066 the world to help you get your message out. Can you be sure your
8067 message will be heard then?
8068 </para>
8069 <para>
8070 No. You cannot. Television stations have a general policy of avoiding
8071 "controversial" ads. Ads sponsored by the government are deemed
8072 uncontroversial; ads disagreeing with the government are
8073 controversial. This selectivity might be thought inconsistent with
8074 the First Amendment, but the Supreme Court has held that stations have
8075 the right to choose what they run. Thus, the major channels of
8076 commercial media will refuse one side of a crucial debate the
8077 opportunity to present its case. And the courts will defend the
8078 rights of the stations to be this biased.<footnote><para>
8079 <!-- f34 -->
8080 The Marijuana Policy Project, in February 2003, sought to place ads
8081 that directly responded to the Nick and Norm series on stations within
8082 the Washington, D.C., area. Comcast rejected the ads as "against
8083 [their] policy." The local NBC affiliate, WRC, rejected the ads
8084 without reviewing them. The local ABC affiliate, WJOA, originally
8085 agreed to run the ads and accepted payment to do so, but later decided
8086 not to run the ads and returned the collected fees. Interview with
8087 Neal Levine, 15 October 2003. These restrictions are, of course, not
8088 limited to drug policy. See, for example, Nat Ives, "On the Issue of
8089 an Iraq War, Advocacy Ads Meet with Rejection from TV Networks," <citetitle>New
8090 York Times</citetitle>, 13 March 2003, C4. Outside of election-related air time
8091 there is very little that the FCC or the courts are willing to do to
8092 even the playing field. For a general overview, see Rhonda Brown, "Ad
8093 Hoc Access: The Regulation of Editorial Advertising on Television and
8094 Radio," <citetitle>Yale Law and Policy Review</citetitle> 6 (1988): 449&ndash;79, and for a
8095 more recent summary of the stance of the FCC and the courts, see
8096 <citetitle>Radio-Television News Directors Association</citetitle> v. <citetitle>FCC</citetitle>, 184 F. 3d 872
8097 (D.C. Cir. 1999). Municipal authorities exercise the same authority as
8098 the networks. In a recent example from San Francisco, the San
8099 Francisco transit authority rejected an ad that criticized its Muni
8100 diesel buses. Phillip Matier and Andrew Ross, "Antidiesel Group Fuming
8101 After Muni Rejects Ad," SFGate.com, 16 June 2003, available at
8102 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #32</ulink>. The ground
8103 was that the criticism was "too controversial."
8104 <indexterm><primary>Comcast</primary></indexterm>
8105 <indexterm><primary>Marijuana Policy Project</primary></indexterm>
8106 <indexterm><primary>WJOA</primary></indexterm>
8107 </para></footnote>
8108 </para>
8109 <para>
8110 I'd be happy to defend the networks' rights, as well&mdash;if we lived
8111 in a media market that was truly diverse. But concentration in the
8112 media throws that condition into doubt. If a handful of companies
8113 control access to the media, and that handful of companies gets to
8114 decide which political positions it will allow to be promoted on its
8115 channels, then in an obvious and important way, concentration
8116 matters. You might like the positions the handful of companies
8117 selects. But you should not like a world in which a mere few get to
8118 decide which issues the rest of us get to know about.
8119 </para>
8120 </section>
8121 <section id="together">
8122 <title>Together</title>
8123 <para>
8124 There is something innocent and obvious about the claim of the
8125 copyright warriors that the government should "protect my property."
8126 In the abstract, it is obviously true and, ordinarily, totally
8127 harmless. No sane sort who is not an anarchist could disagree.
8128 </para>
8129 <para>
8130 But when we see how dramatically this "property" has changed&mdash;
8131 when we recognize how it might now interact with both technology and
8132 markets to mean that the effective constraint on the liberty to
8133 cultivate our culture is dramatically different&mdash;the claim begins
8134 to seem
8135
8136 <!-- PAGE BREAK 180 -->
8137 less innocent and obvious. Given (1) the power of technology to
8138 supplement the law's control, and (2) the power of concentrated
8139 markets to weaken the opportunity for dissent, if strictly enforcing
8140 the massively expanded "property" rights granted by copyright
8141 fundamentally changes the freedom within this culture to cultivate and
8142 build upon our past, then we have to ask whether this property should
8143 be redefined.
8144 </para>
8145 <para>
8146 Not starkly. Or absolutely. My point is not that we should abolish
8147 copyright or go back to the eighteenth century. That would be a total
8148 mistake, disastrous for the most important creative enterprises within
8149 our culture today.
8150 </para>
8151 <para>
8152 But there is a space between zero and one, Internet culture
8153 notwithstanding. And these massive shifts in the effective power of
8154 copyright regulation, tied to increased concentration of the content
8155 industry and resting in the hands of technology that will increasingly
8156 enable control over the use of culture, should drive us to consider
8157 whether another adjustment is called for. Not an adjustment that
8158 increases copyright's power. Not an adjustment that increases its
8159 term. Rather, an adjustment to restore the balance that has
8160 traditionally defined copyright's regulation&mdash;a weakening of that
8161 regulation, to strengthen creativity.
8162 </para>
8163 <para>
8164 Copyright law has not been a rock of Gibraltar. It's not a set of
8165 constant commitments that, for some mysterious reason, teenagers and
8166 geeks now flout. Instead, copyright power has grown dramatically in a
8167 short period of time, as the technologies of distribution and creation
8168 have changed and as lobbyists have pushed for more control by
8169 copyright holders. Changes in the past in response to changes in
8170 technology suggest that we may well need similar changes in the
8171 future. And these changes have to be <emphasis>reductions</emphasis>
8172 in the scope of copyright, in response to the extraordinary increase
8173 in control that technology and the market enable.
8174 </para>
8175 <para>
8176 For the single point that is lost in this war on pirates is a point that
8177 we see only after surveying the range of these changes. When you add
8178 <!-- PAGE BREAK 181 -->
8179 together the effect of changing law, concentrated markets, and
8180 changing technology, together they produce an astonishing conclusion:
8181 <emphasis>Never in our history have fewer had a legal right to control
8182 more of the development of our culture than now</emphasis>.
8183 </para>
8184 <para>
8185 Not when copyrights were perpetual, for when copyrights were
8186 perpetual, they affected only that precise creative work. Not when
8187 only publishers had the tools to publish, for the market then was much
8188 more diverse. Not when there were only three television networks, for
8189 even then, newspapers, film studios, radio stations, and publishers
8190 were independent of the networks. <emphasis>Never</emphasis> has
8191 copyright protected such a wide range of rights, against as broad a
8192 range of actors, for a term that was remotely as long. This form of
8193 regulation&mdash;a tiny regulation of a tiny part of the creative
8194 energy of a nation at the founding&mdash;is now a massive regulation
8195 of the overall creative process. Law plus technology plus the market
8196 now interact to turn this historically benign regulation into the most
8197 significant regulation of culture that our free society has
8198 known.<footnote><para>
8199 <!-- f35 -->
8200 Siva Vaidhyanathan captures a similar point in his "four surrenders" of
8201 copyright law in the digital age. See Vaidhyanathan, 159&ndash;60.
8202 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva</primary></indexterm>
8203 </para></footnote>
8204 </para>
8205 <para>
8206 This has been a long chapter. Its point can now be briefly stated.
8207 </para>
8208 <para>
8209 At the start of this book, I distinguished between commercial and
8210 noncommercial culture. In the course of this chapter, I have
8211 distinguished between copying a work and transforming it. We can now
8212 combine these two distinctions and draw a clear map of the changes
8213 that copyright law has undergone. In 1790, the law looked like this:
8214 </para>
8215
8216 <table id="t2">
8217 <title></title>
8218 <tgroup cols="3" align="char">
8219 <thead>
8220 <row>
8221 <entry></entry>
8222 <entry>PUBLISH</entry>
8223 <entry>TRANSFORM</entry>
8224 </row>
8225 </thead>
8226 <tbody>
8227 <row>
8228 <entry>Commercial</entry>
8229 <entry>&copy;</entry>
8230 <entry>Free</entry>
8231 </row>
8232 <row>
8233 <entry>Noncommercial</entry>
8234 <entry>Free</entry>
8235 <entry>Free</entry>
8236 </row>
8237 </tbody>
8238 </tgroup>
8239 </table>
8240
8241 <para>
8242 The act of publishing a map, chart, and book was regulated by
8243 copyright law. Nothing else was. Transformations were free. And as
8244 copyright attached only with registration, and only those who intended
8245
8246 <!-- PAGE BREAK 182 -->
8247 to benefit commercially would register, copying through publishing of
8248 noncommercial work was also free.
8249 </para>
8250 <para>
8251 By the end of the nineteenth century, the law had changed to this:
8252 </para>
8253
8254 <table id="t3">
8255 <title></title>
8256 <tgroup cols="3" align="char">
8257 <thead>
8258 <row>
8259 <entry></entry>
8260 <entry>PUBLISH</entry>
8261 <entry>TRANSFORM</entry>
8262 </row>
8263 </thead>
8264 <tbody>
8265 <row>
8266 <entry>Commercial</entry>
8267 <entry>&copy;</entry>
8268 <entry>&copy;</entry>
8269 </row>
8270 <row>
8271 <entry>Noncommercial</entry>
8272 <entry>Free</entry>
8273 <entry>Free</entry>
8274 </row>
8275 </tbody>
8276 </tgroup>
8277 </table>
8278
8279 <para>
8280 Derivative works were now regulated by copyright law&mdash;if
8281 published, which again, given the economics of publishing at the time,
8282 means if offered commercially. But noncommercial publishing and
8283 transformation were still essentially free.
8284 </para>
8285 <para>
8286 In 1909 the law changed to regulate copies, not publishing, and after
8287 this change, the scope of the law was tied to technology. As the
8288 technology of copying became more prevalent, the reach of the law
8289 expanded. Thus by 1975, as photocopying machines became more common,
8290 we could say the law began to look like this:
8291 </para>
8292
8293 <table id="t4">
8294 <title></title>
8295 <tgroup cols="3" align="char">
8296 <thead>
8297 <row>
8298 <entry></entry>
8299 <entry>COPY</entry>
8300 <entry>TRANSFORM</entry>
8301 </row>
8302 </thead>
8303 <tbody>
8304 <row>
8305 <entry>Commercial</entry>
8306 <entry>&copy;</entry>
8307 <entry>&copy;</entry>
8308 </row>
8309 <row>
8310 <entry>Noncommercial</entry>
8311 <entry>&copy;/Free</entry>
8312 <entry>Free</entry>
8313 </row>
8314 </tbody>
8315 </tgroup>
8316 </table>
8317
8318 <para>
8319 The law was interpreted to reach noncommercial copying through, say,
8320 copy machines, but still much of copying outside of the commercial
8321 market remained free. But the consequence of the emergence of digital
8322 technologies, especially in the context of a digital network, means
8323 that the law now looks like this:
8324 </para>
8325
8326 <table id="t5">
8327 <title></title>
8328 <tgroup cols="3" align="char">
8329 <thead>
8330 <row>
8331 <entry></entry>
8332 <entry>COPY</entry>
8333 <entry>TRANSFORM</entry>
8334 </row>
8335 </thead>
8336 <tbody>
8337 <row>
8338 <entry>Commercial</entry>
8339 <entry>&copy;</entry>
8340 <entry>&copy;</entry>
8341 </row>
8342 <row>
8343 <entry>Noncommercial</entry>
8344 <entry>&copy;</entry>
8345 <entry>&copy;</entry>
8346 </row>
8347 </tbody>
8348 </tgroup>
8349 </table>
8350
8351 <para>
8352 Every realm is governed by copyright law, whereas before most
8353 creativity was not. The law now regulates the full range of
8354 creativity&mdash;
8355 <!-- PAGE BREAK 183 -->
8356 commercial or not, transformative or not&mdash;with the same rules
8357 designed to regulate commercial publishers.
8358 </para>
8359 <para>
8360 Obviously, copyright law is not the enemy. The enemy is regulation
8361 that does no good. So the question that we should be asking just now
8362 is whether extending the regulations of copyright law into each of
8363 these domains actually does any good.
8364 </para>
8365 <para>
8366 I have no doubt that it does good in regulating commercial copying.
8367 But I also have no doubt that it does more harm than good when
8368 regulating (as it regulates just now) noncommercial copying and,
8369 especially, noncommercial transformation. And increasingly, for the
8370 reasons sketched especially in chapters 7 and 8, one might well wonder
8371 whether it does more harm than good for commercial transformation.
8372 More commercial transformative work would be created if derivative
8373 rights were more sharply restricted.
8374 </para>
8375 <para>
8376 The issue is therefore not simply whether copyright is property. Of
8377 course copyright is a kind of "property," and of course, as with any
8378 property, the state ought to protect it. But first impressions
8379 notwithstanding, historically, this property right (as with all
8380 property rights<footnote><para>
8381 <!-- f36 -->
8382 It was the single most important contribution of the legal realist
8383 movement to demonstrate that all property rights are always crafted to
8384 balance public and private interests. See Thomas C. Grey, "The
8385 Disintegration of Property," in <citetitle>Nomos XXII: Property</citetitle>, J. Roland
8386 Pennock and John W. Chapman, eds. (New York: New York University
8387 Press, 1980).
8388 </para></footnote>)
8389 has been crafted to balance the important need to give authors and
8390 artists incentives with the equally important need to assure access to
8391 creative work. This balance has always been struck in light of new
8392 technologies. And for almost half of our tradition, the "copyright"
8393 did not control <emphasis>at all</emphasis> the freedom of others to
8394 build upon or transform a creative work. American culture was born
8395 free, and for almost 180 years our country consistently protected a
8396 vibrant and rich free culture.
8397 </para>
8398 <para>
8399 We achieved that free culture because our law respected important
8400 limits on the scope of the interests protected by "property." The very
8401 birth of "copyright" as a statutory right recognized those limits, by
8402 granting copyright owners protection for a limited time only (the
8403 story of chapter 6). The tradition of "fair use" is animated by a
8404 similar concern that is increasingly under strain as the costs of
8405 exercising any fair use right become unavoidably high (the story of
8406 chapter 7). Adding
8407 <!-- PAGE BREAK 184 -->
8408 statutory rights where markets might stifle innovation is another
8409 familiar limit on the property right that copyright is (chapter
8410 8). And granting archives and libraries a broad freedom to collect,
8411 claims of property notwithstanding, is a crucial part of guaranteeing
8412 the soul of a culture (chapter 9). Free cultures, like free markets,
8413 are built with property. But the nature of the property that builds a
8414 free culture is very different from the extremist vision that
8415 dominates the debate today.
8416 </para>
8417 <para>
8418 Free culture is increasingly the casualty in this war on piracy. In
8419 response to a real, if not yet quantified, threat that the
8420 technologies of the Internet present to twentieth-century business
8421 models for producing and distributing culture, the law and technology
8422 are being transformed in a way that will undermine our tradition of
8423 free culture. The property right that is copyright is no longer the
8424 balanced right that it was, or was intended to be. The property right
8425 that is copyright has become unbalanced, tilted toward an extreme. The
8426 opportunity to create and transform becomes weakened in a world in
8427 which creation requires permission and creativity must check with a
8428 lawyer.
8429 </para>
8430 <!-- PAGE BREAK 185 -->
8431 </section>
8432 </chapter>
8433 </part>
8434 <part id="c-puzzles">
8435 <title>PUZZLES</title>
8436
8437 <!-- PAGE BREAK 186 -->
8438 <chapter id="chimera">
8439 <title>CHAPTER ELEVEN: Chimera</title>
8440 <indexterm id="idxchimera" class='startofrange'>
8441 <primary>chimeras</primary>
8442 </indexterm>
8443 <indexterm id="idxwells" class='startofrange'>
8444 <primary>Wells, H. G.</primary>
8445 </indexterm>
8446 <indexterm id="idxtcotb" class='startofrange'>
8447 <primary>&quot;Country of the Blind, The&quot; (Wells)</primary>
8448 </indexterm>
8449
8450 <para>
8451 In a well-known short story by H. G. Wells, a mountain climber
8452 named Nunez trips (literally, down an ice slope) into an unknown and
8453 isolated valley in the Peruvian Andes.<footnote><para>
8454 <!-- f1. -->
8455 H. G. Wells, "The Country of the Blind" (1904, 1911). See H. G. Wells,
8456 <citetitle>The Country of the Blind and Other Stories</citetitle>, Michael Sherborne, ed. (New
8457 York: Oxford University Press, 1996).
8458 </para></footnote>
8459 The valley is extraordinarily beautiful, with "sweet water, pasture,
8460 an even climate, slopes of rich brown soil with tangles of a shrub
8461 that bore an excellent fruit." But the villagers are all blind. Nunez
8462 takes this as an opportunity. "In the Country of the Blind," he tells
8463 himself, "the One-Eyed Man is King." So he resolves to live with the
8464 villagers to explore life as a king.
8465 </para>
8466 <para>
8467 Things don't go quite as he planned. He tries to explain the idea of
8468 sight to the villagers. They don't understand. He tells them they are
8469 "blind." They don't have the word <citetitle>blind</citetitle>. They think he's just thick.
8470 Indeed, as they increasingly notice the things he can't do (hear the
8471 sound of grass being stepped on, for example), they increasingly try
8472 to control him. He, in turn, becomes increasingly frustrated. "`You
8473 don't understand,' he cried, in a voice that was meant to be great and
8474 resolute, and which broke. `You are blind and I can see. Leave me
8475 alone!'"
8476 </para>
8477 <para>
8478 <!-- PAGE BREAK 187 -->
8479 The villagers don't leave him alone. Nor do they see (so to speak) the
8480 virtue of his special power. Not even the ultimate target of his
8481 affection, a young woman who to him seems "the most beautiful thing in
8482 the whole of creation," understands the beauty of sight. Nunez's
8483 description of what he sees "seemed to her the most poetical of
8484 fancies, and she listened to his description of the stars and the
8485 mountains and her own sweet white-lit beauty as though it was a guilty
8486 indulgence." "She did not believe," Wells tells us, and "she could
8487 only half understand, but she was mysteriously delighted."
8488 </para>
8489 <para>
8490 When Nunez announces his desire to marry his "mysteriously delighted"
8491 love, the father and the village object. "You see, my dear," her
8492 father instructs, "he's an idiot. He has delusions. He can't do
8493 anything right." They take Nunez to the village doctor.
8494 </para>
8495 <para>
8496 After a careful examination, the doctor gives his opinion. "His brain
8497 is affected," he reports.
8498 </para>
8499 <para>
8500 "What affects it?" the father asks. "Those queer things that are
8501 called the eyes . . . are diseased . . . in such a way as to affect
8502 his brain."
8503 </para>
8504 <para>
8505 The doctor continues: "I think I may say with reasonable certainty
8506 that in order to cure him completely, all that we need to do is a
8507 simple and easy surgical operation&mdash;namely, to remove these
8508 irritant bodies [the eyes]."
8509 </para>
8510 <para>
8511 "Thank Heaven for science!" says the father to the doctor. They inform
8512 Nunez of this condition necessary for him to be allowed his bride.
8513 (You'll have to read the original to learn what happens in the end. I
8514 believe in free culture, but never in giving away the end of a story.)
8515 It sometimes happens that the eggs of twins fuse in the mother's
8516 womb. That fusion produces a "chimera." A chimera is a single creature
8517 with two sets of DNA. The DNA in the blood, for example, might be
8518 different from the DNA of the skin. This possibility is an underused
8519
8520 <!-- PAGE BREAK 188 -->
8521 plot for murder mysteries. "But the DNA shows with 100 percent
8522 certainty that she was not the person whose blood was at the
8523 scene. . . ."
8524 </para>
8525 <indexterm startref="idxtcotb" class='endofrange'/>
8526 <indexterm startref="idxwells" class="endofrange"/>
8527 <para>
8528 Before I had read about chimeras, I would have said they were
8529 impossible. A single person can't have two sets of DNA. The very idea
8530 of DNA is that it is the code of an individual. Yet in fact, not only
8531 can two individuals have the same set of DNA (identical twins), but
8532 one person can have two different sets of DNA (a chimera). Our
8533 understanding of a "person" should reflect this reality.
8534 </para>
8535 <para>
8536 The more I work to understand the current struggle over copyright and
8537 culture, which I've sometimes called unfairly, and sometimes not
8538 unfairly enough, "the copyright wars," the more I think we're dealing
8539 with a chimera. For example, in the battle over the question "What is
8540 p2p file sharing?" both sides have it right, and both sides have it
8541 wrong. One side says, "File sharing is just like two kids taping each
8542 others' records&mdash;the sort of thing we've been doing for the last
8543 thirty years without any question at all." That's true, at least in
8544 part. When I tell my best friend to try out a new CD that I've bought,
8545 but rather than just send the CD, I point him to my p2p server, that
8546 is, in all relevant respects, just like what every executive in every
8547 recording company no doubt did as a kid: sharing music.
8548 </para>
8549 <para>
8550 But the description is also false in part. For when my p2p server is
8551 on a p2p network through which anyone can get access to my music, then
8552 sure, my friends can get access, but it stretches the meaning of
8553 "friends" beyond recognition to say "my ten thousand best friends" can
8554 get access. Whether or not sharing my music with my best friend is
8555 what "we have always been allowed to do," we have not always been
8556 allowed to share music with "our ten thousand best friends."
8557 </para>
8558 <para>
8559 Likewise, when the other side says, "File sharing is just like walking
8560 into a Tower Records and taking a CD off the shelf and walking out
8561 with it," that's true, at least in part. If, after Lyle Lovett
8562 (finally) releases a new album, rather than buying it, I go to Kazaa
8563 and find a free copy to take, that is very much like stealing a copy
8564 from Tower.
8565 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle</primary></indexterm>
8566 </para>
8567 <para>
8568
8569 <!-- PAGE BREAK 189 -->
8570 But it is not quite stealing from Tower. After all, when I take a CD
8571 from Tower Records, Tower has one less CD to sell. And when I take a
8572 CD from Tower Records, I get a bit of plastic and a cover, and
8573 something to show on my shelves. (And, while we're at it, we could
8574 also note that when I take a CD from Tower Records, the maximum fine
8575 that might be imposed on me, under California law, at least, is
8576 $1,000. According to the RIAA, by contrast, if I download a ten-song
8577 CD, I'm liable for $1,500,000 in damages.)
8578 </para>
8579 <para>
8580 The point is not that it is as neither side describes. The point is
8581 that it is both&mdash;both as the RIAA describes it and as Kazaa
8582 describes it. It is a chimera. And rather than simply denying what the
8583 other side asserts, we need to begin to think about how we should
8584 respond to this chimera. What rules should govern it?
8585 </para>
8586 <para>
8587 We could respond by simply pretending that it is not a chimera. We
8588 could, with the RIAA, decide that every act of file sharing should be
8589 a felony. We could prosecute families for millions of dollars in
8590 damages just because file sharing occurred on a family computer. And
8591 we can get universities to monitor all computer traffic to make sure
8592 that no computer is used to commit this crime. These responses might
8593 be extreme, but each of them has either been proposed or actually
8594 implemented.<footnote><para>
8595 <!-- f2. -->
8596 For an excellent summary, see the report prepared by GartnerG2 and the
8597 Berkman Center for Internet and Society at Harvard Law School,
8598 "Copyright and Digital Media in a Post-Napster World," 27 June 2003,
8599 available at
8600 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
8601 #33</ulink>. Reps. John Conyers Jr. (D-Mich.) and Howard L. Berman
8602 (D-Calif.) have introduced a bill that would treat unauthorized
8603 on-line copying as a felony offense with punishments ranging as high
8604 as five years imprisonment; see Jon Healey, "House Bill Aims to Up
8605 Stakes on Piracy," <citetitle>Los Angeles Times</citetitle>, 17 July 2003, available at
8606 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #34</ulink>. Civil
8607 penalties are currently set at $150,000 per copied song. For a recent
8608 (and unsuccessful) legal challenge to the RIAA's demand that an ISP
8609 reveal the identity of a user accused of sharing more than 600 songs
8610 through a family computer, see <citetitle>RIAA</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Verizon Internet Services (In
8611 re. Verizon Internet Services)</citetitle>, 240 F. Supp. 2d 24
8612 (D.D.C. 2003). Such a user could face liability ranging as high as $90
8613 million. Such astronomical figures furnish the RIAA with a powerful
8614 arsenal in its prosecution of file sharers. Settlements ranging from
8615 $12,000 to $17,500 for four students accused of heavy file sharing on
8616 university networks must have seemed a mere pittance next to the $98
8617 billion the RIAA could seek should the matter proceed to court. See
8618 Elizabeth Young, "Downloading Could Lead to Fines," redandblack.com,
8619 August 2003, available at
8620 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #35</ulink>. For an
8621 example of the RIAA's targeting of student file sharing, and of the
8622 subpoenas issued to universities to reveal student file-sharer
8623 identities, see James Collins, "RIAA Steps Up Bid to Force BC, MIT to
8624 Name Students," <citetitle>Boston Globe</citetitle>, 8 August 2003, D3, available at
8625 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #36</ulink>.
8626 <indexterm><primary>Berman, Howard L.</primary></indexterm>
8627 </para></footnote>
8628
8629 </para>
8630 <indexterm startref="idxchimera" class='endofrange'/>
8631 <para>
8632 Alternatively, we could respond to file sharing the way many kids act
8633 as though we've responded. We could totally legalize it. Let there be
8634 no copyright liability, either civil or criminal, for making
8635 copyrighted content available on the Net. Make file sharing like
8636 gossip: regulated, if at all, by social norms but not by law.
8637 </para>
8638 <para>
8639 Either response is possible. I think either would be a mistake.
8640 Rather than embrace one of these two extremes, we should embrace
8641 something that recognizes the truth in both. And while I end this book
8642 with a sketch of a system that does just that, my aim in the next
8643 chapter is to show just how awful it would be for us to adopt the
8644 zero-tolerance extreme. I believe <emphasis>either</emphasis> extreme
8645 would be worse than a reasonable alternative. But I believe the
8646 zero-tolerance solution would be the worse of the two extremes.
8647 </para>
8648 <para>
8649
8650 <!-- PAGE BREAK 190 -->
8651 Yet zero tolerance is increasingly our government's policy. In the
8652 middle of the chaos that the Internet has created, an extraordinary
8653 land grab is occurring. The law and technology are being shifted to
8654 give content holders a kind of control over our culture that they have
8655 never had before. And in this extremism, many an opportunity for new
8656 innovation and new creativity will be lost.
8657 </para>
8658 <para>
8659 I'm not talking about the opportunities for kids to "steal" music. My
8660 focus instead is the commercial and cultural innovation that this war
8661 will also kill. We have never seen the power to innovate spread so
8662 broadly among our citizens, and we have just begun to see the
8663 innovation that this power will unleash. Yet the Internet has already
8664 seen the passing of one cycle of innovation around technologies to
8665 distribute content. The law is responsible for this passing. As the
8666 vice president for global public policy at one of these new
8667 innovators, eMusic.com, put it when criticizing the DMCA's added
8668 protection for copyrighted material,
8669 </para>
8670 <blockquote>
8671 <para>
8672 eMusic opposes music piracy. We are a distributor of copyrighted
8673 material, and we want to protect those rights.
8674 </para>
8675 <para>
8676 But building a technology fortress that locks in the clout of
8677 the major labels is by no means the only way to protect copyright
8678 interests, nor is it necessarily the best. It is simply too early to
8679 answer
8680 that question. Market forces operating naturally may very
8681 well produce a totally different industry model.
8682 </para>
8683 <para>
8684 This is a critical point. The choices that industry sectors make
8685 with respect to these systems will in many ways directly shape the
8686 market for digital media and the manner in which digital media
8687 are distributed. This in turn will directly influence the options
8688 that are available to consumers, both in terms of the ease with
8689 which they will be able to access digital media and the equipment
8690 that they will require to do so. Poor choices made this early in the
8691 game will retard the growth of this market, hurting everyone's
8692 interests.<footnote><para>
8693 <!-- f3. -->
8694 WIPO and the DMCA One Year Later: Assessing Consumer Access to Digital
8695 Entertainment on the Internet and Other Media: Hearing Before the
8696 Subcommittee on Telecommunications, Trade, and Consumer Protection,
8697 House Committee on Commerce, 106th Cong. 29 (1999) (statement of Peter
8698 Harter, vice president, Global Public Policy and Standards,
8699 EMusic.com), available in LEXIS, Federal Document Clearing House
8700 Congressional Testimony File. </para></footnote>
8701 </para>
8702 </blockquote>
8703 <!-- PAGE BREAK 191 -->
8704 <para>
8705 In April 2001, eMusic.com was purchased by Vivendi Universal,
8706 one of "the major labels." Its position on these matters has now
8707 changed.
8708 <indexterm><primary>Vivendi Universal</primary></indexterm>
8709 </para>
8710 <para>
8711 Reversing our tradition of tolerance now will not merely quash
8712 piracy. It will sacrifice values that are important to this culture,
8713 and will kill opportunities that could be extraordinarily valuable.
8714 </para>
8715
8716 <!-- PAGE BREAK 192 -->
8717 </chapter>
8718 <chapter id="harms">
8719 <title>CHAPTER TWELVE: Harms</title>
8720 <para>
8721
8722 To fight "piracy," to protect "property," the content industry has
8723 launched a war. Lobbying and lots of campaign contributions have
8724 now brought the government into this war. As with any war, this one
8725 will have both direct and collateral damage. As with any war of
8726 prohibition,
8727 these damages will be suffered most by our own people.
8728 </para>
8729 <para>
8730 My aim so far has been to describe the consequences of this war, in
8731 particular, the consequences for "free culture." But my aim now is to
8732 extend
8733 this description of consequences into an argument. Is this war
8734 justified?
8735 </para>
8736 <para>
8737 In my view, it is not. There is no good reason why this time, for the
8738 first time, the law should defend the old against the new, just when the
8739 power of the property called "intellectual property" is at its greatest in
8740 our history.
8741 </para>
8742 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee</primary></indexterm>
8743 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie</primary></indexterm>
8744 <para>
8745 Yet "common sense" does not see it this way. Common sense is still on
8746 the side of the Causbys and the content industry. The extreme claims
8747 of control in the name of property still resonate; the uncritical
8748 rejection of "piracy" still has play.
8749 </para>
8750 <para>
8751 <!-- PAGE BREAK 193 -->
8752 There will be many consequences of continuing this war. I want to
8753 describe just three. All three might be said to be unintended. I am quite
8754 confident the third is unintended. I'm less sure about the first two. The
8755 first two protect modern RCAs, but there is no Howard Armstrong in
8756 the wings to fight today's monopolists of culture.
8757 </para>
8758 <section id="constrain">
8759 <title>Constraining Creators</title>
8760 <para>
8761 In the next ten years we will see an explosion of digital
8762 technologies. These technologies will enable almost anyone to capture
8763 and share content. Capturing and sharing content, of course, is what
8764 humans have done since the dawn of man. It is how we learn and
8765 communicate. But capturing and sharing through digital technology is
8766 different. The fidelity and power are different. You could send an
8767 e-mail telling someone about a joke you saw on Comedy Central, or you
8768 could send the clip. You could write an essay about the
8769 inconsistencies in the arguments of the politician you most love to
8770 hate, or you could make a short film that puts statement against
8771 statement. You could write a poem to express your love, or you could
8772 weave together a string&mdash;a mash-up&mdash; of songs from your
8773 favorite artists in a collage and make it available on the Net.
8774 </para>
8775 <para>
8776 This digital "capturing and sharing" is in part an extension of the
8777 capturing and sharing that has always been integral to our culture,
8778 and in part it is something new. It is continuous with the Kodak, but
8779 it explodes the boundaries of Kodak-like technologies. The technology
8780 of digital "capturing and sharing" promises a world of extraordinarily
8781 diverse creativity that can be easily and broadly shared. And as that
8782 creativity is applied to democracy, it will enable a broad range of
8783 citizens to use technology to express and criticize and contribute to
8784 the culture all around.
8785 </para>
8786 <para>
8787 Technology has thus given us an opportunity to do something with
8788 culture that has only ever been possible for individuals in small groups,
8789
8790 <!-- PAGE BREAK 194 -->
8791
8792 isolated from others. Think about an old man telling a story to a
8793 collection of neighbors in a small town. Now imagine that same
8794 storytelling extended across the globe.
8795 </para>
8796 <para>
8797 Yet all this is possible only if the activity is presumptively legal. In
8798 the current regime of legal regulation, it is not. Forget file sharing for
8799 a moment. Think about your favorite amazing sites on the Net. Web
8800 sites that offer plot summaries from forgotten television shows; sites
8801 that catalog cartoons from the 1960s; sites that mix images and sound
8802 to criticize politicians or businesses; sites that gather newspaper articles
8803 on remote topics of science or culture. There is a vast amount of creative
8804 work spread across the Internet. But as the law is currently crafted, this
8805 work is presumptively illegal.
8806 </para>
8807 <para>
8808 That presumption will increasingly chill creativity, as the
8809 examples of extreme penalties for vague infringements continue to
8810 proliferate. It is impossible to get a clear sense of what's allowed
8811 and what's not, and at the same time, the penalties for crossing the
8812 line are astonishingly harsh. The four students who were threatened
8813 by the RIAA ( Jesse Jordan of chapter 3 was just one) were threatened
8814 with a $98 billion lawsuit for building search engines that permitted
8815 songs to be copied. Yet World-Com&mdash;which defrauded investors of
8816 $11 billion, resulting in a loss to investors in market capitalization
8817 of over $200 billion&mdash;received a fine of a mere $750
8818 million.<footnote><para>
8819 <!-- f1. -->
8820 See Lynne W. Jeter, <citetitle>Disconnected: Deceit and Betrayal at WorldCom</citetitle>
8821 (Hoboken, N.J.: John Wiley &amp; Sons, 2003), 176, 204; for details of
8822 the settlement, see MCI press release, "MCI Wins U.S. District Court
8823 Approval for SEC Settlement" (7 July 2003), available at
8824 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #37</ulink>.
8825 <indexterm><primary>Worldcom</primary></indexterm>
8826 </para></footnote>
8827 And under legislation being pushed in Congress right now, a doctor who
8828 negligently removes the wrong leg in an operation would be liable for
8829 no more than $250,000 in damages for pain and
8830 suffering.<footnote>
8831 <para>
8832 <!-- f2. --> The bill, modeled after California's tort reform model, was passed in the
8833 House of Representatives but defeated in a Senate vote in July 2003. For
8834 an overview, see Tanya Albert, "Measure Stalls in Senate: `We'll Be Back,'
8835 Say Tort Reformers," amednews.com, 28 July 2003, available at
8836 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #38</ulink>,
8837 and "Senate Turns Back Malpractice Caps," CBSNews.com, 9 July 2003,
8838 available at
8839 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #39</ulink>. President Bush has continued to urge tort reform in
8840 recent months.
8841 <indexterm><primary>Bush, George W.</primary></indexterm>
8842 </para></footnote>
8843 Can common sense recognize the absurdity in a world where
8844 the maximum fine for downloading two songs off the Internet is more
8845 than the fine for a doctor's negligently butchering a patient?
8846 <indexterm><primary>Worldcom</primary></indexterm>
8847 </para>
8848 <para>
8849 The consequence of this legal uncertainty, tied to these extremely
8850 high penalties, is that an extraordinary amount of creativity will
8851 either never be exercised, or never be exercised in the open. We drive
8852 this creative process underground by branding the modern-day Walt
8853 Disneys "pirates." We make it impossible for businesses to rely upon a
8854 public domain, because the boundaries of the public domain are
8855 designed to
8856
8857 <!-- PAGE BREAK 195 -->
8858 be unclear. It never pays to do anything except pay for the right
8859 to create, and hence only those who can pay are allowed to create. As
8860 was the case in the Soviet Union, though for very different reasons,
8861 we will begin to see a world of underground art&mdash;not because the
8862 message is necessarily political, or because the subject is
8863 controversial, but because the very act of creating the art is legally
8864 fraught. Already, exhibits of "illegal art" tour the United
8865 States.<footnote><para>
8866 <!-- f3. -->
8867
8868 See Danit Lidor, "Artists Just Wanna Be Free," <citetitle>Wired</citetitle>, 7 July
8869 2003, available at
8870 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #40</ulink>. For an overview of the exhibition, see
8871 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #41</ulink>.
8872 </para></footnote>
8873 In what does their "illegality" consist?
8874 In the act of mixing the culture around us with an expression that is
8875 critical or reflective.
8876 </para>
8877 <para>
8878 Part of the reason for this fear of illegality has to do with the
8879 changing law. I described that change in detail in chapter 10. But an
8880 even bigger part has to do with the increasing ease with which
8881 infractions can be tracked. As users of file-sharing systems
8882 discovered in 2002, it is a trivial matter for copyright owners to get
8883 courts to order Internet service providers to reveal who has what
8884 content. It is as if your cassette tape player transmitted a list of
8885 the songs that you played in the privacy of your own home that anyone
8886 could tune into for whatever reason they chose.
8887 </para>
8888 <para>
8889 Never in our history has a painter had to worry about whether
8890 his painting infringed on someone else's work; but the modern-day
8891 painter, using the tools of Photoshop, sharing content on the Web,
8892 must worry all the time. Images are all around, but the only safe images
8893 to use in the act of creation are those purchased from Corbis or another
8894 image farm. And in purchasing, censoring happens. There is a free
8895 market in pencils; we needn't worry about its effect on creativity. But
8896 there is a highly regulated, monopolized market in cultural icons; the
8897 right to cultivate and transform them is not similarly free.
8898 </para>
8899 <para>
8900 Lawyers rarely see this because lawyers are rarely empirical. As I
8901 described in chapter 7, in response to the story about documentary
8902 filmmaker Jon Else, I have been lectured again and again by lawyers
8903 who insist Else's use was fair use, and hence I am wrong to say that the
8904 law regulates such a use.
8905 </para>
8906 <para>
8907
8908 <!-- PAGE BREAK 196 -->
8909 But fair use in America simply means the right to hire a lawyer to
8910 defend your right to create. And as lawyers love to forget, our system
8911 for defending rights such as fair use is astonishingly bad&mdash;in
8912 practically every context, but especially here. It costs too much, it
8913 delivers too slowly, and what it delivers often has little connection
8914 to the justice underlying the claim. The legal system may be tolerable
8915 for the very rich. For everyone else, it is an embarrassment to a
8916 tradition that prides itself on the rule of law.
8917 </para>
8918 <para>
8919 Judges and lawyers can tell themselves that fair use provides adequate
8920 "breathing room" between regulation by the law and the access the law
8921 should allow. But it is a measure of how out of touch our legal system
8922 has become that anyone actually believes this. The rules that
8923 publishers impose upon writers, the rules that film distributors
8924 impose upon filmmakers, the rules that newspapers impose upon
8925 journalists&mdash; these are the real laws governing creativity. And
8926 these rules have little relationship to the "law" with which judges
8927 comfort themselves.
8928 </para>
8929 <para>
8930 For in a world that threatens $150,000 for a single willful
8931 infringement of a copyright, and which demands tens of thousands of
8932 dollars to even defend against a copyright infringement claim, and
8933 which would never return to the wrongfully accused defendant anything
8934 of the costs she suffered to defend her right to speak&mdash;in that
8935 world, the astonishingly broad regulations that pass under the name
8936 "copyright" silence speech and creativity. And in that world, it takes
8937 a studied blindness for people to continue to believe they live in a
8938 culture that is free.
8939 </para>
8940 <para>
8941 As Jed Horovitz, the businessman behind Video Pipeline, said to me,
8942 </para>
8943 <blockquote>
8944 <para>
8945 We're losing [creative] opportunities right and left. Creative people
8946 are being forced not to express themselves. Thoughts are not being
8947 expressed. And while a lot of stuff may [still] be created, it still
8948 won't get distributed. Even if the stuff gets made . . . you're not
8949 going to get it distributed in the mainstream media unless
8950 <!-- PAGE BREAK 197 -->
8951 you've got a little note from a lawyer saying, "This has been
8952 cleared." You're not even going to get it on PBS without that kind of
8953 permission. That's the point at which they control it.
8954 </para>
8955 </blockquote>
8956 </section>
8957 <section id="innovators">
8958 <title>Constraining Innovators</title>
8959 <para>
8960 The story of the last section was a crunchy-lefty
8961 story&mdash;creativity quashed, artists who can't speak, yada yada
8962 yada. Maybe that doesn't get you going. Maybe you think there's enough
8963 weird art out there, and enough expression that is critical of what
8964 seems to be just about everything. And if you think that, you might
8965 think there's little in this story to worry you.
8966 </para>
8967 <para>
8968 But there's an aspect of this story that is not lefty in any sense.
8969 Indeed, it is an aspect that could be written by the most extreme
8970 promarket ideologue. And if you're one of these sorts (and a special
8971 one at that, 188 pages into a book like this), then you can see this
8972 other aspect by substituting "free market" every place I've spoken of
8973 "free culture." The point is the same, even if the interests
8974 affecting culture are more fundamental.
8975 </para>
8976 <para>
8977 The charge I've been making about the regulation of culture is the
8978 same charge free marketers make about regulating markets. Everyone, of
8979 course, concedes that some regulation of markets is necessary&mdash;at
8980 a minimum, we need rules of property and contract, and courts to
8981 enforce both. Likewise, in this culture debate, everyone concedes that
8982 at least some framework of copyright is also required. But both
8983 perspectives vehemently insist that just because some regulation is
8984 good, it doesn't follow that more regulation is better. And both
8985 perspectives are constantly attuned to the ways in which regulation
8986 simply enables the powerful industries of today to protect themselves
8987 against the competitors of tomorrow.
8988 </para>
8989 <indexterm><primary>Barry, Hank</primary></indexterm>
8990 <para>
8991 This is the single most dramatic effect of the shift in regulatory
8992 <!-- PAGE BREAK 198 -->
8993 strategy that I described in chapter 10. The consequence of this
8994 massive threat of liability tied to the murky boundaries of copyright
8995 law is that innovators who want to innovate in this space can safely
8996 innovate only if they have the sign-off from last generation's
8997 dominant industries. That lesson has been taught through a series of
8998 cases that were designed and executed to teach venture capitalists a
8999 lesson. That lesson&mdash;what former Napster CEO Hank Barry calls a
9000 "nuclear pall" that has fallen over the Valley&mdash;has been learned.
9001 </para>
9002 <para>
9003 Consider one example to make the point, a story whose beginning
9004 I told in <citetitle>The Future of Ideas</citetitle> and which has progressed in a way that
9005 even I (pessimist extraordinaire) would never have predicted.
9006 </para>
9007 <para>
9008 In 1997, Michael Roberts launched a company called MP3.com. MP3.com
9009 was keen to remake the music business. Their goal was not just to
9010 facilitate new ways to get access to content. Their goal was also to
9011 facilitate new ways to create content. Unlike the major labels,
9012 MP3.com offered creators a venue to distribute their creativity,
9013 without demanding an exclusive engagement from the creators.
9014 </para>
9015 <para>
9016 To make this system work, however, MP3.com needed a reliable way to
9017 recommend music to its users. The idea behind this alternative was to
9018 leverage the revealed preferences of music listeners to recommend new
9019 artists. If you like Lyle Lovett, you're likely to enjoy Bonnie
9020 Raitt. And so on.
9021 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle</primary></indexterm>
9022 </para>
9023 <para>
9024 This idea required a simple way to gather data about user preferences.
9025 MP3.com came up with an extraordinarily clever way to gather this
9026 preference data. In January 2000, the company launched a service
9027 called my.mp3.com. Using software provided by MP3.com, a user would
9028 sign into an account and then insert into her computer a CD. The
9029 software would identify the CD, and then give the user access to that
9030 content. So, for example, if you inserted a CD by Jill Sobule, then
9031 wherever you were&mdash;at work or at home&mdash;you could get access
9032 to that music once you signed into your account. The system was
9033 therefore a kind of music-lockbox.
9034 </para>
9035 <para>
9036 No doubt some could use this system to illegally copy content. But
9037 that opportunity existed with or without MP3.com. The aim of the
9038
9039 <!-- PAGE BREAK 199 -->
9040 my.mp3.com service was to give users access to their own content, and
9041 as a by-product, by seeing the content they already owned, to discover
9042 the kind of content the users liked.
9043 </para>
9044 <para>
9045 To make this system function, however, MP3.com needed to copy 50,000
9046 CDs to a server. (In principle, it could have been the user who
9047 uploaded the music, but that would have taken a great deal of time,
9048 and would have produced a product of questionable quality.) It
9049 therefore purchased 50,000 CDs from a store, and started the process
9050 of making copies of those CDs. Again, it would not serve the content
9051 from those copies to anyone except those who authenticated that they
9052 had a copy of the CD they wanted to access. So while this was 50,000
9053 copies, it was 50,000 copies directed at giving customers something
9054 they had already bought.
9055 </para>
9056 <indexterm id="idxvivendiuniversal" class='startofrange'>
9057 <primary>Vivendi Universal</primary>
9058 </indexterm>
9059 <para>
9060 Nine days after MP3.com launched its service, the five major labels,
9061 headed by the RIAA, brought a lawsuit against MP3.com. MP3.com settled
9062 with four of the five. Nine months later, a federal judge found
9063 MP3.com to have been guilty of willful infringement with respect to
9064 the fifth. Applying the law as it is, the judge imposed a fine against
9065 MP3.com of $118 million. MP3.com then settled with the remaining
9066 plaintiff, Vivendi Universal, paying over $54 million. Vivendi
9067 purchased MP3.com just about a year later.
9068 </para>
9069 <para>
9070 That part of the story I have told before. Now consider its conclusion.
9071 </para>
9072 <para>
9073 After Vivendi purchased MP3.com, Vivendi turned around and filed a
9074 malpractice lawsuit against the lawyers who had advised it that they
9075 had a good faith claim that the service they wanted to offer would be
9076 considered legal under copyright law. This lawsuit alleged that it
9077 should have been obvious that the courts would find this behavior
9078 illegal; therefore, this lawsuit sought to punish any lawyer who had
9079 dared to suggest that the law was less restrictive than the labels
9080 demanded.
9081 </para>
9082 <para>
9083 The clear purpose of this lawsuit (which was settled for an
9084 unspecified amount shortly after the story was no longer covered in
9085 the press) was to send an unequivocal message to lawyers advising
9086 clients in this
9087 <!-- PAGE BREAK 200 -->
9088 space: It is not just your clients who might suffer if the content
9089 industry directs its guns against them. It is also you. So those of
9090 you who believe the law should be less restrictive should realize that
9091 such a view of the law will cost you and your firm dearly.
9092 </para>
9093 <indexterm startref="idxvivendiuniversal" class='endofrange'/>
9094 <indexterm><primary>Hummer, John</primary></indexterm>
9095 <indexterm><primary>Barry, Hank</primary></indexterm>
9096 <para>
9097 This strategy is not just limited to the lawyers. In April 2003,
9098 Universal and EMI brought a lawsuit against Hummer Winblad, the
9099 venture capital firm (VC) that had funded Napster at a certain stage of
9100 its development, its cofounder ( John Hummer), and general partner
9101 (Hank Barry).<footnote><para>
9102 <!-- f4. -->
9103 See Joseph Menn, "Universal, EMI Sue Napster Investor," <citetitle>Los Angeles
9104 Times</citetitle>, 23 April 2003. For a parallel argument about the effects on
9105 innovation in the distribution of music, see Janelle Brown, "The Music
9106 Revolution Will Not Be Digitized," Salon.com, 1 June 2001, available
9107 at <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #42</ulink>.
9108 See also Jon Healey, "Online Music Services Besieged," <citetitle>Los Angeles
9109 Times</citetitle>, 28 May 2001.
9110 </para></footnote>
9111 The claim here, as well, was that the VC should have recognized the
9112 right of the content industry to control how the industry should
9113 develop. They should be held personally liable for funding a company
9114 whose business turned out to be beyond the law. Here again, the aim of
9115 the lawsuit is transparent: Any VC now recognizes that if you fund a
9116 company whose business is not approved of by the dinosaurs, you are at
9117 risk not just in the marketplace, but in the courtroom as well. Your
9118 investment buys you not only a company, it also buys you a lawsuit.
9119 So extreme has the environment become that even car manufacturers are
9120 afraid of technologies that touch content. In an article in <citetitle>Business
9121 2.0</citetitle>, Rafe Needleman describes a discussion with BMW:
9122 </para>
9123 <blockquote>
9124 <indexterm><primary>BMW</primary></indexterm>
9125 <para>
9126 I asked why, with all the storage capacity and computer power in
9127 the car, there was no way to play MP3 files. I was told that BMW
9128 engineers in Germany had rigged a new vehicle to play MP3s via
9129 the car's built-in sound system, but that the company's marketing
9130 and legal departments weren't comfortable with pushing this
9131 forward for release stateside. Even today, no new cars are sold in the
9132 United States with bona fide MP3 players. . . . <footnote>
9133 <para>
9134 <!-- f5. -->
9135 Rafe Needleman, "Driving in Cars with MP3s," <citetitle>Business 2.0</citetitle>, 16 June
9136 2003, available at
9137 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #43</ulink>. I am grateful
9138 to Dr. Mohammad Al-Ubaydli for this example.
9139 <indexterm><primary>Needleman, Rafe</primary></indexterm>
9140 </para></footnote>
9141 </para>
9142 </blockquote>
9143 <para>
9144 This is the world of the mafia&mdash;filled with "your money or your
9145 life" offers, governed in the end not by courts but by the threats
9146 that the law empowers copyright holders to exercise. It is a system
9147 that will obviously and necessarily stifle new innovation. It is hard
9148 enough to start a company. It is impossibly hard if that company is
9149 constantly threatened by litigation.
9150 </para>
9151 <para>
9152
9153 <!-- PAGE BREAK 201 -->
9154 The point is not that businesses should have a right to start illegal
9155 enterprises. The point is the definition of "illegal." The law is a mess of
9156 uncertainty. We have no good way to know how it should apply to new
9157 technologies. Yet by reversing our tradition of judicial deference, and
9158 by embracing the astonishingly high penalties that copyright law
9159 imposes,
9160 that uncertainty now yields a reality which is far more
9161 conservative
9162 than is right. If the law imposed the death penalty for parking
9163 tickets, we'd not only have fewer parking tickets, we'd also have much
9164 less driving. The same principle applies to innovation. If innovation is
9165 constantly checked by this uncertain and unlimited liability, we will
9166 have much less vibrant innovation and much less creativity.
9167 </para>
9168 <para>
9169 The point is directly parallel to the crunchy-lefty point about fair
9170 use. Whatever the "real" law is, realism about the effect of law in
9171 both contexts is the same. This wildly punitive system of regulation
9172 will systematically stifle creativity and innovation. It will protect
9173 some industries and some creators, but it will harm industry and
9174 creativity generally. Free market and free culture depend upon vibrant
9175 competition. Yet the effect of the law today is to stifle just this
9176 kind of competition. The effect is to produce an overregulated
9177 culture, just as the effect of too much control in the market is to
9178 produce an overregulatedregulated market.
9179 </para>
9180 <para>
9181 The building of a permission culture, rather than a free culture, is
9182 the first important way in which the changes I have described will
9183 burden innovation. A permission culture means a lawyer's
9184 culture&mdash;a culture in which the ability to create requires a call
9185 to your lawyer. Again, I am not antilawyer, at least when they're kept
9186 in their proper place. I am certainly not antilaw. But our profession
9187 has lost the sense of its limits. And leaders in our profession have
9188 lost an appreciation of the high costs that our profession imposes
9189 upon others. The inefficiency of the law is an embarrassment to our
9190 tradition. And while I believe our profession should therefore do
9191 everything it can to make the law more efficient, it should at least
9192 do everything it can to limit the reach of the
9193 <!-- PAGE BREAK 202 -->
9194 law where the law is not doing any good. The transaction costs buried
9195 within a permission culture are enough to bury a wide range of
9196 creativity. Someone needs to do a lot of justifying to justify that
9197 result. The uncertainty of the law is one burden on innovation. There
9198 is a second burden that operates more directly. This is the effort by
9199 many in the content industry to use the law to directly regulate the
9200 technology of the Internet so that it better protects their content.
9201 </para>
9202 <para>
9203 The motivation for this response is obvious. The Internet enables the
9204 efficient spread of content. That efficiency is a feature of the
9205 Internet's design. But from the perspective of the content industry,
9206 this feature is a "bug." The efficient spread of content means that
9207 content distributors have a harder time controlling the distribution
9208 of content. One obvious response to this efficiency is thus to make
9209 the Internet less efficient. If the Internet enables "piracy," then,
9210 this response says, we should break the kneecaps of the Internet.
9211 </para>
9212 <para>
9213 The examples of this form of legislation are many. At the urging of
9214 the content industry, some in Congress have threatened legislation that
9215 would require computers to determine whether the content they access
9216 is protected or not, and to disable the spread of protected content.<footnote><para>
9217 <!-- f6. --> "Copyright and Digital Media in a Post-Napster World," GartnerG2 and
9218 the Berkman Center for Internet and Society at Harvard Law School
9219 (2003), 33&ndash;35, available at
9220 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #44</ulink>.
9221 </para></footnote>
9222
9223 Congress
9224 has already launched proceedings to explore a mandatory
9225 "broadcast
9226 flag" that would be required on any device capable of transmitting
9227 digital video (i.e., a computer), and that would disable the copying of
9228 any content that is marked with a broadcast flag. Other members of
9229 Congress have proposed immunizing content providers from liability
9230 for technology they might deploy that would hunt down copyright
9231 violators
9232 and disable their machines.<footnote><para>
9233 <!-- f7. --> GartnerG2, 26&ndash;27.
9234 </para></footnote>
9235
9236 </para>
9237 <para>
9238 In one sense, these solutions seem sensible. If the problem is the
9239 code, why not regulate the code to remove the problem. But any
9240 regulation
9241 of technical infrastructure will always be tuned to the particular
9242 technology of the day. It will impose significant burdens and costs on
9243
9244 <!-- PAGE BREAK 203 -->
9245 the technology, but will likely be eclipsed by advances around exactly
9246 those requirements.
9247 </para>
9248 <para>
9249 In March 2002, a broad coalition of technology companies, led by
9250 Intel, tried to get Congress to see the harm that such legislation would
9251 impose.<footnote><para>
9252 <!-- f8. --> See David McGuire, "Tech Execs Square Off Over Piracy," Newsbytes,
9253 February 2002 (Entertainment).
9254 </para></footnote>
9255 Their argument was obviously not that copyright should not
9256 be protected. Instead, they argued, any protection should not do more
9257 harm than good.
9258 </para>
9259 <para>
9260 There is one more obvious way in which this war has harmed
9261 innovation&mdash;again,
9262 a story that will be quite familiar to the free market
9263 crowd.
9264 </para>
9265 <para>
9266 Copyright may be property, but like all property, it is also a form
9267 of regulation. It is a regulation that benefits some and harms others.
9268 When done right, it benefits creators and harms leeches. When done
9269 wrong, it is regulation the powerful use to defeat competitors.
9270 </para>
9271 <para>
9272 As I described in chapter 10, despite this feature of copyright as
9273 regulation, and subject to important qualifications outlined by Jessica
9274 Litman in her book <citetitle>Digital Copyright</citetitle>,<footnote><para>
9275 <!-- f9. --> Jessica Litman, <citetitle>Digital Copyright</citetitle> (Amherst, N.Y.: Prometheus Books,
9276 2001).
9277 <indexterm><primary>Litman, Jessica</primary></indexterm>
9278 </para></footnote>
9279 overall this history of copyright
9280 is not bad. As chapter 10 details, when new technologies have come
9281 along, Congress has struck a balance to assure that the new is protected
9282 from the old. Compulsory, or statutory, licenses have been one part of
9283 that strategy. Free use (as in the case of the VCR) has been another.
9284 </para>
9285 <para>
9286 But that pattern of deference to new technologies has now changed
9287 with the rise of the Internet. Rather than striking a balance between
9288 the claims of a new technology and the legitimate rights of content
9289 creators, both the courts and Congress have imposed legal restrictions
9290 that will have the effect of smothering the new to benefit the old.
9291 </para>
9292 <para>
9293 The response by the courts has been fairly universal.<footnote><para>
9294 <!-- f10. -->
9295 The only circuit court exception is found in <citetitle>Recording Industry
9296 Association of America (RIAA)</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Diamond Multimedia Systems</citetitle>, 180 F. 3d
9297 1072 (9th Cir. 1999). There the court of appeals for the Ninth Circuit
9298 reasoned that makers of a portable MP3 player were not liable for
9299 contributory copyright infringement for a device that is unable to
9300 record or redistribute music (a device whose only copying function is
9301 to render portable a music file already stored on a user's hard
9302 drive). At the district court level, the only exception is found in
9303 <citetitle>Metro-Goldwyn-Mayer Studios, Inc</citetitle>. v. <citetitle>Grokster, Ltd</citetitle>., 259 F. Supp. 2d
9304 1029 (C.D. Cal., 2003), where the court found the link between the
9305 distributor and any given user's conduct too attenuated to make the
9306 distributor liable for contributory or vicarious infringement
9307 liability.
9308 </para></footnote>
9309 It has been mirrored in the responses threatened and actually
9310 implemented by Congress. I won't catalog all of those responses
9311 here.<footnote><para>
9312 <!-- f11. -->
9313 For example, in July 2002, Representative Howard Berman introduced the
9314 Peer-to-Peer Piracy Prevention Act (H.R. 5211), which would immunize
9315 copyright holders from liability for damage done to computers when the
9316 copyright holders use technology to stop copyright infringement. In
9317 August 2002, Representative Billy Tauzin introduced a bill to mandate
9318 that technologies capable of rebroadcasting digital copies of films
9319 broadcast on TV (i.e., computers) respect a "broadcast flag" that
9320 would disable copying of that content. And in March of the same year,
9321 Senator Fritz Hollings introduced the Consumer Broadband and Digital
9322 Television Promotion Act, which mandated copyright protection
9323 technology in all digital media devices. See GartnerG2, "Copyright and
9324 Digital Media in a Post-Napster World," 27 June 2003, 33&ndash;34,
9325 available at
9326 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #44</ulink>.
9327 <indexterm><primary>Berman, Howard L.</primary></indexterm>
9328 </para></footnote>
9329 But there is one example that captures the flavor of them all. This is
9330 the story of the demise of Internet radio.
9331 </para>
9332 <para>
9333
9334 <!-- PAGE BREAK 204 -->
9335 As I described in chapter 4, when a radio station plays a song, the
9336 recording artist doesn't get paid for that "radio performance" unless
9337 he or she is also the composer. So, for example if Marilyn Monroe had
9338 recorded a version of "Happy Birthday"&mdash;to memorialize her famous
9339 performance before President Kennedy at Madison Square Garden&mdash;
9340 then whenever that recording was played on the radio, the current
9341 copyright owners of "Happy Birthday" would get some money, whereas
9342 Marilyn Monroe would not.
9343 </para>
9344 <para>
9345 The reasoning behind this balance struck by Congress makes some
9346 sense. The justification was that radio was a kind of advertising. The
9347 recording artist thus benefited because by playing her music, the
9348 radio station was making it more likely that her records would be
9349 purchased. Thus, the recording artist got something, even if only
9350 indirectly. Probably this reasoning had less to do with the result
9351 than with the power of radio stations: Their lobbyists were quite good
9352 at stopping any efforts to get Congress to require compensation to the
9353 recording artists.
9354 </para>
9355 <para>
9356 Enter Internet radio. Like regular radio, Internet radio is a
9357 technology to stream content from a broadcaster to a listener. The
9358 broadcast travels across the Internet, not across the ether of radio
9359 spectrum. Thus, I can "tune in" to an Internet radio station in
9360 Berlin while sitting in San Francisco, even though there's no way for
9361 me to tune in to a regular radio station much beyond the San Francisco
9362 metropolitan area.
9363 </para>
9364 <para>
9365 This feature of the architecture of Internet radio means that there
9366 are potentially an unlimited number of radio stations that a user
9367 could tune in to using her computer, whereas under the existing
9368 architecture for broadcast radio, there is an obvious limit to the
9369 number of broadcasters and clear broadcast frequencies. Internet radio
9370 could therefore be more competitive than regular radio; it could
9371 provide a wider range of selections. And because the potential
9372 audience for Internet radio is the whole world, niche stations could
9373 easily develop and market their content to a relatively large number
9374 of users worldwide. According to some estimates, more than eighty
9375 million users worldwide have tuned in to this new form of radio.
9376 </para>
9377 <para>
9378
9379 <!-- PAGE BREAK 205 -->
9380 Internet radio is thus to radio what FM was to AM. It is an
9381 improvement potentially vastly more significant than the FM
9382 improvement over AM, since not only is the technology better, so, too,
9383 is the competition. Indeed, there is a direct parallel between the
9384 fight to establish FM radio and the fight to protect Internet
9385 radio. As one author describes Howard Armstrong's struggle to enable
9386 FM radio,
9387 </para>
9388 <blockquote>
9389 <para>
9390 An almost unlimited number of FM stations was possible in the
9391 shortwaves, thus ending the unnatural restrictions imposed on radio in
9392 the crowded longwaves. If FM were freely developed, the number of
9393 stations would be limited only by economics and competition rather
9394 than by technical restrictions. . . . Armstrong likened the situation
9395 that had grown up in radio to that following the invention of the
9396 printing press, when governments and ruling interests attempted to
9397 control this new instrument of mass communications by imposing
9398 restrictive licenses on it. This tyranny was broken only when it
9399 became possible for men freely to acquire printing presses and freely
9400 to run them. FM in this sense was as great an invention as the
9401 printing presses, for it gave radio the opportunity to strike off its
9402 shackles.<footnote><para>
9403 <!-- f12. -->
9404 Lessing, 239.
9405 </para></footnote>
9406 </para>
9407 </blockquote>
9408 <para>
9409 This potential for FM radio was never realized&mdash;not
9410 because Armstrong was wrong about the technology, but because he
9411 underestimated the power of "vested interests, habits, customs and
9412 legislation"<footnote><para>
9413 <!-- f13. -->
9414 Ibid., 229.
9415 </para></footnote>
9416 to retard the growth of this competing technology.
9417 </para>
9418 <para>
9419 Now the very same claim could be made about Internet radio. For
9420 again, there is no technical limitation that could restrict the number of
9421 Internet radio stations. The only restrictions on Internet radio are
9422 those imposed by the law. Copyright law is one such law. So the first
9423 question we should ask is, what copyright rules would govern Internet
9424 radio?
9425 </para>
9426 <para>
9427 But here the power of the lobbyists is reversed. Internet radio is a
9428 new industry. The recording artists, on the other hand, have a very
9429
9430 <!-- PAGE BREAK 206 -->
9431 powerful lobby, the RIAA. Thus when Congress considered the phenomenon
9432 of Internet radio in 1995, the lobbyists had primed Congress to adopt
9433 a different rule for Internet radio than the rule that applies to
9434 terrestrial radio. While terrestrial radio does not have to pay our
9435 hypothetical Marilyn Monroe when it plays her hypothetical recording
9436 of "Happy Birthday" on the air, <emphasis>Internet radio
9437 does</emphasis>. Not only is the law not neutral toward Internet
9438 radio&mdash;the law actually burdens Internet radio more than it
9439 burdens terrestrial radio.
9440 </para>
9441 <para>
9442 This financial burden is not slight. As Harvard law professor
9443 William Fisher estimates, if an Internet radio station distributed adfree
9444 popular music to (on average) ten thousand listeners, twenty-four
9445 hours a day, the total artist fees that radio station would owe would be
9446 over $1 million a year.<footnote>
9447 <para>
9448 <!-- f14. -->
9449 This example was derived from fees set by the original Copyright
9450 Arbitration Royalty Panel (CARP) proceedings, and is drawn from an
9451 example offered by Professor William Fisher. Conference Proceedings,
9452 iLaw (Stanford), 3 July 2003, on file with author. Professors Fisher
9453 and Zittrain submitted testimony in the CARP proceeding that was
9454 ultimately rejected. See Jonathan Zittrain, Digital Performance Right
9455 in Sound Recordings and Ephemeral Recordings, Docket No. 2000-9, CARP
9456 DTRA 1 and 2, available at
9457 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #45</ulink>.
9458 For an excellent analysis making a similar point, see Randal
9459 C. Picker, "Copyright as Entry Policy: The Case of Digital
9460 Distribution," <citetitle>Antitrust Bulletin</citetitle> (Summer/Fall 2002): 461: "This was
9461 not confusion, these are just old-fashioned entry barriers. Analog
9462 radio stations are protected from digital entrants, reducing entry in
9463 radio and diversity. Yes, this is done in the name of getting
9464 royalties to copyright holders, but, absent the play of powerful
9465 interests, that could have been done in a media-neutral way."
9466 <indexterm><primary>CARP (Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panel)</primary></indexterm>
9467 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.</primary></indexterm>
9468 </para></footnote>
9469 A regular radio station broadcasting the same content would pay no
9470 equivalent fee.
9471 </para>
9472 <para>
9473 The burden is not financial only. Under the original rules that were
9474 proposed, an Internet radio station (but not a terrestrial radio
9475 station) would have to collect the following data from <emphasis>every
9476 listening transaction</emphasis>:
9477 </para>
9478 <!-- PAGE BREAK 207 -->
9479 <orderedlist numeration="arabic">
9480 <listitem><para>
9481 name of the service;
9482 </para></listitem>
9483 <listitem><para>
9484 channel of the program (AM/FM stations use station ID);
9485 </para></listitem>
9486 <listitem><para>
9487 type of program (archived/looped/live);
9488 </para></listitem>
9489 <listitem><para>
9490 date of transmission;
9491 </para></listitem>
9492 <listitem><para>
9493 time of transmission;
9494 </para></listitem>
9495 <listitem><para>
9496 time zone of origination of transmission;
9497 </para></listitem>
9498 <listitem><para>
9499 numeric designation of the place of the sound recording within the program;
9500 </para></listitem>
9501 <listitem><para>
9502 duration of transmission (to nearest second);
9503 </para></listitem>
9504 <listitem><para>
9505 sound recording title;
9506 </para></listitem>
9507 <listitem><para>
9508 ISRC code of the recording;
9509 </para></listitem>
9510 <listitem><para>
9511 release year of the album per copyright notice and in the case of compilation albums, the release year of the album and copy- right date of the track;
9512 </para></listitem>
9513 <listitem><para>
9514 featured recording artist;
9515 </para></listitem>
9516 <listitem><para>
9517 retail album title;
9518 </para></listitem>
9519 <listitem><para>
9520 recording label;
9521 </para></listitem>
9522 <listitem><para>
9523 UPC code of the retail album;
9524 </para></listitem>
9525 <listitem><para>
9526 catalog number;
9527 </para></listitem>
9528 <listitem><para>
9529 copyright owner information;
9530 </para></listitem>
9531 <listitem><para>
9532 musical genre of the channel or program (station format);
9533 </para></listitem>
9534 <listitem><para>
9535 name of the service or entity;
9536 </para></listitem>
9537 <listitem><para>
9538 channel or program;
9539 </para></listitem>
9540 <listitem><para>
9541 date and time that the user logged in (in the user's time zone);
9542 </para></listitem>
9543 <listitem><para>
9544 date and time that the user logged out (in the user's time zone);
9545 </para></listitem>
9546 <listitem><para>
9547 time zone where the signal was received (user);
9548 </para></listitem>
9549 <listitem><para>
9550 Unique User identifier;
9551 </para></listitem>
9552 <listitem><para>
9553 the country in which the user received the transmissions.
9554 </para></listitem>
9555 </orderedlist>
9556
9557 <para>
9558 The Librarian of Congress eventually suspended these reporting
9559 requirements, pending further study. And he also changed the original
9560 rates set by the arbitration panel charged with setting rates. But the
9561 basic difference between Internet radio and terrestrial radio remains:
9562 Internet radio has to pay a <emphasis>type of copyright fee</emphasis>
9563 that terrestrial radio does not.
9564 </para>
9565 <para>
9566 Why? What justifies this difference? Was there any study of the
9567 economic consequences from Internet radio that would justify these
9568 differences? Was the motive to protect artists against piracy?
9569 </para>
9570 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex</primary></indexterm>
9571 <para>
9572 In a rare bit of candor, one RIAA expert admitted what seemed obvious
9573 to everyone at the time. As Alex Alben, vice president for Public
9574 Policy at Real Networks, told me,
9575 </para>
9576 <blockquote>
9577 <para>
9578 The RIAA, which was representing the record labels, presented
9579 some testimony about what they thought a willing buyer would
9580 pay to a willing seller, and it was much higher. It was ten times
9581 higher than what radio stations pay to perform the same songs for
9582 the same period of time. And so the attorneys representing the
9583 webcasters asked the RIAA, . . . "How do you come up with a
9584
9585 <!-- PAGE BREAK 208 -->
9586 rate that's so much higher? Why is it worth more than radio?
9587 Because
9588 here we have hundreds of thousands of webcasters who
9589 want to pay, and that should establish the market rate, and if you
9590 set the rate so high, you're going to drive the small webcasters out
9591 of business. . . ."
9592 </para>
9593 <para>
9594 And the RIAA experts said, "Well, we don't really model this as an
9595 industry with thousands of webcasters, <emphasis>we think it should be
9596 an industry with, you know, five or seven big players who can pay a
9597 high rate and it's a stable, predictable market</emphasis>." (Emphasis
9598 added.)
9599 </para>
9600 </blockquote>
9601 <para>
9602 Translation: The aim is to use the law to eliminate competition, so
9603 that this platform of potentially immense competition, which would
9604 cause the diversity and range of content available to explode, would not
9605 cause pain to the dinosaurs of old. There is no one, on either the right
9606 or the left, who should endorse this use of the law. And yet there is
9607 practically no one, on either the right or the left, who is doing anything
9608 effective to prevent it.
9609 </para>
9610 </section>
9611 <section id="corruptingcitizens">
9612 <title>Corrupting Citizens</title>
9613 <para>
9614 Overregulation stifles creativity. It smothers innovation. It gives
9615 dinosaurs
9616 a veto over the future. It wastes the extraordinary opportunity
9617 for a democratic creativity that digital technology enables.
9618 </para>
9619 <para>
9620 In addition to these important harms, there is one more that was
9621 important to our forebears, but seems forgotten today. Overregulation
9622 corrupts citizens and weakens the rule of law.
9623 </para>
9624 <para>
9625 The war that is being waged today is a war of prohibition. As with
9626 every war of prohibition, it is targeted against the behavior of a very
9627 large number of citizens. According to <citetitle>The New York Times</citetitle>, 43 million
9628 Americans downloaded music in May 2002.<footnote><para>
9629 <!-- f15. --> Mike Graziano and Lee Rainie, "The Music Downloading Deluge," Pew
9630 Internet and American Life Project (24 April 2001), available at
9631 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #46</ulink>.
9632 The Pew Internet and American Life Project reported that 37 million
9633 Americans had downloaded music files from the Internet by early 2001.
9634 </para></footnote>
9635 According to the RIAA,
9636 the behavior of those 43 million Americans is a felony. We thus have a
9637 set of rules that transform 20 percent of America into criminals. As the
9638
9639 <!-- PAGE BREAK 209 -->
9640 RIAA launches lawsuits against not only the Napsters and Kazaas of
9641 the world, but against students building search engines, and
9642 increasingly
9643 against ordinary users downloading content, the technologies for
9644 sharing will advance to further protect and hide illegal use. It is an arms
9645 race or a civil war, with the extremes of one side inviting a more
9646 extreme
9647 response by the other.
9648 </para>
9649 <para>
9650 The content industry's tactics exploit the failings of the American
9651 legal system. When the RIAA brought suit against Jesse Jordan, it
9652 knew that in Jordan it had found a scapegoat, not a defendant. The
9653 threat of having to pay either all the money in the world in damages
9654 ($15,000,000) or almost all the money in the world to defend against
9655 paying all the money in the world in damages ($250,000 in legal fees)
9656 led Jordan to choose to pay all the money he had in the world
9657 ($12,000) to make the suit go away. The same strategy animates the
9658 RIAA's suits against individual users. In September 2003, the RIAA
9659 sued 261 individuals&mdash;including a twelve-year-old girl living in public
9660 housing and a seventy-year-old man who had no idea what file sharing
9661 was.<footnote><para>
9662 <!-- f16. -->
9663 Alex Pham, "The Labels Strike Back: N.Y. Girl Settles RIAA Case," <citetitle>Los
9664 Angeles Times</citetitle>, 10 September 2003, Business.
9665 </para></footnote>
9666 As these scapegoats discovered, it will always cost more to defend
9667 against these suits than it would cost to simply settle. (The twelve
9668 year old, for example, like Jesse Jordan, paid her life savings of $2,000
9669 to settle the case.) Our law is an awful system for defending rights. It
9670 is an embarrassment to our tradition. And the consequence of our law
9671 as it is, is that those with the power can use the law to quash any rights
9672 they oppose.
9673 </para>
9674 <para>
9675 Wars of prohibition are nothing new in America. This one is just
9676 something more extreme than anything we've seen before. We
9677 experimented with alcohol prohibition, at a time when the per capita
9678 consumption of alcohol was 1.5 gallons per capita per year. The war
9679 against drinking initially reduced that consumption to just 30 percent
9680 of its preprohibition levels, but by the end of prohibition,
9681 consumption was up to 70 percent of the preprohibition
9682 level. Americans were drinking just about as much, but now, a vast
9683 number were criminals.<footnote><para>
9684 <!-- f17. -->
9685 Jeffrey A. Miron and Jeffrey Zwiebel, "Alcohol Consumption During
9686 Prohibition," <citetitle>American Economic Review</citetitle> 81, no. 2 (1991): 242.
9687 </para></footnote>
9688 We have
9689 <!-- PAGE BREAK 210 -->
9690 launched a war on drugs aimed at reducing the consumption of regulated
9691 narcotics that 7 percent (or 16 million) Americans now use.<footnote><para>
9692 <!-- f18. -->
9693 National Drug Control Policy: Hearing Before the House Government
9694 Reform Committee, 108th Cong., 1st sess. (5 March 2003) (statement of
9695 John P. Walters, director of National Drug Control Policy).
9696 </para></footnote>
9697 That is a drop from the high (so to speak) in 1979 of 14 percent of
9698 the population. We regulate automobiles to the point where the vast
9699 majority of Americans violate the law every day. We run such a complex
9700 tax system that a majority of cash businesses regularly
9701 cheat.<footnote><para>
9702 <!-- f19. -->
9703 See James Andreoni, Brian Erard, and Jonathon Feinstein, "Tax
9704 Compliance," <citetitle>Journal of Economic Literature</citetitle> 36 (1998): 818 (survey of
9705 compliance literature).
9706 </para></footnote>
9707 We pride ourselves on our "free society," but an endless array of
9708 ordinary behavior is regulated within our society. And as a result, a
9709 huge proportion of Americans regularly violate at least some law.
9710 </para>
9711 <para>
9712 This state of affairs is not without consequence. It is a particularly
9713 salient issue for teachers like me, whose job it is to teach law
9714 students about the importance of "ethics." As my colleague Charlie
9715 Nesson told a class at Stanford, each year law schools admit thousands
9716 of students who have illegally downloaded music, illegally consumed
9717 alcohol and sometimes drugs, illegally worked without paying taxes,
9718 illegally driven cars. These are kids for whom behaving illegally is
9719 increasingly the norm. And then we, as law professors, are supposed to
9720 teach them how to behave ethically&mdash;how to say no to bribes, or
9721 keep client funds separate, or honor a demand to disclose a document
9722 that will mean that your case is over. Generations of
9723 Americans&mdash;more significantly in some parts of America than in
9724 others, but still, everywhere in America today&mdash;can't live their
9725 lives both normally and legally, since "normally" entails a certain
9726 degree of illegality.
9727 </para>
9728 <para>
9729 The response to this general illegality is either to enforce the law
9730 more severely or to change the law. We, as a society, have to learn
9731 how to make that choice more rationally. Whether a law makes sense
9732 depends, in part, at least, upon whether the costs of the law, both
9733 intended and collateral, outweigh the benefits. If the costs, intended
9734 and collateral, do outweigh the benefits, then the law ought to be
9735 changed. Alternatively, if the costs of the existing system are much
9736 greater than the costs of an alternative, then we have a good reason
9737 to consider the alternative.
9738 </para>
9739 <para>
9740
9741 <!-- PAGE BREAK 211 -->
9742 My point is not the idiotic one: Just because people violate a law, we
9743 should therefore repeal it. Obviously, we could reduce murder statistics
9744 dramatically by legalizing murder on Wednesdays and Fridays. But
9745 that wouldn't make any sense, since murder is wrong every day of the
9746 week. A society is right to ban murder always and everywhere.
9747 </para>
9748 <para>
9749 My point is instead one that democracies understood for generations,
9750 but that we recently have learned to forget. The rule of law depends
9751 upon people obeying the law. The more often, and more repeatedly, we
9752 as citizens experience violating the law, the less we respect the
9753 law. Obviously, in most cases, the important issue is the law, not
9754 respect for the law. I don't care whether the rapist respects the law
9755 or not; I want to catch and incarcerate the rapist. But I do care
9756 whether my students respect the law. And I do care if the rules of law
9757 sow increasing disrespect because of the extreme of regulation they
9758 impose. Twenty million Americans have come of age since the Internet
9759 introduced this different idea of "sharing." We need to be able to
9760 call these twenty million Americans "citizens," not "felons."
9761 </para>
9762 <para>
9763 When at least forty-three million citizens download content from the
9764 Internet, and when they use tools to combine that content in ways
9765 unauthorized by copyright holders, the first question we should be
9766 asking is not how best to involve the FBI. The first question should
9767 be whether this particular prohibition is really necessary in order to
9768 achieve the proper ends that copyright law serves. Is there another
9769 way to assure that artists get paid without transforming forty-three
9770 million Americans into felons? Does it make sense if there are other
9771 ways to assure that artists get paid without transforming America into
9772 a nation of felons?
9773 </para>
9774 <para>
9775 This abstract point can be made more clear with a particular example.
9776 </para>
9777 <para>
9778 We all own CDs. Many of us still own phonograph records. These pieces
9779 of plastic encode music that in a certain sense we have bought. The
9780 law protects our right to buy and sell that plastic: It is not a
9781 copyright infringement for me to sell all my classical records at a
9782 used
9783
9784 <!-- PAGE BREAK 212 -->
9785 record store and buy jazz records to replace them. That "use" of the
9786 recordings is free.
9787 </para>
9788 <para>
9789 But as the MP3 craze has demonstrated, there is another use of
9790 phonograph records that is effectively free. Because these recordings
9791 were made without copy-protection technologies, I am "free" to copy,
9792 or "rip," music from my records onto a computer hard disk. Indeed,
9793 Apple Corporation went so far as to suggest that "freedom" was a
9794 right: In a series of commercials, Apple endorsed the "Rip, Mix, Burn"
9795 capacities of digital technologies.
9796 </para>
9797 <indexterm><primary>Adromeda</primary></indexterm>
9798 <para>
9799 This "use" of my records is certainly valuable. I have begun a large
9800 process at home of ripping all of my and my wife's CDs, and storing
9801 them in one archive. Then, using Apple's iTunes, or a wonderful
9802 program called Andromeda, we can build different play lists of our
9803 music: Bach, Baroque, Love Songs, Love Songs of Significant
9804 Others&mdash;the potential is endless. And by reducing the costs of
9805 mixing play lists, these technologies help build a creativity with
9806 play lists that is itself independently valuable. Compilations of
9807 songs are creative and meaningful in their own right.
9808 </para>
9809 <para>
9810 This use is enabled by unprotected media&mdash;either CDs or records.
9811 But unprotected media also enable file sharing. File sharing threatens
9812 (or so the content industry believes) the ability of creators to earn
9813 a fair return from their creativity. And thus, many are beginning to
9814 experiment with technologies to eliminate unprotected media. These
9815 technologies, for example, would enable CDs that could not be
9816 ripped. Or they might enable spy programs to identify ripped content
9817 on people's machines.
9818 </para>
9819 <para>
9820 If these technologies took off, then the building of large archives of
9821 your own music would become quite difficult. You might hang in hacker
9822 circles, and get technology to disable the technologies that protect
9823 the content. Trading in those technologies is illegal, but maybe that
9824 doesn't bother you much. In any case, for the vast majority of people,
9825 these protection technologies would effectively destroy the archiving
9826
9827 <!-- PAGE BREAK 213 -->
9828 use of CDs. The technology, in other words, would force us all back to
9829 the world where we either listened to music by manipulating pieces of
9830 plastic or were part of a massively complex "digital rights
9831 management" system.
9832 </para>
9833 <para>
9834 If the only way to assure that artists get paid were the elimination
9835 of the ability to freely move content, then these technologies to
9836 interfere with the freedom to move content would be justifiable. But
9837 what if there were another way to assure that artists are paid,
9838 without locking down any content? What if, in other words, a different
9839 system could assure compensation to artists while also preserving the
9840 freedom to move content easily?
9841 </para>
9842 <para>
9843 My point just now is not to prove that there is such a system. I offer
9844 a version of such a system in the last chapter of this book. For now,
9845 the only point is the relatively uncontroversial one: If a different
9846 system achieved the same legitimate objectives that the existing
9847 copyright system achieved, but left consumers and creators much more
9848 free, then we'd have a very good reason to pursue this
9849 alternative&mdash;namely, freedom. The choice, in other words, would
9850 not be between property and piracy; the choice would be between
9851 different property systems and the freedoms each allowed.
9852 </para>
9853 <para>
9854 I believe there is a way to assure that artists are paid without
9855 turning forty-three million Americans into felons. But the salient
9856 feature of this alternative is that it would lead to a very different
9857 market for producing and distributing creativity. The dominant few,
9858 who today control the vast majority of the distribution of content in
9859 the world, would no longer exercise this extreme of control. Rather,
9860 they would go the way of the horse-drawn buggy.
9861 </para>
9862 <para>
9863 Except that this generation's buggy manufacturers have already saddled
9864 Congress, and are riding the law to protect themselves against this
9865 new form of competition. For them the choice is between fortythree
9866 million Americans as criminals and their own survival.
9867 </para>
9868 <para>
9869 It is understandable why they choose as they do. It is not
9870 understandable why we as a democracy continue to choose as we do. Jack
9871
9872 <!-- PAGE BREAK 214 -->
9873
9874 Valenti is charming; but not so charming as to justify giving up a
9875 tradition as deep and important as our tradition of free culture.
9876 There's one more aspect to this corruption that is particularly
9877 important to civil liberties, and follows directly from any war of
9878 prohibition. As Electronic Frontier Foundation attorney Fred von
9879 Lohmann describes, this is the "collateral damage" that "arises
9880 whenever you turn a very large percentage of the population into
9881 criminals." This is the collateral damage to civil liberties
9882 generally.
9883 <indexterm><primary>Electronic Frontier Foundation</primary></indexterm>
9884 </para>
9885 <para>
9886 "If you can treat someone as a putative lawbreaker," von Lohmann
9887 explains,
9888 <indexterm><primary>von Lohmann, Fred</primary></indexterm>
9889 </para>
9890 <blockquote>
9891 <para>
9892 then all of a sudden a lot of basic civil liberty protections
9893 evaporate to one degree or another. . . . If you're a copyright
9894 infringer, how can you hope to have any privacy rights? If you're a
9895 copyright infringer, how can you hope to be secure against seizures of
9896 your computer? How can you hope to continue to receive Internet
9897 access? . . . Our sensibilities change as soon as we think, "Oh, well,
9898 but that person's a criminal, a lawbreaker." Well, what this campaign
9899 against file sharing has done is turn a remarkable percentage of the
9900 American Internet-using population into "lawbreakers."
9901 </para>
9902 </blockquote>
9903 <para>
9904 And the consequence of this transformation of the American public
9905 into criminals is that it becomes trivial, as a matter of due process, to
9906 effectively erase much of the privacy most would presume.
9907 </para>
9908 <para>
9909 Users of the Internet began to see this generally in 2003 as the RIAA
9910 launched its campaign to force Internet service providers to turn over
9911 the names of customers who the RIAA believed were violating copyright
9912 law. Verizon fought that demand and lost. With a simple request to a
9913 judge, and without any notice to the customer at all, the identity of
9914 an Internet user is revealed.
9915 </para>
9916 <para>
9917 <!-- PAGE BREAK 215 -->
9918 The RIAA then expanded this campaign, by announcing a general strategy
9919 to sue individual users of the Internet who are alleged to have
9920 downloaded copyrighted music from file-sharing systems. But as we've
9921 seen, the potential damages from these suits are astronomical: If a
9922 family's computer is used to download a single CD's worth of music,
9923 the family could be liable for $2 million in damages. That didn't stop
9924 the RIAA from suing a number of these families, just as they had sued
9925 Jesse Jordan.<footnote><para>
9926 <!-- f20. -->
9927 See Frank Ahrens, "RIAA's Lawsuits Meet Surprised Targets; Single
9928 Mother in Calif., 12-Year-Old Girl in N.Y. Among Defendants,"
9929 <citetitle>Washington Post</citetitle>, 10 September 2003, E1; Chris Cobbs, "Worried Parents
9930 Pull Plug on File `Stealing'; With the Music Industry Cracking Down on
9931 File Swapping, Parents are Yanking Software from Home PCs to Avoid
9932 Being Sued," <citetitle>Orlando Sentinel Tribune</citetitle>, 30 August 2003, C1; Jefferson
9933 Graham, "Recording Industry Sues Parents," <citetitle>USA Today</citetitle>, 15 September
9934 2003, 4D; John Schwartz, "She Says She's No Music Pirate. No Snoop
9935 Fan, Either," <citetitle>New York Times</citetitle>, 25 September 2003, C1; Margo Varadi, "Is
9936 Brianna a Criminal?" <citetitle>Toronto Star</citetitle>, 18 September 2003, P7.
9937 </para></footnote>
9938
9939 </para>
9940 <para>
9941 Even this understates the espionage that is being waged by the
9942 RIAA. A report from CNN late last summer described a strategy the
9943 RIAA had adopted to track Napster users.<footnote><para>
9944 <!-- f21. -->
9945 See "Revealed: How RIAA Tracks Downloaders: Music Industry Discloses
9946 Some Methods Used," CNN.com, available at
9947 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #47</ulink>.
9948 </para></footnote>
9949 Using a sophisticated hashing algorithm, the RIAA took what is in
9950 effect a fingerprint of every song in the Napster catalog. Any copy of
9951 one of those MP3s will have the same "fingerprint."
9952 </para>
9953 <para>
9954 So imagine the following not-implausible scenario: Imagine a
9955 friend gives a CD to your daughter&mdash;a collection of songs just
9956 like the cassettes you used to make as a kid. You don't know, and
9957 neither does your daughter, where these songs came from. But she
9958 copies these songs onto her computer. She then takes her computer to
9959 college and connects it to a college network, and if the college
9960 network is "cooperating" with the RIAA's espionage, and she hasn't
9961 properly protected her content from the network (do you know how to do
9962 that yourself ?), then the RIAA will be able to identify your daughter
9963 as a "criminal." And under the rules that universities are beginning
9964 to deploy,<footnote><para>
9965 <!-- f22. -->
9966 See Jeff Adler, "Cambridge: On Campus, Pirates Are Not Penitent,"
9967 <citetitle>Boston Globe</citetitle>, 18 May 2003, City Weekly, 1; Frank Ahrens, "Four
9968 Students Sued over Music Sites; Industry Group Targets File Sharing at
9969 Colleges," <citetitle>Washington Post</citetitle>, 4 April 2003, E1; Elizabeth Armstrong,
9970 "Students `Rip, Mix, Burn' at Their Own Risk," <citetitle>Christian Science
9971 Monitor</citetitle>, 2 September 2003, 20; Robert Becker and Angela Rozas, "Music
9972 Pirate Hunt Turns to Loyola; Two Students Names Are Handed Over;
9973 Lawsuit Possible," <citetitle>Chicago Tribune</citetitle>, 16 July 2003, 1C; Beth Cox, "RIAA
9974 Trains Antipiracy Guns on Universities," <citetitle>Internet News</citetitle>, 30 January
9975 2003, available at <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
9976 #48</ulink>; Benny Evangelista, "Download Warning 101: Freshman
9977 Orientation This Fall to Include Record Industry Warnings Against File
9978 Sharing," <citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle</citetitle>, 11 August 2003, E11; "Raid, Letters
9979 Are Weapons at Universities," <citetitle>USA Today</citetitle>, 26 September 2000, 3D.
9980 </para></footnote>
9981 your daughter can lose the right to use the university's computer
9982 network. She can, in some cases, be expelled.
9983 </para>
9984 <para>
9985 Now, of course, she'll have the right to defend herself. You can hire
9986 a lawyer for her (at $300 per hour, if you're lucky), and she can
9987 plead that she didn't know anything about the source of the songs or
9988 that they came from Napster. And it may well be that the university
9989 believes her. But the university might not believe her. It might treat
9990 this "contraband" as presumptive of guilt. And as any number of
9991 college students
9992
9993 <!-- PAGE BREAK 216 -->
9994 have already learned, our presumptions about innocence disappear in
9995 the middle of wars of prohibition. This war is no different.
9996 Says von Lohmann,
9997 <indexterm><primary>von Lohmann, Fred</primary></indexterm>
9998 </para>
9999 <blockquote>
10000 <para>
10001 So when we're talking about numbers like forty to sixty million
10002 Americans that are essentially copyright infringers, you create a
10003 situation where the civil liberties of those people are very much in
10004 peril in a general matter. [I don't] think [there is any] analog where
10005 you could randomly choose any person off the street and be confident
10006 that they were committing an unlawful act that could put them on the
10007 hook for potential felony liability or hundreds of millions of dollars
10008 of civil liability. Certainly we all speed, but speeding isn't the
10009 kind of an act for which we routinely forfeit civil liberties. Some
10010 people use drugs, and I think that's the closest analog, [but] many
10011 have noted that the war against drugs has eroded all of our civil
10012 liberties because it's treated so many Americans as criminals. Well, I
10013 think it's fair to say that file sharing is an order of magnitude
10014 larger number of Americans than drug use. . . . If forty to sixty
10015 million Americans have become lawbreakers, then we're really on a
10016 slippery slope to lose a lot of civil liberties for all forty to sixty
10017 million of them.
10018 </para>
10019 </blockquote>
10020 <para>
10021 When forty to sixty million Americans are considered "criminals" under
10022 the law, and when the law could achieve the same objective&mdash;
10023 securing rights to authors&mdash;without these millions being
10024 considered "criminals," who is the villain? Americans or the law?
10025 Which is American, a constant war on our own people or a concerted
10026 effort through our democracy to change our law?
10027 </para>
10028
10029 <!-- PAGE BREAK 217 -->
10030 </section>
10031 </chapter>
10032 </part>
10033 <part id="c-balances">
10034 <title>BALANCES</title>
10035 <partintro>
10036
10037 <!-- PAGE BREAK 218 -->
10038 <para>
10039 So here's the picture: You're standing at the side of the road. Your
10040 car is on fire. You are angry and upset because in part you helped start
10041 the fire. Now you don't know how to put it out. Next to you is a bucket,
10042 filled with gasoline. Obviously, gasoline won't put the fire out.
10043 </para>
10044 <para>
10045 As you ponder the mess, someone else comes along. In a panic, she
10046 grabs the bucket. Before you have a chance to tell her to
10047 stop&mdash;or before she understands just why she should
10048 stop&mdash;the bucket is in the air. The gasoline is about to hit the
10049 blazing car. And the fire that gasoline will ignite is about to ignite
10050 everything around.
10051 </para>
10052 <para>
10053 A war about copyright rages all around&mdash;and we're all focusing on
10054 the wrong thing. No doubt, current technologies threaten existing
10055 businesses. No doubt they may threaten artists. But technologies
10056 change. The industry and technologists have plenty of ways to use
10057 technology to protect themselves against the current threats of the
10058 Internet. This is a fire that if let alone would burn itself out.
10059 </para>
10060 <para>
10061 <!-- PAGE BREAK 219 -->
10062 Yet policy makers are not willing to leave this fire to itself. Primed
10063 with plenty of lobbyists' money, they are keen to intervene to
10064 eliminate the problem they perceive. But the problem they perceive is
10065 not the real threat this culture faces. For while we watch this small
10066 fire in the corner, there is a massive change in the way culture is
10067 made that is happening all around.
10068 </para>
10069 <para>
10070 Somehow we have to find a way to turn attention to this more important
10071 and fundamental issue. Somehow we have to find a way to avoid pouring
10072 gasoline onto this fire.
10073 </para>
10074 <para>
10075 We have not found that way yet. Instead, we seem trapped in a simpler,
10076 binary view. However much many people push to frame this debate more
10077 broadly, it is the simple, binary view that remains. We rubberneck to
10078 look at the fire when we should be keeping our eyes on the road.
10079 </para>
10080 <para>
10081 This challenge has been my life these last few years. It has also been
10082 my failure. In the two chapters that follow, I describe one small
10083 brace of efforts, so far failed, to find a way to refocus this
10084 debate. We must understand these failures if we're to understand what
10085 success will require.
10086 </para>
10087 </partintro>
10088
10089 <!-- PAGE BREAK 220 -->
10090 <chapter id="eldred">
10091 <title>CHAPTER THIRTEEN: Eldred</title>
10092 <para>
10093 In 1995, a father was frustrated that his daughters didn't seem to
10094 like Hawthorne. No doubt there was more than one such father, but at
10095 least one did something about it. Eric Eldred, a retired computer
10096 programmer living in New Hampshire, decided to put Hawthorne on the
10097 Web. An electronic version, Eldred thought, with links to pictures and
10098 explanatory text, would make this nineteenth-century author's work
10099 come alive.
10100 </para>
10101 <para>
10102 It didn't work&mdash;at least for his daughters. They didn't find
10103 Hawthorne any more interesting than before. But Eldred's experiment
10104 gave birth to a hobby, and his hobby begat a cause: Eldred would build
10105 a library of public domain works by scanning these works and making
10106 them available for free.
10107 </para>
10108 <para>
10109 Eldred's library was not simply a copy of certain public domain
10110 works, though even a copy would have been of great value to people
10111 across the world who can't get access to printed versions of these
10112 works. Instead, Eldred was producing derivative works from these
10113 public domain works. Just as Disney turned Grimm into stories more
10114 <!-- PAGE BREAK 221 -->
10115 accessible to the twentieth century, Eldred transformed Hawthorne, and
10116 many others, into a form more accessible&mdash;technically
10117 accessible&mdash;today.
10118 </para>
10119 <para>
10120 Eldred's freedom to do this with Hawthorne's work grew from the same
10121 source as Disney's. Hawthorne's <citetitle>Scarlet Letter</citetitle> had passed into the
10122 public domain in 1907. It was free for anyone to take without the
10123 permission of the Hawthorne estate or anyone else. Some, such as Dover
10124 Press and Penguin Classics, take works from the public domain and
10125 produce printed editions, which they sell in bookstores across the
10126 country. Others, such as Disney, take these stories and turn them into
10127 animated cartoons, sometimes successfully (<citetitle>Cinderella</citetitle>), sometimes not
10128 (<citetitle>The Hunchback of Notre Dame</citetitle>, <citetitle>Treasure Planet</citetitle>). These are all
10129 commercial publications of public domain works.
10130 </para>
10131 <para>
10132 The Internet created the possibility of noncommercial publications of
10133 public domain works. Eldred's is just one example. There are literally
10134 thousands of others. Hundreds of thousands from across the world have
10135 discovered this platform of expression and now use it to share works
10136 that are, by law, free for the taking. This has produced what we might
10137 call the "noncommercial publishing industry," which before the
10138 Internet was limited to people with large egos or with political or
10139 social causes. But with the Internet, it includes a wide range of
10140 individuals and groups dedicated to spreading culture
10141 generally.<footnote><para>
10142 <!-- f1. -->
10143 There's a parallel here with pornography that is a bit hard to
10144 describe, but it's a strong one. One phenomenon that the Internet
10145 created was a world of noncommercial pornographers&mdash;people who
10146 were distributing porn but were not making money directly or
10147 indirectly from that distribution. Such a class didn't exist before
10148 the Internet came into being because the costs of distributing porn
10149 were so high. Yet this new class of distributors got special attention
10150 in the Supreme Court, when the Court struck down the Communications
10151 Decency Act of 1996. It was partly because of the burden on
10152 noncommercial speakers that the statute was found to exceed Congress's
10153 power. The same point could have been made about noncommercial
10154 publishers after the advent of the Internet. The Eric Eldreds of the
10155 world before the Internet were extremely few. Yet one would think it
10156 at least as important to protect the Eldreds of the world as to
10157 protect noncommercial pornographers.</para></footnote>
10158 </para>
10159 <para>
10160 As I said, Eldred lives in New Hampshire. In 1998, Robert Frost's
10161 collection of poems <citetitle>New Hampshire</citetitle> was slated to pass into the public
10162 domain. Eldred wanted to post that collection in his free public
10163 library. But Congress got in the way. As I described in chapter 10,
10164 in 1998, for the eleventh time in forty years, Congress extended the
10165 terms of existing copyrights&mdash;this time by twenty years. Eldred
10166 would not be free to add any works more recent than 1923 to his
10167 collection until 2019. Indeed, no copyrighted work would pass into
10168 the public domain until that year (and not even then, if Congress
10169 extends the term again). By contrast, in the same period, more than 1
10170 million patents will pass into the public domain.
10171 </para>
10172 <para>
10173
10174 <!-- PAGE BREAK 222 -->
10175 This was the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act
10176 (CTEA), enacted in memory of the congressman and former musician
10177 Sonny Bono, who, his widow, Mary Bono, says, believed that
10178 "copyrights should be forever."<footnote><para>
10179 <!-- f2. -->
10180 The full text is: "Sonny [Bono] wanted the term of copyright
10181 protection to last forever. I am informed by staff that such a change
10182 would violate the Constitution. I invite all of you to work with me to
10183 strengthen our copyright laws in all of the ways available to us. As
10184 you know, there is also Jack Valenti's proposal for a term to last
10185 forever less one day. Perhaps the Committee may look at that next
10186 Congress," 144 Cong. Rec. H9946, 9951-2 (October 7, 1998).
10187 </para></footnote>
10188
10189 </para>
10190 <para>
10191 Eldred decided to fight this law. He first resolved to fight it through
10192 civil disobedience. In a series of interviews, Eldred announced that he
10193 would publish as planned, CTEA notwithstanding. But because of a
10194 second law passed in 1998, the NET (No Electronic Theft) Act, his act
10195 of publishing would make Eldred a felon&mdash;whether or not anyone
10196 complained. This was a dangerous strategy for a disabled programmer
10197 to undertake.
10198 </para>
10199 <para>
10200 It was here that I became involved in Eldred's battle. I was a
10201 constitutional
10202 scholar whose first passion was constitutional
10203 interpretation.
10204 And though constitutional law courses never focus upon the
10205 Progress Clause of the Constitution, it had always struck me as
10206 importantly
10207 different. As you know, the Constitution says,
10208 </para>
10209 <blockquote>
10210 <para>
10211 Congress has the power to promote the Progress of Science . . .
10212 by securing for limited Times to Authors . . . exclusive Right to
10213 their . . . Writings. . . .
10214 </para>
10215 </blockquote>
10216 <para>
10217 As I've described, this clause is unique within the power-granting
10218 clause of Article I, section 8 of our Constitution. Every other clause
10219 granting power to Congress simply says Congress has the power to do
10220 something&mdash;for example, to regulate "commerce among the several
10221 states" or "declare War." But here, the "something" is something quite
10222 specific&mdash;to "promote . . . Progress"&mdash;through means that
10223 are also specific&mdash; by "securing" "exclusive Rights" (i.e.,
10224 copyrights) "for limited Times."
10225 </para>
10226 <para>
10227 In the past forty years, Congress has gotten into the practice of
10228 extending existing terms of copyright protection. What puzzled me
10229 about this was, if Congress has the power to extend existing terms,
10230 then the Constitution's requirement that terms be "limited" will have
10231 <!-- PAGE BREAK 223 -->
10232 no practical effect. If every time a copyright is about to expire,
10233 Congress has the power to extend its term, then Congress can achieve
10234 what the Constitution plainly forbids&mdash;perpetual terms "on the
10235 installment plan," as Professor Peter Jaszi so nicely put it.
10236 <indexterm><primary>Jaszi, Peter</primary></indexterm>
10237 </para>
10238 <para>
10239 As an academic, my first response was to hit the books. I remember
10240 sitting late at the office, scouring on-line databases for any serious
10241 consideration of the question. No one had ever challenged Congress's
10242 practice of extending existing terms. That failure may in part be why
10243 Congress seemed so untroubled in its habit. That, and the fact that
10244 the practice had become so lucrative for Congress. Congress knows that
10245 copyright owners will be willing to pay a great deal of money to see
10246 their copyright terms extended. And so Congress is quite happy to keep
10247 this gravy train going.
10248 </para>
10249 <para>
10250 For this is the core of the corruption in our present system of
10251 government. "Corruption" not in the sense that representatives are
10252 bribed. Rather, "corruption" in the sense that the system induces the
10253 beneficiaries of Congress's acts to raise and give money to Congress
10254 to induce it to act. There's only so much time; there's only so much
10255 Congress can do. Why not limit its actions to those things it must
10256 do&mdash;and those things that pay? Extending copyright terms pays.
10257 </para>
10258 <para>
10259 If that's not obvious to you, consider the following: Say you're one
10260 of the very few lucky copyright owners whose copyright continues to
10261 make money one hundred years after it was created. The Estate of
10262 Robert Frost is a good example. Frost died in 1963. His poetry
10263 continues to be extraordinarily valuable. Thus the Robert Frost estate
10264 benefits greatly from any extension of copyright, since no publisher
10265 would pay the estate any money if the poems Frost wrote could be
10266 published by anyone for free.
10267 </para>
10268 <para>
10269 So imagine the Robert Frost estate is earning $100,000 a year from
10270 three of Frost's poems. And imagine the copyright for those poems
10271 is about to expire. You sit on the board of the Robert Frost estate.
10272 Your financial adviser comes to your board meeting with a very grim
10273 report:
10274 </para>
10275 <para>
10276 "Next year," the adviser announces, "our copyrights in works A, B,
10277
10278 <!-- PAGE BREAK 224 -->
10279 and C will expire. That means that after next year, we will no longer be
10280 receiving the annual royalty check of $100,000 from the publishers of
10281 those works.
10282 </para>
10283 <para>
10284 "There's a proposal in Congress, however," she continues, "that
10285 could change this. A few congressmen are floating a bill to extend the
10286 terms of copyright by twenty years. That bill would be extraordinarily
10287 valuable to us. So we should hope this bill passes."
10288 </para>
10289 <para>
10290 "Hope?" a fellow board member says. "Can't we be doing something
10291 about it?"
10292 </para>
10293 <para>
10294 "Well, obviously, yes," the adviser responds. "We could contribute
10295 to the campaigns of a number of representatives to try to assure that
10296 they support the bill."
10297 </para>
10298 <para>
10299 You hate politics. You hate contributing to campaigns. So you want
10300 to know whether this disgusting practice is worth it. "How much
10301 would we get if this extension were passed?" you ask the adviser. "How
10302 much is it worth?"
10303 </para>
10304 <para>
10305 "Well," the adviser says, "if you're confident that you will continue
10306 to get at least $100,000 a year from these copyrights, and you use the
10307 `discount rate' that we use to evaluate estate investments (6 percent),
10308 then this law would be worth $1,146,000 to the estate."
10309 </para>
10310 <para>
10311 You're a bit shocked by the number, but you quickly come to the
10312 correct conclusion:
10313 </para>
10314 <para>
10315 "So you're saying it would be worth it for us to pay more than
10316 $1,000,000 in campaign contributions if we were confident those
10317 contributions
10318 would assure that the bill was passed?"
10319 </para>
10320 <para>
10321 "Absolutely," the adviser responds. "It is worth it to you to
10322 contribute
10323 up to the `present value' of the income you expect from these
10324 copyrights. Which for us means over $1,000,000."
10325 </para>
10326 <para>
10327 You quickly get the point&mdash;you as the member of the board and, I
10328 trust, you the reader. Each time copyrights are about to expire, every
10329 beneficiary in the position of the Robert Frost estate faces the same
10330 choice: If they can contribute to get a law passed to extend copyrights,
10331 <!-- PAGE BREAK 225 -->
10332 they will benefit greatly from that extension. And so each time
10333 copyrights
10334 are about to expire, there is a massive amount of lobbying to get
10335 the copyright term extended.
10336 </para>
10337 <para>
10338 Thus a congressional perpetual motion machine: So long as legislation
10339 can be bought (albeit indirectly), there will be all the incentive in
10340 the world to buy further extensions of copyright.
10341 </para>
10342 <para>
10343 In the lobbying that led to the passage of the Sonny Bono
10344 Copyright
10345 Term Extension Act, this "theory" about incentives was proved
10346 real. Ten of the thirteen original sponsors of the act in the House
10347 received the maximum contribution from Disney's political action
10348 committee; in the Senate, eight of the twelve sponsors received
10349 contributions.<footnote><para>
10350 <!-- f3. --> Associated Press, "Disney Lobbying for Copyright Extension No Mickey
10351 Mouse Effort; Congress OKs Bill Granting Creators 20 More Years,"
10352 <citetitle>Chicago Tribune</citetitle>, 17 October 1998, 22.
10353 </para></footnote>
10354 The RIAA and the MPAA are estimated to have spent over
10355 $1.5 million lobbying in the 1998 election cycle. They paid out more
10356 than $200,000 in campaign contributions.<footnote><para>
10357 <!-- f4. --> See Nick Brown, "Fair Use No More?: Copyright in the Information
10358 Age," available at
10359 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #49</ulink>.
10360 </para></footnote>
10361 Disney is estimated to have
10362 contributed more than $800,000 to reelection campaigns in the
10363 cycle.<footnote><para>
10364 <!-- f5. -->
10365 Alan K. Ota, "Disney in Washington: The Mouse That Roars,"
10366 <citetitle>Congressional Quarterly This Week</citetitle>, 8 August 1990, available at
10367 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #50</ulink>.
10368 </para></footnote>
10369
10370 </para>
10371 <para>
10372 Constitutional law is not oblivious to the obvious. Or at least,
10373 it need not be. So when I was considering Eldred's complaint, this
10374 reality
10375 about the never-ending incentives to increase the copyright term
10376 was central to my thinking. In my view, a pragmatic court committed
10377 to interpreting and applying the Constitution of our framers would see
10378 that if Congress has the power to extend existing terms, then there
10379 would be no effective constitutional requirement that terms be
10380 "limited."
10381 If they could extend it once, they would extend it again and again
10382 and again.
10383 </para>
10384 <para>
10385 It was also my judgment that <emphasis>this</emphasis> Supreme Court
10386 would not allow Congress to extend existing terms. As anyone close to
10387 the Supreme Court's work knows, this Court has increasingly restricted
10388 the power of Congress when it has viewed Congress's actions as
10389 exceeding the power granted to it by the Constitution. Among
10390 constitutional scholars, the most famous example of this trend was the
10391 Supreme Court's
10392
10393 <!-- PAGE BREAK 226 -->
10394 decision in 1995 to strike down a law that banned the possession of
10395 guns near schools.
10396 </para>
10397 <para>
10398 Since 1937, the Supreme Court had interpreted Congress's granted
10399 powers very broadly; so, while the Constitution grants Congress the
10400 power to regulate only "commerce among the several states" (aka
10401 "interstate
10402 commerce"), the Supreme Court had interpreted that power to
10403 include the power to regulate any activity that merely affected
10404 interstate
10405 commerce.
10406 </para>
10407 <para>
10408 As the economy grew, this standard increasingly meant that there was
10409 no limit to Congress's power to regulate, since just about every
10410 activity, when considered on a national scale, affects interstate
10411 commerce. A Constitution designed to limit Congress's power was
10412 instead interpreted to impose no limit.
10413 </para>
10414 <para>
10415 The Supreme Court, under Chief Justice Rehnquist's command, changed
10416 that in <citetitle>United States</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle>. The government had
10417 argued that possessing guns near schools affected interstate
10418 commerce. Guns near schools increase crime, crime lowers property
10419 values, and so on. In the oral argument, the Chief Justice asked the
10420 government whether there was any activity that would not affect
10421 interstate commerce under the reasoning the government advanced. The
10422 government said there was not; if Congress says an activity affects
10423 interstate commerce, then that activity affects interstate
10424 commerce. The Supreme Court, the government said, was not in the
10425 position to second-guess Congress.
10426 </para>
10427 <para>
10428 "We pause to consider the implications of the government's arguments,"
10429 the Chief Justice wrote.<footnote><para>
10430 <!-- f6. --> <citetitle>United States</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle>, 514 U.S. 549, 564 (1995).
10431 </para></footnote>
10432 If anything Congress says is interstate commerce must therefore be
10433 considered interstate commerce, then there would be no limit to
10434 Congress's power. The decision in <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle> was reaffirmed five years
10435 later in <citetitle>United States</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Morrison</citetitle>.<footnote><para>
10436 <!-- f7. -->
10437 <citetitle>United States</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Morrison</citetitle>, 529 U.S. 598 (2000).
10438 </para></footnote>
10439 </para>
10440 <para>
10441 If a principle were at work here, then it should apply to the Progress
10442 Clause as much as the Commerce Clause.<footnote><para>
10443 <!-- f8. -->
10444 If it is a principle about enumerated powers, then the principle
10445 carries from one enumerated power to another. The animating point in
10446 the context of the Commerce Clause was that the interpretation offered
10447 by the government would allow the government unending power to
10448 regulate commerce&mdash;the limitation to interstate commerce
10449 notwithstanding. The same point is true in the context of the
10450 Copyright Clause. Here, too, the government's interpretation would
10451 allow the government unending power to regulate copyrights&mdash;the
10452 limitation to "limited times" notwithstanding.
10453 </para></footnote>
10454 And if it is applied to the Progress Clause, the principle should
10455 yield the conclusion that Congress
10456 <!-- PAGE BREAK 227 -->
10457 can't extend an existing term. If Congress could extend an existing
10458 term, then there would be no "stopping point" to Congress's power over
10459 terms, though the Constitution expressly states that there is such a
10460 limit. Thus, the same principle applied to the power to grant
10461 copyrights should entail that Congress is not allowed to extend the
10462 term of existing copyrights.
10463 </para>
10464 <para>
10465 <emphasis>If</emphasis>, that is, the principle announced in <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle>
10466 stood for a principle. Many believed the decision in <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle> stood for
10467 politics&mdash;a conservative Supreme Court, which believed in states'
10468 rights, using its power over Congress to advance its own personal
10469 political preferences. But I rejected that view of the Supreme Court's
10470 decision. Indeed, shortly after the decision, I wrote an article
10471 demonstrating the "fidelity" in such an interpretation of the
10472 Constitution. The idea that the Supreme Court decides cases based upon
10473 its politics struck me as extraordinarily boring. I was not going to
10474 devote my life to teaching constitutional law if these nine Justices
10475 were going to be petty politicians.
10476 </para>
10477 <para>
10478 Now let's pause for a moment to make sure we understand what the
10479 argument in <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle> was not about. By insisting on the
10480 Constitution's limits to copyright, obviously Eldred was not endorsing
10481 piracy. Indeed, in an obvious sense, he was fighting a kind of
10482 piracy&mdash;piracy of the public domain. When Robert Frost wrote his
10483 work and when Walt Disney created Mickey Mouse, the maximum copyright
10484 term was just fifty-six years. Because of interim changes, Frost and
10485 Disney had already enjoyed a seventy-five-year monopoly for their
10486 work. They had gotten the benefit of the bargain that the Constitution
10487 envisions: In exchange for a monopoly protected for fifty-six years,
10488 they created new work. But now these entities were using their
10489 power&mdash;expressed through the power of lobbyists' money&mdash;to
10490 get another twenty-year dollop of monopoly. That twenty-year dollop
10491 would be taken from the public domain. Eric Eldred was fighting a
10492 piracy that affects us all.
10493 </para>
10494 <para>
10495 Some people view the public domain with contempt. In their brief
10496
10497 <!-- PAGE BREAK 228 -->
10498 before the Supreme Court, the Nashville Songwriters Association
10499 wrote that the public domain is nothing more than "legal piracy."<footnote><para>
10500 <!-- f9. -->
10501 Brief of the Nashville Songwriters Association, <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle>
10502 v. <citetitle>Ashcroft</citetitle>, 537 U.S. 186 (2003) (No. 01-618), n.10, available
10503 at <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #51</ulink>.
10504 </para></footnote>
10505 But it is not piracy when the law allows it; and in our constitutional
10506 system, our law requires it. Some may not like the Constitution's
10507 requirements, but that doesn't make the Constitution a pirate's
10508 charter.
10509 </para>
10510 <para>
10511 As we've seen, our constitutional system requires limits on
10512 copyright
10513 as a way to assure that copyright holders do not too heavily
10514 influence
10515 the development and distribution of our culture. Yet, as Eric
10516 Eldred discovered, we have set up a system that assures that copyright
10517 terms will be repeatedly extended, and extended, and extended. We
10518 have created the perfect storm for the public domain. Copyrights have
10519 not expired, and will not expire, so long as Congress is free to be
10520 bought to extend them again.
10521 </para>
10522 <para>
10523 It is valuable copyrights that are responsible for terms being
10524 extended.
10525 Mickey Mouse and "Rhapsody in Blue." These works are too
10526 valuable for copyright owners to ignore. But the real harm to our
10527 society
10528 from copyright extensions is not that Mickey Mouse remains
10529 Disney's.
10530 Forget Mickey Mouse. Forget Robert Frost. Forget all the works
10531 from the 1920s and 1930s that have continuing commercial value. The
10532 real harm of term extension comes not from these famous works. The
10533 real harm is to the works that are not famous, not commercially
10534 exploited,
10535 and no longer available as a result.
10536 </para>
10537 <para>
10538 If you look at the work created in the first twenty years (1923 to
10539 1942) affected by the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act,
10540 2 percent of that work has any continuing commercial value. It was the
10541 copyright holders for that 2 percent who pushed the CTEA through.
10542 But the law and its effect were not limited to that 2 percent. The law
10543 extended the terms of copyright generally.<footnote><para>
10544 <!-- f10. --> The figure of 2 percent is an extrapolation from the study by the
10545 Congressional
10546 Research Service, in light of the estimated renewal ranges. See Brief
10547 of Petitioners, <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Ashcroft</citetitle>, 7, available at
10548 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #52</ulink>.
10549 </para></footnote>
10550
10551 </para>
10552 <para>
10553 Think practically about the consequence of this
10554 extension&mdash;practically,
10555 as a businessperson, and not as a lawyer eager for more legal
10556
10557 <!-- PAGE BREAK 229 -->
10558 work. In 1930, 10,047 books were published. In 2000, 174 of those
10559 books were still in print. Let's say you were Brewster Kahle, and you
10560 wanted to make available to the world in your iArchive project the
10561 remaining
10562 9,873. What would you have to do?
10563 </para>
10564 <para>
10565 Well, first, you'd have to determine which of the 9,873 books were
10566 still under copyright. That requires going to a library (these data are
10567 not on-line) and paging through tomes of books, cross-checking the
10568 titles and authors of the 9,873 books with the copyright registration
10569 and renewal records for works published in 1930. That will produce a
10570 list of books still under copyright.
10571 </para>
10572 <para>
10573 Then for the books still under copyright, you would need to locate
10574 the current copyright owners. How would you do that?
10575 </para>
10576 <para>
10577 Most people think that there must be a list of these copyright
10578 owners
10579 somewhere. Practical people think this way. How could there be
10580 thousands and thousands of government monopolies without there
10581 being at least a list?
10582 </para>
10583 <para>
10584 But there is no list. There may be a name from 1930, and then in
10585 1959, of the person who registered the copyright. But just think
10586 practically
10587 about how impossibly difficult it would be to track down
10588 thousands
10589 of such records&mdash;especially since the person who registered is
10590 not necessarily the current owner. And we're just talking about 1930!
10591 </para>
10592 <para>
10593 "But there isn't a list of who owns property generally," the
10594 apologists for the system respond. "Why should there be a list of
10595 copyright owners?"
10596 </para>
10597 <para>
10598 Well, actually, if you think about it, there <emphasis>are</emphasis>
10599 plenty of lists of who owns what property. Think about deeds on
10600 houses, or titles to cars. And where there isn't a list, the code of
10601 real space is pretty good at suggesting who the owner of a bit of
10602 property is. (A swing set in your backyard is probably yours.) So
10603 formally or informally, we have a pretty good way to know who owns
10604 what tangible property.
10605 </para>
10606 <para>
10607 So: You walk down a street and see a house. You can know who
10608 owns the house by looking it up in the courthouse registry. If you see
10609 a car, there is ordinarily a license plate that will link the owner to the
10610
10611 <!-- PAGE BREAK 230 -->
10612 car. If you see a bunch of children's toys sitting on the front lawn of a
10613 house, it's fairly easy to determine who owns the toys. And if you
10614 happen
10615 to see a baseball lying in a gutter on the side of the road, look
10616 around for a second for some kids playing ball. If you don't see any
10617 kids, then okay: Here's a bit of property whose owner we can't easily
10618 determine. It is the exception that proves the rule: that we ordinarily
10619 know quite well who owns what property.
10620 </para>
10621 <para>
10622 Compare this story to intangible property. You go into a library.
10623 The library owns the books. But who owns the copyrights? As I've
10624 already
10625 described, there's no list of copyright owners. There are authors'
10626 names, of course, but their copyrights could have been assigned, or
10627 passed down in an estate like Grandma's old jewelry. To know who
10628 owns what, you would have to hire a private detective. The bottom
10629 line: The owner cannot easily be located. And in a regime like ours, in
10630 which it is a felony to use such property without the property owner's
10631 permission, the property isn't going to be used.
10632 </para>
10633 <para>
10634 The consequence with respect to old books is that they won't be
10635 digitized, and hence will simply rot away on shelves. But the
10636 consequence
10637 for other creative works is much more dire.
10638 </para>
10639 <indexterm><primary>Agee, Michael</primary></indexterm>
10640 <para>
10641 Consider the story of Michael Agee, chairman of Hal Roach Studios,
10642 which owns the copyrights for the Laurel and Hardy films. Agee is a
10643 direct beneficiary of the Bono Act. The Laurel and Hardy films were
10644 made between 1921 and 1951. Only one of these films, <citetitle>The Lucky Dog</citetitle>, is
10645 currently out of copyright. But for the CTEA, films made after 1923
10646 would have begun entering the public domain. Because Agee controls the
10647 exclusive rights for these popular films, he makes a great deal of
10648 money. According to one estimate, "Roach has sold about 60,000
10649 videocassettes and 50,000 DVDs of the duo's silent
10650 films."<footnote><para>
10651 <!-- f11. -->
10652 See David G. Savage, "High Court Scene of Showdown on Copyright Law,"
10653 <citetitle>Los Angeles Times</citetitle>, 6 October 2002; David Streitfeld, "Classic Movies,
10654 Songs, Books at Stake; Supreme Court Hears Arguments Today on Striking
10655 Down Copyright Extension," <citetitle>Orlando Sentinel Tribune</citetitle>, 9 October 2002.
10656 </para></footnote>
10657
10658 <indexterm><primary>Lucky Dog, The</primary></indexterm>
10659 </para>
10660 <para>
10661 Yet Agee opposed the CTEA. His reasons demonstrate a rare virtue in
10662 this culture: selflessness. He argued in a brief before the Supreme
10663 Court that the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act will, if left
10664 standing, destroy a whole generation of American film.
10665 </para>
10666 <para>
10667 His argument is straightforward. A tiny fraction of this work has
10668
10669 <!-- PAGE BREAK 231 -->
10670 any continuing commercial value. The rest&mdash;to the extent it
10671 survives at all&mdash;sits in vaults gathering dust. It may be that
10672 some of this work not now commercially valuable will be deemed to be
10673 valuable by the owners of the vaults. For this to occur, however, the
10674 commercial benefit from the work must exceed the costs of making the
10675 work available for distribution.
10676 </para>
10677 <para>
10678 We can't know the benefits, but we do know a lot about the costs.
10679 For most of the history of film, the costs of restoring film were very
10680 high; digital technology has lowered these costs substantially. While
10681 it cost more than $10,000 to restore a ninety-minute black-and-white
10682 film in 1993, it can now cost as little as $100 to digitize one hour of
10683 mm film.<footnote><para>
10684 <!-- f12. -->
10685 Brief of Hal Roach Studios and Michael Agee as Amicus Curiae
10686 Supporting the Petitoners, <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Ashcroft</citetitle>, 537
10687 U.S. 186 (2003) (No. 01- 618), 12. See also Brief of Amicus Curiae
10688 filed on behalf of Petitioners by the Internet Archive, <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle>
10689 v. <citetitle>Ashcroft</citetitle>, available at
10690 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #53</ulink>.
10691 </para></footnote>
10692
10693 </para>
10694 <para>
10695 Restoration technology is not the only cost, nor the most
10696 important.
10697 Lawyers, too, are a cost, and increasingly, a very important one. In
10698 addition to preserving the film, a distributor needs to secure the rights.
10699 And to secure the rights for a film that is under copyright, you need to
10700 locate the copyright owner.
10701 </para>
10702 <para>
10703 Or more accurately, <emphasis>owners</emphasis>. As we've seen, there
10704 isn't only a single copyright associated with a film; there are
10705 many. There isn't a single person whom you can contact about those
10706 copyrights; there are as many as can hold the rights, which turns out
10707 to be an extremely large number. Thus the costs of clearing the rights
10708 to these films is exceptionally high.
10709 </para>
10710 <para>
10711 "But can't you just restore the film, distribute it, and then pay the
10712 copyright owner when she shows up?" Sure, if you want to commit a
10713 felony. And even if you're not worried about committing a felony, when
10714 she does show up, she'll have the right to sue you for all the profits you
10715 have made. So, if you're successful, you can be fairly confident you'll be
10716 getting a call from someone's lawyer. And if you're not successful, you
10717 won't make enough to cover the costs of your own lawyer. Either way,
10718 you have to talk to a lawyer. And as is too often the case, saying you have
10719 to talk to a lawyer is the same as saying you won't make any money.
10720 </para>
10721 <para>
10722 For some films, the benefit of releasing the film may well exceed
10723
10724 <!-- PAGE BREAK 232 -->
10725 these costs. But for the vast majority of them, there is no way the
10726 benefit
10727 would outweigh the legal costs. Thus, for the vast majority of old
10728 films, Agee argued, the film will not be restored and distributed until
10729 the copyright expires.
10730 </para>
10731 <para>
10732 But by the time the copyright for these films expires, the film will
10733 have expired. These films were produced on nitrate-based stock, and
10734 nitrate stock dissolves over time. They will be gone, and the metal
10735 canisters
10736 in which they are now stored will be filled with nothing more
10737 than dust.
10738 </para>
10739 <para>
10740 Of all the creative work produced by humans anywhere, a tiny
10741 fraction has continuing commercial value. For that tiny fraction, the
10742 copyright is a crucially important legal device. For that tiny fraction,
10743 the copyright creates incentives to produce and distribute the
10744 creative
10745 work. For that tiny fraction, the copyright acts as an "engine of
10746 free expression."
10747 </para>
10748 <para>
10749 But even for that tiny fraction, the actual time during which the
10750 creative work has a commercial life is extremely short. As I've
10751 indicated,
10752 most books go out of print within one year. The same is true of
10753 music and film. Commercial culture is sharklike. It must keep moving.
10754 And when a creative work falls out of favor with the commercial
10755 distributors,
10756 the commercial life ends.
10757 </para>
10758 <para>
10759 Yet that doesn't mean the life of the creative work ends. We don't
10760 keep libraries of books in order to compete with Barnes &amp; Noble, and
10761 we don't have archives of films because we expect people to choose
10762 between
10763 spending Friday night watching new movies and spending
10764 Friday
10765 night watching a 1930 news documentary. The noncommercial life
10766 of culture is important and valuable&mdash;for entertainment but also, and
10767 more importantly, for knowledge. To understand who we are, and
10768 where we came from, and how we have made the mistakes that we
10769 have, we need to have access to this history.
10770 </para>
10771 <para>
10772 Copyrights in this context do not drive an engine of free expression.
10773
10774 <!-- PAGE BREAK 233 -->
10775 In this context, there is no need for an exclusive right. Copyrights in
10776 this context do no good.
10777 </para>
10778 <para>
10779 Yet, for most of our history, they also did little harm. For most of
10780 our history, when a work ended its commercial life, there was no
10781 <emphasis>copyright-related use</emphasis> that would be inhibited by
10782 an exclusive right. When a book went out of print, you could not buy
10783 it from a publisher. But you could still buy it from a used book
10784 store, and when a used book store sells it, in America, at least,
10785 there is no need to pay the copyright owner anything. Thus, the
10786 ordinary use of a book after its commercial life ended was a use that
10787 was independent of copyright law.
10788 </para>
10789 <para>
10790 The same was effectively true of film. Because the costs of restoring
10791 a film&mdash;the real economic costs, not the lawyer costs&mdash;were
10792 so high, it was never at all feasible to preserve or restore
10793 film. Like the remains of a great dinner, when it's over, it's
10794 over. Once a film passed out of its commercial life, it may have been
10795 archived for a bit, but that was the end of its life so long as the
10796 market didn't have more to offer.
10797 </para>
10798 <para>
10799 In other words, though copyright has been relatively short for most
10800 of our history, long copyrights wouldn't have mattered for the works
10801 that lost their commercial value. Long copyrights for these works
10802 would not have interfered with anything.
10803 </para>
10804 <para>
10805 But this situation has now changed.
10806 </para>
10807 <para>
10808 One crucially important consequence of the emergence of digital
10809 technologies is to enable the archive that Brewster Kahle dreams of.
10810 Digital technologies now make it possible to preserve and give access
10811 to all sorts of knowledge. Once a book goes out of print, we can now
10812 imagine digitizing it and making it available to everyone,
10813 forever. Once a film goes out of distribution, we could digitize it
10814 and make it available to everyone, forever. Digital technologies give
10815 new life to copyrighted material after it passes out of its commercial
10816 life. It is now possible to preserve and assure universal access to
10817 this knowledge and culture, whereas before it was not.
10818 </para>
10819 <para>
10820 <!-- PAGE BREAK 234 -->
10821 And now copyright law does get in the way. Every step of producing
10822 this digital archive of our culture infringes on the exclusive right
10823 of copyright. To digitize a book is to copy it. To do that requires
10824 permission of the copyright owner. The same with music, film, or any
10825 other aspect of our culture protected by copyright. The effort to make
10826 these things available to history, or to researchers, or to those who
10827 just want to explore, is now inhibited by a set of rules that were
10828 written for a radically different context.
10829 </para>
10830 <para>
10831 Here is the core of the harm that comes from extending terms: Now that
10832 technology enables us to rebuild the library of Alexandria, the law
10833 gets in the way. And it doesn't get in the way for any useful
10834 <emphasis>copyright</emphasis> purpose, for the purpose of copyright
10835 is to enable the commercial market that spreads culture. No, we are
10836 talking about culture after it has lived its commercial life. In this
10837 context, copyright is serving no purpose <emphasis>at all</emphasis>
10838 related to the spread of knowledge. In this context, copyright is not
10839 an engine of free expression. Copyright is a brake.
10840 </para>
10841 <para>
10842 You may well ask, "But if digital technologies lower the costs for
10843 Brewster Kahle, then they will lower the costs for Random House, too.
10844 So won't Random House do as well as Brewster Kahle in spreading
10845 culture widely?"
10846 </para>
10847 <para>
10848 Maybe. Someday. But there is absolutely no evidence to suggest that
10849 publishers would be as complete as libraries. If Barnes &amp; Noble
10850 offered to lend books from its stores for a low price, would that
10851 eliminate the need for libraries? Only if you think that the only role
10852 of a library is to serve what "the market" would demand. But if you
10853 think the role of a library is bigger than this&mdash;if you think its
10854 role is to archive culture, whether there's a demand for any
10855 particular bit of that culture or not&mdash;then we can't count on the
10856 commercial market to do our library work for us.
10857 </para>
10858 <para>
10859 I would be the first to agree that it should do as much as it can: We
10860 should rely upon the market as much as possible to spread and enable
10861 culture. My message is absolutely not antimarket. But where we see the
10862 market is not doing the job, then we should allow nonmarket forces the
10863
10864 <!-- PAGE BREAK 235 -->
10865 freedom to fill the gaps. As one researcher calculated for American
10866 culture, 94 percent of the films, books, and music produced between
10867 and 1946 is not commercially available. However much you love the
10868 commercial market, if access is a value, then 6 percent is a failure
10869 to provide that value.<footnote><para>
10870 <!-- f13. -->
10871 Jason Schultz, "The Myth of the 1976 Copyright `Chaos' Theory," 20
10872 December 2002, available at
10873 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #54</ulink>.
10874 </para></footnote>
10875
10876 </para>
10877 <para>
10878 In January 1999, we filed a lawsuit on Eric Eldred's behalf in federal
10879 district court in Washington, D.C., asking the court to declare the
10880 Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act unconstitutional. The two
10881 central claims that we made were (1) that extending existing terms
10882 violated the Constitution's "limited Times" requirement, and (2) that
10883 extending terms by another twenty years violated the First Amendment.
10884 </para>
10885 <para>
10886 The district court dismissed our claims without even hearing an
10887 argument. A panel of the Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit also
10888 dismissed our claims, though after hearing an extensive argument. But
10889 that decision at least had a dissent, by one of the most conservative
10890 judges on that court. That dissent gave our claims life.
10891 </para>
10892 <para>
10893 Judge David Sentelle said the CTEA violated the requirement that
10894 copyrights be for "limited Times" only. His argument was as elegant as
10895 it was simple: If Congress can extend existing terms, then there is no
10896 "stopping point" to Congress's power under the Copyright Clause. The
10897 power to extend existing terms means Congress is not required to grant
10898 terms that are "limited." Thus, Judge Sentelle argued, the court had
10899 to interpret the term "limited Times" to give it meaning. And the best
10900 interpretation, Judge Sentelle argued, would be to deny Congress the
10901 power to extend existing terms.
10902 </para>
10903 <para>
10904 We asked the Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit as a whole to
10905 hear the case. Cases are ordinarily heard in panels of three, except for
10906 important cases or cases that raise issues specific to the circuit as a
10907 whole, where the court will sit "en banc" to hear the case.
10908 </para>
10909 <para>
10910 The Court of Appeals rejected our request to hear the case en banc.
10911 This time, Judge Sentelle was joined by the most liberal member of the
10912
10913 <!-- PAGE BREAK 236 -->
10914 D.C. Circuit, Judge David Tatel. Both the most conservative and the
10915 most liberal judges in the D.C. Circuit believed Congress had
10916 overstepped its bounds.
10917 </para>
10918 <para>
10919 It was here that most expected Eldred v. Ashcroft would die, for the
10920 Supreme Court rarely reviews any decision by a court of appeals. (It
10921 hears about one hundred cases a year, out of more than five thousand
10922 appeals.) And it practically never reviews a decision that upholds a
10923 statute when no other court has yet reviewed the statute.
10924 </para>
10925 <para>
10926 But in February 2002, the Supreme Court surprised the world by
10927 granting our petition to review the D.C. Circuit opinion. Argument
10928 was set for October of 2002. The summer would be spent writing
10929 briefs and preparing for argument.
10930 </para>
10931 <para>
10932 It is over a year later as I write these words. It is still
10933 astonishingly hard. If you know anything at all about this story, you
10934 know that we lost the appeal. And if you know something more than just
10935 the minimum, you probably think there was no way this case could have
10936 been won. After our defeat, I received literally thousands of missives
10937 by well-wishers and supporters, thanking me for my work on behalf of
10938 this noble but doomed cause. And none from this pile was more
10939 significant to me than the e-mail from my client, Eric Eldred.
10940 </para>
10941 <para>
10942 But my client and these friends were wrong. This case could have
10943 been won. It should have been won. And no matter how hard I try to
10944 retell this story to myself, I can never escape believing that my own
10945 mistake lost it.
10946 </para>
10947 <indexterm><primary>Steward, Geoffrey</primary></indexterm>
10948 <para>
10949 The mistake was made early, though it became obvious only at the very
10950 end. Our case had been supported from the very beginning by an
10951 extraordinary lawyer, Geoffrey Stewart, and by the law firm he had
10952 moved to, Jones, Day, Reavis and Pogue. Jones Day took a great deal of
10953 heat
10954 <!-- PAGE BREAK 237 -->
10955 from its copyright-protectionist clients for supporting us. They
10956 ignored this pressure (something that few law firms today would ever
10957 do), and throughout the case, they gave it everything they could.
10958 </para>
10959 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don</primary></indexterm>
10960 <indexterm><primary>Bromberg, Dan</primary></indexterm>
10961 <indexterm><primary>Steward, Geoffrey</primary></indexterm>
10962 <para>
10963 There were three key lawyers on the case from Jones Day. Geoff
10964 Stewart was the first, but then Dan Bromberg and Don Ayer became
10965 quite involved. Bromberg and Ayer in particular had a common view
10966 about how this case would be won: We would only win, they repeatedly
10967 told me, if we could make the issue seem "important" to the Supreme
10968 Court. It had to seem as if dramatic harm were being done to free
10969 speech and free culture; otherwise, they would never vote against "the
10970 most powerful media companies in the world."
10971 </para>
10972 <para>
10973 I hate this view of the law. Of course I thought the Sonny Bono Act
10974 was a dramatic harm to free speech and free culture. Of course I still
10975 think it is. But the idea that the Supreme Court decides the law based
10976 on how important they believe the issues are is just wrong. It might be
10977 "right" as in "true," I thought, but it is "wrong" as in "it just shouldn't be
10978 that way." As I believed that any faithful interpretation of what the
10979 framers of our Constitution did would yield the conclusion that the
10980 CTEA was unconstitutional, and as I believed that any faithful
10981 interpretation
10982 of what the First Amendment means would yield the
10983 conclusion that the power to extend existing copyright terms is
10984 unconstitutional,
10985 I was not persuaded that we had to sell our case like soap.
10986 Just as a law that bans the swastika is unconstitutional not because the
10987 Court likes Nazis but because such a law would violate the
10988 Constitution,
10989 so too, in my view, would the Court decide whether Congress's
10990 law was constitutional based on the Constitution, not based on whether
10991 they liked the values that the framers put in the Constitution.
10992 </para>
10993 <para>
10994 In any case, I thought, the Court must already see the danger and
10995 the harm caused by this sort of law. Why else would they grant review?
10996 There was no reason to hear the case in the Supreme Court if they
10997 weren't convinced that this regulation was harmful. So in my view, we
10998 didn't need to persuade them that this law was bad, we needed to show
10999 why it was unconstitutional.
11000 </para>
11001 <para>
11002 There was one way, however, in which I felt politics would matter
11003
11004 <!-- PAGE BREAK 238 -->
11005 and in which I thought a response was appropriate. I was convinced
11006 that the Court would not hear our arguments if it thought these were
11007 just the arguments of a group of lefty loons. This Supreme Court was
11008 not about to launch into a new field of judicial review if it seemed
11009 that this field of review was simply the preference of a small
11010 political minority. Although my focus in the case was not to
11011 demonstrate how bad the Sonny Bono Act was but to demonstrate that it
11012 was unconstitutional, my hope was to make this argument against a
11013 background of briefs that covered the full range of political
11014 views. To show that this claim against the CTEA was grounded in
11015 <emphasis>law</emphasis> and not politics, then, we tried to gather
11016 the widest range of credible critics&mdash;credible not because they
11017 were rich and famous, but because they, in the aggregate, demonstrated
11018 that this law was unconstitutional regardless of one's politics.
11019 </para>
11020 <para>
11021 The first step happened all by itself. Phyllis Schlafly's
11022 organization, Eagle Forum, had been an opponent of the CTEA from the
11023 very beginning. Mrs. Schlafly viewed the CTEA as a sellout by
11024 Congress. In November 1998, she wrote a stinging editorial attacking
11025 the Republican Congress for allowing the law to pass. As she wrote,
11026 "Do you sometimes wonder why bills that create a financial windfall to
11027 narrow special interests slide easily through the intricate
11028 legislative process, while bills that benefit the general public seem
11029 to get bogged down?" The answer, as the editorial documented, was the
11030 power of money. Schlafly enumerated Disney's contributions to the key
11031 players on the committees. It was money, not justice, that gave Mickey
11032 Mouse twenty more years in Disney's control, Schlafly argued.
11033 <indexterm><primary>Eagle Forum</primary></indexterm>
11034 <indexterm><primary>Schlafly, Phyllis</primary></indexterm>
11035 </para>
11036 <para>
11037 In the Court of Appeals, Eagle Forum was eager to file a brief
11038 supporting our position. Their brief made the argument that became the
11039 core claim in the Supreme Court: If Congress can extend the term of
11040 existing copyrights, there is no limit to Congress's power to set
11041 terms. That strong conservative argument persuaded a strong
11042 conservative judge, Judge Sentelle.
11043 </para>
11044 <para>
11045 In the Supreme Court, the briefs on our side were about as diverse as
11046 it gets. They included an extraordinary historical brief by the Free
11047
11048 <!-- PAGE BREAK 239 -->
11049 Software Foundation (home of the GNU project that made GNU/ Linux
11050 possible). They included a powerful brief about the costs of
11051 uncertainty by Intel. There were two law professors' briefs, one by
11052 copyright scholars and one by First Amendment scholars. There was an
11053 exhaustive and uncontroverted brief by the world's experts in the
11054 history of the Progress Clause. And of course, there was a new brief
11055 by Eagle Forum, repeating and strengthening its arguments.
11056 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system</primary></indexterm>
11057 <indexterm><primary>Eagle Forum</primary></indexterm>
11058 </para>
11059 <para>
11060 Those briefs framed a legal argument. Then to support the legal
11061 argument, there were a number of powerful briefs by libraries and
11062 archives, including the Internet Archive, the American Association of
11063 Law Libraries, and the National Writers Union.
11064 </para>
11065 <para>
11066 But two briefs captured the policy argument best. One made the
11067 argument I've already described: A brief by Hal Roach Studios argued
11068 that unless the law was struck, a whole generation of American film
11069 would disappear. The other made the economic argument absolutely
11070 clear.
11071 </para>
11072 <indexterm><primary>Akerlof, George</primary></indexterm>
11073 <indexterm><primary>Arrow, Kenneth</primary></indexterm>
11074 <indexterm><primary>Buchanan, James</primary></indexterm>
11075 <indexterm><primary>Coase, Ronald</primary></indexterm>
11076 <indexterm><primary>Friedman, Milton</primary></indexterm>
11077 <para>
11078 This economists' brief was signed by seventeen economists, including
11079 five Nobel Prize winners, including Ronald Coase, James Buchanan,
11080 Milton Friedman, Kenneth Arrow, and George Akerlof. The economists, as
11081 the list of Nobel winners demonstrates, spanned the political
11082 spectrum. Their conclusions were powerful: There was no plausible
11083 claim that extending the terms of existing copyrights would do
11084 anything to increase incentives to create. Such extensions were
11085 nothing more than "rent-seeking"&mdash;the fancy term economists use
11086 to describe special-interest legislation gone wild.
11087 </para>
11088 <para>
11089 The same effort at balance was reflected in the legal team we gathered
11090 to write our briefs in the case. The Jones Day lawyers had been with
11091 us from the start. But when the case got to the Supreme Court, we
11092 added three lawyers to help us frame this argument to this Court: Alan
11093 Morrison, a lawyer from Public Citizen, a Washington group that had
11094 made constitutional history with a series of seminal victories in the
11095 Supreme Court defending individual rights; my colleague and dean,
11096 Kathleen Sullivan, who had argued many cases in the Court, and
11097
11098 <!-- PAGE BREAK 240 -->
11099 who had advised us early on about a First Amendment strategy; and
11100 finally, former solicitor general Charles Fried.
11101 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles</primary></indexterm>
11102 </para>
11103 <para>
11104 Fried was a special victory for our side. Every other former solicitor
11105 general was hired by the other side to defend Congress's power to give
11106 media companies the special favor of extended copyright terms. Fried
11107 was the only one who turned down that lucrative assignment to stand up
11108 for something he believed in. He had been Ronald Reagan's chief lawyer
11109 in the Supreme Court. He had helped craft the line of cases that
11110 limited Congress's power in the context of the Commerce Clause. And
11111 while he had argued many positions in the Supreme Court that I
11112 personally disagreed with, his joining the cause was a vote of
11113 confidence in our argument.
11114 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles</primary></indexterm>
11115 </para>
11116 <para>
11117 The government, in defending the statute, had its collection of
11118 friends, as well. Significantly, however, none of these "friends" included
11119 historians or economists. The briefs on the other side of the case were
11120 written exclusively by major media companies, congressmen, and
11121 copyright holders.
11122 </para>
11123 <para>
11124 The media companies were not surprising. They had the most to gain
11125 from the law. The congressmen were not surprising either&mdash;they
11126 were defending their power and, indirectly, the gravy train of
11127 contributions such power induced. And of course it was not surprising
11128 that the copyright holders would defend the idea that they should
11129 continue to have the right to control who did what with content they
11130 wanted to control.
11131 </para>
11132 <para>
11133 Dr. Seuss's representatives, for example, argued that it was
11134 better for the Dr. Seuss estate to control what happened to
11135 Dr. Seuss's work&mdash; better than allowing it to fall into the
11136 public domain&mdash;because if this creativity were in the public
11137 domain, then people could use it to "glorify drugs or to create
11138 pornography."<footnote><para>
11139 <!-- f14. -->
11140 Brief of Amici Dr. Seuss Enterprise et al., <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Ashcroft</citetitle>, 537
11141 U.S. (2003) (No. 01-618), 19.
11142 </para></footnote>
11143 That was also the motive of the Gershwin estate, which defended its
11144 "protection" of the work of George Gershwin. They refuse, for example,
11145 to license <citetitle>Porgy and Bess</citetitle> to anyone who refuses to use African
11146 Americans in the cast.<footnote><para>
11147 <!-- f15. -->
11148 Dinitia Smith, "Immortal Words, Immortal Royalties? Even Mickey
11149 Mouse Joins the Fray," <citetitle>New York Times</citetitle>, 28 March 1998, B7.
11150 </para></footnote>
11151 That's
11152 <!-- PAGE BREAK 241 -->
11153 their view of how this part of American culture should be controlled,
11154 and they wanted this law to help them effect that control.
11155 <indexterm><primary>Gershwin, George</primary></indexterm>
11156 </para>
11157 <para>
11158 This argument made clear a theme that is rarely noticed in this
11159 debate. When Congress decides to extend the term of existing
11160 copyrights, Congress is making a choice about which speakers it will
11161 favor. Famous and beloved copyright owners, such as the Gershwin
11162 estate and Dr. Seuss, come to Congress and say, "Give us twenty years
11163 to control the speech about these icons of American culture. We'll do
11164 better with them than anyone else." Congress of course likes to reward
11165 the popular and famous by giving them what they want. But when
11166 Congress gives people an exclusive right to speak in a certain way,
11167 that's just what the First Amendment is traditionally meant to block.
11168 </para>
11169 <para>
11170 We argued as much in a final brief. Not only would upholding the CTEA
11171 mean that there was no limit to the power of Congress to extend
11172 copyrights&mdash;extensions that would further concentrate the market;
11173 it would also mean that there was no limit to Congress's power to play
11174 favorites, through copyright, with who has the right to speak.
11175 Between February and October, there was little I did beyond preparing
11176 for this case. Early on, as I said, I set the strategy.
11177 </para>
11178 <para>
11179 The Supreme Court was divided into two important camps. One
11180 camp we called "the Conservatives." The other we called "the Rest."
11181 The Conservatives included Chief Justice Rehnquist, Justice O'Connor,
11182 Justice Scalia, Justice Kennedy, and Justice Thomas. These five had
11183 been the most consistent in limiting Congress's power. They were the
11184 five who had supported the <citetitle>Lopez/Morrison</citetitle> line of cases that said that
11185 an enumerated power had to be interpreted to assure that Congress's
11186 powers had limits.
11187 </para>
11188 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen</primary></indexterm>
11189 <para>
11190 The Rest were the four Justices who had strongly opposed limits on
11191 Congress's power. These four&mdash;Justice Stevens, Justice Souter,
11192 Justice Ginsburg, and Justice Breyer&mdash;had repeatedly argued that
11193 the Constitution
11194 <!-- PAGE BREAK 242 -->
11195 gives Congress broad discretion to decide how best to implement its
11196 powers. In case after case, these justices had argued that the Court's
11197 role should be one of deference. Though the votes of these four
11198 justices were the votes that I personally had most consistently agreed
11199 with, they were also the votes that we were least likely to get.
11200 </para>
11201 <para>
11202 In particular, the least likely was Justice Ginsburg's. In addition to
11203 her general view about deference to Congress (except where issues of
11204 gender are involved), she had been particularly deferential in the
11205 context of intellectual property protections. She and her daughter (an
11206 excellent and well-known intellectual property scholar) were cut from
11207 the same intellectual property cloth. We expected she would agree with
11208 the writings of her daughter: that Congress had the power in this
11209 context to do as it wished, even if what Congress wished made little
11210 sense.
11211 </para>
11212 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen</primary></indexterm>
11213 <para>
11214 Close behind Justice Ginsburg were two justices whom we also viewed as
11215 unlikely allies, though possible surprises. Justice Souter strongly
11216 favored deference to Congress, as did Justice Breyer. But both were
11217 also very sensitive to free speech concerns. And as we strongly
11218 believed, there was a very important free speech argument against
11219 these retrospective extensions.
11220 </para>
11221 <para>
11222 The only vote we could be confident about was that of Justice
11223 Stevens. History will record Justice Stevens as one of the greatest
11224 judges on this Court. His votes are consistently eclectic, which just
11225 means that no simple ideology explains where he will stand. But he
11226 had consistently argued for limits in the context of intellectual property
11227 generally. We were fairly confident he would recognize limits here.
11228 </para>
11229 <para>
11230 This analysis of "the Rest" showed most clearly where our focus
11231 had to be: on the Conservatives. To win this case, we had to crack open
11232 these five and get at least a majority to go our way. Thus, the single
11233 overriding
11234 argument that animated our claim rested on the Conservatives'
11235 most important jurisprudential innovation&mdash;the argument that Judge
11236 Sentelle had relied upon in the Court of Appeals, that Congress's power
11237 must be interpreted so that its enumerated powers have limits.
11238 </para>
11239 <para>
11240 This then was the core of our strategy&mdash;a strategy for which I am
11241 responsible. We would get the Court to see that just as with the
11242 <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle>
11243
11244 <!-- PAGE BREAK 243 -->
11245 case, under the government's argument here, Congress would always have
11246 unlimited power to extend existing terms. If anything was plain about
11247 Congress's power under the Progress Clause, it was that this power was
11248 supposed to be "limited." Our aim would be to get the Court to
11249 reconcile <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle> with <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle>: If Congress's power to
11250 regulate commerce was limited, then so, too, must Congress's power to
11251 regulate copyright be limited.
11252 </para>
11253 <para>
11254 The argument on the government's side came down to this: Congress has
11255 done it before. It should be allowed to do it again. The government
11256 claimed that from the very beginning, Congress has been extending the
11257 term of existing copyrights. So, the government argued, the Court
11258 should not now say that practice is unconstitutional.
11259 </para>
11260 <para>
11261 There was some truth to the government's claim, but not much. We
11262 certainly agreed that Congress had extended existing terms in
11263 and in 1909. And of course, in 1962, Congress began extending
11264 existing
11265 terms regularly&mdash;eleven times in forty years.
11266 </para>
11267 <para>
11268 But this "consistency" should be kept in perspective. Congress
11269 extended
11270 existing terms once in the first hundred years of the Republic.
11271 It then extended existing terms once again in the next fifty. Those rare
11272 extensions are in contrast to the now regular practice of extending
11273 existing
11274 terms. Whatever restraint Congress had had in the past, that
11275 restraint
11276 was now gone. Congress was now in a cycle of extensions; there
11277 was no reason to expect that cycle would end. This Court had not
11278 hesitated
11279 to intervene where Congress was in a similar cycle of extension.
11280 There was no reason it couldn't intervene here.
11281 Oral argument was scheduled for the first week in October. I
11282 arrived
11283 in D.C. two weeks before the argument. During those two
11284 weeks, I was repeatedly "mooted" by lawyers who had volunteered to
11285
11286 <!-- PAGE BREAK 244 -->
11287 help in the case. Such "moots" are basically practice rounds, where
11288 wannabe justices fire questions at wannabe winners.
11289 </para>
11290 <para>
11291 I was convinced that to win, I had to keep the Court focused on a
11292 single point: that if this extension is permitted, then there is no limit to
11293 the power to set terms. Going with the government would mean that
11294 terms would be effectively unlimited; going with us would give
11295 Congress
11296 a clear line to follow: Don't extend existing terms. The moots
11297 were an effective practice; I found ways to take every question back to
11298 this central idea.
11299 </para>
11300 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don</primary></indexterm>
11301 <para>
11302 One moot was before the lawyers at Jones Day. Don Ayer was the
11303 skeptic. He had served in the Reagan Justice Department with Solicitor
11304 General Charles Fried. He had argued many cases before the Supreme
11305 Court. And in his review of the moot, he let his concern speak:
11306 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles</primary></indexterm>
11307 </para>
11308 <para>
11309 "I'm just afraid that unless they really see the harm, they won't be
11310 willing to upset this practice that the government says has been a
11311 consistent practice for two hundred years. You have to make them see
11312 the harm&mdash;passionately get them to see the harm. For if they
11313 don't see that, then we haven't any chance of winning."
11314 </para>
11315 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don</primary></indexterm>
11316 <para>
11317 He may have argued many cases before this Court, I thought, but
11318 he didn't understand its soul. As a clerk, I had seen the Justices do the
11319 right thing&mdash;not because of politics but because it was right. As a law
11320 professor, I had spent my life teaching my students that this Court
11321 does the right thing&mdash;not because of politics but because it is right. As
11322 I listened to Ayer's plea for passion in pressing politics, I understood
11323 his point, and I rejected it. Our argument was right. That was enough.
11324 Let the politicians learn to see that it was also good.
11325 The night before the argument, a line of people began to form
11326 in front of the Supreme Court. The case had become a focus of the
11327 press and of the movement to free culture. Hundreds stood in line
11328
11329 <!-- PAGE BREAK 245 -->
11330 for the chance to see the proceedings. Scores spent the night on the
11331 Supreme Court steps so that they would be assured a seat.
11332 </para>
11333 <para>
11334 Not everyone has to wait in line. People who know the Justices can
11335 ask for seats they control. (I asked Justice Scalia's chambers for seats for
11336 my parents, for example.) Members of the Supreme Court bar can get
11337 a seat in a special section reserved for them. And senators and
11338 congressmen
11339 have a special place where they get to sit, too. And finally, of
11340 course, the press has a gallery, as do clerks working for the Justices on
11341 the Court. As we entered that morning, there was no place that was
11342 not taken. This was an argument about intellectual property law, yet
11343 the halls were filled. As I walked in to take my seat at the front of the
11344 Court, I saw my parents sitting on the left. As I sat down at the table,
11345 I saw Jack Valenti sitting in the special section ordinarily reserved for
11346 family of the Justices.
11347 </para>
11348 <para>
11349 When the Chief Justice called me to begin my argument, I began
11350 where I intended to stay: on the question of the limits on Congress's
11351 power. This was a case about enumerated powers, I said, and whether
11352 those enumerated powers had any limit.
11353 </para>
11354 <para>
11355 Justice O'Connor stopped me within one minute of my opening.
11356 The history was bothering her.
11357 </para>
11358 <blockquote>
11359 <para>
11360 justice o'connor: Congress has extended the term so often
11361 through the years, and if you are right, don't we run the risk of
11362 upsetting previous extensions of time? I mean, this seems to be a
11363 practice that began with the very first act.
11364 </para>
11365 </blockquote>
11366 <para>
11367 She was quite willing to concede "that this flies directly in the face
11368 of what the framers had in mind." But my response again and again
11369 was to emphasize limits on Congress's power.
11370 </para>
11371 <blockquote>
11372 <para>
11373 mr. lessig: Well, if it flies in the face of what the framers had in
11374 mind, then the question is, is there a way of interpreting their
11375 <!-- PAGE BREAK 246 -->
11376 words that gives effect to what they had in mind, and the answer
11377 is yes.
11378 </para>
11379 </blockquote>
11380 <para>
11381 There were two points in this argument when I should have seen
11382 where the Court was going. The first was a question by Justice
11383 Kennedy, who observed,
11384 </para>
11385 <blockquote>
11386 <para>
11387 justice kennedy: Well, I suppose implicit in the argument that
11388 the '76 act, too, should have been declared void, and that we
11389 might leave it alone because of the disruption, is that for all these
11390 years the act has impeded progress in science and the useful arts.
11391 I just don't see any empirical evidence for that.
11392 </para>
11393 </blockquote>
11394 <para>
11395 Here follows my clear mistake. Like a professor correcting a
11396 student,
11397 I answered,
11398 </para>
11399 <blockquote>
11400 <para>
11401 mr. lessig: Justice, we are not making an empirical claim at all.
11402 Nothing in our Copyright Clause claim hangs upon the empirical
11403 assertion about impeding progress. Our only argument is this is a
11404 structural limit necessary to assure that what would be an effectively
11405 perpetual term not be permitted under the copyright laws.
11406 </para>
11407 </blockquote>
11408 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don</primary></indexterm>
11409 <para>
11410 That was a correct answer, but it wasn't the right answer. The right
11411 answer was instead that there was an obvious and profound harm. Any
11412 number of briefs had been written about it. He wanted to hear it. And
11413 here was the place Don Ayer's advice should have mattered. This was a
11414 softball; my answer was a swing and a miss.
11415 </para>
11416 <para>
11417 The second came from the Chief, for whom the whole case had been
11418 crafted. For the Chief Justice had crafted the <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle> ruling,
11419 and we hoped that he would see this case as its second cousin.
11420 </para>
11421 <para>
11422 It was clear a second into his question that he wasn't at all
11423 sympathetic. To him, we were a bunch of anarchists. As he asked:
11424
11425 <!-- PAGE BREAK 247 -->
11426 </para>
11427 <blockquote>
11428 <para>
11429 chief justice: Well, but you want more than that. You want the
11430 right to copy verbatim other people's books, don't you?
11431 </para>
11432 <para>
11433 mr. lessig: We want the right to copy verbatim works that
11434 should be in the public domain and would be in the public
11435 domain
11436 but for a statute that cannot be justified under ordinary First
11437 Amendment analysis or under a proper reading of the limits built
11438 into the Copyright Clause.
11439 </para>
11440 </blockquote>
11441 <para>
11442 Things went better for us when the government gave its argument;
11443 for now the Court picked up on the core of our claim. As Justice Scalia
11444 asked Solicitor General Olson,
11445 </para>
11446 <blockquote>
11447 <para>
11448 justice scalia: You say that the functional equivalent of an unlimited
11449 time would be a violation [of the Constitution], but that's precisely
11450 the argument that's being made by petitioners here, that a limited
11451 time which is extendable is the functional equivalent of an unlimited
11452 time.
11453 </para>
11454 </blockquote>
11455 <para>
11456 When Olson was finished, it was my turn to give a closing rebuttal.
11457 Olson's flailing had revived my anger. But my anger still was directed
11458 to the academic, not the practical. The government was arguing as if
11459 this were the first case ever to consider limits on Congress's
11460 Copyright and Patent Clause power. Ever the professor and not the
11461 advocate, I closed by pointing out the long history of the Court
11462 imposing limits on Congress's power in the name of the Copyright and
11463 Patent Clause&mdash; indeed, the very first case striking a law of
11464 Congress as exceeding a specific enumerated power was based upon the
11465 Copyright and Patent Clause. All true. But it wasn't going to move the
11466 Court to my side.
11467 </para>
11468 <para>
11469 As I left the court that day, I knew there were a hundred points I
11470 wished I could remake. There were a hundred questions I wished I had
11471
11472 <!-- PAGE BREAK 248 -->
11473 answered differently. But one way of thinking about this case left me
11474 optimistic.
11475 </para>
11476 <para>
11477 The government had been asked over and over again, what is the limit?
11478 Over and over again, it had answered there is no limit. This was
11479 precisely the answer I wanted the Court to hear. For I could not
11480 imagine how the Court could understand that the government believed
11481 Congress's power was unlimited under the terms of the Copyright
11482 Clause, and sustain the government's argument. The solicitor general
11483 had made my argument for me. No matter how often I tried, I could not
11484 understand how the Court could find that Congress's power under the
11485 Commerce Clause was limited, but under the Copyright Clause,
11486 unlimited. In those rare moments when I let myself believe that we may
11487 have prevailed, it was because I felt this Court&mdash;in particular,
11488 the Conservatives&mdash;would feel itself constrained by the rule of
11489 law that it had established elsewhere.
11490 </para>
11491 <para>
11492 The morning of January 15, 2003, I was five minutes late to the office
11493 and missed the 7:00 A.M. call from the Supreme Court clerk. Listening to
11494 the message, I could tell in an instant that she had bad news to report.The
11495 Supreme Court had affirmed the decision of the Court of Appeals. Seven
11496 justices had voted in the majority. There were two dissents.
11497 </para>
11498 <para>
11499 A few seconds later, the opinions arrived by e-mail. I took the
11500 phone off the hook, posted an announcement to our blog, and sat
11501 down to see where I had been wrong in my reasoning.
11502 </para>
11503 <para>
11504 My <emphasis>reasoning</emphasis>. Here was a case that pitted all the
11505 money in the world against <emphasis>reasoning</emphasis>. And here
11506 was the last naïve law professor, scouring the pages, looking for
11507 reasoning.
11508 </para>
11509 <para>
11510 I first scoured the opinion, looking for how the Court would
11511 distinguish the principle in this case from the principle in
11512 <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle>. The argument was nowhere to be found. The case was not even
11513 cited. The argument that was the core argument of our case did not
11514 even appear in the Court's opinion.
11515 </para>
11516 <para>
11517
11518 <!-- PAGE BREAK 249 -->
11519 Justice Ginsburg simply ignored the enumerated powers argument.
11520 Consistent with her view that Congress's power was not limited
11521 generally, she had found Congress's power not limited here.
11522 </para>
11523 <para>
11524 Her opinion was perfectly reasonable&mdash;for her, and for Justice
11525 Souter. Neither believes in <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle>. It would be too much to expect them
11526 to write an opinion that recognized, much less explained, the doctrine
11527 they had worked so hard to defeat.
11528 </para>
11529 <para>
11530 But as I realized what had happened, I couldn't quite believe what I
11531 was reading. I had said there was no way this Court could reconcile
11532 limited powers with the Commerce Clause and unlimited powers with the
11533 Progress Clause. It had never even occurred to me that they could
11534 reconcile the two simply <emphasis>by not addressing the
11535 argument</emphasis>. There was no inconsistency because they would not
11536 talk about the two together. There was therefore no principle that
11537 followed from the <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle> case: In that context, Congress's power would
11538 be limited, but in this context it would not.
11539 </para>
11540 <para>
11541 Yet by what right did they get to choose which of the framers' values
11542 they would respect? By what right did they&mdash;the silent
11543 five&mdash;get to select the part of the Constitution they would
11544 enforce based on the values they thought important? We were right back
11545 to the argument that I said I hated at the start: I had failed to
11546 convince them that the issue here was important, and I had failed to
11547 recognize that however much I might hate a system in which the Court
11548 gets to pick the constitutional values that it will respect, that is
11549 the system we have.
11550 </para>
11551 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen</primary></indexterm>
11552 <para>
11553 Justices Breyer and Stevens wrote very strong dissents. Stevens's
11554 opinion was crafted internal to the law: He argued that the tradition
11555 of intellectual property law should not support this unjustified
11556 extension of terms. He based his argument on a parallel analysis that
11557 had governed in the context of patents (so had we). But the rest of
11558 the Court discounted the parallel&mdash;without explaining how the
11559 very same words in the Progress Clause could come to mean totally
11560 different things depending upon whether the words were about patents
11561 or copyrights. The Court let Justice Stevens's charge go unanswered.
11562 </para>
11563 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen</primary></indexterm>
11564 <para>
11565 <!-- PAGE BREAK 250 -->
11566 Justice Breyer's opinion, perhaps the best opinion he has ever
11567 written, was external to the Constitution. He argued that the term of
11568 copyrights has become so long as to be effectively unlimited. We had
11569 said that under the current term, a copyright gave an author 99.8
11570 percent of the value of a perpetual term. Breyer said we were wrong,
11571 that the actual number was 99.9997 percent of a perpetual term. Either
11572 way, the point was clear: If the Constitution said a term had to be
11573 "limited," and the existing term was so long as to be effectively
11574 unlimited, then it was unconstitutional.
11575 </para>
11576 <para>
11577 These two justices understood all the arguments we had made. But
11578 because neither believed in the <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle> case, neither was willing to push
11579 it as a reason to reject this extension. The case was decided without
11580 anyone having addressed the argument that we had carried from Judge
11581 Sentelle. It was <citetitle>Hamlet</citetitle> without the Prince.
11582 </para>
11583 <para>
11584 Defeat brings depression. They say it is a sign of health when
11585 depression gives way to anger. My anger came quickly, but it didn't cure
11586 the depression. This anger was of two sorts.
11587 </para>
11588 <para>
11589 It was first anger with the five "Conservatives." It would have been
11590 one thing for them to have explained why the principle of <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle> didn't
11591 apply in this case. That wouldn't have been a very convincing
11592 argument, I don't believe, having read it made by others, and having
11593 tried to make it myself. But it at least would have been an act of
11594 integrity. These justices in particular have repeatedly said that the
11595 proper mode of interpreting the Constitution is "originalism"&mdash;to
11596 first understand the framers' text, interpreted in their context, in
11597 light of the structure of the Constitution. That method had produced
11598 <citetitle>Lopez</citetitle> and many other "originalist" rulings. Where was their
11599 "originalism" now?
11600 </para>
11601 <para>
11602 Here, they had joined an opinion that never once tried to explain
11603 what the framers had meant by crafting the Progress Clause as they
11604 did; they joined an opinion that never once tried to explain how the
11605 structure of that clause would affect the interpretation of Congress's
11606
11607 <!-- PAGE BREAK 251 -->
11608 power. And they joined an opinion that didn't even try to explain why
11609 this grant of power could be unlimited, whereas the Commerce Clause
11610 would be limited. In short, they had joined an opinion that did not
11611 apply to, and was inconsistent with, their own method for interpreting
11612 the Constitution. This opinion may well have yielded a result that
11613 they liked. It did not produce a reason that was consistent with their
11614 own principles.
11615 </para>
11616 <para>
11617 My anger with the Conservatives quickly yielded to anger with
11618 myself.
11619 For I had let a view of the law that I liked interfere with a view of
11620 the law as it is.
11621 </para>
11622 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don</primary></indexterm>
11623 <para>
11624 Most lawyers, and most law professors, have little patience for
11625 idealism about courts in general and this Supreme Court in particular.
11626 Most have a much more pragmatic view. When Don Ayer said that this
11627 case would be won based on whether I could convince the Justices that
11628 the framers' values were important, I fought the idea, because I
11629 didn't want to believe that that is how this Court decides. I insisted
11630 on arguing this case as if it were a simple application of a set of
11631 principles. I had an argument that followed in logic. I didn't need
11632 to waste my time showing it should also follow in popularity.
11633 </para>
11634 <para>
11635 As I read back over the transcript from that argument in October, I
11636 can see a hundred places where the answers could have taken the
11637 conversation in different directions, where the truth about the harm
11638 that this unchecked power will cause could have been made clear to
11639 this Court. Justice Kennedy in good faith wanted to be shown. I,
11640 idiotically, corrected his question. Justice Souter in good faith
11641 wanted to be shown the First Amendment harms. I, like a math teacher,
11642 reframed the question to make the logical point. I had shown them how
11643 they could strike this law of Congress if they wanted to. There were a
11644 hundred places where I could have helped them want to, yet my
11645 stubbornness, my refusal to give in, stopped me. I have stood before
11646 hundreds of audiences trying to persuade; I have used passion in that
11647 effort to persuade; but I
11648 <!-- PAGE BREAK 252 -->
11649 refused to stand before this audience and try to persuade with the
11650 passion I had used elsewhere. It was not the basis on which a court
11651 should decide the issue.
11652 </para>
11653 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don</primary></indexterm>
11654 <para>
11655 Would it have been different if I had argued it differently? Would it
11656 have been different if Don Ayer had argued it? Or Charles Fried? Or
11657 Kathleen Sullivan?
11658 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles</primary></indexterm>
11659 </para>
11660 <para>
11661 My friends huddled around me to insist it would not. The Court
11662 was not ready, my friends insisted. This was a loss that was destined. It
11663 would take a great deal more to show our society why our framers were
11664 right. And when we do that, we will be able to show that Court.
11665 </para>
11666 <para>
11667 Maybe, but I doubt it. These Justices have no financial interest in
11668 doing anything except the right thing. They are not lobbied. They have
11669 little reason to resist doing right. I can't help but think that if I had
11670 stepped down from this pretty picture of dispassionate justice, I could
11671 have persuaded.
11672 </para>
11673 <para>
11674 And even if I couldn't, then that doesn't excuse what happened in
11675 January. For at the start of this case, one of America's leading
11676 intellectual property professors stated publicly that my bringing this
11677 case was a mistake. "The Court is not ready," Peter Jaszi said; this
11678 issue should not be raised until it is.
11679 <indexterm><primary>Jaszi, Peter</primary></indexterm>
11680 </para>
11681 <para>
11682 After the argument and after the decision, Peter said to me, and
11683 publicly, that he was wrong. But if indeed that Court could not have
11684 been persuaded, then that is all the evidence that's needed to know that
11685 here again Peter was right. Either I was not ready to argue this case in
11686 a way that would do some good or they were not ready to hear this case
11687 in a way that would do some good. Either way, the decision to bring
11688 this case&mdash;a decision I had made four years before&mdash;was wrong.
11689 While the reaction to the Sonny Bono Act itself was almost
11690 unanimously negative, the reaction to the Court's decision was mixed.
11691 No one, at least in the press, tried to say that extending the term of
11692 copyright was a good idea. We had won that battle over ideas. Where
11693
11694 <!-- PAGE BREAK 253 -->
11695 the decision was praised, it was praised by papers that had been
11696 skeptical of the Court's activism in other cases. Deference was a good
11697 thing, even if it left standing a silly law. But where the decision
11698 was attacked, it was attacked because it left standing a silly and
11699 harmful law. <citetitle>The New York Times</citetitle> wrote in its editorial,
11700 </para>
11701 <blockquote>
11702 <para>
11703 In effect, the Supreme Court's decision makes it likely that we are
11704 seeing the beginning of the end of public domain and the birth of
11705 copyright perpetuity. The public domain has been a grand experiment,
11706 one that should not be allowed to die. The ability to draw freely on
11707 the entire creative output of humanity is one of the reasons we live
11708 in a time of such fruitful creative ferment.
11709 </para>
11710 </blockquote>
11711 <para>
11712 The best responses were in the cartoons. There was a gaggle of
11713 hilarious images&mdash;of Mickey in jail and the like. The best, from
11714 my view of the case, was Ruben Bolling's, reproduced on the next
11715 page. The "powerful and wealthy" line is a bit unfair. But the punch
11716 in the face felt exactly like that.
11717 <indexterm><primary>Bolling, Ruben</primary></indexterm>
11718 </para>
11719 <para>
11720 The image that will always stick in my head is that evoked by the
11721 quote from <citetitle>The New York Times</citetitle>. That "grand experiment" we call the
11722 "public domain" is over? When I can make light of it, I think, "Honey,
11723 I shrunk the Constitution." But I can rarely make light of it. We had
11724 in our Constitution a commitment to free culture. In the case that I
11725 fathered, the Supreme Court effectively renounced that commitment. A
11726 better lawyer would have made them see differently.
11727 </para>
11728 <!-- PAGE BREAK 254 -->
11729 </chapter>
11730 <chapter id="eldred-ii">
11731 <title>CHAPTER FOURTEEN: Eldred II</title>
11732 <para>
11733 The day <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle> was decided, fate would have it that I was to travel to
11734 Washington, D.C. (The day the rehearing petition in <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle> was
11735 denied&mdash;meaning the case was really finally over&mdash;fate would
11736 have it that I was giving a speech to technologists at Disney World.)
11737 This was a particularly long flight to my least favorite city. The
11738 drive into the city from Dulles was delayed because of traffic, so I
11739 opened up my computer and wrote an op-ed piece.
11740 </para>
11741 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don</primary></indexterm>
11742 <para>
11743 It was an act of contrition. During the whole of the flight from San
11744 Francisco to Washington, I had heard over and over again in my head
11745 the same advice from Don Ayer: You need to make them see why it is
11746 important. And alternating with that command was the question of
11747 Justice Kennedy: "For all these years the act has impeded progress in
11748 science and the useful arts. I just don't see any empirical evidence for
11749 that." And so, having failed in the argument of constitutional principle,
11750 finally, I turned to an argument of politics.
11751 </para>
11752 <para>
11753 <citetitle>The New York Times</citetitle> published the piece. In it, I proposed a simple
11754 fix: Fifty years after a work has been published, the copyright owner
11755 <!-- PAGE BREAK 256 -->
11756 would be required to register the work and pay a small fee. If he paid
11757 the fee, he got the benefit of the full term of copyright. If he did not,
11758 the work passed into the public domain.
11759 </para>
11760 <para>
11761 We called this the Eldred Act, but that was just to give it a name.
11762 Eric Eldred was kind enough to let his name be used once again, but as
11763 he said early on, it won't get passed unless it has another name.
11764 </para>
11765 <para>
11766 Or another two names. For depending upon your perspective, this
11767 is either the "Public Domain Enhancement Act" or the "Copyright
11768 Term Deregulation Act." Either way, the essence of the idea is clear
11769 and obvious: Remove copyright where it is doing nothing except
11770 blocking access and the spread of knowledge. Leave it for as long as
11771 Congress allows for those works where its worth is at least $1. But for
11772 everything else, let the content go.
11773 </para>
11774 <indexterm><primary>Forbes, Steve</primary></indexterm>
11775 <para>
11776 The reaction to this idea was amazingly strong. Steve Forbes endorsed
11777 it in an editorial. I received an avalanche of e-mail and letters
11778 expressing support. When you focus the issue on lost creativity,
11779 people can see the copyright system makes no sense. As a good
11780 Republican might say, here government regulation is simply getting in
11781 the way of innovation and creativity. And as a good Democrat might
11782 say, here the government is blocking access and the spread of
11783 knowledge for no good reason. Indeed, there is no real difference
11784 between Democrats and Republicans on this issue. Anyone can recognize
11785 the stupid harm of the present system.
11786 </para>
11787 <para>
11788 Indeed, many recognized the obvious benefit of the registration
11789 requirement. For one of the hardest things about the current system
11790 for people who want to license content is that there is no obvious
11791 place to look for the current copyright owners. Since registration is
11792 not required, since marking content is not required, since no
11793 formality at all is required, it is often impossibly hard to locate
11794 copyright owners to ask permission to use or license their work. This
11795 system would lower these costs, by establishing at least one registry
11796 where copyright owners could be identified.
11797 </para>
11798 <indexterm><primary>Berlin Act (1908)</primary></indexterm>
11799 <indexterm><primary>Berne Convention (1908)</primary></indexterm>
11800 <para>
11801 <!-- PAGE BREAK 257 -->
11802 As I described in chapter 10, formalities in copyright law were
11803 removed in 1976, when Congress followed the Europeans by abandoning
11804 any formal requirement before a copyright is granted.<footnote><para>
11805 <!-- f1. -->
11806 Until the 1908 Berlin Act of the Berne Convention, national copyright
11807 legislation sometimes made protection depend upon compliance with
11808 formalities such as registration, deposit, and affixation of notice of
11809 the author's claim of copyright. However, starting with the 1908 act,
11810 every text of the Convention has provided that "the enjoyment and the
11811 exercise" of rights guaranteed by the Convention "shall not be subject
11812 to any formality." The prohibition against formalities is presently
11813 embodied in Article 5(2) of the Paris Text of the Berne
11814 Convention. Many countries continue to impose some form of deposit or
11815 registration requirement, albeit not as a condition of
11816 copyright. French law, for example, requires the deposit of copies of
11817 works in national repositories, principally the National Museum.
11818 Copies of books published in the United Kingdom must be deposited in
11819 the British Library. The German Copyright Act provides for a Registrar
11820 of Authors where the author's true name can be filed in the case of
11821 anonymous or pseudonymous works. Paul Goldstein, <citetitle>International
11822 Intellectual Property Law, Cases and Materials</citetitle> (New York: Foundation
11823 Press, 2001), 153&ndash;54. </para></footnote>
11824 The Europeans are said to view copyright as a "natural right." Natural
11825 rights don't need forms to exist. Traditions, like the Anglo-American
11826 tradition that required copyright owners to follow form if their
11827 rights were to be protected, did not, the Europeans thought, properly
11828 respect the dignity of the author. My right as a creator turns on my
11829 creativity, not upon the special favor of the government.
11830 </para>
11831 <para>
11832 That's great rhetoric. It sounds wonderfully romantic. But it is
11833 absurd copyright policy. It is absurd especially for authors, because
11834 a world without formalities harms the creator. The ability to spread
11835 "Walt Disney creativity" is destroyed when there is no simple way to
11836 know what's protected and what's not.
11837 </para>
11838 <indexterm><primary>Berne Convention (1908)</primary></indexterm>
11839 <para>
11840 The fight against formalities achieved its first real victory in
11841 Berlin in 1908. International copyright lawyers amended the Berne
11842 Convention in 1908, to require copyright terms of life plus fifty
11843 years, as well as the abolition of copyright formalities. The
11844 formalities were hated because the stories of inadvertent loss were
11845 increasingly common. It was as if a Charles Dickens character ran all
11846 copyright offices, and the failure to dot an <citetitle>i</citetitle> or cross a
11847 <citetitle>t</citetitle> resulted in the loss of widows' only income.
11848 </para>
11849 <para>
11850 These complaints were real and sensible. And the strictness of the
11851 formalities, especially in the United States, was absurd. The law
11852 should always have ways of forgiving innocent mistakes. There is no
11853 reason copyright law couldn't, as well. Rather than abandoning
11854 formalities totally, the response in Berlin should have been to
11855 embrace a more equitable system of registration.
11856 </para>
11857 <para>
11858 Even that would have been resisted, however, because registration
11859 in the nineteenth and twentieth centuries was still expensive. It was
11860 also a hassle. The abolishment of formalities promised not only to save
11861 the starving widows, but also to lighten an unnecessary regulatory
11862 burden
11863 imposed upon creators.
11864 </para>
11865 <para>
11866 In addition to the practical complaint of authors in 1908, there was
11867 a moral claim as well. There was no reason that creative property
11868
11869 <!-- PAGE BREAK 258 -->
11870 should be a second-class form of property. If a carpenter builds a
11871 table, his rights over the table don't depend upon filing a form with
11872 the government. He has a property right over the table "naturally,"
11873 and he can assert that right against anyone who would steal the table,
11874 whether or not he has informed the government of his ownership of the
11875 table.
11876 </para>
11877 <para>
11878 This argument is correct, but its implications are misleading. For the
11879 argument in favor of formalities does not depend upon creative
11880 property being second-class property. The argument in favor of
11881 formalities turns upon the special problems that creative property
11882 presents. The law of formalities responds to the special physics of
11883 creative property, to assure that it can be efficiently and fairly
11884 spread.
11885 </para>
11886 <para>
11887 No one thinks, for example, that land is second-class property just
11888 because you have to register a deed with a court if your sale of land
11889 is to be effective. And few would think a car is second-class property
11890 just because you must register the car with the state and tag it with
11891 a license. In both of those cases, everyone sees that there is an
11892 important reason to secure registration&mdash;both because it makes
11893 the markets more efficient and because it better secures the rights of
11894 the owner. Without a registration system for land, landowners would
11895 perpetually have to guard their property. With registration, they can
11896 simply point the police to a deed. Without a registration system for
11897 cars, auto theft would be much easier. With a registration system, the
11898 thief has a high burden to sell a stolen car. A slight burden is
11899 placed on the property owner, but those burdens produce a much better
11900 system of protection for property generally.
11901 </para>
11902 <para>
11903 It is similarly special physics that makes formalities important in
11904 copyright law. Unlike a carpenter's table, there's nothing in nature that
11905 makes it relatively obvious who might own a particular bit of creative
11906 property. A recording of Lyle Lovett's latest album can exist in a billion
11907 places without anything necessarily linking it back to a particular
11908 owner. And like a car, there's no way to buy and sell creative property
11909 with confidence unless there is some simple way to authenticate who is
11910 the author and what rights he has. Simple transactions are destroyed in
11911
11912 <!-- PAGE BREAK 259 -->
11913 a world without formalities. Complex, expensive,
11914 <emphasis>lawyer</emphasis> transactions take their place.
11915 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle</primary></indexterm>
11916 </para>
11917 <para>
11918 This was the understanding of the problem with the Sonny Bono
11919 Act that we tried to demonstrate to the Court. This was the part it
11920 didn't "get." Because we live in a system without formalities, there is no
11921 way easily to build upon or use culture from our past. If copyright
11922 terms were, as Justice Story said they would be, "short," then this
11923 wouldn't matter much. For fourteen years, under the framers' system, a
11924 work would be presumptively controlled. After fourteen years, it would
11925 be presumptively uncontrolled.
11926 </para>
11927 <para>
11928 But now that copyrights can be just about a century long, the
11929 inability to know what is protected and what is not protected becomes
11930 a huge and obvious burden on the creative process. If the only way a
11931 library can offer an Internet exhibit about the New Deal is to hire a
11932 lawyer to clear the rights to every image and sound, then the
11933 copyright system is burdening creativity in a way that has never been
11934 seen before <emphasis>because there are no formalities</emphasis>.
11935 </para>
11936 <para>
11937 The Eldred Act was designed to respond to exactly this problem. If
11938 it is worth $1 to you, then register your work and you can get the
11939 longer term. Others will know how to contact you and, therefore, how
11940 to get your permission if they want to use your work. And you will get
11941 the benefit of an extended copyright term.
11942 </para>
11943 <para>
11944 If it isn't worth it to you to register to get the benefit of an extended
11945 term, then it shouldn't be worth it for the government to defend your
11946 monopoly over that work either. The work should pass into the public
11947 domain where anyone can copy it, or build archives with it, or create a
11948 movie based on it. It should become free if it is not worth $1 to you.
11949 </para>
11950 <para>
11951 Some worry about the burden on authors. Won't the burden of
11952 registering the work mean that the $1 is really misleading? Isn't the
11953 hassle worth more than $1? Isn't that the real problem with
11954 registration?
11955 </para>
11956 <para>
11957 It is. The hassle is terrible. The system that exists now is awful. I
11958 completely agree that the Copyright Office has done a terrible job (no
11959 doubt because they are terribly funded) in enabling simple and cheap
11960
11961 <!-- PAGE BREAK 260 -->
11962 registrations. Any real solution to the problem of formalities must
11963 address the real problem of <emphasis>governments</emphasis> standing
11964 at the core of any system of formalities. In this book, I offer such a
11965 solution. That solution essentially remakes the Copyright Office. For
11966 now, assume it was Amazon that ran the registration system. Assume it
11967 was one-click registration. The Eldred Act would propose a simple,
11968 one-click registration fifty years after a work was published. Based
11969 upon historical data, that system would move up to 98 percent of
11970 commercial work, commercial work that no longer had a commercial life,
11971 into the public domain within fifty years. What do you think?
11972 </para>
11973 <indexterm><primary>Forbes, Steve</primary></indexterm>
11974 <para>
11975 When Steve Forbes endorsed the idea, some in Washington began to pay
11976 attention. Many people contacted me pointing to representatives who
11977 might be willing to introduce the Eldred Act. And I had a few who
11978 directly suggested that they might be willing to take the first step.
11979 </para>
11980 <para>
11981 One representative, Zoe Lofgren of California, went so far as to get
11982 the bill drafted. The draft solved any problem with international
11983 law. It imposed the simplest requirement upon copyright owners
11984 possible. In May 2003, it looked as if the bill would be
11985 introduced. On May 16, I posted on the Eldred Act blog, "we are
11986 close." There was a general reaction in the blog community that
11987 something good might happen here.
11988 <indexterm><primary>Lofgren, Zoe</primary></indexterm>
11989 </para>
11990 <para>
11991 But at this stage, the lobbyists began to intervene. Jack Valenti and
11992 the MPAA general counsel came to the congresswoman's office to give
11993 the view of the MPAA. Aided by his lawyer, as Valenti told me, Valenti
11994 informed the congresswoman that the MPAA would oppose the Eldred
11995 Act. The reasons are embarrassingly thin. More importantly, their
11996 thinness shows something clear about what this debate is really about.
11997 </para>
11998 <para>
11999 The MPAA argued first that Congress had "firmly rejected the central
12000 concept in the proposed bill"&mdash;that copyrights be renewed. That
12001 was true, but irrelevant, as Congress's "firm rejection" had occurred
12002 <!-- PAGE BREAK 261 -->
12003 long before the Internet made subsequent uses much more likely.
12004 Second, they argued that the proposal would harm poor copyright
12005 owners&mdash;apparently those who could not afford the $1 fee. Third,
12006 they argued that Congress had determined that extending a copyright
12007 term would encourage restoration work. Maybe in the case of the small
12008 percentage of work covered by copyright law that is still commercially
12009 valuable, but again this was irrelevant, as the proposal would not cut
12010 off the extended term unless the $1 fee was not paid. Fourth, the MPAA
12011 argued that the bill would impose "enormous" costs, since a
12012 registration system is not free. True enough, but those costs are
12013 certainly less than the costs of clearing the rights for a copyright
12014 whose owner is not known. Fifth, they worried about the risks if the
12015 copyright to a story underlying a film were to pass into the public
12016 domain. But what risk is that? If it is in the public domain, then the
12017 film is a valid derivative use.
12018 </para>
12019 <para>
12020 Finally, the MPAA argued that existing law enabled copyright owners to
12021 do this if they wanted. But the whole point is that there are
12022 thousands of copyright owners who don't even know they have a
12023 copyright to give. Whether they are free to give away their copyright
12024 or not&mdash;a controversial claim in any case&mdash;unless they know
12025 about a copyright, they're not likely to.
12026 </para>
12027 <para>
12028 At the beginning of this book, I told two stories about the law
12029 reacting to changes in technology. In the one, common sense prevailed.
12030 In the other, common sense was delayed. The difference between the two
12031 stories was the power of the opposition&mdash;the power of the side
12032 that fought to defend the status quo. In both cases, a new technology
12033 threatened old interests. But in only one case did those interest's
12034 have the power to protect themselves against this new competitive
12035 threat.
12036 </para>
12037 <para>
12038 I used these two cases as a way to frame the war that this book has
12039 been about. For here, too, a new technology is forcing the law to react.
12040 And here, too, we should ask, is the law following or resisting common
12041 sense? If common sense supports the law, what explains this common
12042 sense?
12043 </para>
12044 <para>
12045
12046 <!-- PAGE BREAK 262 -->
12047 When the issue is piracy, it is right for the law to back the
12048 copyright owners. The commercial piracy that I described is wrong and
12049 harmful, and the law should work to eliminate it. When the issue is
12050 p2p sharing, it is easy to understand why the law backs the owners
12051 still: Much of this sharing is wrong, even if much is harmless. When
12052 the issue is copyright terms for the Mickey Mouses of the world, it is
12053 possible still to understand why the law favors Hollywood: Most people
12054 don't recognize the reasons for limiting copyright terms; it is thus
12055 still possible to see good faith within the resistance.
12056 </para>
12057 <para>
12058 But when the copyright owners oppose a proposal such as the Eldred
12059 Act, then, finally, there is an example that lays bare the naked
12060 selfinterest driving this war. This act would free an extraordinary
12061 range of content that is otherwise unused. It wouldn't interfere with
12062 any copyright owner's desire to exercise continued control over his
12063 content. It would simply liberate what Kevin Kelly calls the "Dark
12064 Content" that fills archives around the world. So when the warriors
12065 oppose a change like this, we should ask one simple question:
12066 </para>
12067 <para>
12068 What does this industry really want?
12069 </para>
12070 <para>
12071 With very little effort, the warriors could protect their content. So
12072 the effort to block something like the Eldred Act is not really about
12073 protecting <emphasis>their</emphasis> content. The effort to block the
12074 Eldred Act is an effort to assure that nothing more passes into the
12075 public domain. It is another step to assure that the public domain
12076 will never compete, that there will be no use of content that is not
12077 commercially controlled, and that there will be no commercial use of
12078 content that doesn't require <emphasis>their</emphasis> permission
12079 first.
12080 </para>
12081 <para>
12082 The opposition to the Eldred Act reveals how extreme the other side
12083 is. The most powerful and sexy and well loved of lobbies really has as
12084 its aim not the protection of "property" but the rejection of a
12085 tradition. Their aim is not simply to protect what is
12086 theirs. <emphasis>Their aim is to assure that all there is is what is
12087 theirs</emphasis>.
12088 </para>
12089 <para>
12090 It is not hard to understand why the warriors take this view. It is not
12091 hard to see why it would benefit them if the competition of the public
12092
12093 <!-- PAGE BREAK 263 -->
12094 domain tied to the Internet could somehow be quashed. Just as RCA
12095 feared the competition of FM, they fear the competition of a public
12096 domain connected to a public that now has the means to create with it
12097 and to share its own creation.
12098 </para>
12099 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee</primary></indexterm>
12100 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie</primary></indexterm>
12101 <para>
12102 What is hard to understand is why the public takes this view. It is
12103 as if the law made airplanes trespassers. The MPAA stands with the
12104 Causbys and demands that their remote and useless property rights be
12105 respected, so that these remote and forgotten copyright holders might
12106 block the progress of others.
12107 </para>
12108 <para>
12109 All this seems to follow easily from this untroubled acceptance of the
12110 "property" in intellectual property. Common sense supports it, and so
12111 long as it does, the assaults will rain down upon the technologies of
12112 the Internet. The consequence will be an increasing "permission
12113 society." The past can be cultivated only if you can identify the
12114 owner and gain permission to build upon his work. The future will be
12115 controlled by this dead (and often unfindable) hand of the past.
12116 </para>
12117 <!-- PAGE BREAK 264 -->
12118 </chapter>
12119 </part>
12120 <part id="c-conclusion">
12121 <title>CONCLUSION</title>
12122 <partintro>
12123 <para>
12124 There are more than 35 million people with the AIDS virus
12125 worldwide. Twenty-five million of them live in sub-Saharan Africa.
12126 Seventeen million have already died. Seventeen million Africans
12127 is proportional percentage-wise to seven million Americans. More
12128 importantly, it is seventeen million Africans.
12129 </para>
12130 <para>
12131 There is no cure for AIDS, but there are drugs to slow its
12132 progression. These antiretroviral therapies are still experimental,
12133 but they have already had a dramatic effect. In the United States,
12134 AIDS patients who regularly take a cocktail of these drugs increase
12135 their life expectancy by ten to twenty years. For some, the drugs make
12136 the disease almost invisible.
12137 </para>
12138 <para>
12139 These drugs are expensive. When they were first introduced in the
12140 United States, they cost between $10,000 and $15,000 per person per
12141 year. Today, some cost $25,000 per year. At these prices, of course, no
12142 African nation can afford the drugs for the vast majority of its
12143 population:
12144 $15,000 is thirty times the per capita gross national product of
12145 Zimbabwe. At these prices, the drugs are totally unavailable.<footnote><para>
12146 <!-- f1. --> Commission on Intellectual Property Rights, "Final Report: Integrating
12147 Intellectual Property Rights and Development Policy" (London, 2002),
12148 available at
12149 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #55</ulink>. According to a World Health Organization press
12150 release
12151 issued 9 July 2002, only 230,000 of the 6 million who need drugs in
12152 the developing world receive them&mdash;and half of them are in Brazil.
12153 </para></footnote>
12154 </para>
12155 <para>
12156 <!-- PAGE BREAK 265 -->
12157 These prices are not high because the ingredients of the drugs are
12158 expensive. These prices are high because the drugs are protected by
12159 patents. The drug companies that produced these life-saving mixes
12160 enjoy at least a twenty-year monopoly for their inventions. They use
12161 that monopoly power to extract the most they can from the market. That
12162 power is in turn used to keep the prices high.
12163 </para>
12164 <para>
12165 There are many who are skeptical of patents, especially drug
12166 patents. I am not. Indeed, of all the areas of research that might be
12167 supported by patents, drug research is, in my view, the clearest case
12168 where patents are needed. The patent gives the drug company some
12169 assurance that if it is successful in inventing a new drug to treat a
12170 disease, it will be able to earn back its investment and more. This is
12171 socially an extremely valuable incentive. I am the last person who
12172 would argue that the law should abolish it, at least without other
12173 changes.
12174 </para>
12175 <para>
12176 But it is one thing to support patents, even drug patents. It is
12177 another thing to determine how best to deal with a crisis. And as
12178 African leaders began to recognize the devastation that AIDS was
12179 bringing, they started looking for ways to import HIV treatments at
12180 costs significantly below the market price.
12181 </para>
12182 <para>
12183 In 1997, South Africa tried one tack. It passed a law to allow the
12184 importation of patented medicines that had been produced or sold in
12185 another nation's market with the consent of the patent owner. For
12186 example, if the drug was sold in India, it could be imported into
12187 Africa from India. This is called "parallel importation," and it is
12188 generally permitted under international trade law and is specifically
12189 permitted within the European Union.<footnote>
12190 <para>
12191 <!-- f2. -->
12192 See Peter Drahos with John Braithwaite, Information Feudalism: <citetitle>Who
12193 Owns the Knowledge Economy?</citetitle> (New York: The New Press, 2003), 37.
12194 <indexterm><primary>Braithwaite, John</primary></indexterm>
12195 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter</primary></indexterm>
12196 </para></footnote>
12197 </para>
12198 <para>
12199 However, the United States government opposed the bill. Indeed, more
12200 than opposed. As the International Intellectual Property Association
12201 characterized it, "The U.S. government pressured South Africa . . .
12202 not to permit compulsory licensing or parallel
12203 imports."<footnote><para>
12204 <!-- f3. -->
12205 International Intellectual Property Institute (IIPI), <citetitle>Patent
12206 Protection and Access to HIV/AIDS Pharmaceuticals in Sub-Saharan
12207 Africa, a Report Prepared for the World Intellectual Property
12208 Organization</citetitle> (Washington, D.C., 2000), 14, available at
12209 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #56</ulink>. For a
12210 firsthand account of the struggle over South Africa, see Hearing
12211 Before the Subcommittee on Criminal Justice, Drug Policy, and Human
12212 Resources, House Committee on Government Reform, H. Rep., 1st sess.,
12213 Ser. No. 106-126 (22 July 1999), 150&ndash;57 (statement of James
12214 Love).
12215 </para></footnote>
12216 Through the Office of the United States Trade Representative, the
12217 government asked South Africa to change the law&mdash;and to add
12218 pressure to that request, in 1998, the USTR listed South Africa for
12219 possible trade sanctions.
12220 <!-- PAGE BREAK 266 -->
12221 That same year, more than forty pharmaceutical companies began
12222 proceedings in the South African courts to challenge the government's
12223 actions. The United States was then joined by other governments from
12224 the EU. Their claim, and the claim of the pharmaceutical companies,
12225 was that South Africa was violating its obligations under
12226 international law by discriminating against a particular kind of
12227 patent&mdash; pharmaceutical patents. The demand of these governments,
12228 with the United States in the lead, was that South Africa respect
12229 these patents as it respects any other patent, regardless of any
12230 effect on the treatment of AIDS within South Africa.<footnote><para>
12231 <!-- f4. -->
12232 International Intellectual Property Institute (IIPI), <citetitle>Patent
12233 Protection and Access to HIV/AIDS Pharmaceuticals in Sub-Saharan
12234 Africa, a Report Prepared for the World Intellectual Property
12235 Organization</citetitle> (Washington, D.C., 2000), 15. </para></footnote>
12236 </para>
12237 <para>
12238 We should place the intervention by the United States in context. No
12239 doubt patents are not the most important reason that Africans don't
12240 have access to drugs. Poverty and the total absence of an effective
12241 health care infrastructure matter more. But whether patents are the
12242 most important reason or not, the price of drugs has an effect on
12243 their demand, and patents affect price. And so, whether massive or
12244 marginal, there was an effect from our government's intervention to
12245 stop the flow of medications into Africa.
12246 </para>
12247 <para>
12248 By stopping the flow of HIV treatment into Africa, the United
12249 States government was not saving drugs for United States citizens.
12250 This is not like wheat (if they eat it, we can't); instead, the flow that the
12251 United States intervened to stop was, in effect, a flow of knowledge:
12252 information about how to take chemicals that exist within Africa, and
12253 turn those chemicals into drugs that would save 15 to 30 million lives.
12254 </para>
12255 <para>
12256 Nor was the intervention by the United States going to protect the
12257 profits of United States drug companies&mdash;at least, not substantially. It
12258 was not as if these countries were in the position to buy the drugs for
12259 the prices the drug companies were charging. Again, the Africans are
12260 wildly too poor to afford these drugs at the offered prices. Stopping the
12261 parallel import of these drugs would not substantially increase the sales
12262 by U.S. companies.
12263 </para>
12264 <para>
12265 Instead, the argument in favor of restricting this flow of
12266 information, which was needed to save the lives of millions, was an
12267 argument
12268 <!-- PAGE BREAK 267 -->
12269 about the sanctity of property.<footnote><para>
12270 <!-- f5. -->
12271 See Sabin Russell, "New Crusade to Lower AIDS Drug Costs: Africa's
12272 Needs at Odds with Firms' Profit Motive," <citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle</citetitle>, 24
12273 May 1999, A1, available at
12274 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #57</ulink>
12275 ("compulsory licenses and gray markets pose a threat to the entire
12276 system of intellectual property protection"); Robert Weissman, "AIDS
12277 and Developing Countries: Democratizing Access to Essential
12278 Medicines," <citetitle>Foreign Policy in Focus</citetitle> 4:23 (August 1999), available at
12279 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #58</ulink>
12280 (describing U.S. policy); John A. Harrelson, "TRIPS, Pharmaceutical
12281 Patents, and the HIV/AIDS Crisis: Finding the Proper Balance Between
12282 Intellectual Property Rights and Compassion, a Synopsis," <citetitle>Widener Law
12283 Symposium Journal</citetitle> (Spring 2001): 175.
12284 <!-- PAGE BREAK 333 -->
12285 </para></footnote>
12286 It was because "intellectual property" would be violated that these
12287 drugs should not flow into Africa. It was a principle about the
12288 importance of "intellectual property" that led these government actors
12289 to intervene against the South African response to AIDS.
12290 </para>
12291 <para>
12292 Now just step back for a moment. There will be a time thirty years
12293 from now when our children look back at us and ask, how could we have
12294 let this happen? How could we allow a policy to be pursued whose
12295 direct cost would be to speed the death of 15 to 30 million Africans,
12296 and whose only real benefit would be to uphold the "sanctity" of an
12297 idea? What possible justification could there ever be for a policy
12298 that results in so many deaths? What exactly is the insanity that
12299 would allow so many to die for such an abstraction?
12300 </para>
12301 <para>
12302 Some blame the drug companies. I don't. They are corporations.
12303 Their managers are ordered by law to make money for the corporation.
12304 They push a certain patent policy not because of ideals, but because it is
12305 the policy that makes them the most money. And it only makes them the
12306 most money because of a certain corruption within our political system&mdash;
12307 a corruption the drug companies are certainly not responsible for.
12308 </para>
12309 <para>
12310 The corruption is our own politicians' failure of integrity. For the
12311 drug companies would love&mdash;they say, and I believe them&mdash;to
12312 sell their drugs as cheaply as they can to countries in Africa and
12313 elsewhere. There are issues they'd have to resolve to make sure the
12314 drugs didn't get back into the United States, but those are mere
12315 problems of technology. They could be overcome.
12316 </para>
12317 <para>
12318 A different problem, however, could not be overcome. This is the
12319 fear of the grandstanding politician who would call the presidents of
12320 the drug companies before a Senate or House hearing, and ask, "How
12321 is it you can sell this HIV drug in Africa for only $1 a pill, but the same
12322 drug would cost an American $1,500?" Because there is no "sound
12323 bite" answer to that question, its effect would be to induce regulation
12324 of prices in America. The drug companies thus avoid this spiral by
12325 avoiding the first step. They reinforce the idea that property should be
12326 <!-- PAGE BREAK 268 -->
12327 sacred. They adopt a rational strategy in an irrational context, with the
12328 unintended consequence that perhaps millions die. And that rational
12329 strategy thus becomes framed in terms of this ideal&mdash;the sanctity of an
12330 idea called "intellectual property."
12331 </para>
12332 <para>
12333 So when the common sense of your child confronts you, what will
12334 you say? When the common sense of a generation finally revolts
12335 against what we have done, how will we justify what we have done?
12336 What is the argument?
12337 </para>
12338 <para>
12339 A sensible patent policy could endorse and strongly support the patent
12340 system without having to reach everyone everywhere in exactly the same
12341 way. Just as a sensible copyright policy could endorse and strongly
12342 support a copyright system without having to regulate the spread of
12343 culture perfectly and forever, a sensible patent policy could endorse
12344 and strongly support a patent system without having to block the
12345 spread of drugs to a country not rich enough to afford market prices
12346 in any case. A sensible policy, in other words, could be a balanced
12347 policy. For most of our history, both copyright and patent policies
12348 were balanced in just this sense.
12349 </para>
12350 <para>
12351 But we as a culture have lost this sense of balance. We have lost the
12352 critical eye that helps us see the difference between truth and
12353 extremism. A certain property fundamentalism, having no connection to
12354 our tradition, now reigns in this culture&mdash;bizarrely, and with
12355 consequences more grave to the spread of ideas and culture than almost
12356 any other single policy decision that we as a democracy will make. A
12357 simple idea blinds us, and under the cover of darkness, much happens
12358 that most of us would reject if any of us looked. So uncritically do
12359 we accept the idea of property in ideas that we don't even notice how
12360 monstrous it is to deny ideas to a people who are dying without
12361 them. So uncritically do we accept the idea of property in culture
12362 that we don't even question when the control of that property removes
12363 our
12364 <!-- PAGE BREAK 269 -->
12365 ability, as a people, to develop our culture democratically. Blindness
12366 becomes our common sense. And the challenge for anyone who would
12367 reclaim the right to cultivate our culture is to find a way to make
12368 this common sense open its eyes.
12369 </para>
12370 <para>
12371 So far, common sense sleeps. There is no revolt. Common sense
12372 does not yet see what there could be to revolt about. The extremism
12373 that now dominates this debate fits with ideas that seem natural, and
12374 that fit is reinforced by the RCAs of our day. They wage a frantic war
12375 to fight "piracy," and devastate a culture for creativity. They defend
12376 the idea of "creative property," while transforming real creators into
12377 modern-day sharecroppers. They are insulted by the idea that rights
12378 should be balanced, even though each of the major players in this
12379 content war was itself a beneficiary of a more balanced ideal. The
12380 hypocrisy reeks. Yet in a city like Washington, hypocrisy is not even
12381 noticed. Powerful lobbies, complex issues, and MTV attention spans
12382 produce the "perfect storm" for free culture.
12383 </para>
12384 <para>
12385 In August 2003, a fight broke out in the United States about a
12386 decision by the World Intellectual Property Organization to cancel a
12387 meeting.<footnote><para>
12388 <!-- f6. --> Jonathan Krim, "The Quiet War over Open-Source," <citetitle>Washington Post</citetitle>,
12389 August 2003, E1, available at
12390 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #59</ulink>; William New, "Global Group's
12391 Shift on `Open Source' Meeting Spurs Stir," <citetitle>National Journal's Technology
12392 Daily</citetitle>, 19 August 2003, available at
12393 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #60</ulink>; William New, "U.S. Official
12394 Opposes `Open Source' Talks at WIPO," <citetitle>National Journal's Technology
12395 Daily</citetitle>, 19 August 2003, available at
12396 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #61</ulink>.
12397 </para></footnote>
12398 At the request of a wide range of interests, WIPO had decided to hold
12399 a meeting to discuss "open and collaborative projects to create public
12400 goods." These are projects that have been successful in producing
12401 public goods without relying exclusively upon a proprietary use of
12402 intellectual property. Examples include the Internet and the World
12403 Wide Web, both of which were developed on the basis of protocols in
12404 the public domain. It included an emerging trend to support open
12405 academic journals, including the Public Library of Science project
12406 that I describe in the Afterword. It included a project to develop
12407 single nucleotide polymorphisms (SNPs), which are thought to have
12408 great significance in biomedical research. (That nonprofit project
12409 comprised a consortium of the Wellcome Trust and pharmaceutical and
12410 technological companies, including Amersham Biosciences, AstraZeneca,
12411 <!-- PAGE BREAK 270 -->
12412 Aventis, Bayer, Bristol-Myers Squibb, Hoffmann-La Roche,
12413 Glaxo-SmithKline, IBM, Motorola, Novartis, Pfizer, and Searle.) It
12414 included the Global Positioning System, which Ronald Reagan set free
12415 in the early 1980s. And it included "open source and free software."
12416 <indexterm><primary>PLoS (Public Library of Science)</primary></indexterm>
12417 </para>
12418 <para>
12419 The aim of the meeting was to consider this wide range of projects
12420 from one common perspective: that none of these projects relied upon
12421 intellectual property extremism. Instead, in all of them, intellectual
12422 property was balanced by agreements to keep access open or to impose
12423 limitations on the way in which proprietary claims might be used.
12424 </para>
12425 <para>
12426 From the perspective of this book, then, the conference was ideal.<footnote><para>
12427 <!-- f7. --> I should disclose that I was one of the people who asked WIPO for the
12428 meeting.
12429 </para></footnote>
12430 The projects within its scope included both commercial and
12431 noncommercial work. They primarily involved science, but from many
12432 perspectives. And WIPO was an ideal venue for this discussion, since
12433 WIPO is the preeminent international body dealing with intellectual
12434 property issues.
12435 </para>
12436 <para>
12437 Indeed, I was once publicly scolded for not recognizing this fact
12438 about WIPO. In February 2003, I delivered a keynote address to a
12439 preparatory conference for the World Summit on the Information Society
12440 (WSIS). At a press conference before the address, I was asked what I
12441 would say. I responded that I would be talking a little about the
12442 importance of balance in intellectual property for the development of
12443 an information society. The moderator for the event then promptly
12444 interrupted to inform me and the assembled reporters that no question
12445 about intellectual property would be discussed by WSIS, since those
12446 questions were the exclusive domain of WIPO. In the talk that I had
12447 prepared, I had actually made the issue of intellectual property
12448 relatively minor. But after this astonishing statement, I made
12449 intellectual property the sole focus of my talk. There was no way to
12450 talk about an "Information Society" unless one also talked about the
12451 range of information and culture that would be free. My talk did not
12452 make my immoderate moderator very happy. And she was no doubt correct
12453 that the scope of intellectual property protections was ordinarily the
12454 stuff of
12455 <!-- PAGE BREAK 271 -->
12456 WIPO. But in my view, there couldn't be too much of a conversation
12457 about how much intellectual property is needed, since in my view, the
12458 very idea of balance in intellectual property had been lost.
12459 </para>
12460 <para>
12461 So whether or not WSIS can discuss balance in intellectual property, I
12462 had thought it was taken for granted that WIPO could and should. And
12463 thus the meeting about "open and collaborative projects to create
12464 public goods" seemed perfectly appropriate within the WIPO agenda.
12465 </para>
12466 <para>
12467 But there is one project within that list that is highly
12468 controversial, at least among lobbyists. That project is "open source
12469 and free software." Microsoft in particular is wary of discussion of
12470 the subject. From its perspective, a conference to discuss open source
12471 and free software would be like a conference to discuss Apple's
12472 operating system. Both open source and free software compete with
12473 Microsoft's software. And internationally, many governments have begun
12474 to explore requirements that they use open source or free software,
12475 rather than "proprietary software," for their own internal uses.
12476 </para>
12477 <para>
12478 I don't mean to enter that debate here. It is important only to
12479 make clear that the distinction is not between commercial and
12480 noncommercial software. There are many important companies that depend
12481 fundamentally upon open source and free software, IBM being the most
12482 prominent. IBM is increasingly shifting its focus to the GNU/Linux
12483 operating system, the most famous bit of "free software"&mdash;and IBM
12484 is emphatically a commercial entity. Thus, to support "open source and
12485 free software" is not to oppose commercial entities. It is, instead,
12486 to support a mode of software development that is different from
12487 Microsoft's.<footnote><para>
12488 <!-- f8. -->
12489 Microsoft's position about free and open source software is more
12490 sophisticated. As it has repeatedly asserted, it has no problem with
12491 "open source" software or software in the public domain. Microsoft's
12492 principal opposition is to "free software" licensed under a "copyleft"
12493 license, meaning a license that requires the licensee to adopt the
12494 same terms on any derivative work. See Bradford L. Smith, "The Future
12495 of Software: Enabling the Marketplace to Decide," <citetitle>Government Policy
12496 Toward Open Source Software</citetitle> (Washington, D.C.: AEI-Brookings Joint
12497 Center for Regulatory Studies, American Enterprise Institute for
12498 Public Policy Research, 2002), 69, available at
12499 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #62</ulink>. See also
12500 Craig Mundie, Microsoft senior vice president, <citetitle>The Commercial Software
12501 Model</citetitle>, discussion at New York University Stern School of Business (3
12502 May 2001), available at
12503 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #63</ulink>.
12504 </para></footnote>
12505 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system</primary></indexterm>
12506 </para>
12507 <para>
12508 More important for our purposes, to support "open source and free
12509 software" is not to oppose copyright. "Open source and free software"
12510 is not software in the public domain. Instead, like Microsoft's
12511 software, the copyright owners of free and open source software insist
12512 quite strongly that the terms of their software license be respected
12513 by
12514 <!-- PAGE BREAK 272 -->
12515 adopters of free and open source software. The terms of that license
12516 are no doubt different from the terms of a proprietary software
12517 license. Free software licensed under the General Public License
12518 (GPL), for example, requires that the source code for the software be
12519 made available by anyone who modifies and redistributes the
12520 software. But that requirement is effective only if copyright governs
12521 software. If copyright did not govern software, then free software
12522 could not impose the same kind of requirements on its adopters. It
12523 thus depends upon copyright law just as Microsoft does.
12524 </para>
12525 <para>
12526 It is therefore understandable that as a proprietary software
12527 developer, Microsoft would oppose this WIPO meeting, and
12528 understandable that it would use its lobbyists to get the United
12529 States government to oppose it, as well. And indeed, that is just what
12530 was reported to have happened. According to Jonathan Krim of the
12531 <citetitle>Washington Post</citetitle>, Microsoft's lobbyists succeeded in getting the United
12532 States government to veto the meeting.<footnote><para>
12533 <!-- f9. -->
12534 Krim, "The Quiet War over Open-Source," available at <ulink
12535 url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #64</ulink>.
12536 </para></footnote>
12537 And without U.S. backing, the meeting was canceled.
12538 </para>
12539 <para>
12540 I don't blame Microsoft for doing what it can to advance its own
12541 interests, consistent with the law. And lobbying governments is
12542 plainly consistent with the law. There was nothing surprising about
12543 its lobbying here, and nothing terribly surprising about the most
12544 powerful software producer in the United States having succeeded in
12545 its lobbying efforts.
12546 </para>
12547 <para>
12548 What was surprising was the United States government's reason for
12549 opposing the meeting. Again, as reported by Krim, Lois Boland, acting
12550 director of international relations for the U.S. Patent and Trademark
12551 Office, explained that "open-source software runs counter to the
12552 mission of WIPO, which is to promote intellectual-property rights."
12553 She is quoted as saying, "To hold a meeting which has as its purpose
12554 to disclaim or waive such rights seems to us to be contrary to the
12555 goals of WIPO."
12556 </para>
12557 <para>
12558 These statements are astonishing on a number of levels.
12559 </para>
12560 <!-- PAGE BREAK 273 -->
12561 <para>
12562 First, they are just flat wrong. As I described, most open source and
12563 free software relies fundamentally upon the intellectual property
12564 right called "copyright". Without it, restrictions imposed by those
12565 licenses wouldn't work. Thus, to say it "runs counter" to the mission
12566 of promoting intellectual property rights reveals an extraordinary gap
12567 in understanding&mdash;the sort of mistake that is excusable in a
12568 first-year law student, but an embarrassment from a high government
12569 official dealing with intellectual property issues.
12570 </para>
12571 <para>
12572 Second, who ever said that WIPO's exclusive aim was to "promote"
12573 intellectual property maximally? As I had been scolded at the
12574 preparatory conference of WSIS, WIPO is to consider not only how best
12575 to protect intellectual property, but also what the best balance of
12576 intellectual property is. As every economist and lawyer knows, the
12577 hard question in intellectual property law is to find that
12578 balance. But that there should be limits is, I had thought,
12579 uncontested. One wants to ask Ms. Boland, are generic drugs (drugs
12580 based on drugs whose patent has expired) contrary to the WIPO mission?
12581 Does the public domain weaken intellectual property? Would it have
12582 been better if the protocols of the Internet had been patented?
12583 </para>
12584 <para>
12585 Third, even if one believed that the purpose of WIPO was to maximize
12586 intellectual property rights, in our tradition, intellectual property
12587 rights are held by individuals and corporations. They get to decide
12588 what to do with those rights because, again, they are
12589 <emphasis>their</emphasis> rights. If they want to "waive" or
12590 "disclaim" their rights, that is, within our tradition, totally
12591 appropriate. When Bill Gates gives away more than $20 billion to do
12592 good in the world, that is not inconsistent with the objectives of the
12593 property system. That is, on the contrary, just what a property system
12594 is supposed to be about: giving individuals the right to decide what
12595 to do with <emphasis>their</emphasis> property.
12596 <indexterm><primary>Gates, Bill</primary></indexterm>
12597 </para>
12598 <para>
12599 When Ms. Boland says that there is something wrong with a meeting
12600 "which has as its purpose to disclaim or waive such rights," she's
12601 saying that WIPO has an interest in interfering with the choices of
12602 <!-- PAGE BREAK 274 -->
12603 the individuals who own intellectual property rights. That somehow,
12604 WIPO's objective should be to stop an individual from "waiving" or
12605 "disclaiming" an intellectual property right. That the interest of
12606 WIPO is not just that intellectual property rights be maximized, but
12607 that they also should be exercised in the most extreme and restrictive
12608 way possible.
12609 </para>
12610 <para>
12611 There is a history of just such a property system that is well known
12612 in the Anglo-American tradition. It is called "feudalism." Under
12613 feudalism, not only was property held by a relatively small number of
12614 individuals and entities. And not only were the rights that ran with
12615 that property powerful and extensive. But the feudal system had a
12616 strong interest in assuring that property holders within that system
12617 not weaken feudalism by liberating people or property within their
12618 control to the free market. Feudalism depended upon maximum control
12619 and concentration. It fought any freedom that might interfere with
12620 that control.
12621 </para>
12622 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter</primary></indexterm>
12623 <indexterm><primary>Braithwaite, John</primary></indexterm>
12624 <para>
12625 As Peter Drahos and John Braithwaite relate, this is precisely the
12626 choice we are now making about intellectual property.<footnote><para>
12627 <!-- f10. -->
12628 See Drahos with Braithwaite, <citetitle>Information Feudalism</citetitle>, 210&ndash;20.
12629 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter</primary></indexterm>
12630 </para></footnote>
12631 We will have an information society. That much is certain. Our only
12632 choice now is whether that information society will be
12633 <emphasis>free</emphasis> or <emphasis>feudal</emphasis>. The trend is
12634 toward the feudal.
12635 </para>
12636 <para>
12637 When this battle broke, I blogged it. A spirited debate within the
12638 comment section ensued. Ms. Boland had a number of supporters who
12639 tried to show why her comments made sense. But there was one comment
12640 that was particularly depressing for me. An anonymous poster wrote,
12641 </para>
12642 <blockquote>
12643 <para>
12644 George, you misunderstand Lessig: He's only talking about the world as
12645 it should be ("the goal of WIPO, and the goal of any government,
12646 should be to promote the right balance of intellectual property rights,
12647 not simply to promote intellectual property rights"), not as it is. If
12648 we were talking about the world as it is, then of course Boland didn't
12649 say anything wrong. But in the world
12650 <!-- PAGE BREAK 275 -->
12651 as Lessig would have it, then of course she did. Always pay attention
12652 to the distinction between Lessig's world and ours.
12653 </para>
12654 </blockquote>
12655 <para>
12656 I missed the irony the first time I read it. I read it quickly and
12657 thought the poster was supporting the idea that seeking balance was
12658 what our government should be doing. (Of course, my criticism of Ms.
12659 Boland was not about whether she was seeking balance or not; my
12660 criticism was that her comments betrayed a first-year law student's
12661 mistake. I have no illusion about the extremism of our government,
12662 whether Republican or Democrat. My only illusion apparently is about
12663 whether our government should speak the truth or not.)
12664 </para>
12665 <para>
12666 Obviously, however, the poster was not supporting that idea. Instead,
12667 the poster was ridiculing the very idea that in the real world, the
12668 "goal" of a government should be "to promote the right balance" of
12669 intellectual property. That was obviously silly to him. And it
12670 obviously betrayed, he believed, my own silly utopianism. "Typical for
12671 an academic," the poster might well have continued.
12672 </para>
12673 <para>
12674 I understand criticism of academic utopianism. I think utopianism is
12675 silly, too, and I'd be the first to poke fun at the absurdly
12676 unrealistic ideals of academics throughout history (and not just in
12677 our own country's history).
12678 </para>
12679 <para>
12680 But when it has become silly to suppose that the role of our
12681 government should be to "seek balance," then count me with the silly,
12682 for that means that this has become quite serious indeed. If it should
12683 be obvious to everyone that the government does not seek balance, that
12684 the government is simply the tool of the most powerful lobbyists, that
12685 the idea of holding the government to a different standard is absurd,
12686 that the idea of demanding of the government that it speak truth and
12687 not lies is just na&iuml;ve, then who have we, the most powerful
12688 democracy in the world, become?
12689 </para>
12690 <para>
12691 It might be crazy to expect a high government official to speak
12692 the truth. It might be crazy to believe that government policy will be
12693 something more than the handmaiden of the most powerful interests.
12694 <!-- PAGE BREAK 276 -->
12695 It might be crazy to argue that we should preserve a tradition that has
12696 been part of our tradition for most of our history&mdash;free culture.
12697 </para>
12698 <indexterm><primary>CodePink Women in Peace</primary></indexterm>
12699 <para>
12700 If this is crazy, then let there be more crazies. Soon. There are
12701 moments of hope in this struggle. And moments that surprise. When the
12702 FCC was considering relaxing ownership rules, which would thereby
12703 further increase the concentration in media ownership, an
12704 extraordinary bipartisan coalition formed to fight this change. For
12705 perhaps the first time in history, interests as diverse as the NRA,
12706 the ACLU, Moveon.org, William Safire, Ted Turner, and CodePink Women
12707 for Peace organized to oppose this change in FCC policy. An
12708 astonishing 700,000 letters were sent to the FCC, demanding more
12709 hearings and a different result.
12710 <indexterm><primary>Turner, Ted</primary></indexterm>
12711 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William</primary></indexterm>
12712 </para>
12713 <para>
12714 This activism did not stop the FCC, but soon after, a broad coalition
12715 in the Senate voted to reverse the FCC decision. The hostile hearings
12716 leading up to that vote revealed just how powerful this movement had
12717 become. There was no substantial support for the FCC's decision, and
12718 there was broad and sustained support for fighting further
12719 concentration in the media.
12720 </para>
12721 <para>
12722 But even this movement misses an important piece of the puzzle.
12723 Largeness as such is not bad. Freedom is not threatened just because
12724 some become very rich, or because there are only a handful of big
12725 players. The poor quality of Big Macs or Quarter Pounders does not
12726 mean that you can't get a good hamburger from somewhere else.
12727 </para>
12728 <para>
12729 The danger in media concentration comes not from the concentration,
12730 but instead from the feudalism that this concentration, tied to the
12731 change in copyright, produces. It is not just that there are a few
12732 powerful companies that control an ever expanding slice of the
12733 media. It is that this concentration can call upon an equally bloated
12734 range of rights&mdash;property rights of a historically extreme
12735 form&mdash;that makes their bigness bad.
12736 </para>
12737 <!-- PAGE BREAK 277 -->
12738 <para>
12739 It is therefore significant that so many would rally to demand
12740 competition and increased diversity. Still, if the rally is understood
12741 as being about bigness alone, it is not terribly surprising. We
12742 Americans have a long history of fighting "big," wisely or not. That
12743 we could be motivated to fight "big" again is not something new.
12744 </para>
12745 <para>
12746 It would be something new, and something very important, if an equal
12747 number could be rallied to fight the increasing extremism built within
12748 the idea of "intellectual property." Not because balance is alien to
12749 our tradition; indeed, as I've argued, balance is our tradition. But
12750 because the muscle to think critically about the scope of anything
12751 called "property" is not well exercised within this tradition anymore.
12752 </para>
12753 <para>
12754 If we were Achilles, this would be our heel. This would be the place
12755 of our tragedy.
12756 </para>
12757 <indexterm><primary>Dylan, Bob</primary></indexterm>
12758 <para>
12759 As I write these final words, the news is filled with stories about
12760 the RIAA lawsuits against almost three hundred individuals.<footnote><para>
12761 <!-- f11. -->
12762 John Borland, "RIAA Sues 261 File Swappers," CNET News.com, September
12763 2003, available at
12764 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #65</ulink>; Paul
12765 R. La Monica, "Music Industry Sues Swappers," CNN/Money, 8 September
12766 2003, available at
12767 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #66</ulink>; Soni
12768 Sangha and Phyllis Furman with Robert Gearty, "Sued for a Song,
12769 N.Y.C. 12-Yr-Old Among 261 Cited as Sharers," <citetitle>New York Daily News</citetitle>, 9
12770 September 2003, 3; Frank Ahrens, "RIAA's Lawsuits Meet Surprised
12771 Targets; Single Mother in Calif., 12-Year-Old Girl in N.Y. Among
12772 Defendants," <citetitle>Washington Post</citetitle>, 10 September 2003, E1; Katie Dean,
12773 "Schoolgirl Settles with RIAA," <citetitle>Wired News</citetitle>, 10 September 2003,
12774 available at
12775 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #67</ulink>.
12776 </para></footnote>
12777 Eminem has just been sued for "sampling" someone else's
12778 music.<footnote><para>
12779 <!-- f12. -->
12780 Jon Wiederhorn, "Eminem Gets Sued . . . by a Little Old Lady,"
12781 mtv.com, 17 September 2003, available at
12782 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #68</ulink>.
12783 </para></footnote>
12784 The story about Bob Dylan "stealing" from a Japanese author has just
12785 finished making the rounds.<footnote><para>
12786 <!-- f13. -->
12787 Kenji Hall, Associated Press, "Japanese Book May Be Inspiration for
12788 Dylan Songs," Kansascity.com, 9 July 2003, available at
12789 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #69</ulink>.
12790 <!-- PAGE BREAK 334 -->
12791 </para></footnote>
12792 An insider from Hollywood&mdash;who insists he must remain
12793 anonymous&mdash;reports "an amazing conversation with these studio
12794 guys. They've got extraordinary [old] content that they'd love to use
12795 but can't because they can't begin to clear the rights. They've got
12796 scores of kids who could do amazing things with the content, but it
12797 would take scores of lawyers to clean it first." Congressmen are
12798 talking about deputizing computer viruses to bring down computers
12799 thought to violate the law. Universities are threatening expulsion for
12800 kids who use a computer to share content.
12801 </para>
12802 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee</primary></indexterm>
12803 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie</primary></indexterm>
12804 <indexterm><primary>Creative Commons</primary></indexterm>
12805 <indexterm><primary>Gil, Gilberto</primary></indexterm>
12806 <para>
12807 Yet on the other side of the Atlantic, the BBC has just announced
12808 that it will build a "Creative Archive," from which British citizens can
12809 download BBC content, and rip, mix, and burn it.<footnote><para>
12810 <!-- f14. --> "BBC Plans to Open Up Its Archive to the Public," BBC press release,
12811 24 August 2003, available at
12812 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #70</ulink>.
12813 </para></footnote>
12814 And in Brazil, the culture minister, Gilberto Gil, himself a folk hero
12815 of Brazilian music, has joined with Creative Commons to release
12816 content and free licenses in that Latin American
12817 country.<footnote><para>
12818 <!-- f15. -->
12819 "Creative Commons and Brazil," Creative Commons Weblog, 6 August 2003,
12820 available at
12821 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #71</ulink>.
12822 </para></footnote>
12823 <!-- PAGE BREAK 278 -->
12824 I've told a dark story. The truth is more mixed. A technology has
12825 given us a new freedom. Slowly, some begin to understand that this
12826 freedom need not mean anarchy. We can carry a free culture into the
12827 twenty-first century, without artists losing and without the potential of
12828 digital technology being destroyed. It will take some thought, and
12829 more importantly, it will take some will to transform the RCAs of our
12830 day into the Causbys.
12831 </para>
12832 <para>
12833 Common sense must revolt. It must act to free culture. Soon, if this
12834 potential is ever to be realized.
12835
12836 <!-- PAGE BREAK 279 -->
12837
12838 </para>
12839 </partintro>
12840 <chapter><title></title><para></para></chapter>
12841 </part>
12842 <part id="c-afterword">
12843 <title>AFTERWORD</title>
12844 <partintro>
12845 <para>
12846
12847 <!-- PAGE BREAK 280 -->
12848 At least some who have read this far will agree with me that something
12849 must be done to change where we are heading. The balance of this book
12850 maps what might be done.
12851 </para>
12852 <para>
12853 I divide this map into two parts: that which anyone can do now,
12854 and that which requires the help of lawmakers. If there is one lesson
12855 that we can draw from the history of remaking common sense, it is that
12856 it requires remaking how many people think about the very same issue.
12857 </para>
12858 <para>
12859 That means this movement must begin in the streets. It must recruit a
12860 significant number of parents, teachers, librarians, creators,
12861 authors, musicians, filmmakers, scientists&mdash;all to tell this
12862 story in their own words, and to tell their neighbors why this battle
12863 is so important.
12864 </para>
12865 <para>
12866 Once this movement has its effect in the streets, it has some hope of
12867 having an effect in Washington. We are still a democracy. What people
12868 think matters. Not as much as it should, at least when an RCA stands
12869 opposed, but still, it matters. And thus, in the second part below, I
12870 sketch changes that Congress could make to better secure a free culture.
12871 </para>
12872 <!-- PAGE BREAK 281 -->
12873
12874 <section id="usnow">
12875 <title>US, NOW</title>
12876 <para>
12877 Common sense is with the copyright warriors because the debate so far
12878 has been framed at the extremes&mdash;as a grand either/or: either
12879 property or anarchy, either total control or artists won't be paid. If
12880 that really is the choice, then the warriors should win.
12881 </para>
12882 <para>
12883 The mistake here is the error of the excluded middle. There are
12884 extremes in this debate, but the extremes are not all that there
12885 is. There are those who believe in maximal copyright&mdash;"All Rights
12886 Reserved"&mdash; and those who reject copyright&mdash;"No Rights
12887 Reserved." The "All Rights Reserved" sorts believe that you should ask
12888 permission before you "use" a copyrighted work in any way. The "No
12889 Rights Reserved" sorts believe you should be able to do with content
12890 as you wish, regardless of whether you have permission or not.
12891 </para>
12892 <para>
12893 When the Internet was first born, its initial architecture effectively
12894 tilted in the "no rights reserved" direction. Content could be copied
12895 perfectly and cheaply; rights could not easily be controlled. Thus,
12896 regardless of anyone's desire, the effective regime of copyright under
12897 the
12898
12899 <!-- PAGE BREAK 282 -->
12900 original design of the Internet was "no rights reserved." Content was
12901 "taken" regardless of the rights. Any rights were effectively
12902 unprotected.
12903 </para>
12904 <para>
12905 This initial character produced a reaction (opposite, but not quite
12906 equal) by copyright owners. That reaction has been the topic of this
12907 book. Through legislation, litigation, and changes to the network's
12908 design, copyright holders have been able to change the essential
12909 character of the environment of the original Internet. If the original
12910 architecture made the effective default "no rights reserved," the
12911 future architecture will make the effective default "all rights
12912 reserved." The architecture and law that surround the Internet's
12913 design will increasingly produce an environment where all use of
12914 content requires permission. The "cut and paste" world that defines
12915 the Internet today will become a "get permission to cut and paste"
12916 world that is a creator's nightmare.
12917 </para>
12918 <para>
12919 What's needed is a way to say something in the middle&mdash;neither
12920 "all rights reserved" nor "no rights reserved" but "some rights
12921 reserved"&mdash; and thus a way to respect copyrights but enable
12922 creators to free content as they see fit. In other words, we need a
12923 way to restore a set of freedoms that we could just take for granted
12924 before.
12925 </para>
12926
12927 <section id="examples">
12928 <title>Rebuilding Freedoms Previously Presumed: Examples</title>
12929 <para>
12930 If you step back from the battle I've been describing here, you will
12931 recognize this problem from other contexts. Think about
12932 privacy. Before the Internet, most of us didn't have to worry much
12933 about data about our lives that we broadcast to the world. If you
12934 walked into a bookstore and browsed through some of the works of Karl
12935 Marx, you didn't need to worry about explaining your browsing habits
12936 to your neighbors or boss. The "privacy" of your browsing habits was
12937 assured.
12938 </para>
12939 <para>
12940 What made it assured?
12941 </para>
12942 <!-- PAGE BREAK 283 -->
12943 <para>
12944 Well, if we think in terms of the modalities I described in chapter
12945 10, your privacy was assured because of an inefficient architecture
12946 for gathering data and hence a market constraint (cost) on anyone who
12947 wanted to gather that data. If you were a suspected spy for North
12948 Korea, working for the CIA, no doubt your privacy would not be
12949 assured. But that's because the CIA would (we hope) find it valuable
12950 enough to spend the thousands required to track you. But for most of
12951 us (again, we can hope), spying doesn't pay. The highly inefficient
12952 architecture of real space means we all enjoy a fairly robust amount
12953 of privacy. That privacy is guaranteed to us by friction. Not by law
12954 (there is no law protecting "privacy" in public places), and in many
12955 places, not by norms (snooping and gossip are just fun), but instead,
12956 by the costs that friction imposes on anyone who would want to spy.
12957 </para>
12958 <indexterm><primary>Amazon</primary></indexterm>
12959 <para>
12960 Enter the Internet, where the cost of tracking browsing in particular
12961 has become quite tiny. If you're a customer at Amazon, then as you
12962 browse the pages, Amazon collects the data about what you've looked
12963 at. You know this because at the side of the page, there's a list of
12964 "recently viewed" pages. Now, because of the architecture of the Net
12965 and the function of cookies on the Net, it is easier to collect the
12966 data than not. The friction has disappeared, and hence any "privacy"
12967 protected by the friction disappears, too.
12968 </para>
12969 <para>
12970 Amazon, of course, is not the problem. But we might begin to worry
12971 about libraries. If you're one of those crazy lefties who thinks that
12972 people should have the "right" to browse in a library without the
12973 government knowing which books you look at (I'm one of those lefties,
12974 too), then this change in the technology of monitoring might concern
12975 you. If it becomes simple to gather and sort who does what in
12976 electronic spaces, then the friction-induced privacy of yesterday
12977 disappears.
12978 </para>
12979 <para>
12980 It is this reality that explains the push of many to define "privacy"
12981 on the Internet. It is the recognition that technology can remove what
12982 friction before gave us that leads many to push for laws to do what
12983 friction did.<footnote><para>
12984 <!-- f1. -->
12985
12986 See, for example, Marc Rotenberg, "Fair Information Practices and the
12987 Architecture of Privacy (What Larry Doesn't Get)," <citetitle>Stanford Technology
12988 Law Review</citetitle> 1 (2001): par. 6&ndash;18, available at
12989
12990 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #72</ulink>
12991 (describing examples in which technology defines privacy policy). See
12992 also Jeffrey Rosen, <citetitle>The Naked Crowd: Reclaiming Security and Freedom
12993 in an Anxious Age</citetitle> (New York: Random House, 2004) (mapping tradeoffs
12994 between technology and privacy).</para></footnote>
12995 And whether you're in favor of those laws or not, it is the pattern
12996 that is important here. We must take affirmative steps to secure a
12997
12998 <!-- PAGE BREAK 284 -->
12999 kind of freedom that was passively provided before. A change in
13000 technology now forces those who believe in privacy to affirmatively
13001 act where, before, privacy was given by default.
13002 </para>
13003 <para>
13004 A similar story could be told about the birth of the free software
13005 movement. When computers with software were first made available
13006 commercially, the software&mdash;both the source code and the
13007 binaries&mdash; was free. You couldn't run a program written for a
13008 Data General machine on an IBM machine, so Data General and IBM didn't
13009 care much about controlling their software.
13010 </para>
13011 <indexterm><primary>Stallman, Richard</primary></indexterm>
13012 <para>
13013 That was the world Richard Stallman was born into, and while he was a
13014 researcher at MIT, he grew to love the community that developed when
13015 one was free to explore and tinker with the software that ran on
13016 machines. Being a smart sort himself, and a talented programmer,
13017 Stallman grew to depend upon the freedom to add to or modify other
13018 people's work.
13019 </para>
13020 <para>
13021 In an academic setting, at least, that's not a terribly radical
13022 idea. In a math department, anyone would be free to tinker with a
13023 proof that someone offered. If you thought you had a better way to
13024 prove a theorem, you could take what someone else did and change
13025 it. In a classics department, if you believed a colleague's
13026 translation of a recently discovered text was flawed, you were free to
13027 improve it. Thus, to Stallman, it seemed obvious that you should be
13028 free to tinker with and improve the code that ran a machine. This,
13029 too, was knowledge. Why shouldn't it be open for criticism like
13030 anything else?
13031 </para>
13032 <para>
13033 No one answered that question. Instead, the architecture of revenue
13034 for computing changed. As it became possible to import programs from
13035 one system to another, it became economically attractive (at least in
13036 the view of some) to hide the code of your program. So, too, as
13037 companies started selling peripherals for mainframe systems. If I
13038 could just take your printer driver and copy it, then that would make
13039 it easier for me to sell a printer to the market than it was for you.
13040 </para>
13041 <para>
13042 Thus, the practice of proprietary code began to spread, and by the
13043 early 1980s, Stallman found himself surrounded by proprietary code.
13044 <!-- PAGE BREAK 285 -->
13045 The world of free software had been erased by a change in the
13046 economics of computing. And as he believed, if he did nothing about
13047 it, then the freedom to change and share software would be
13048 fundamentally weakened.
13049 </para>
13050 <para>
13051 Therefore, in 1984, Stallman began a project to build a free operating
13052 system, so that at least a strain of free software would survive. That
13053 was the birth of the GNU project, into which Linus Torvalds's "Linux"
13054 kernel was added to produce the GNU/Linux operating system.
13055 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system</primary></indexterm>
13056 </para>
13057 <para>
13058 Stallman's technique was to use copyright law to build a world of
13059 software that must be kept free. Software licensed under the Free
13060 Software Foundation's GPL cannot be modified and distributed unless
13061 the source code for that software is made available as well. Thus,
13062 anyone building upon GPL'd software would have to make their buildings
13063 free as well. This would assure, Stallman believed, that an ecology of
13064 code would develop that remained free for others to build upon. His
13065 fundamental goal was freedom; innovative creative code was a
13066 byproduct.
13067 </para>
13068 <para>
13069 Stallman was thus doing for software what privacy advocates now
13070 do for privacy. He was seeking a way to rebuild a kind of freedom that
13071 was taken for granted before. Through the affirmative use of licenses
13072 that bind copyrighted code, Stallman was affirmatively reclaiming a
13073 space where free software would survive. He was actively protecting
13074 what before had been passively guaranteed.
13075 </para>
13076 <para>
13077 Finally, consider a very recent example that more directly resonates
13078 with the story of this book. This is the shift in the way academic and
13079 scientific journals are produced.
13080 </para>
13081 <para>
13082 As digital technologies develop, it is becoming obvious to many that
13083 printing thousands of copies of journals every month and sending them
13084 to libraries is perhaps not the most efficient way to distribute
13085 knowledge. Instead, journals are increasingly becoming electronic, and
13086 libraries and their users are given access to these electronic
13087 journals through password-protected sites. Something similar to this
13088 has been happening in law for almost thirty years: Lexis and Westlaw
13089 have had electronic versions of case reports available to subscribers
13090 to their service. Although a Supreme Court opinion is not
13091 copyrighted, and anyone is free to go to a library and read it, Lexis
13092 and Westlaw are also free
13093 <!-- PAGE BREAK 286 -->
13094 to charge users for the privilege of gaining access to that Supreme
13095 Court opinion through their respective services.
13096 </para>
13097 <para>
13098 There's nothing wrong in general with this, and indeed, the ability to
13099 charge for access to even public domain materials is a good incentive
13100 for people to develop new and innovative ways to spread knowledge.
13101 The law has agreed, which is why Lexis and Westlaw have been allowed
13102 to flourish. And if there's nothing wrong with selling the public
13103 domain, then there could be nothing wrong, in principle, with selling
13104 access to material that is not in the public domain.
13105 </para>
13106 <para>
13107 But what if the only way to get access to social and scientific data
13108 was through proprietary services? What if no one had the ability to
13109 browse this data except by paying for a subscription?
13110 </para>
13111 <para>
13112 As many are beginning to notice, this is increasingly the reality with
13113 scientific journals. When these journals were distributed in paper
13114 form, libraries could make the journals available to anyone who had
13115 access to the library. Thus, patients with cancer could become cancer
13116 experts because the library gave them access. Or patients trying to
13117 understand the risks of a certain treatment could research those risks
13118 by reading all available articles about that treatment. This freedom
13119 was therefore a function of the institution of libraries (norms) and
13120 the technology of paper journals (architecture)&mdash;namely, that it
13121 was very hard to control access to a paper journal.
13122 </para>
13123 <para>
13124 As journals become electronic, however, the publishers are demanding
13125 that libraries not give the general public access to the
13126 journals. This means that the freedoms provided by print journals in
13127 public libraries begin to disappear. Thus, as with privacy and with
13128 software, a changing technology and market shrink a freedom taken for
13129 granted before.
13130 </para>
13131 <para>
13132 This shrinking freedom has led many to take affirmative steps to
13133 restore the freedom that has been lost. The Public Library of Science
13134 (PLoS), for example, is a nonprofit corporation dedicated to making
13135 scientific research available to anyone with a Web connection. Authors
13136 <!-- PAGE BREAK 287 -->
13137 of scientific work submit that work to the Public Library of Science.
13138 That work is then subject to peer review. If accepted, the work is
13139 then deposited in a public, electronic archive and made permanently
13140 available for free. PLoS also sells a print version of its work, but
13141 the copyright for the print journal does not inhibit the right of
13142 anyone to redistribute the work for free.
13143 <indexterm><primary>PLoS (Public Library of Science)</primary></indexterm>
13144 </para>
13145 <para>
13146 This is one of many such efforts to restore a freedom taken for
13147 granted before, but now threatened by changing technology and markets.
13148 There's no doubt that this alternative competes with the traditional
13149 publishers and their efforts to make money from the exclusive
13150 distribution of content. But competition in our tradition is
13151 presumptively a good&mdash;especially when it helps spread knowledge
13152 and science.
13153 </para>
13154
13155 </section>
13156 <section id="oneidea">
13157 <title>Rebuilding Free Culture: One Idea</title>
13158 <indexterm id="idxcc" class='startofrange'>
13159 <primary>Creative Commons</primary>
13160 </indexterm>
13161 <para>
13162 The same strategy could be applied to culture, as a response to the
13163 increasing control effected through law and technology.
13164 </para>
13165 <para>
13166 Enter the Creative Commons. The Creative Commons is a nonprofit
13167 corporation established in Massachusetts, but with its home at
13168 Stanford University. Its aim is to build a layer of
13169 <emphasis>reasonable</emphasis> copyright on top of the extremes that
13170 now reign. It does this by making it easy for people to build upon
13171 other people's work, by making it simple for creators to express the
13172 freedom for others to take and build upon their work. Simple tags,
13173 tied to human-readable descriptions, tied to bulletproof licenses,
13174 make this possible.
13175 </para>
13176 <para>
13177 <emphasis>Simple</emphasis>&mdash;which means without a middleman, or
13178 without a lawyer. By developing a free set of licenses that people
13179 can attach to their content, Creative Commons aims to mark a range of
13180 content that can easily, and reliably, be built upon. These tags are
13181 then linked to machine-readable versions of the license that enable
13182 computers automatically to identify content that can easily be
13183 shared. These three expressions together&mdash;a legal license, a
13184 human-readable description, and
13185 <!-- PAGE BREAK 288 -->
13186 machine-readable tags&mdash;constitute a Creative Commons license. A
13187 Creative Commons license constitutes a grant of freedom to anyone who
13188 accesses the license, and more importantly, an expression of the ideal
13189 that the person associated with the license believes in something
13190 different than the "All" or "No" extremes. Content is marked with the
13191 CC mark, which does not mean that copyright is waived, but that
13192 certain freedoms are given.
13193 </para>
13194 <para>
13195 These freedoms are beyond the freedoms promised by fair use. Their
13196 precise contours depend upon the choices the creator makes. The
13197 creator can choose a license that permits any use, so long as
13198 attribution is given. She can choose a license that permits only
13199 noncommercial use. She can choose a license that permits any use so
13200 long as the same freedoms are given to other uses ("share and share
13201 alike"). Or any use so long as no derivative use is made. Or any use
13202 at all within developing nations. Or any sampling use, so long as full
13203 copies are not made. Or lastly, any educational use.
13204 </para>
13205 <para>
13206 These choices thus establish a range of freedoms beyond the default of
13207 copyright law. They also enable freedoms that go beyond traditional
13208 fair use. And most importantly, they express these freedoms in a way
13209 that subsequent users can use and rely upon without the need to hire a
13210 lawyer. Creative Commons thus aims to build a layer of content,
13211 governed by a layer of reasonable copyright law, that others can build
13212 upon. Voluntary choice of individuals and creators will make this
13213 content available. And that content will in turn enable us to rebuild
13214 a public domain.
13215 </para>
13216 <para>
13217 This is just one project among many within the Creative Commons. And
13218 of course, Creative Commons is not the only organization pursuing such
13219 freedoms. But the point that distinguishes the Creative Commons from
13220 many is that we are not interested only in talking about a public
13221 domain or in getting legislators to help build a public domain. Our
13222 aim is to build a movement of consumers and producers
13223 <!-- PAGE BREAK 289 -->
13224 of content ("content conducers," as attorney Mia Garlick calls them)
13225 who help build the public domain and, by their work, demonstrate the
13226 importance of the public domain to other creativity.
13227 <indexterm><primary>Garlick, Mia</primary></indexterm>
13228 </para>
13229 <para>
13230 The aim is not to fight the "All Rights Reserved" sorts. The aim is to
13231 complement them. The problems that the law creates for us as a culture
13232 are produced by insane and unintended consequences of laws written
13233 centuries ago, applied to a technology that only Jefferson could have
13234 imagined. The rules may well have made sense against a background of
13235 technologies from centuries ago, but they do not make sense against
13236 the background of digital technologies. New rules&mdash;with different
13237 freedoms, expressed in ways so that humans without lawyers can use
13238 them&mdash;are needed. Creative Commons gives people a way effectively
13239 to begin to build those rules.
13240 </para>
13241 <para>
13242 Why would creators participate in giving up total control? Some
13243 participate to better spread their content. Cory Doctorow, for
13244 example, is a science fiction author. His first novel, <citetitle>Down and Out in
13245 the Magic Kingdom</citetitle>, was released on-line and for free, under a Creative
13246 Commons license, on the same day that it went on sale in bookstores.
13247 </para>
13248 <para>
13249 Why would a publisher ever agree to this? I suspect his publisher
13250 reasoned like this: There are two groups of people out there: (1)
13251 those who will buy Cory's book whether or not it's on the Internet,
13252 and (2) those who may never hear of Cory's book, if it isn't made
13253 available for free on the Internet. Some part of (1) will download
13254 Cory's book instead of buying it. Call them bad-(1)s. Some part of (2)
13255 will download Cory's book, like it, and then decide to buy it. Call
13256 them (2)-goods. If there are more (2)-goods than bad-(1)s, the
13257 strategy of releasing Cory's book free on-line will probably
13258 <emphasis>increase</emphasis> sales of Cory's book.
13259 </para>
13260 <para>
13261 Indeed, the experience of his publisher clearly supports that
13262 conclusion. The book's first printing was exhausted months before the
13263 publisher had expected. This first novel of a science fiction author
13264 was a total success.
13265 </para>
13266 <para>
13267 The idea that free content might increase the value of nonfree content
13268 was confirmed by the experience of another author. Peter Wayner,
13269 <!-- PAGE BREAK 290 -->
13270 who wrote a book about the free software movement titled <citetitle>Free for All</citetitle>,
13271 made an electronic version of his book free on-line under a Creative
13272 Commons license after the book went out of print. He then monitored
13273 used book store prices for the book. As predicted, as the number of
13274 downloads increased, the used book price for his book increased, as
13275 well.
13276 </para>
13277 <para>
13278 These are examples of using the Commons to better spread proprietary
13279 content. I believe that is a wonderful and common use of the
13280 Commons. There are others who use Creative Commons licenses for other
13281 reasons. Many who use the "sampling license" do so because anything
13282 else would be hypocritical. The sampling license says that others are
13283 free, for commercial or noncommercial purposes, to sample content from
13284 the licensed work; they are just not free to make full copies of the
13285 licensed work available to others. This is consistent with their own
13286 art&mdash;they, too, sample from others. Because the
13287 <emphasis>legal</emphasis> costs of sampling are so high (Walter
13288 Leaphart, manager of the rap group Public Enemy, which was born
13289 sampling the music of others, has stated that he does not "allow"
13290 Public Enemy to sample anymore, because the legal costs are so
13291 high<footnote><para>
13292 <!-- f2. -->
13293
13294 <citetitle>Willful Infringement: A Report from the Front Lines of the Real
13295 Culture Wars</citetitle> (2003), produced by Jed Horovitz, directed by Greg
13296 Hittelman, a Fiat Lucre production, available at
13297 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #72</ulink>.
13298 </para></footnote>),
13299 these artists release into the creative environment content
13300 that others can build upon, so that their form of creativity might grow.
13301 </para>
13302 <para>
13303 Finally, there are many who mark their content with a Creative Commons
13304 license just because they want to express to others the importance of
13305 balance in this debate. If you just go along with the system as it is,
13306 you are effectively saying you believe in the "All Rights Reserved"
13307 model. Good for you, but many do not. Many believe that however
13308 appropriate that rule is for Hollywood and freaks, it is not an
13309 appropriate description of how most creators view the rights
13310 associated with their content. The Creative Commons license expresses
13311 this notion of "Some Rights Reserved," and gives many the chance to
13312 say it to others.
13313 </para>
13314 <para>
13315 In the first six months of the Creative Commons experiment, over
13316 1 million objects were licensed with these free-culture licenses. The next
13317 step is partnerships with middleware content providers to help them
13318 build into their technologies simple ways for users to mark their content
13319
13320 <!-- PAGE BREAK 291 -->
13321 with Creative Commons freedoms. Then the next step is to watch and
13322 celebrate creators who build content based upon content set free.
13323 </para>
13324 <para>
13325 These are first steps to rebuilding a public domain. They are not
13326 mere arguments; they are action. Building a public domain is the first
13327 step to showing people how important that domain is to creativity and
13328 innovation. Creative Commons relies upon voluntary steps to achieve
13329 this rebuilding. They will lead to a world in which more than voluntary
13330 steps are possible.
13331 </para>
13332 <para>
13333 Creative Commons is just one example of voluntary efforts by
13334 individuals and creators to change the mix of rights that now govern
13335 the creative field. The project does not compete with copyright; it
13336 complements it. Its aim is not to defeat the rights of authors, but to
13337 make it easier for authors and creators to exercise their rights more
13338 flexibly and cheaply. That difference, we believe, will enable
13339 creativity to spread more easily.
13340 </para>
13341 <indexterm startref="idxcc" class='endofrange'/>
13342
13343 <!-- PAGE BREAK 292 -->
13344 </section>
13345 </section>
13346 <section id="themsoon">
13347 <title>THEM, SOON</title>
13348 <para>
13349 We will not reclaim a free culture by individual action alone. It will
13350 also take important reforms of laws. We have a long way to go before
13351 the politicians will listen to these ideas and implement these reforms.
13352 But that also means that we have time to build awareness around the
13353 changes that we need.
13354 </para>
13355 <para>
13356 In this chapter, I outline five kinds of changes: four that are general,
13357 and one that's specific to the most heated battle of the day, music. Each
13358 is a step, not an end. But any of these steps would carry us a long way
13359 to our end.
13360 </para>
13361
13362 <section id="formalities">
13363 <title>1. More Formalities</title>
13364 <para>
13365 If you buy a house, you have to record the sale in a deed. If you buy land
13366 upon which to build a house, you have to record the purchase in a deed.
13367 If you buy a car, you get a bill of sale and register the car. If you buy an
13368 airplane ticket, it has your name on it.
13369 </para>
13370 <para>
13371 <!-- PAGE BREAK 293 -->
13372 These are all formalities associated with property. They are
13373 requirements that we all must bear if we want our property to be
13374 protected.
13375 </para>
13376 <para>
13377 In contrast, under current copyright law, you automatically get a
13378 copyright, regardless of whether you comply with any formality. You
13379 don't have to register. You don't even have to mark your content. The
13380 default is control, and "formalities" are banished.
13381 </para>
13382 <para>
13383 Why?
13384 </para>
13385 <para>
13386 As I suggested in chapter 10, the motivation to abolish formalities
13387 was a good one. In the world before digital technologies, formalities
13388 imposed a burden on copyright holders without much benefit. Thus, it
13389 was progress when the law relaxed the formal requirements that a
13390 copyright owner must bear to protect and secure his work. Those
13391 formalities were getting in the way.
13392 </para>
13393 <para>
13394 But the Internet changes all this. Formalities today need not be a
13395 burden. Rather, the world without formalities is the world that
13396 burdens creativity. Today, there is no simple way to know who owns
13397 what, or with whom one must deal in order to use or build upon the
13398 creative work of others. There are no records, there is no system to
13399 trace&mdash; there is no simple way to know how to get permission. Yet
13400 given the massive increase in the scope of copyright's rule, getting
13401 permission is a necessary step for any work that builds upon our
13402 past. And thus, the <emphasis>lack</emphasis> of formalities forces
13403 many into silence where they otherwise could speak.
13404 </para>
13405 <para>
13406 The law should therefore change this requirement<footnote><para>
13407 <!-- f1. -->
13408 The proposal I am advancing here would apply to American works only.
13409 Obviously, I believe it would be beneficial for the same idea to be
13410 adopted by other countries as well.</para></footnote>&mdash;but it
13411 should not change it by going back to the old, broken system. We
13412 should require formalities, but we should establish a system that will
13413 create the incentives to minimize the burden of these formalities.
13414 </para>
13415 <para>
13416 The important formalities are three: marking copyrighted work,
13417 registering copyrights, and renewing the claim to
13418 copyright. Traditionally, the first of these three was something the
13419 copyright owner did; the second two were something the government
13420 did. But a revised system of formalities would banish the government
13421 from the process, except for the sole purpose of approving standards
13422 developed by others.
13423 </para>
13424
13425 <!-- PAGE BREAK 294 -->
13426
13427 <section id="registration">
13428 <title>REGISTRATION AND RENEWAL</title>
13429 <para>
13430 Under the old system, a copyright owner had to file a registration
13431 with the Copyright Office to register or renew a copyright. When
13432 filing that registration, the copyright owner paid a fee. As with most
13433 government agencies, the Copyright Office had little incentive to
13434 minimize the burden of registration; it also had little incentive to
13435 minimize the fee. And as the Copyright Office is not a main target of
13436 government policymaking, the office has historically been terribly
13437 underfunded. Thus, when people who know something about the process
13438 hear this idea about formalities, their first reaction is
13439 panic&mdash;nothing could be worse than forcing people to deal with
13440 the mess that is the Copyright Office.
13441 </para>
13442 <para>
13443 Yet it is always astonishing to me that we, who come from a tradition
13444 of extraordinary innovation in governmental design, can no longer
13445 think innovatively about how governmental functions can be designed.
13446 Just because there is a public purpose to a government role, it
13447 doesn't follow that the government must actually administer the
13448 role. Instead, we should be creating incentives for private parties to
13449 serve the public, subject to standards that the government sets.
13450 </para>
13451 <para>
13452 In the context of registration, one obvious model is the Internet.
13453 There are at least 32 million Web sites registered around the world.
13454 Domain name owners for these Web sites have to pay a fee to keep their
13455 registration alive. In the main top-level domains (.com, .org, .net),
13456 there is a central registry. The actual registrations are, however,
13457 performed by many competing registrars. That competition drives the
13458 cost of registering down, and more importantly, it drives the ease
13459 with which registration occurs up.
13460 </para>
13461 <para>
13462 We should adopt a similar model for the registration and renewal of
13463 copyrights. The Copyright Office may well serve as the central
13464 registry, but it should not be in the registrar business. Instead, it
13465 should establish a database, and a set of standards for registrars. It
13466 should approve registrars that meet its standards. Those registrars
13467 would then compete with one another to deliver the cheapest and
13468 simplest systems for registering and renewing copyrights. That
13469 competition would substantially lower the burden of this
13470 formality&mdash;while producing a database
13471 <!-- PAGE BREAK 295 -->
13472 of registrations that would facilitate the licensing of content.
13473 </para>
13474
13475 </section>
13476 <section id="marking">
13477 <title>MARKING</title>
13478 <para>
13479 It used to be that the failure to include a copyright notice on a
13480 creative work meant that the copyright was forfeited. That was a harsh
13481 punishment for failing to comply with a regulatory rule&mdash;akin to
13482 imposing the death penalty for a parking ticket in the world of
13483 creative rights. Here again, there is no reason that a marking
13484 requirement needs to be enforced in this way. And more importantly,
13485 there is no reason a marking requirement needs to be enforced
13486 uniformly across all media.
13487 </para>
13488 <para>
13489 The aim of marking is to signal to the public that this work is
13490 copyrighted and that the author wants to enforce his rights. The mark
13491 also makes it easy to locate a copyright owner to secure permission to
13492 use the work.
13493 </para>
13494 <para>
13495 One of the problems the copyright system confronted early on was
13496 that different copyrighted works had to be differently marked. It wasn't
13497 clear how or where a statue was to be marked, or a record, or a film. A
13498 new marking requirement could solve these problems by recognizing
13499 the differences in media, and by allowing the system of marking to
13500 evolve as technologies enable it to. The system could enable a special
13501 signal from the failure to mark&mdash;not the loss of the copyright, but the
13502 loss of the right to punish someone for failing to get permission first.
13503 </para>
13504 <para>
13505 Let's start with the last point. If a copyright owner allows his work
13506 to be published without a copyright notice, the consequence of that
13507 failure need not be that the copyright is lost. The consequence could
13508 instead be that anyone has the right to use this work, until the
13509 copyright owner complains and demonstrates that it is his work and he
13510 doesn't give permission.<footnote><para>
13511 <!-- f2. -->
13512 There would be a complication with derivative works that I have not
13513 solved here. In my view, the law of derivatives creates a more complicated
13514 system than is justified by the marginal incentive it creates.
13515 </para></footnote>
13516 The meaning of an unmarked work would therefore be "use unless someone
13517 complains." If someone does complain, then the obligation would be to
13518 stop using the work in any new
13519 <!-- PAGE BREAK 296 -->
13520 work from then on though no penalty would attach for existing uses.
13521 This would create a strong incentive for copyright owners to mark
13522 their work.
13523 </para>
13524 <para>
13525 That in turn raises the question about how work should best be
13526 marked. Here again, the system needs to adjust as the technologies
13527 evolve. The best way to ensure that the system evolves is to limit the
13528 Copyright Office's role to that of approving standards for marking
13529 content that have been crafted elsewhere.
13530 </para>
13531 <para>
13532 For example, if a recording industry association devises a method for
13533 marking CDs, it would propose that to the Copyright Office. The
13534 Copyright Office would hold a hearing, at which other proposals could
13535 be made. The Copyright Office would then select the proposal that it
13536 judged preferable, and it would base that choice
13537 <emphasis>solely</emphasis> upon the consideration of which method
13538 could best be integrated into the registration and renewal system. We
13539 would not count on the government to innovate; but we would count on
13540 the government to keep the product of innovation in line with its
13541 other important functions.
13542 </para>
13543 <para>
13544 Finally, marking content clearly would simplify registration
13545 requirements. If photographs were marked by author and year, there
13546 would be little reason not to allow a photographer to reregister, for
13547 example, all photographs taken in a particular year in one quick
13548 step. The aim of the formality is not to burden the creator; the
13549 system itself should be kept as simple as possible.
13550 </para>
13551 <para>
13552 The objective of formalities is to make things clear. The existing
13553 system does nothing to make things clear. Indeed, it seems designed to
13554 make things unclear.
13555 </para>
13556 <para>
13557 If formalities such as registration were reinstated, one of the most
13558 difficult aspects of relying upon the public domain would be removed.
13559 It would be simple to identify what content is presumptively free; it
13560 would be simple to identify who controls the rights for a particular
13561 kind of content; it would be simple to assert those rights, and to renew
13562 that assertion at the appropriate time.
13563 </para>
13564
13565 <!-- PAGE BREAK 297 -->
13566 </section>
13567 </section>
13568 <section id="shortterms">
13569 <title>2. Shorter Terms</title>
13570 <para>
13571 The term of copyright has gone from fourteen years to ninety-five
13572 years for corporate authors, and life of the author plus seventy years for
13573 natural authors.
13574 </para>
13575 <para>
13576 In <citetitle>The Future of Ideas</citetitle>, I proposed a seventy-five-year term,
13577 granted in five-year increments with a requirement of renewal every
13578 five years. That seemed radical enough at the time. But after we lost
13579 <citetitle>Eldred</citetitle> v. <citetitle>Ashcroft</citetitle>, the proposals became even more
13580 radical. <citetitle>The Economist</citetitle> endorsed a proposal for a fourteen-year
13581 copyright term.<footnote><para>
13582
13583 <!-- f3. -->
13584 "A Radical Rethink," <citetitle>Economist</citetitle>, 366:8308 (25 January 2003): 15,
13585 available at
13586 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #74</ulink>.
13587 </para></footnote>
13588 Others have proposed tying the term to the term for patents.
13589 </para>
13590 <para>
13591 I agree with those who believe that we need a radical change in
13592 copyright's term. But whether fourteen years or seventy-five, there
13593 are four principles that are important to keep in mind about copyright
13594 terms.
13595 </para>
13596 <orderedlist numeration="arabic">
13597 <listitem><para>
13598 <!-- (1) -->
13599 <emphasis>Keep it short:</emphasis> The term should be as long as
13600 necessary to give incentives to create, but no longer. If it were tied
13601 to very strong protections for authors (so authors were able to
13602 reclaim rights from publishers), rights to the same work (not
13603 derivative works) might be extended further. The key is not to tie the
13604 work up with legal regulations when it no longer benefits an author.
13605 </para></listitem>
13606 <listitem><para>
13607 <!-- (2) -->
13608 <emphasis>Keep it simple:</emphasis> The line between the public
13609 domain and protected content must be kept clear. Lawyers like the
13610 fuzziness of "fair use," and the distinction between "ideas" and
13611 "expression." That kind of law gives them lots of work. But our
13612 framers had a simpler idea in mind: protected versus unprotected. The
13613 value of short terms is that there is little need to build exceptions
13614 into copyright when the term itself is kept short. A clear and active
13615 "lawyer-free zone" makes the complexities of "fair use" and
13616 "idea/expression" less necessary to navigate.
13617 <!-- PAGE BREAK 298 -->
13618 </para></listitem>
13619 <listitem><para>
13620 <!-- (3) -->
13621 <emphasis>Keep it alive:</emphasis> Copyright should have to be
13622 renewed. Especially if the maximum term is long, the copyright owner
13623 should be required to signal periodically that he wants the protection
13624 continued. This need not be an onerous burden, but there is no reason
13625 this monopoly protection has to be granted for free. On average, it
13626 takes ninety minutes for a veteran to apply for a
13627 pension.<footnote><para>
13628 <!-- f4. -->
13629 Department of Veterans Affairs, Veteran's Application for Compensation
13630 and/or Pension, VA Form 21-526 (OMB Approved No. 2900-0001),
13631 available at
13632 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #75</ulink>.
13633 </para></footnote>
13634 If we make veterans suffer that burden, I don't see why we couldn't
13635 require authors to spend ten minutes every fifty years to file a
13636 single form.
13637 <indexterm><primary>veterans' pensions</primary></indexterm>
13638 </para></listitem>
13639 <listitem><para>
13640 <!-- (4) -->
13641 <emphasis>Keep it prospective:</emphasis> Whatever the term of
13642 copyright should be, the clearest lesson that economists teach is that
13643 a term once given should not be extended. It might have been a mistake
13644 in 1923 for the law to offer authors only a fifty-six-year term. I
13645 don't think so, but it's possible. If it was a mistake, then the
13646 consequence was that we got fewer authors to create in 1923 than we
13647 otherwise would have. But we can't correct that mistake today by
13648 increasing the term. No matter what we do today, we will not increase
13649 the number of authors who wrote in 1923. Of course, we can increase
13650 the reward that those who write now get (or alternatively, increase
13651 the copyright burden that smothers many works that are today
13652 invisible). But increasing their reward will not increase their
13653 creativity in 1923. What's not done is not done, and there's nothing
13654 we can do about that now. </para></listitem>
13655 </orderedlist>
13656 <para>
13657 These changes together should produce an <emphasis>average</emphasis>
13658 copyright term that is much shorter than the current term. Until 1976,
13659 the average term was just 32.2 years. We should be aiming for the
13660 same.
13661 </para>
13662 <para>
13663 No doubt the extremists will call these ideas "radical." (After all, I
13664 call them "extremists.") But again, the term I recommended was longer
13665 than the term under Richard Nixon. How "radical" can it be to ask for
13666 a more generous copyright law than Richard Nixon presided over?
13667 </para>
13668
13669 <!-- PAGE BREAK 299 -->
13670
13671 </section>
13672 <section id="freefairuse">
13673 <title>3. Free Use Vs. Fair Use</title>
13674 <para>
13675 As I observed at the beginning of this book, property law originally
13676 granted property owners the right to control their property from the
13677 ground to the heavens. The airplane came along. The scope of property
13678 rights quickly changed. There was no fuss, no constitutional
13679 challenge. It made no sense anymore to grant that much control, given
13680 the emergence of that new technology.
13681 </para>
13682 <para>
13683 Our Constitution gives Congress the power to give authors "exclusive
13684 right" to "their writings." Congress has given authors an exclusive
13685 right to "their writings" plus any derivative writings (made by
13686 others) that are sufficiently close to the author's original
13687 work. Thus, if I write a book, and you base a movie on that book, I
13688 have the power to deny you the right to release that movie, even
13689 though that movie is not "my writing."
13690 </para>
13691 <para>
13692 Congress granted the beginnings of this right in 1870, when it
13693 expanded the exclusive right of copyright to include a right to
13694 control translations and dramatizations of a work.<footnote><para>
13695 <!-- f5. -->
13696 Benjamin Kaplan, <citetitle>An Unhurried View of Copyright</citetitle> (New York: Columbia
13697 University Press, 1967), 32.
13698 </para></footnote>
13699 The courts have expanded it slowly through judicial interpretation
13700 ever since. This expansion has been commented upon by one of the law's
13701 greatest judges, Judge Benjamin Kaplan.
13702 </para>
13703 <blockquote>
13704 <para>
13705 So inured have we become to the extension of the monopoly to a
13706 large range of so-called derivative works, that we no longer sense
13707 the oddity of accepting such an enlargement of copyright while
13708 yet intoning the abracadabra of idea and expression.<footnote><para>
13709 <!-- f6. --> Ibid., 56.
13710 </para></footnote>
13711 </para>
13712 </blockquote>
13713 <para>
13714 I think it's time to recognize that there are airplanes in this field and
13715 the expansiveness of these rights of derivative use no longer make
13716 sense. More precisely, they don't make sense for the period of time that
13717 a copyright runs. And they don't make sense as an amorphous grant.
13718 Consider each limitation in turn.
13719 </para>
13720 <para>
13721 <emphasis>Term:</emphasis> If Congress wants to grant a derivative
13722 right, then that right should be for a much shorter term. It makes
13723 sense to protect John
13724
13725 <!-- PAGE BREAK 300 -->
13726 Grisham's right to sell the movie rights to his latest novel (or at least
13727 I'm willing to assume it does); but it does not make sense for that right
13728 to run for the same term as the underlying copyright. The derivative
13729 right could be important in inducing creativity; it is not important long
13730 after the creative work is done.
13731 <indexterm><primary>Grisham, John</primary></indexterm>
13732 </para>
13733 <para>
13734 <emphasis>Scope:</emphasis> Likewise should the scope of derivative
13735 rights be narrowed. Again, there are some cases in which derivative
13736 rights are important. Those should be specified. But the law should
13737 draw clear lines around regulated and unregulated uses of copyrighted
13738 material. When all "reuse" of creative material was within the control
13739 of businesses, perhaps it made sense to require lawyers to negotiate
13740 the lines. It no longer makes sense for lawyers to negotiate the
13741 lines. Think about all the creative possibilities that digital
13742 technologies enable; now imagine pouring molasses into the
13743 machines. That's what this general requirement of permission does to
13744 the creative process. Smothers it.
13745 </para>
13746 <para>
13747 This was the point that Alben made when describing the making of the
13748 Clint Eastwood CD. While it makes sense to require negotiation for
13749 foreseeable derivative rights&mdash;turning a book into a movie, or a
13750 poem into a musical score&mdash;it doesn't make sense to require
13751 negotiation for the unforeseeable. Here, a statutory right would make
13752 much more sense.
13753 </para>
13754 <para>
13755 In each of these cases, the law should mark the uses that are
13756 protected, and the presumption should be that other uses are not
13757 protected. This is the reverse of the recommendation of my colleague
13758 Paul Goldstein.<footnote>
13759 <para>
13760 <!-- f7. -->
13761 Paul Goldstein, <citetitle>Copyright's Highway: From Gutenberg to the Celestial
13762 Jukebox</citetitle> (Stanford: Stanford University Press, 2003), 187&ndash;216.
13763 <indexterm><primary>Goldstein, Paul</primary></indexterm>
13764 </para></footnote>
13765 His view is that the law should be written so that
13766 expanded protections follow expanded uses.
13767 </para>
13768 <para>
13769 Goldstein's analysis would make perfect sense if the cost of the legal
13770 system were small. But as we are currently seeing in the context of
13771 the Internet, the uncertainty about the scope of protection, and the
13772 incentives to protect existing architectures of revenue, combined with
13773 a strong copyright, weaken the process of innovation.
13774 </para>
13775 <para>
13776 The law could remedy this problem either by removing protection
13777 <!-- PAGE BREAK 301 -->
13778 beyond the part explicitly drawn or by granting reuse rights upon
13779 certain statutory conditions. Either way, the effect would be to free
13780 a great deal of culture to others to cultivate. And under a statutory
13781 rights regime, that reuse would earn artists more income.
13782 </para>
13783 </section>
13784
13785 <section id="liberatemusic">
13786 <title>4. Liberate the Music&mdash;Again</title>
13787 <para>
13788 The battle that got this whole war going was about music, so it
13789 wouldn't be fair to end this book without addressing the issue that
13790 is, to most people, most pressing&mdash;music. There is no other
13791 policy issue that better teaches the lessons of this book than the
13792 battles around the sharing of music.
13793 </para>
13794 <para>
13795 The appeal of file-sharing music was the crack cocaine of the
13796 Internet's growth. It drove demand for access to the Internet more
13797 powerfully than any other single application. It was the Internet's
13798 killer app&mdash;possibly in two senses of that word. It no doubt was
13799 the application that drove demand for bandwidth. It may well be the
13800 application that drives demand for regulations that in the end kill
13801 innovation on the network.
13802 </para>
13803 <para>
13804 The aim of copyright, with respect to content in general and music in
13805 particular, is to create the incentives for music to be composed,
13806 performed, and, most importantly, spread. The law does this by giving
13807 an exclusive right to a composer to control public performances of his
13808 work, and to a performing artist to control copies of her performance.
13809 </para>
13810 <para>
13811 File-sharing networks complicate this model by enabling the
13812 spread of content for which the performer has not been paid. But of
13813 course, that's not all the file-sharing networks do. As I described in
13814 chapter 5, they enable four different kinds of sharing:
13815 </para>
13816 <orderedlist numeration="upperalpha">
13817 <listitem><para>
13818 <!-- A. -->
13819 There are some who are using sharing networks as substitutes
13820 for purchasing CDs.
13821 </para></listitem>
13822 <listitem><para>
13823 <!-- B. -->
13824 There are also some who are using sharing networks to sample,
13825 on the way to purchasing CDs.
13826 </para></listitem>
13827 <listitem><para>
13828 <!-- PAGE BREAK 302 -->
13829 <!-- C. -->
13830 There are many who are using file-sharing networks to get access to
13831 content that is no longer sold but is still under copyright or that
13832 would have been too cumbersome to buy off the Net.
13833 </para></listitem>
13834 <listitem><para>
13835 <!-- D. -->
13836 There are many who are using file-sharing networks to get access to
13837 content that is not copyrighted or to get access that the copyright
13838 owner plainly endorses.
13839 </para></listitem>
13840 </orderedlist>
13841 <para>
13842 Any reform of the law needs to keep these different uses in focus. It
13843 must avoid burdening type D even if it aims to eliminate type A. The
13844 eagerness with which the law aims to eliminate type A, moreover,
13845 should depend upon the magnitude of type B. As with VCRs, if the net
13846 effect of sharing is actually not very harmful, the need for regulation is
13847 significantly weakened.
13848 </para>
13849 <para>
13850 As I said in chapter 5, the actual harm caused by sharing is
13851 controversial. For the purposes of this chapter, however, I assume
13852 the harm is real. I assume, in other words, that type A sharing is
13853 significantly greater than type B, and is the dominant use of sharing
13854 networks.
13855 </para>
13856 <para>
13857 Nonetheless, there is a crucial fact about the current technological
13858 context that we must keep in mind if we are to understand how the law
13859 should respond.
13860 </para>
13861 <para>
13862 Today, file sharing is addictive. In ten years, it won't be. It is
13863 addictive today because it is the easiest way to gain access to a
13864 broad range of content. It won't be the easiest way to get access to
13865 a broad range of content in ten years. Today, access to the Internet
13866 is cumbersome and slow&mdash;we in the United States are lucky to have
13867 broadband service at 1.5 MBs, and very rarely do we get service at
13868 that speed both up and down. Although wireless access is growing, most
13869 of us still get access across wires. Most only gain access through a
13870 machine with a keyboard. The idea of the always on, always connected
13871 Internet is mainly just an idea.
13872 </para>
13873 <para>
13874 But it will become a reality, and that means the way we get access to
13875 the Internet today is a technology in transition. Policy makers should
13876 not make policy on the basis of technology in transition. They should
13877 <!-- PAGE BREAK 303 -->
13878 make policy on the basis of where the technology is going. The
13879 question should not be, how should the law regulate sharing in this
13880 world? The question should be, what law will we require when the
13881 network becomes the network it is clearly becoming? That network is
13882 one in which every machine with electricity is essentially on the Net;
13883 where everywhere you are&mdash;except maybe the desert or the
13884 Rockies&mdash;you can instantaneously be connected to the
13885 Internet. Imagine the Internet as ubiquitous as the best cell-phone
13886 service, where with the flip of a device, you are connected.
13887 </para>
13888 <para>
13889 In that world, it will be extremely easy to connect to services that
13890 give you access to content on the fly&mdash;such as Internet radio,
13891 content that is streamed to the user when the user demands. Here,
13892 then, is the critical point: When it is <emphasis>extremely</emphasis>
13893 easy to connect to services that give access to content, it will be
13894 <emphasis>easier</emphasis> to connect to services that give you
13895 access to content than it will be to download and store content
13896 <emphasis>on the many devices you will have for playing
13897 content</emphasis>. It will be easier, in other words, to subscribe
13898 than it will be to be a database manager, as everyone in the
13899 download-sharing world of Napster-like technologies essentially
13900 is. Content services will compete with content sharing, even if the
13901 services charge money for the content they give access to. Already
13902 cell-phone services in Japan offer music (for a fee) streamed over
13903 cell phones (enhanced with plugs for headphones). The Japanese are
13904 paying for this content even though "free" content is available in the
13905 form of MP3s across the Web.<footnote><para>
13906 <!-- f8. -->
13907 See, for example, "Music Media Watch," The J@pan Inc. Newsletter, 3
13908 April 2002, available at
13909 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #76</ulink>.
13910 </para></footnote>
13911
13912 </para>
13913 <para>
13914 This point about the future is meant to suggest a perspective on the
13915 present: It is emphatically temporary. The "problem" with file
13916 sharing&mdash;to the extent there is a real problem&mdash;is a problem
13917 that will increasingly disappear as it becomes easier to connect to
13918 the Internet. And thus it is an extraordinary mistake for policy
13919 makers today to be "solving" this problem in light of a technology
13920 that will be gone tomorrow. The question should not be how to
13921 regulate the Internet to eliminate file sharing (the Net will evolve
13922 that problem away). The question instead should be how to assure that
13923 artists get paid, during
13924
13925 <!-- PAGE BREAK 304 -->
13926 this transition between twentieth-century models for doing business
13927 and twenty-first-century technologies.
13928 </para>
13929 <para>
13930 The answer begins with recognizing that there are different "problems"
13931 here to solve. Let's start with type D content&mdash;uncopyrighted
13932 content or copyrighted content that the artist wants shared. The
13933 "problem" with this content is to make sure that the technology that
13934 would enable this kind of sharing is not rendered illegal. You can
13935 think of it this way: Pay phones are used to deliver ransom demands,
13936 no doubt. But there are many who need to use pay phones who have
13937 nothing to do with ransoms. It would be wrong to ban pay phones in
13938 order to eliminate kidnapping.
13939 </para>
13940 <para>
13941 Type C content raises a different "problem." This is content that was,
13942 at one time, published and is no longer available. It may be
13943 unavailable because the artist is no longer valuable enough for the
13944 record label he signed with to carry his work. Or it may be
13945 unavailable because the work is forgotten. Either way, the aim of the
13946 law should be to facilitate the access to this content, ideally in a
13947 way that returns something to the artist.
13948 </para>
13949 <para>
13950 Again, the model here is the used book store. Once a book goes out of
13951 print, it may still be available in libraries and used book
13952 stores. But libraries and used book stores don't pay the copyright
13953 owner when someone reads or buys an out-of-print book. That makes
13954 total sense, of course, since any other system would be so burdensome
13955 as to eliminate the possibility of used book stores' existing. But
13956 from the author's perspective, this "sharing" of his content without
13957 his being compensated is less than ideal.
13958 </para>
13959 <para>
13960 The model of used book stores suggests that the law could simply deem
13961 out-of-print music fair game. If the publisher does not make copies of
13962 the music available for sale, then commercial and noncommercial
13963 providers would be free, under this rule, to "share" that content,
13964 even though the sharing involved making a copy. The copy here would be
13965 incidental to the trade; in a context where commercial publishing has
13966 ended, trading music should be as free as trading books.
13967 </para>
13968 <para>
13969
13970 <!-- PAGE BREAK 305 -->
13971 Alternatively, the law could create a statutory license that would
13972 ensure that artists get something from the trade of their work. For
13973 example, if the law set a low statutory rate for the commercial
13974 sharing of content that was not offered for sale by a commercial
13975 publisher, and if that rate were automatically transferred to a trust
13976 for the benefit of the artist, then businesses could develop around
13977 the idea of trading this content, and artists would benefit from this
13978 trade.
13979 </para>
13980 <para>
13981 This system would also create an incentive for publishers to keep
13982 works available commercially. Works that are available commercially
13983 would not be subject to this license. Thus, publishers could protect
13984 the right to charge whatever they want for content if they kept the
13985 work commercially available. But if they don't keep it available, and
13986 instead, the computer hard disks of fans around the world keep it
13987 alive, then any royalty owed for such copying should be much less than
13988 the amount owed a commercial publisher.
13989 </para>
13990 <para>
13991 The hard case is content of types A and B, and again, this case is
13992 hard only because the extent of the problem will change over time, as
13993 the technologies for gaining access to content change. The law's
13994 solution should be as flexible as the problem is, understanding that
13995 we are in the middle of a radical transformation in the technology for
13996 delivering and accessing content.
13997 </para>
13998 <para>
13999 So here's a solution that will at first seem very strange to both sides
14000 in this war, but which upon reflection, I suggest, should make some sense.
14001 </para>
14002 <para>
14003 Stripped of the rhetoric about the sanctity of property, the basic
14004 claim of the content industry is this: A new technology (the Internet)
14005 has harmed a set of rights that secure copyright. If those rights are to
14006 be protected, then the content industry should be compensated for that
14007 harm. Just as the technology of tobacco harmed the health of millions
14008 of Americans, or the technology of asbestos caused grave illness to
14009 thousands of miners, so, too, has the technology of digital networks
14010 harmed the interests of the content industry.
14011 </para>
14012 <para>
14013 <!-- PAGE BREAK 306 -->
14014 I love the Internet, and so I don't like likening it to tobacco or
14015 asbestos. But the analogy is a fair one from the perspective of the
14016 law. And it suggests a fair response: Rather than seeking to destroy
14017 the Internet, or the p2p technologies that are currently harming
14018 content providers on the Internet, we should find a relatively simple
14019 way to compensate those who are harmed.
14020 </para>
14021 <para>
14022 The idea would be a modification of a proposal that has been
14023 floated by Harvard law professor William Fisher.<footnote>
14024 <para>
14025 <!-- f9. -->
14026 William Fisher, <citetitle>Digital Music: Problems and Possibilities</citetitle> (last
14027 revised: 10 October 2000), available at
14028 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #77</ulink>; William
14029 Fisher, <citetitle>Promises to Keep: Technology, Law, and the Future of
14030 Entertainment</citetitle> (forthcoming) (Stanford: Stanford University Press,
14031 2004), ch. 6, available at
14032 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #78</ulink>. Professor
14033 Netanel has proposed a related idea that would exempt noncommercial
14034 sharing from the reach of copyright and would establish compensation
14035 to artists to balance any loss. See Neil Weinstock Netanel, "Impose a
14036 Noncommercial Use Levy to Allow Free P2P File Sharing," available at
14037 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #79</ulink>. For other proposals, see Lawrence Lessig, "Who's Holding Back
14038 Broadband?" <citetitle>Washington Post</citetitle>, 8 January 2002, A17; Philip S. Corwin on
14039 behalf of Sharman Networks, A Letter to Senator Joseph R. Biden, Jr.,
14040 Chairman of the Senate Foreign Relations Committee, 26 February 2002,
14041 available at
14042 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #80</ulink>; Serguei Osokine, <citetitle>A Quick Case for Intellectual Property
14043 Use Fee (IPUF)</citetitle>, 3 March 2002, available at
14044 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #81</ulink>; Jefferson Graham,
14045 "Kazaa, Verizon Propose to Pay Artists Directly," <citetitle>USA Today</citetitle>, 13 May
14046 2002, available at
14047 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #82</ulink>; Steven M. Cherry, "Getting Copyright Right,"
14048 IEEE Spectrum Online, 1 July 2002, available at
14049 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #83</ulink>; Declan
14050 McCullagh, "Verizon's Copyright Campaign," CNET News.com, 27 August
14051 2002, available at
14052 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #84</ulink>.
14053 Fisher's proposal is very similar to Richard Stallman's proposal for
14054 DAT. Unlike Fisher's, Stallman's proposal would not pay artists directly
14055 proportionally, though more popular artists would get more than the less
14056 popular. As is typical with Stallman, his proposal predates the current
14057 debate by about a decade. See
14058 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #85</ulink>.
14059 <indexterm><primary>Netanel, Neil Weinstock</primary></indexterm>
14060 <indexterm><primary>Fisher, William</primary></indexterm>
14061 </para></footnote>
14062 Fisher suggests a very clever way around the current impasse of the
14063 Internet. Under his plan, all content capable of digital transmission
14064 would (1) be marked with a digital watermark (don't worry about how
14065 easy it is to evade these marks; as you'll see, there's no incentive
14066 to evade them). Once the content is marked, then entrepreneurs would
14067 develop (2) systems to monitor how many items of each content were
14068 distributed. On the basis of those numbers, then (3) artists would be
14069 compensated. The compensation would be paid for by (4) an appropriate
14070 tax.
14071 </para>
14072 <para>
14073 Fisher's proposal is careful and comprehensive. It raises a million
14074 questions, most of which he answers well in his upcoming book,
14075 <citetitle>Promises to Keep</citetitle>. The modification that I would make is relatively
14076 simple: Fisher imagines his proposal replacing the existing copyright
14077 system. I imagine it complementing the existing system. The aim of
14078 the proposal would be to facilitate compensation to the extent that
14079 harm could be shown. This compensation would be temporary, aimed at
14080 facilitating a transition between regimes. And it would require
14081 renewal after a period of years. If it continues to make sense to
14082 facilitate free exchange of content, supported through a taxation
14083 system, then it can be continued. If this form of protection is no
14084 longer necessary, then the system could lapse into the old system of
14085 controlling access.
14086 </para>
14087 <para>
14088 Fisher would balk at the idea of allowing the system to lapse. His aim
14089 is not just to ensure that artists are paid, but also to ensure that
14090 the system supports the widest range of "semiotic democracy"
14091 possible. But the aims of semiotic democracy would be satisfied if the
14092 other changes I described were accomplished&mdash;in particular, the
14093 limits on derivative
14094
14095 <!-- PAGE BREAK 307 -->
14096 uses. A system that simply charges for access would not greatly burden
14097 semiotic democracy if there were few limitations on what one was
14098 allowed to do with the content itself.
14099 </para>
14100 <para>
14101 No doubt it would be difficult to calculate the proper measure of
14102 "harm" to an industry. But the difficulty of making that calculation
14103 would be outweighed by the benefit of facilitating innovation. This
14104 background system to compensate would also not need to interfere with
14105 innovative proposals such as Apple's MusicStore. As experts predicted
14106 when Apple launched the MusicStore, it could beat "free" by being
14107 easier than free is. This has proven correct: Apple has sold millions
14108 of songs at even the very high price of 99 cents a song. (At 99 cents,
14109 the cost is the equivalent of a per-song CD price, though the labels
14110 have none of the costs of a CD to pay.) Apple's move was countered by
14111 Real Networks, offering music at just 79 cents a song. And no doubt
14112 there will be a great deal of competition to offer and sell music
14113 on-line.
14114 </para>
14115 <para>
14116 This competition has already occurred against the background of "free"
14117 music from p2p systems. As the sellers of cable television have known
14118 for thirty years, and the sellers of bottled water for much more than
14119 that, there is nothing impossible at all about "competing with free."
14120 Indeed, if anything, the competition spurs the competitors to offer
14121 new and better products. This is precisely what the competitive market
14122 was to be about. Thus in Singapore, though piracy is rampant, movie
14123 theaters are often luxurious&mdash;with "first class" seats, and meals
14124 served while you watch a movie&mdash;as they struggle and succeed in
14125 finding ways to compete with "free."
14126 </para>
14127 <para>
14128 This regime of competition, with a backstop to assure that artists
14129 don't lose, would facilitate a great deal of innovation in the
14130 delivery of content. That competition would continue to shrink type A
14131 sharing. It would inspire an extraordinary range of new
14132 innovators&mdash;ones who would have a right to the content, and would
14133 no longer fear the uncertain and barbarically severe punishments of
14134 the law.
14135 </para>
14136 <para>
14137 In summary, then, my proposal is this:
14138 </para>
14139 <para>
14140
14141 <!-- PAGE BREAK 308 -->
14142 The Internet is in transition. We should not be regulating a
14143 technology in transition. We should instead be regulating to minimize
14144 the harm to interests affected by this technological change, while
14145 enabling, and encouraging, the most efficient technology we can
14146 create.
14147 </para>
14148 <para>
14149 We can minimize that harm while maximizing the benefit to innovation
14150 by
14151 </para>
14152 <orderedlist numeration="arabic">
14153 <listitem><para>
14154 <!-- 1. -->
14155 guaranteeing the right to engage in type D sharing;
14156 </para></listitem>
14157 <listitem><para>
14158 <!-- 2. -->
14159 permitting noncommercial type C sharing without liability,
14160 and commercial type C sharing at a low and fixed rate set by
14161 statute;
14162 </para></listitem>
14163 <listitem><para>
14164 <!-- 3. -->
14165 while in this transition, taxing and compensating for type A
14166 sharing, to the extent actual harm is demonstrated.
14167 </para></listitem>
14168 </orderedlist>
14169 <para>
14170 But what if "piracy" doesn't disappear? What if there is a competitive
14171 market providing content at a low cost, but a significant number of
14172 consumers continue to "take" content for nothing? Should the law do
14173 something then?
14174 </para>
14175 <para>
14176 Yes, it should. But, again, what it should do depends upon how the
14177 facts develop. These changes may not eliminate type A sharing. But the
14178 real issue is not whether it eliminates sharing in the abstract. The
14179 real issue is its effect on the market. Is it better (a) to have a
14180 technology that is 95 percent secure and produces a market of size <citetitle>x</citetitle>,
14181 or (b) to have a technology that is 50 percent secure but produces a
14182 market of five times <citetitle>x</citetitle>? Less secure might produce more unauthorized
14183 sharing, but it is likely to also produce a much bigger market in
14184 authorized sharing. The most important thing is to assure artists'
14185 compensation without breaking the Internet. Once that's assured, then
14186 it may well be appropriate to find ways to track down the petty
14187 pirates.
14188 </para>
14189 <para>
14190 But we're a long way away from whittling the problem down to this
14191 subset of type A sharers. And our focus until we're there should not
14192 be on finding ways to break the Internet. Our focus until we're there
14193
14194 <!-- PAGE BREAK 309 -->
14195 should be on how to make sure the artists are paid, while protecting
14196 the space for innovation and creativity that the Internet is.
14197 </para>
14198 </section>
14199
14200 <section id="firelawyers">
14201 <title>5. Fire Lots of Lawyers</title>
14202 <para>
14203 I'm a lawyer. I make lawyers for a living. I believe in the law. I believe
14204 in the law of copyright. Indeed, I have devoted my life to working in
14205 law, not because there are big bucks at the end but because there are
14206 ideals at the end that I would love to live.
14207 </para>
14208 <para>
14209 Yet much of this book has been a criticism of lawyers, or the role
14210 lawyers have played in this debate. The law speaks to ideals, but it
14211 is my view that our profession has become too attuned to the
14212 client. And in a world where the rich clients have one strong view,
14213 the unwillingness of the profession to question or counter that one
14214 strong view queers the law.
14215 </para>
14216 <para>
14217 The evidence of this bending is compelling. I'm attacked as a
14218 "radical" by many within the profession, yet the positions that I am
14219 advocating are precisely the positions of some of the most moderate
14220 and significant figures in the history of this branch of the
14221 law. Many, for example, thought crazy the challenge that we brought to
14222 the Copyright Term Extension Act. Yet just thirty years ago, the
14223 dominant scholar and practitioner in the field of copyright, Melville
14224 Nimmer, thought it obvious.<footnote><para>
14225 <!-- f10. -->
14226 Lawrence Lessig, "Copyright's First Amendment" (Melville B. Nimmer
14227 Memorial Lecture), <citetitle>UCLA Law Review</citetitle> 48 (2001): 1057, 1069&ndash;70.
14228 </para></footnote>
14229
14230 </para>
14231 <para>
14232 However, my criticism of the role that lawyers have played in this
14233 debate is not just about a professional bias. It is more importantly
14234 about our failure to actually reckon the costs of the law.
14235 </para>
14236 <para>
14237 Economists are supposed to be good at reckoning costs and benefits.
14238 But more often than not, economists, with no clue about how the legal
14239 system actually functions, simply assume that the transaction costs of
14240 the legal system are slight.<footnote><para>
14241 <!-- f11. -->
14242 A good example is the work of Professor Stan Liebowitz. Liebowitz is
14243 to be commended for his careful review of data about infringement,
14244 leading him to question his own publicly stated
14245 position&mdash;twice. He initially predicted that downloading would
14246 substantially harm the industry. He then revised his view in light of
14247 the data, and he has since revised his view again. Compare Stan
14248 J. Liebowitz, <citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy: The True Forces That
14249 Drive the Digital Marketplace</citetitle> (New York: Amacom, 2002), (reviewing his
14250 original view but expressing skepticism) with Stan J. Liebowitz,
14251 "Will MP3s Annihilate the Record Industry?" working paper, June 2003,
14252 available at
14253 <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #86</ulink>.
14254 Liebowitz's careful analysis is extremely valuable in estimating the
14255 effect of file-sharing technology. In my view, however, he
14256 underestimates the costs of the legal system. See, for example,
14257 <citetitle>Rethinking</citetitle>, 174&ndash;76.
14258 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan</primary></indexterm>
14259 </para></footnote>
14260 They see a system that has been around for hundreds of years, and they
14261 assume it works the way their elementary school civics class taught
14262 them it works.
14263 </para>
14264 <para>
14265 <!-- PAGE BREAK 310 -->
14266 But the legal system doesn't work. Or more accurately, it doesn't work
14267 for anyone except those with the most resources. Not because the
14268 system is corrupt. I don't think our legal system (at the federal
14269 level, at least) is at all corrupt. I mean simply because the costs of
14270 our legal system are so astonishingly high that justice can
14271 practically never be done.
14272 </para>
14273 <para>
14274 These costs distort free culture in many ways. A lawyer's time is
14275 billed at the largest firms at more than $400 per hour. How much time
14276 should such a lawyer spend reading cases carefully, or researching
14277 obscure strands of authority? The answer is the increasing reality:
14278 very little. The law depended upon the careful articulation and
14279 development of doctrine, but the careful articulation and development
14280 of legal doctrine depends upon careful work. Yet that careful work
14281 costs too much, except in the most high-profile and costly cases.
14282 </para>
14283 <para>
14284 The costliness and clumsiness and randomness of this system mock
14285 our tradition. And lawyers, as well as academics, should consider it
14286 their duty to change the way the law works&mdash;or better, to change the
14287 law so that it works. It is wrong that the system works well only for the
14288 top 1 percent of the clients. It could be made radically more efficient,
14289 and inexpensive, and hence radically more just.
14290 </para>
14291 <para>
14292 But until that reform is complete, we as a society should keep the law
14293 away from areas that we know it will only harm. And that is precisely
14294 what the law will too often do if too much of our culture is left to
14295 its review.
14296 </para>
14297 <para>
14298 Think about the amazing things your kid could do or make with digital
14299 technology&mdash;the film, the music, the Web page, the blog. Or think
14300 about the amazing things your community could facilitate with digital
14301 technology&mdash;a wiki, a barn raising, activism to change something.
14302 Think about all those creative things, and then imagine cold molasses
14303 poured onto the machines. This is what any regime that requires
14304 permission produces. Again, this is the reality of Brezhnev's Russia.
14305 </para>
14306 <para>
14307 The law should regulate in certain areas of culture&mdash;but it should
14308 regulate culture only where that regulation does good. Yet lawyers
14309
14310 <!-- PAGE BREAK 311 -->
14311 rarely test their power, or the power they promote, against this
14312 simple pragmatic question: "Will it do good?" When challenged about
14313 the expanding reach of the law, the lawyer answers, "Why not?"
14314 </para>
14315 <para>
14316 We should ask, "Why?" Show me why your regulation of culture is
14317 needed. Show me how it does good. And until you can show me both,
14318 keep your lawyers away.
14319 </para>
14320 <!-- PAGE BREAK 312 -->
14321 </section>
14322 </section>
14323 </partintro>
14324 <chapter><title></title><para></para></chapter>
14325 </part>
14326 <chapter id="c-notes">
14327 <title>NOTES</title>
14328 <para>
14329 Throughout this text, there are references to links on the World Wide
14330 Web. As anyone who has tried to use the Web knows, these links can be
14331 highly unstable. I have tried to remedy the instability by redirecting
14332 readers to the original source through the Web site associated with
14333 this book. For each link below, you can go to
14334 http://free-culture.cc/notes and locate the original source by
14335 clicking on the number after the # sign. If the original link remains
14336 alive, you will be redirected to that link. If the original link has
14337 disappeared, you will be redirected to an appropriate reference for
14338 the material.
14339 </para>
14340 <!-- PAGE BREAK 336 -->
14341
14342 </chapter>
14343 <chapter id="c-acknowledgments">
14344 <title>ACKNOWLEDGMENTS</title>
14345 <para>
14346 This book is the product of a long and as yet unsuccessful struggle that
14347 began when I read of Eric Eldred's war to keep books free. Eldred's
14348 work helped launch a movement, the free culture movement, and it is
14349 to him that this book is dedicated.
14350 </para>
14351 <para>
14352 I received guidance in various places from friends and academics,
14353 including Glenn Brown, Peter DiCola, Jennifer Mnookin, Richard Posner,
14354 Mark Rose, and Kathleen Sullivan. And I received correction and
14355 guidance from many amazing students at Stanford Law School and
14356 Stanford University. They included Andrew B. Coan, John Eden, James
14357 P. Fellers, Christopher Guzelian, Erica Goldberg, Robert Hallman,
14358 Andrew Harris, Matthew Kahn, Brian Link, Ohad Mayblum, Alina Ng, and
14359 Erica Platt. I am particularly grateful to Catherine Crump and Harry
14360 Surden, who helped direct their research, and to Laura Lynch, who
14361 brilliantly managed the army that they assembled, and provided her own
14362 critical eye on much of this.
14363 </para>
14364 <para>
14365 Yuko Noguchi helped me to understand the laws of Japan as well as
14366 its culture. I am thankful to her, and to the many in Japan who helped
14367 me prepare this book: Joi Ito, Takayuki Matsutani, Naoto Misaki,
14368 Michihiro Sasaki, Hiromichi Tanaka, Hiroo Yamagata, and Yoshihiro
14369 <!-- PAGE BREAK 337 -->
14370 Yonezawa. I am thankful as well as to Professor Nobuhiro Nakayama,
14371 and the Tokyo University Business Law Center, for giving me the
14372 chance to spend time in Japan, and to Tadashi Shiraishi and Kiyokazu
14373 Yamagami for their generous help while I was there.
14374 </para>
14375 <para>
14376 These are the traditional sorts of help that academics regularly draw
14377 upon. But in addition to them, the Internet has made it possible to
14378 receive advice and correction from many whom I have never even
14379 met. Among those who have responded with extremely helpful advice to
14380 requests on my blog about the book are Dr. Mohammad Al-Ubaydli, David
14381 Gerstein, and Peter DiMauro, as well as a long list of those who had
14382 specific ideas about ways to develop my argument. They included
14383 Richard Bondi, Steven Cherry, David Coe, Nik Cubrilovic, Bob Devine,
14384 Charles Eicher, Thomas Guida, Elihu M. Gerson, Jeremy Hunsinger,
14385 Vaughn Iverson, John Karabaic, Jeff Keltner, James Lindenschmidt,
14386 K. L. Mann, Mark Manning, Nora McCauley, Jeffrey McHugh, Evan
14387 McMullen, Fred Norton, John Pormann, Pedro A. D. Rezende, Shabbir
14388 Safdar, Saul Schleimer, Clay Shirky, Adam Shostack, Kragen Sitaker,
14389 Chris Smith, Bruce Steinberg, Andrzej Jan Taramina, Sean Walsh, Matt
14390 Wasserman, Miljenko Williams, "Wink," Roger Wood, "Ximmbo da Jazz,"
14391 and Richard Yanco. (I apologize if I have missed anyone; with
14392 computers come glitches, and a crash of my e-mail system meant I lost
14393 a bunch of great replies.)
14394 </para>
14395 <para>
14396 Richard Stallman and Michael Carroll each read the whole book in
14397 draft, and each provided extremely helpful correction and advice.
14398 Michael helped me to see more clearly the significance of the
14399 regulation of derivitive works. And Richard corrected an
14400 embarrassingly large number of errors. While my work is in part
14401 inspired by Stallman's, he does not agree with me in important places
14402 throughout this book.
14403 </para>
14404 <para>
14405 Finally, and forever, I am thankful to Bettina, who has always
14406 insisted that there would be unending happiness away from these
14407 battles, and who has always been right. This slow learner is, as ever,
14408 grateful for her perpetual patience and love.
14409 </para>
14410 <!-- PAGE BREAK 338 -->
14411
14412 </chapter>
14413 </book>